* server.c (handle_query) <qSupported>: Do two passes over the
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
... / ...
CommitLineData
1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2@c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
6@c %**start of header
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24@syncodeindex tp cp
25
26@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
27@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
28@syncodeindex vr cp
29@syncodeindex fn cp
30
31@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
32@c This is updated by GNU Press.
33@set EDITION Ninth
34
35@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
36@set EDITOR /bin/ex
37
38@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
39
40@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
41@c manuals to an info tree.
42@dircategory Software development
43@direntry
44* Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
45@end direntry
46
47@copying
48Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
491998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
50Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51
52Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
53under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
54any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
55Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
56Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
57and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
58
59(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
60this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
61developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
62@end copying
63
64@ifnottex
65This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
66
67This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
68@value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
69@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
70@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
71@end ifset
72Version @value{GDBVN}.
73
74@insertcopying
75@end ifnottex
76
77@titlepage
78@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
79@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
80@sp 1
81@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
82@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
83@sp 1
84@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
85@end ifset
86@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
87@page
88@tex
89{\parskip=0pt
90\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
91\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
92\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
93}
94@end tex
95
96@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
97Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9851 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
101
102@insertcopying
103@page
104This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
105Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
106software in general. We will miss him.
107@end titlepage
108@page
109
110@ifnottex
111@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120@end ifset
121Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123Copyright (C) 1988-2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127software in general. We will miss him.
128
129@menu
130* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137* Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138* Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139* Stack:: Examining the stack
140* Source:: Examining source files
141* Data:: Examining data
142* Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150* Altering:: Altering execution
151* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156* Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157* Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162* JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163
164* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
165
166* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
167* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
168* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
169* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
170* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
171* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
172* Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
173* Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
174 @value{GDBN}
175* Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
176 the operating system
177* Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
178* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
179 how you can copy and share GDB
180* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
181* Index:: Index
182@end menu
183
184@end ifnottex
185
186@contents
187
188@node Summary
189@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
190
191The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
192going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
193program was doing at the moment it crashed.
194
195@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
196these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
197
198@itemize @bullet
199@item
200Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
201
202@item
203Make your program stop on specified conditions.
204
205@item
206Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
207
208@item
209Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
210effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
211@end itemize
212
213You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
214For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
215For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
216
217Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
218@ref{D,,D}.
219
220@cindex Modula-2
221Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
222@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
223
224@cindex Pascal
225Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
226nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
227entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
228syntax.
229
230@cindex Fortran
231@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
232it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
233underscore.
234
235@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
236using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
237
238@menu
239* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
240* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
241@end menu
242
243@node Free Software
244@unnumberedsec Free Software
245
246@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
247General Public License
248(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
249program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
250freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
251the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
252Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
253Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
254
255Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
256you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
257from anyone else.
258
259@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
260
261The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
262the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
263include with the free software. Many of our most important
264programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
265texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
266when an important free software package does not come with a free
267manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
268gaps today.
269
270Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
271normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
272authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
273copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
274them from the free software world.
275
276That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
277from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
278manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
279only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
280contract to make it non-free.
281
282Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
283price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
284charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
285Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
286problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
287are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
288modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
289
290The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
291free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
292commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
293accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
294
295Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
296When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
297are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
298provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
299manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
300a changed version of the program is not really available to our
301community.
302
303Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
304acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
305author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
306authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
307to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
308may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
309with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
310are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
311of the manual.
312
313However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
314content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
315media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
316obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
317manual to replace it.
318
319Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
320lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
321free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
322the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
323realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
324the free software community.
325
326If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
327the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
328license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
329don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
330will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
331option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
332what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
333try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
334is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
335
336You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
337manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
338copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
339improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
340at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
341and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
342Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
343have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
344
345The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
346published by other publishers, at
347@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
348
349@node Contributors
350@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
351
352Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
353other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
354development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
355of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
356to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
357file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
358blow-by-blow account.
359
360Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
361
362@quotation
363@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
364or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
365omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
366@end quotation
367
368So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
369particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
370releases:
371Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
372Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
373Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
374Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
375Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
376Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
377John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
378Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
379and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
380
381Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
382Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
383
384Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
385in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
386Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
387demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
388much general update work leading to release 3.0).
389
390@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
391object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
392Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
393
394David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
395the original support for encapsulated COFF.
396
397Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
398
399Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
400Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
401support.
402Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
403Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
404Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
405David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
406Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
407Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
408Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
409Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
410Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
411Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
412Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
413Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
414Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
415Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
416Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
417Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
418
419Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
420
421Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
422libraries.
423
424Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
425about several machine instruction sets.
426
427Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
428remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
429contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
430and RDI targets, respectively.
431
432Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
433command-line editing and command history.
434
435Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
436Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
437
438Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
439He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
440symbols.
441
442Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
443H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
444
445NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
446
447Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
448processors.
449
450Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
451
452Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
453
454Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
455
456Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
457watchpoints.
458
459Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
460
461Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
462
463Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
464nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
465
466The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
467support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
468(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
469compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
470Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
471Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
472provided HP-specific information in this manual.
473
474DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
475Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
476
477Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
478development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
479fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
480Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
481Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
482Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
483Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
484addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
485JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
486Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
487Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
488Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
489Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
490Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
491Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
492
493Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
494Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
495
496Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
497Hat.
498
499Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
500people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
501Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
502Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
503Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
504with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
505
506Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
507unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
508frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
509Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
510libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
511trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
512complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
513Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
514Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
515Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
516Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
517Weigand.
518
519Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
520Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
521who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
522Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
523
524Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
525Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
526
527@node Sample Session
528@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
529
530You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
531However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
532debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
533
534@iftex
535In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
536to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
537@end iftex
538
539@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
540@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
541
542One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
543processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
544quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
545definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
546session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
547then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
548same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
549@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
550procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
551
552@smallexample
553$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
554$ @b{./m4}
555@b{define(foo,0000)}
556
557@b{foo}
5580000
559@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
560
561@b{bar}
5620000
563@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
564
565@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
566@b{baz}
567@b{Ctrl-d}
568m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
569@end smallexample
570
571@noindent
572Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
573
574@smallexample
575$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
576@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
577@c FIXME... format to come out better.
578@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
579 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
580 the conditions.
581There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
582 for details.
583
584@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
585(@value{GDBP})
586@end smallexample
587
588@noindent
589@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
590rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
591We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
592that examples fit in this manual.
593
594@smallexample
595(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
596@end smallexample
597
598@noindent
599We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
600Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
601@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
602@code{break} command.
603
604@smallexample
605(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
606Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
607@end smallexample
608
609@noindent
610Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
611control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
612subroutine, the program runs as usual:
613
614@smallexample
615(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
616Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
617@b{define(foo,0000)}
618
619@b{foo}
6200000
621@end smallexample
622
623@noindent
624To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
625suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
626context where it stops.
627
628@smallexample
629@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
630
631Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
632 at builtin.c:879
633879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
634@end smallexample
635
636@noindent
637Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
638the next line of the current function.
639
640@smallexample
641(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
642882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
643 : nil,
644@end smallexample
645
646@noindent
647@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
648by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
649@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
650subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
651
652@smallexample
653(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
654set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
655 at input.c:530
656530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
657@end smallexample
658
659@noindent
660The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
661suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
662shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
663command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
664in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
665stack frame for each active subroutine.
666
667@smallexample
668(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
669#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
670 at input.c:530
671#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
672 at builtin.c:882
673#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
674#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
675 at macro.c:71
676#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
677#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
678@end smallexample
679
680@noindent
681We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
682times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
683falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
684
685@smallexample
686(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6870x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
688(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6890x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
690def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
691(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
692536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
693 : xstrdup(rq);
694(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
695538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
696@end smallexample
697
698@noindent
699The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
700@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
701and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
702(@code{print}) to see their values.
703
704@smallexample
705(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
706$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
707(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
708$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
709@end smallexample
710
711@noindent
712@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
713To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
714surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
715
716@smallexample
717(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
718533 xfree(rquote);
719534
720535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
721 : xstrdup (lq);
722536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
723 : xstrdup (rq);
724537
725538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
726539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
727540 @}
728541
729542 void
730@end smallexample
731
732@noindent
733Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
734@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
735
736@smallexample
737(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
738539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
739(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
740540 @}
741(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
742$3 = 9
743(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
744$4 = 7
745@end smallexample
746
747@noindent
748That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
749@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
750@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
751the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
752any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
753assignments.
754
755@smallexample
756(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
757$5 = 7
758(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
759$6 = 9
760@end smallexample
761
762@noindent
763Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
764@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
765executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
766example that caused trouble initially:
767
768@smallexample
769(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
770Continuing.
771
772@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
773
774baz
7750000
776@end smallexample
777
778@noindent
779Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
780problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
781lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
782
783@smallexample
784@b{Ctrl-d}
785Program exited normally.
786@end smallexample
787
788@noindent
789The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
790indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
791session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
792
793@smallexample
794(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
795@end smallexample
796
797@node Invocation
798@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
799
800This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
801The essentials are:
802@itemize @bullet
803@item
804type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
805@item
806type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
807@end itemize
808
809@menu
810* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
811* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
812* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
813* Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
814@end menu
815
816@node Invoking GDB
817@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
818
819Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
820@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
821
822You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
823to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
824
825The command-line options described here are designed
826to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
827options may effectively be unavailable.
828
829The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
830specifying an executable program:
831
832@smallexample
833@value{GDBP} @var{program}
834@end smallexample
835
836@noindent
837You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
838specified:
839
840@smallexample
841@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
842@end smallexample
843
844You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
845to debug a running process:
846
847@smallexample
848@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
849@end smallexample
850
851@noindent
852would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
853named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
854
855Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
856complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
857debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
858``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
859will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
860
861You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
862executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
863option processing.
864@smallexample
865@value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
866@end smallexample
867This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
868@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
869
870You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
871@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
872
873@smallexample
874@value{GDBP} -silent
875@end smallexample
876
877@noindent
878You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
879options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
880
881@noindent
882Type
883
884@smallexample
885@value{GDBP} -help
886@end smallexample
887
888@noindent
889to display all available options and briefly describe their use
890(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
891
892All options and command line arguments you give are processed
893in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
894@samp{-x} option is used.
895
896
897@menu
898* File Options:: Choosing files
899* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
900* Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
901@end menu
902
903@node File Options
904@subsection Choosing Files
905
906When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
907specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
908the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
909@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
910first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
911equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
912second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
913equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
914If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
915first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
916to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
917a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
918prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
919
920If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
921such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
922argument and ignore it.
923
924Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
925following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
926them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
927(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
928than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
929
930@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
931@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
932@c it.
933
934@table @code
935@item -symbols @var{file}
936@itemx -s @var{file}
937@cindex @code{--symbols}
938@cindex @code{-s}
939Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
940
941@item -exec @var{file}
942@itemx -e @var{file}
943@cindex @code{--exec}
944@cindex @code{-e}
945Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
946and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
947
948@item -se @var{file}
949@cindex @code{--se}
950Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
951file.
952
953@item -core @var{file}
954@itemx -c @var{file}
955@cindex @code{--core}
956@cindex @code{-c}
957Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
958
959@item -pid @var{number}
960@itemx -p @var{number}
961@cindex @code{--pid}
962@cindex @code{-p}
963Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
964
965@item -command @var{file}
966@itemx -x @var{file}
967@cindex @code{--command}
968@cindex @code{-x}
969Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
970evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
971@xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
972
973@item -eval-command @var{command}
974@itemx -ex @var{command}
975@cindex @code{--eval-command}
976@cindex @code{-ex}
977Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
978
979This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
980also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
981
982@smallexample
983@value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
984 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
985@end smallexample
986
987@item -directory @var{directory}
988@itemx -d @var{directory}
989@cindex @code{--directory}
990@cindex @code{-d}
991Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
992
993@item -r
994@itemx -readnow
995@cindex @code{--readnow}
996@cindex @code{-r}
997Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
998the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
999This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1000
1001@end table
1002
1003@node Mode Options
1004@subsection Choosing Modes
1005
1006You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1007batch mode or quiet mode.
1008
1009@table @code
1010@item -nx
1011@itemx -n
1012@cindex @code{--nx}
1013@cindex @code{-n}
1014Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1015@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1016options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1017Files}.
1018
1019@item -quiet
1020@itemx -silent
1021@itemx -q
1022@cindex @code{--quiet}
1023@cindex @code{--silent}
1024@cindex @code{-q}
1025``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1026messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1027
1028@item -batch
1029@cindex @code{--batch}
1030Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1031command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1032initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1033nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1034in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination;
1035@pxref{Screen Size} and acts as if @kbd{set confirm off} were in
1036effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1037
1038Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1039example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1040make this more useful, the message
1041
1042@smallexample
1043Program exited normally.
1044@end smallexample
1045
1046@noindent
1047(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1048@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1049mode.
1050
1051@item -batch-silent
1052@cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1053Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1054@value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1055unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1056for an interactive session.
1057
1058This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1059messages, for example.
1060
1061Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1062writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1063
1064@item -return-child-result
1065@cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1066The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1067process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1068
1069@itemize @bullet
1070@item
1071@value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1072internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1073without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1074@item
1075The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1076@item
1077The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1078the exit code will be -1.
1079@end itemize
1080
1081This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1082when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1083interface.
1084
1085@item -nowindows
1086@itemx -nw
1087@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1088@cindex @code{-nw}
1089``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1090(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1091interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1092
1093@item -windows
1094@itemx -w
1095@cindex @code{--windows}
1096@cindex @code{-w}
1097If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1098used if possible.
1099
1100@item -cd @var{directory}
1101@cindex @code{--cd}
1102Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1103instead of the current directory.
1104
1105@item -fullname
1106@itemx -f
1107@cindex @code{--fullname}
1108@cindex @code{-f}
1109@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1110subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1111number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1112displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1113recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1114the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1115and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1116@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1117frame.
1118
1119@item -epoch
1120@cindex @code{--epoch}
1121The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1122@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1123routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1124separate window.
1125
1126@item -annotate @var{level}
1127@cindex @code{--annotate}
1128This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1129effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1130(@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1131information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1132expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1133normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1134@sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1135that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1136
1137The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1138(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1139
1140@item --args
1141@cindex @code{--args}
1142Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1143executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1144This option stops option processing.
1145
1146@item -baud @var{bps}
1147@itemx -b @var{bps}
1148@cindex @code{--baud}
1149@cindex @code{-b}
1150Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1151interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1152
1153@item -l @var{timeout}
1154@cindex @code{-l}
1155Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1156for remote debugging.
1157
1158@item -tty @var{device}
1159@itemx -t @var{device}
1160@cindex @code{--tty}
1161@cindex @code{-t}
1162Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1163@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1164
1165@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1166@item -tui
1167@cindex @code{--tui}
1168Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1169Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1170source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1171(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1172Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1173@samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1174Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1175
1176@c @item -xdb
1177@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1178@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1179@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1180@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1181@c systems.
1182
1183@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1184@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1185Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1186program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1187communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1188@xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1189
1190@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1191@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1192The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1193previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1194selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1195@sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1196
1197@item -write
1198@cindex @code{--write}
1199Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1200is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1201(@pxref{Patching}).
1202
1203@item -statistics
1204@cindex @code{--statistics}
1205This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1206memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1207
1208@item -version
1209@cindex @code{--version}
1210This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1211no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1212
1213@end table
1214
1215@node Startup
1216@subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1217@cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1218
1219Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1220
1221@enumerate
1222@item
1223Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1224(@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1225
1226@item
1227@cindex init file
1228Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1229used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1230 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1231that file.
1232
1233@item
1234Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1235DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1236@code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1237that file.
1238
1239@item
1240Processes command line options and operands.
1241
1242@item
1243Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1244working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1245different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1246init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1247to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1248@value{GDBN}.
1249
1250@item
1251Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1252Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1253
1254@item
1255Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1256@xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1257files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1258@end enumerate
1259
1260Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1261Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1262file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1263complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1264and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1265option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1266
1267To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1268can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1269
1270@cindex init file name
1271@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1272@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1273The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1274The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1275the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1276ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1277@file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1278the file to the standard name.
1279
1280
1281@node Quitting GDB
1282@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1283@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1284@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1285
1286@table @code
1287@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1288@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1289@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1290@itemx q
1291To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1292@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1293do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1294otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1295error code.
1296@end table
1297
1298@cindex interrupt
1299An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1300terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1301returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1302character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1303until a time when it is safe.
1304
1305If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1306device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1307(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1308
1309@node Shell Commands
1310@section Shell Commands
1311
1312If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1313debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1314just use the @code{shell} command.
1315
1316@table @code
1317@kindex shell
1318@cindex shell escape
1319@item shell @var{command string}
1320Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1321If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1322shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1323(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1324@end table
1325
1326The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1327You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1328@value{GDBN}:
1329
1330@table @code
1331@kindex make
1332@cindex calling make
1333@item make @var{make-args}
1334Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1335arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1336@end table
1337
1338@node Logging Output
1339@section Logging Output
1340@cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1341@cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1342
1343You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1344There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1345
1346@table @code
1347@kindex set logging
1348@item set logging on
1349Enable logging.
1350@item set logging off
1351Disable logging.
1352@cindex logging file name
1353@item set logging file @var{file}
1354Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1355@item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1356By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1357you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1358@item set logging redirect [on|off]
1359By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1360Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1361@kindex show logging
1362@item show logging
1363Show the current values of the logging settings.
1364@end table
1365
1366@node Commands
1367@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1368
1369You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1370name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1371@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1372key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1373show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1374
1375@menu
1376* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1377* Completion:: Command completion
1378* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1379@end menu
1380
1381@node Command Syntax
1382@section Command Syntax
1383
1384A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1385how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1386arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1387command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1388step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1389with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1390
1391@cindex abbreviation
1392@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1393unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1394documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1395abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1396equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1397names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1398arguments to the @code{help} command.
1399
1400@cindex repeating commands
1401@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1402A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1403repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1404will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1405repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1406repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1407@ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1408
1409The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1410@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1411exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1412
1413@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1414output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1415(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1416@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1417repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1418
1419@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1420@cindex comment
1421Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1422nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1423Files,,Command Files}).
1424
1425@cindex repeating command sequences
1426@kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1427The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1428commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1429then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1430for editing.
1431
1432@node Completion
1433@section Command Completion
1434
1435@cindex completion
1436@cindex word completion
1437@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1438only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1439are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1440commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1441
1442Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1443of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1444word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1445enter it). For example, if you type
1446
1447@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1448@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1449@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1450@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1451@smallexample
1452(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1453@end smallexample
1454
1455@noindent
1456@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1457the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1458
1459@smallexample
1460(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1461@end smallexample
1462
1463@noindent
1464You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1465breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1466@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1467were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1468might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1469to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1470
1471If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1472@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1473characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1474@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1475example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1476begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1477just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1478function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1479example:
1480
1481@smallexample
1482(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1483@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1484make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1485make_abs_section make_function_type
1486make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1487make_cleanup make_reference_type
1488make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1489(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1490@end smallexample
1491
1492@noindent
1493After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1494partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1495command.
1496
1497If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1498can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1499means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1500key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1501one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1502
1503@cindex quotes in commands
1504@cindex completion of quoted strings
1505Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1506parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1507its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1508situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1509@value{GDBN} commands.
1510
1511The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1512name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1513overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1514by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1515may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1516that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1517that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1518word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1519@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1520@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1521when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1522
1523@smallexample
1524(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1525bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1526(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1527@end smallexample
1528
1529In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1530quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1531completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1532place:
1533
1534@smallexample
1535(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1536@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1537(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1538@end smallexample
1539
1540@noindent
1541In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1542you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1543completion on an overloaded symbol.
1544
1545For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1546Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1547overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1548see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1549
1550@cindex completion of structure field names
1551@cindex structure field name completion
1552@cindex completion of union field names
1553@cindex union field name completion
1554When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1555structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1556confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1557examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1558limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1559left-hand-side:
1560
1561@smallexample
1562(@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1563magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1564to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1565@end smallexample
1566
1567@noindent
1568This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1569@code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1570follows:
1571
1572@smallexample
1573struct ui_file
1574@{
1575 int *magic;
1576 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1577 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1578 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1579 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1580 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1581 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1582 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1583 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1584 void *to_data;
1585@}
1586@end smallexample
1587
1588
1589@node Help
1590@section Getting Help
1591@cindex online documentation
1592@kindex help
1593
1594You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1595using the command @code{help}.
1596
1597@table @code
1598@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1599@item help
1600@itemx h
1601You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1602display a short list of named classes of commands:
1603
1604@smallexample
1605(@value{GDBP}) help
1606List of classes of commands:
1607
1608aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1609breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1610data -- Examining data
1611files -- Specifying and examining files
1612internals -- Maintenance commands
1613obscure -- Obscure features
1614running -- Running the program
1615stack -- Examining the stack
1616status -- Status inquiries
1617support -- Support facilities
1618tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1619 stopping the program
1620user-defined -- User-defined commands
1621
1622Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1623commands in that class.
1624Type "help" followed by command name for full
1625documentation.
1626Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1627(@value{GDBP})
1628@end smallexample
1629@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1630
1631@item help @var{class}
1632Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1633list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1634help display for the class @code{status}:
1635
1636@smallexample
1637(@value{GDBP}) help status
1638Status inquiries.
1639
1640List of commands:
1641
1642@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1643@c to fit in smallbook page size.
1644info -- Generic command for showing things
1645 about the program being debugged
1646show -- Generic command for showing things
1647 about the debugger
1648
1649Type "help" followed by command name for full
1650documentation.
1651Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1652(@value{GDBP})
1653@end smallexample
1654
1655@item help @var{command}
1656With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1657short paragraph on how to use that command.
1658
1659@kindex apropos
1660@item apropos @var{args}
1661The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1662commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1663@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1664
1665@smallexample
1666apropos reload
1667@end smallexample
1668
1669@noindent
1670results in:
1671
1672@smallexample
1673@c @group
1674set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1675 multiple times in one run
1676show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1677 multiple times in one run
1678@c @end group
1679@end smallexample
1680
1681@kindex complete
1682@item complete @var{args}
1683The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1684for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1685command you want completed. For example:
1686
1687@smallexample
1688complete i
1689@end smallexample
1690
1691@noindent results in:
1692
1693@smallexample
1694@group
1695if
1696ignore
1697info
1698inspect
1699@end group
1700@end smallexample
1701
1702@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1703@end table
1704
1705In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1706and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1707of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1708manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1709under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1710all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1711
1712@c @group
1713@table @code
1714@kindex info
1715@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1716@item info
1717This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1718program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1719with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1720registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1721You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1722@w{@code{help info}}.
1723
1724@kindex set
1725@item set
1726You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1727@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1728@code{set prompt $}.
1729
1730@kindex show
1731@item show
1732In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1733@value{GDBN} itself.
1734You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1735related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1736system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1737which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1738
1739@kindex info set
1740To display all the settable parameters and their current
1741values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1742@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1743@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1744@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1745@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1746@end table
1747@c @end group
1748
1749Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1750exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1751
1752@table @code
1753@kindex show version
1754@cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1755@item show version
1756Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1757information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1758@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1759version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1760commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1761system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1762variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1763The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1764@value{GDBN}.
1765
1766@kindex show copying
1767@kindex info copying
1768@cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1769@item show copying
1770@itemx info copying
1771Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1772
1773@kindex show warranty
1774@kindex info warranty
1775@item show warranty
1776@itemx info warranty
1777Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1778if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1779
1780@end table
1781
1782@node Running
1783@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1784
1785When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1786debugging information when you compile it.
1787
1788You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1789of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1790your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1791kill a child process.
1792
1793@menu
1794* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1795* Starting:: Starting your program
1796* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1797* Environment:: Your program's environment
1798
1799* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1800* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1801* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1802* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1803
1804* Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1805* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1806* Forks:: Debugging forks
1807* Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1808@end menu
1809
1810@node Compilation
1811@section Compiling for Debugging
1812
1813In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1814debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1815is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1816variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1817and addresses in the executable code.
1818
1819To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1820the compiler.
1821
1822Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1823optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1824compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1825together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1826executables containing debugging information.
1827
1828@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1829without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1830recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1831program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1832in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1833
1834Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1835@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1836format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1837
1838@value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1839expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1840about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1841the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1842Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1843provides macro information if you specify the options
1844@option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1845debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1846``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1847ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1848@option{-g} alone.
1849
1850@need 2000
1851@node Starting
1852@section Starting your Program
1853@cindex starting
1854@cindex running
1855
1856@table @code
1857@kindex run
1858@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1859@item run
1860@itemx r
1861Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1862You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1863argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1864@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1865(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1866
1867@end table
1868
1869If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1870supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1871that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1872@code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1873like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1874message like this one:
1875
1876@smallexample
1877The "remote" target does not support "run".
1878Try "help target" or "continue".
1879@end smallexample
1880
1881@noindent
1882then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1883first (@pxref{load}).
1884
1885The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1886receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1887information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1888can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1889your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1890divided into four categories:
1891
1892@table @asis
1893@item The @emph{arguments.}
1894Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1895@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1896is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1897(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1898the arguments.
1899In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1900@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1901@xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1902
1903@item The @emph{environment.}
1904Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1905use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1906environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1907your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1908
1909@item The @emph{working directory.}
1910Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1911the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1912@xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1913
1914@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1915Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1916standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1917in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1918set a different device for your program.
1919@xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1920
1921@cindex pipes
1922@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1923pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1924program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1925wrong program.
1926@end table
1927
1928When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1929immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1930of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1931stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1932or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1933
1934If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1935time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1936table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1937your current breakpoints.
1938
1939@table @code
1940@kindex start
1941@item start
1942@cindex run to main procedure
1943The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1944With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1945other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1946main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1947execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1948procedure, depending on the language used.
1949
1950The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1951breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1952the @samp{run} command.
1953
1954@cindex elaboration phase
1955Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1956executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1957languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1958constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1959@code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1960before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1961will remain to halt execution.
1962
1963Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1964@samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1965underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1966reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1967@samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1968
1969It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1970these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1971your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1972elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1973elaboration code before running your program.
1974
1975@kindex set exec-wrapper
1976@item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1977@itemx show exec-wrapper
1978@itemx unset exec-wrapper
1979When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1980launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1981with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1982@var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1983arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1984appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1985your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1986
1987You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1988its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1989this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1990with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1991
1992For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1993the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1994environment:
1995
1996@smallexample
1997(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1998(@value{GDBP}) run
1999@end smallexample
2000
2001This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2002@sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2003
2004@kindex set disable-randomization
2005@item set disable-randomization
2006@itemx set disable-randomization on
2007This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2008randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2009is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2010reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2011
2012This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2013behavior using
2014
2015@smallexample
2016(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2017@end smallexample
2018
2019@item set disable-randomization off
2020Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2021ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2022disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2023@value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2024as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2025disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2026
2027The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2028It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2029cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2030code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2031a code at its expected addresses.
2032
2033Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2034makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2035having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2036library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2037misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2038random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2039startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2040a randomly chosen address.
2041
2042Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2043similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2044a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2045already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2046executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2047
2048Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2049(as long as the randomization is enabled).
2050
2051@item show disable-randomization
2052Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2053the virtual address space of the started program.
2054
2055@end table
2056
2057@node Arguments
2058@section Your Program's Arguments
2059
2060@cindex arguments (to your program)
2061The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2062@code{run} command.
2063They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2064performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2065@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2066@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2067the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2068
2069On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2070@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2071calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2072the program, not by the shell.
2073
2074@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2075@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2076
2077@table @code
2078@kindex set args
2079@item set args
2080Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2081@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2082with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2083using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2084it again without arguments.
2085
2086@kindex show args
2087@item show args
2088Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2089@end table
2090
2091@node Environment
2092@section Your Program's Environment
2093
2094@cindex environment (of your program)
2095The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2096their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2097your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2098path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2099the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2100debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2101environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2102
2103@table @code
2104@kindex path
2105@item path @var{directory}
2106Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2107(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2108The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2109You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2110system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2111MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2112is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2113
2114You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2115working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2116use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2117@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2118@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2119@var{directory} to the search path.
2120@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2121@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2122
2123@kindex show paths
2124@item show paths
2125Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2126environment variable).
2127
2128@kindex show environment
2129@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2130Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2131your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2132print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2133your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2134
2135@kindex set environment
2136@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2137Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2138changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2139be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2140any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2141parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2142null value.
2143@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2144@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2145
2146For example, this command:
2147
2148@smallexample
2149set env USER = foo
2150@end smallexample
2151
2152@noindent
2153tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2154@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2155are not actually required.)
2156
2157@kindex unset environment
2158@item unset environment @var{varname}
2159Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2160program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2161@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2162rather than assigning it an empty value.
2163@end table
2164
2165@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2166the shell indicated
2167by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2168@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2169that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2170@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2171your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2172files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2173@file{.profile}.
2174
2175@node Working Directory
2176@section Your Program's Working Directory
2177
2178@cindex working directory (of your program)
2179Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2180working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2181The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2182from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2183working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2184
2185The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2186that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2187Specify Files}.
2188
2189@table @code
2190@kindex cd
2191@cindex change working directory
2192@item cd @var{directory}
2193Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2194
2195@kindex pwd
2196@item pwd
2197Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2198@end table
2199
2200It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2201the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2202during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2203configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2204proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2205current working directory of the debuggee.
2206
2207@node Input/Output
2208@section Your Program's Input and Output
2209
2210@cindex redirection
2211@cindex i/o
2212@cindex terminal
2213By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2214the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2215to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2216modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2217running your program.
2218
2219@table @code
2220@kindex info terminal
2221@item info terminal
2222Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2223program is using.
2224@end table
2225
2226You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2227redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2228
2229@smallexample
2230run > outfile
2231@end smallexample
2232
2233@noindent
2234starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2235
2236@kindex tty
2237@cindex controlling terminal
2238Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2239with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2240argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2241commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2242process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2243
2244@smallexample
2245tty /dev/ttyb
2246@end smallexample
2247
2248@noindent
2249directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2250default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2251that as their controlling terminal.
2252
2253An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2254effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2255terminal.
2256
2257When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2258command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2259for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2260for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2261
2262@cindex inferior tty
2263@cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2264You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2265display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2266program.
2267
2268@table @code
2269@item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2270@kindex set inferior-tty
2271Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2272
2273@item show inferior-tty
2274@kindex show inferior-tty
2275Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2276@end table
2277
2278@node Attach
2279@section Debugging an Already-running Process
2280@kindex attach
2281@cindex attach
2282
2283@table @code
2284@item attach @var{process-id}
2285This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2286outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2287targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2288find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2289or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2290
2291@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2292executing the command.
2293@end table
2294
2295To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2296which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2297programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2298also have permission to send the process a signal.
2299
2300When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2301the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2302the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2303(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2304the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2305Specify Files}.
2306
2307The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2308process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2309with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2310you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2311can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2312process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2313attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2314
2315@table @code
2316@kindex detach
2317@item detach
2318When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2319@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2320the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2321that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2322are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2323@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2324executing the command.
2325@end table
2326
2327If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2328that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2329By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2330things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2331@code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2332Messages}).
2333
2334@node Kill Process
2335@section Killing the Child Process
2336
2337@table @code
2338@kindex kill
2339@item kill
2340Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2341@end table
2342
2343This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2344running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2345is running.
2346
2347On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2348while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2349@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2350outside the debugger.
2351
2352The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2353relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2354executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2355next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2356reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2357breakpoint settings).
2358
2359@node Inferiors and Programs
2360@section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2361
2362@value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2363session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2364several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2365before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2366multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2367from multiple executables.
2368
2369@cindex inferior
2370@value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2371object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2372a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2373have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2374may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2375identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2376inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2377embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2378of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2379threads running in it.
2380
2381To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2382inferiors}}:
2383
2384@table @code
2385@kindex info inferiors
2386@item info inferiors
2387Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2388
2389@value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2390
2391@enumerate
2392@item
2393the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2394
2395@item
2396the target system's inferior identifier
2397
2398@item
2399the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2400
2401@end enumerate
2402
2403@noindent
2404An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2405indicates the current inferior.
2406
2407For example,
2408@end table
2409@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2410
2411@smallexample
2412(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2413 Num Description Executable
2414 2 process 2307 hello
2415* 1 process 3401 goodbye
2416@end smallexample
2417
2418To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2419
2420@table @code
2421@kindex inferior @var{infno}
2422@item inferior @var{infno}
2423Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2424@var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2425in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2426@end table
2427
2428
2429You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2430@code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2431systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2432automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2433remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2434@w{@code{remove-inferior}} command.
2435
2436@table @code
2437@kindex add-inferior
2438@item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2439Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2440executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2441the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2442change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2443@code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2444
2445@kindex clone-inferior
2446@item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2447Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2448@var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2449number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2450want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2451
2452@smallexample
2453(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2454 Num Description Executable
2455* 1 process 29964 helloworld
2456(@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2457Added inferior 2.
24581 inferiors added.
2459(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2460 Num Description Executable
2461 2 <null> helloworld
2462* 1 process 29964 helloworld
2463@end smallexample
2464
2465You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2466
2467@kindex remove-inferior
2468@item remove-inferior @var{infno}
2469Removes the inferior @var{infno}. It is not possible to remove an
2470inferior that is running with this command. For those, use the
2471@code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2472
2473@end table
2474
2475To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2476inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2477inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2478using the @w{@code{kill inferior}} command:
2479
2480@table @code
2481@kindex detach inferior @var{infno}
2482@item detach inferior @var{infno}
2483Detach from the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2484@var{infno}, and remove it from the inferior list.
2485
2486@kindex kill inferior @var{infno}
2487@item kill inferior @var{infno}
2488Kill the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2489@var{infno}, and remove it from the inferior list.
2490@end table
2491
2492After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2493@code{detach inferior}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferior}, or after
2494a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2495@code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2496
2497
2498To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2499control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2500
2501@table @code
2502@kindex set print inferior-events
2503@cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2504@item set print inferior-events
2505@itemx set print inferior-events on
2506@itemx set print inferior-events off
2507The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2508disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2509inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2510detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2511
2512@kindex show print inferior-events
2513@item show print inferior-events
2514Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2515inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2516@end table
2517
2518Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2519single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2520value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2521
2522
2523Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2524get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2525spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2526info program-spaces}} command.
2527
2528@table @code
2529@kindex maint info program-spaces
2530@item maint info program-spaces
2531Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2532@value{GDBN}.
2533
2534@value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2535
2536@enumerate
2537@item
2538the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2539
2540@item
2541the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2542the @code{file} command.
2543
2544@end enumerate
2545
2546@noindent
2547An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2548indicates the current program space.
2549
2550In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2551information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2552example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2553
2554@smallexample
2555(@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2556 Id Executable
2557 2 goodbye
2558 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2559* 1 hello
2560@end smallexample
2561
2562Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2563while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2564some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2565same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2566the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2567
2568@smallexample
2569(@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2570 Id Executable
2571* 1 vfork-test
2572 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2573@end smallexample
2574
2575Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2576space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2577@end table
2578
2579@node Threads
2580@section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2581
2582@cindex threads of execution
2583@cindex multiple threads
2584@cindex switching threads
2585In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2586may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2587of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2588the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2589that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2590modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2591registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2592
2593@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2594programs:
2595
2596@itemize @bullet
2597@item automatic notification of new threads
2598@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2599@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2600@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2601a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2602@item thread-specific breakpoints
2603@item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2604messages on thread start and exit.
2605@item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2606the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2607isn't compatible with the program.
2608@end itemize
2609
2610@quotation
2611@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2612@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2613If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2614effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2615from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2616like this:
2617
2618@smallexample
2619(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2620(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2621Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2622see the IDs of currently known threads.
2623@end smallexample
2624@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2625@c doesn't support threads"?
2626@end quotation
2627
2628@cindex focus of debugging
2629@cindex current thread
2630The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2631threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2632control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2633This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2634program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2635
2636@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2637@cindex thread identifier (system)
2638@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2639@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2640@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2641Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2642the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2643form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2644whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2645@sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2646
2647@smallexample
2648[New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2649@end smallexample
2650
2651@noindent
2652when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2653the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2654further qualifier.
2655
2656@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2657@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2658@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2659@c program?
2660@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2661@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2662@c threads ab initio?
2663
2664@cindex thread number
2665@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2666For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2667number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2668
2669@table @code
2670@kindex info threads
2671@item info threads
2672Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2673program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2674
2675@enumerate
2676@item
2677the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2678
2679@item
2680the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2681
2682@item
2683the current stack frame summary for that thread
2684@end enumerate
2685
2686@noindent
2687An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2688indicates the current thread.
2689
2690For example,
2691@end table
2692@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2693
2694@smallexample
2695(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2696 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2697 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2698* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2699 at threadtest.c:68
2700@end smallexample
2701
2702On HP-UX systems:
2703
2704@cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2705@cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2706For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2707number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2708thread in your program.
2709
2710@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2711@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2712@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2713@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2714@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2715Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2716both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2717form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2718whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2719HP-UX, you see
2720
2721@smallexample
2722[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2723@end smallexample
2724
2725@noindent
2726when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2727
2728@table @code
2729@kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2730@item info threads
2731Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2732program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2733
2734@enumerate
2735@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2736
2737@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2738
2739@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2740@end enumerate
2741
2742@noindent
2743An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2744indicates the current thread.
2745
2746For example,
2747@end table
2748@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2749
2750@smallexample
2751(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2752 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2753 at quicksort.c:137
2754 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2755 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2756 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2757 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2758@end smallexample
2759
2760On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2761Solaris-specific command:
2762
2763@table @code
2764@item maint info sol-threads
2765@kindex maint info sol-threads
2766@cindex thread info (Solaris)
2767Display info on Solaris user threads.
2768@end table
2769
2770@table @code
2771@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2772@item thread @var{threadno}
2773Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2774argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2775shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2776@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2777you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2778
2779@smallexample
2780@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2781(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2782[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
27830x34e5 in sigpause ()
2784@end smallexample
2785
2786@noindent
2787As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2788@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2789threads.
2790
2791@kindex thread apply
2792@cindex apply command to several threads
2793@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2794The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2795@var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2796threads that you want affected with the command argument
2797@var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2798shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2799could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2800command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2801
2802@kindex set print thread-events
2803@cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2804@item set print thread-events
2805@itemx set print thread-events on
2806@itemx set print thread-events off
2807The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2808disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2809started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2810be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2811Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2812
2813@kindex show print thread-events
2814@item show print thread-events
2815Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2816have started and exited.
2817@end table
2818
2819@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2820more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2821programs with multiple threads.
2822
2823@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2824watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2825
2826@table @code
2827@kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2828@cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2829@item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2830If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2831directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2832If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2833an empty list.
2834
2835On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2836@code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2837inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2838to find @code{libthread_db}. If that fails, @value{GDBN} will continue
2839with default system shared library directories, and finally the directory
2840from which @code{libpthread} was loaded in the inferior process.
2841
2842For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
2843@value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
2844If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
2845mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
2846will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
2847If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
2848@value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
2849
2850Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
2851only on some platforms.
2852
2853@kindex show libthread-db-search-path
2854@item show libthread-db-search-path
2855Display current libthread_db search path.
2856@end table
2857
2858@node Forks
2859@section Debugging Forks
2860
2861@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2862@cindex multiple processes
2863@cindex processes, multiple
2864On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2865programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2866function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2867parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2868set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2869will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2870will cause it to terminate.
2871
2872However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2873which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2874the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2875only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2876so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2877on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2878get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2879@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2880the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2881the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2882
2883On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2884create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2885Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2886only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2887
2888By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2889the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2890
2891If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2892use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2893
2894@table @code
2895@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2896@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2897Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2898@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2899process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2900
2901@table @code
2902@item parent
2903The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2904unimpeded. This is the default.
2905
2906@item child
2907The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2908unimpeded.
2909
2910@end table
2911
2912@kindex show follow-fork-mode
2913@item show follow-fork-mode
2914Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2915@end table
2916
2917@cindex debugging multiple processes
2918On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2919command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2920
2921@table @code
2922@kindex set detach-on-fork
2923@item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2924Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2925retain debugger control over them both.
2926
2927@table @code
2928@item on
2929The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2930@code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2931independently. This is the default.
2932
2933@item off
2934Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2935One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2936@code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2937is held suspended.
2938
2939@end table
2940
2941@kindex show detach-on-fork
2942@item show detach-on-fork
2943Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2944@end table
2945
2946If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
2947will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
2948You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
2949using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
2950to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
2951Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
2952
2953To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2954from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferior}} command (allowing it
2955to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferior}}
2956command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2957and Programs}.
2958
2959If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2960@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2961breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2962@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2963the child process's @code{main}.
2964
2965On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
2966cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2967
2968If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2969call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
2970process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
2971as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
2972@value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
2973You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
2974command.
2975
2976@table @code
2977@kindex set follow-exec-mode
2978@item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
2979
2980Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
2981@code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
2982
2983@code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
2984
2985@table @code
2986@item new
2987@value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
2988new inferior. The program the process was running before the
2989@code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
2990original inferior.
2991
2992For example:
2993
2994@smallexample
2995(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2996(gdb) info inferior
2997 Id Description Executable
2998* 1 <null> prog1
2999(@value{GDBP}) run
3000process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3001Program exited normally.
3002(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3003 Id Description Executable
3004* 2 <null> prog2
3005 1 <null> prog1
3006@end smallexample
3007
3008@item same
3009@value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3010executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3011inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3012e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3013running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3014
3015For example:
3016
3017@smallexample
3018(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3019 Id Description Executable
3020* 1 <null> prog1
3021(@value{GDBP}) run
3022process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3023Program exited normally.
3024(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3025 Id Description Executable
3026* 1 <null> prog2
3027@end smallexample
3028
3029@end table
3030@end table
3031
3032You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3033a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3034Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3035
3036@node Checkpoint/Restart
3037@section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3038
3039@cindex checkpoint
3040@cindex restart
3041@cindex bookmark
3042@cindex snapshot of a process
3043@cindex rewind program state
3044
3045On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3046@sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3047program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3048later.
3049
3050Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3051happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3052includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3053system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3054moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3055
3056Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3057getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3058a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3059the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3060from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3061start again from there.
3062
3063This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3064steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3065
3066To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3067
3068@table @code
3069@kindex checkpoint
3070@item checkpoint
3071Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3072The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3073is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3074
3075@kindex info checkpoints
3076@item info checkpoints
3077List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3078session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3079listed:
3080
3081@table @code
3082@item Checkpoint ID
3083@item Process ID
3084@item Code Address
3085@item Source line, or label
3086@end table
3087
3088@kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3089@item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3090Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3091@var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3092etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3093was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3094in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3095
3096Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3097are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3098only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3099the debugger.
3100
3101@kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3102@item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3103Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3104
3105@end table
3106
3107Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3108of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3109(OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3110a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3111so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3112opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3113previously read data can be read again.
3114
3115Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3116external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3117from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3118but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3119be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3120been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3121
3122However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3123program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3124again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3125different execution path this time.
3126
3127@cindex checkpoints and process id
3128Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3129different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3130id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3131and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3132If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3133potentially pose a problem.
3134
3135@subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3136
3137On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3138is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3139difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3140absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3141absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3142next.
3143
3144A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3145Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3146and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3147process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3148your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3149
3150@node Stopping
3151@chapter Stopping and Continuing
3152
3153The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3154program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3155trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3156
3157Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3158such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3159@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3160change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3161continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3162ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3163explicitly request this information at any time.
3164
3165@table @code
3166@kindex info program
3167@item info program
3168Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3169running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3170@end table
3171
3172@menu
3173* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3174* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3175* Signals:: Signals
3176* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3177@end menu
3178
3179@node Breakpoints
3180@section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3181
3182@cindex breakpoints
3183A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3184the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3185control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3186breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3187Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3188should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3189program.
3190
3191On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3192the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3193you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3194in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3195(for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3196call).
3197
3198@cindex watchpoints
3199@cindex data breakpoints
3200@cindex memory tracing
3201@cindex breakpoint on memory address
3202@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3203A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3204when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3205of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3206combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3207@dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3208watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3209from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3210enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3211same commands.
3212
3213You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3214whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3215Automatic Display}.
3216
3217@cindex catchpoints
3218@cindex breakpoint on events
3219A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3220when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3221exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3222different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3223Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3224other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3225@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3226
3227@cindex breakpoint numbers
3228@cindex numbers for breakpoints
3229@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3230catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3231starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3232features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3233breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3234@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3235enable it again.
3236
3237@cindex breakpoint ranges
3238@cindex ranges of breakpoints
3239Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3240operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3241@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3242hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3243all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3244
3245@menu
3246* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3247* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3248* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3249* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3250* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3251* Conditions:: Break conditions
3252* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3253* Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3254* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3255* Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3256@end menu
3257
3258@node Set Breaks
3259@subsection Setting Breakpoints
3260
3261@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3262@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3263@c
3264@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3265
3266@kindex break
3267@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3268@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3269@cindex latest breakpoint
3270Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3271@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3272number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3273Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3274convenience variables.
3275
3276@table @code
3277@item break @var{location}
3278Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3279function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3280(@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3281specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3282before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3283
3284When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3285C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3286@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3287that situation.
3288
3289It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3290only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3291or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3292
3293@item break
3294When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3295the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3296(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3297innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3298returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3299@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3300that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3301@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3302the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3303inside loops.
3304
3305@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3306least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3307would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3308breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3309existed when your program stopped.
3310
3311@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3312Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3313@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3314value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3315@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3316above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3317,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3318
3319@kindex tbreak
3320@item tbreak @var{args}
3321Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3322same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3323way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3324program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3325
3326@kindex hbreak
3327@cindex hardware breakpoints
3328@item hbreak @var{args}
3329Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3330@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3331breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3332have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3333debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3334changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3335provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3336will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3337address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3338breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3339example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3340@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3341or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3342(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3343@xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3344For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3345breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3346hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3347
3348@kindex thbreak
3349@item thbreak @var{args}
3350Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3351are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3352the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3353the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3354first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3355command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3356may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3357See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3358
3359@kindex rbreak
3360@cindex regular expression
3361@cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3362@cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3363@item rbreak @var{regex}
3364Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3365@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3366matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3367breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3368the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3369them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3370
3371The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3372like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3373shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3374an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3375@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3376match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3377
3378@cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3379When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3380breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3381classes.
3382
3383@cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3384The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3385@strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3386
3387@smallexample
3388(@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3389@end smallexample
3390
3391@item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3392If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3393the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3394specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3395every function in a given file:
3396
3397@smallexample
3398(@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3399@end smallexample
3400
3401The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3402optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3403
3404@kindex info breakpoints
3405@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3406@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3407@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3408Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3409not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3410about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3411each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3412
3413@table @emph
3414@item Breakpoint Numbers
3415@item Type
3416Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3417@item Disposition
3418Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3419@item Enabled or Disabled
3420Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3421that are not enabled.
3422@item Address
3423Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3424pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3425contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3426library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3427See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3428have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3429@item What
3430Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3431line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3432the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3433the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3434@end table
3435
3436@noindent
3437If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3438the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3439are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3440specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3441library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3442valid location.
3443
3444@noindent
3445@code{info break} with a breakpoint
3446number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3447convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3448the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3449listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3450
3451@noindent
3452@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3453has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3454@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3455hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3456was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3457will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3458@end table
3459
3460@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3461your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3462the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3463(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3464
3465@cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3466@cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3467It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3468in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3469
3470@itemize @bullet
3471@item
3472For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3473instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3474
3475@item
3476For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3477correspond to any number of instantiations.
3478
3479@item
3480For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3481several places where that function is inlined.
3482@end itemize
3483
3484In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3485the relevant locations@footnote{
3486As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3487line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3488will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3489info with line numbers for them.}.
3490
3491A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3492table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3493each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3494address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3495addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3496locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3497@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3498
3499For example:
3500
3501@smallexample
3502Num Type Disp Enb Address What
35031 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3504 stop only if i==1
3505 breakpoint already hit 1 time
35061.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
35071.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3508@end smallexample
3509
3510Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3511@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3512@code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3513delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3514entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3515the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3516the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3517the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3518that belong to that breakpoint.
3519
3520@cindex pending breakpoints
3521It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3522Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3523and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3524this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3525any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3526set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3527debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3528symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3529breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3530a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3531is not yet resolved.
3532
3533After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3534@value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3535shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3536pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3537ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3538that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3539
3540This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3541example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3542a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3543a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3544
3545Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3546differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3547enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3548
3549@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3550happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3551address specification to an address:
3552
3553@kindex set breakpoint pending
3554@kindex show breakpoint pending
3555@table @code
3556@item set breakpoint pending auto
3557This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3558location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3559
3560@item set breakpoint pending on
3561This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3562result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3563
3564@item set breakpoint pending off
3565This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3566unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3567not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3568
3569@item show breakpoint pending
3570Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3571@end table
3572
3573The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3574variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3575as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3576
3577@cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3578For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3579software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3580breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3581breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3582breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3583breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3584breakpoints.
3585
3586You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3587
3588@kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3589@kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3590@table @code
3591@item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3592This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3593will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3594breakpoint must be used.
3595
3596@item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3597This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3598type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3599trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3600@end table
3601
3602@value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3603at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3604executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3605code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3606the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3607behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3608target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3609targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3610This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3611
3612@kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3613@kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3614@table @code
3615@item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3616All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3617the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3618removed from the target when it stops.
3619
3620@item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3621Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3622the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3623breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3624removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3625
3626@cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3627@item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3628This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3629in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3630@code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3631controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3632@code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3633@end table
3634
3635@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3636@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3637@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3638special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3639programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3640starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3641You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3642@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3643
3644
3645@node Set Watchpoints
3646@subsection Setting Watchpoints
3647
3648@cindex setting watchpoints
3649You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3650expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3651this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3652The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3653as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3654
3655@itemize @bullet
3656@item
3657A reference to the value of a single variable.
3658
3659@item
3660An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3661@samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3662address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3663
3664@item
3665An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3666expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3667language (@pxref{Languages}).
3668@end itemize
3669
3670You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3671not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3672@samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3673@value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3674the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3675valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3676pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3677@code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3678the expression changes.
3679
3680@cindex software watchpoints
3681@cindex hardware watchpoints
3682Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3683hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3684program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3685times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3686catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3687culprit.)
3688
3689On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3690x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3691watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3692
3693@table @code
3694@kindex watch
3695@item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3696Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3697expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3698changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3699to watch the value of a single variable:
3700
3701@smallexample
3702(@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3703@end smallexample
3704
3705If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3706clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3707@var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3708change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3709that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3710with Hardware Watchpoints.
3711
3712@kindex rwatch
3713@item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3714Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3715by the program.
3716
3717@kindex awatch
3718@item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3719Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3720or written into by the program.
3721
3722@kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3723@item info watchpoints
3724This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
3725@code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3726@end table
3727
3728@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3729watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3730value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3731cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3732executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3733@emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3734
3735@cindex use only software watchpoints
3736You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3737@kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3738zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3739the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3740watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3741@code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3742mechanism of watching expression values.)
3743
3744@table @code
3745@item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3746@kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3747Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3748
3749@item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3750@kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3751Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3752@end table
3753
3754For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3755watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3756hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3757
3758When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3759
3760@smallexample
3761Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3762@end smallexample
3763
3764@noindent
3765if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3766
3767Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3768hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3769value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3770every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3771that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3772hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3773will print a message like this:
3774
3775@smallexample
3776Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3777@end smallexample
3778
3779Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3780data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3781watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3782can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3783cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3784double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3785wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3786into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3787
3788If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3789to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3790Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3791time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3792able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3793warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3794
3795@smallexample
3796Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3797@end smallexample
3798
3799@noindent
3800If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3801
3802Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3803exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3804That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3805expression with separately allocated resources.
3806
3807If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3808any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3809kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3810
3811@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3812(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3813they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3814which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3815being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3816and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3817rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3818way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3819@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3820
3821@cindex watchpoints and threads
3822@cindex threads and watchpoints
3823In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3824watched expression from every thread.
3825
3826@quotation
3827@emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3828have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3829watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3830single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3831change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3832confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3833software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3834when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3835watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3836@end quotation
3837
3838@xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3839
3840@node Set Catchpoints
3841@subsection Setting Catchpoints
3842@cindex catchpoints, setting
3843@cindex exception handlers
3844@cindex event handling
3845
3846You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3847kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3848shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3849
3850@table @code
3851@kindex catch
3852@item catch @var{event}
3853Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3854@table @code
3855@item throw
3856@cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3857The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3858
3859@item catch
3860The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3861
3862@item exception
3863@cindex Ada exception catching
3864@cindex catch Ada exceptions
3865An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3866at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3867the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3868Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3869
3870When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3871name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3872fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3873@value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3874rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3875called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3876the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3877Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3878
3879@item exception unhandled
3880An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3881
3882@item assert
3883A failed Ada assertion.
3884
3885@item exec
3886@cindex break on fork/exec
3887A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3888and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3889
3890@item syscall
3891@itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
3892@cindex break on a system call.
3893A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
3894syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
3895from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
3896@value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
3897debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
3898argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
3899will be caught.
3900
3901@var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
3902underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
3903GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
3904names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
3905
3906@c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
3907@c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
3908@c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
3909@c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
3910
3911Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
3912each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
3913facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
3914available choices.
3915
3916You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
3917number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
3918identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
3919name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
3920into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
3921may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
3922list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
3923behind the OS upgrades).
3924
3925The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
3926arguments to it:
3927
3928@smallexample
3929(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
3930Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
3931(@value{GDBP}) r
3932Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3933
3934Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
3935 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3936(@value{GDBP}) c
3937Continuing.
3938
3939Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
3940 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3941(@value{GDBP})
3942@end smallexample
3943
3944Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
3945
3946@smallexample
3947(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
3948Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
3949(@value{GDBP}) r
3950Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3951
3952Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
3953 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3954(@value{GDBP}) c
3955Continuing.
3956
3957Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
3958 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3959(@value{GDBP})
3960@end smallexample
3961
3962An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
3963below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
3964file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
3965
3966@smallexample
3967(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
3968Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
3969(@value{GDBP}) r
3970Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3971
3972Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
3973 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3974(@value{GDBP}) c
3975Continuing.
3976
3977Program exited normally.
3978(@value{GDBP})
3979@end smallexample
3980
3981However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
3982in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
3983a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
3984but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
3985
3986@smallexample
3987(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
3988warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
3989Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
3990(@value{GDBP})
3991@end smallexample
3992
3993If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
3994it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
3995architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
3996you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
3997notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
3998name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
3999
4000@smallexample
4001(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4002warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4003warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4004GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4005Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4006(@value{GDBP})
4007@end smallexample
4008
4009Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4010
4011Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4012number. In this case, you would see something like:
4013
4014@smallexample
4015(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4016Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4017@end smallexample
4018
4019Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4020
4021@item fork
4022A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4023and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4024
4025@item vfork
4026A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4027and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4028
4029@end table
4030
4031@item tcatch @var{event}
4032Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4033automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4034
4035@end table
4036
4037Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4038
4039There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
4040(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
4041
4042@itemize @bullet
4043@item
4044If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4045control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4046raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4047returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4048simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4049that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4050you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4051disabled within interactive calls.
4052
4053@item
4054You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4055
4056@item
4057You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4058@end itemize
4059
4060@cindex raise exceptions
4061Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
4062if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
4063stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
4064can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
4065breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
4066out where the exception was raised.
4067
4068To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
4069knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
4070raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
4071which has the following ANSI C interface:
4072
4073@smallexample
4074 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
4075 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
4076 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
4077@end smallexample
4078
4079@noindent
4080To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
4081unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
4082(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
4083
4084With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
4085that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
4086a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
4087breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
4088raised.
4089
4090
4091@node Delete Breaks
4092@subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4093
4094@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4095@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4096It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4097catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4098to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4099breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4100
4101With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4102where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4103delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4104their breakpoint numbers.
4105
4106It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4107automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4108when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4109
4110@table @code
4111@kindex clear
4112@item clear
4113Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4114selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4115the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4116breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4117
4118@item clear @var{location}
4119Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4120@xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4121most useful ones are listed below:
4122
4123@table @code
4124@item clear @var{function}
4125@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4126Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4127
4128@item clear @var{linenum}
4129@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4130Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4131@var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4132@end table
4133
4134@cindex delete breakpoints
4135@kindex delete
4136@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4137@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4138Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4139ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4140breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4141confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4142@end table
4143
4144@node Disabling
4145@subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4146
4147@cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4148Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4149prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4150it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4151that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4152
4153You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4154the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4155one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4156print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4157do not know which numbers to use.
4158
4159Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4160affects all of its locations.
4161
4162A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
4163states of enablement:
4164
4165@itemize @bullet
4166@item
4167Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4168with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4169@item
4170Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4171@item
4172Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4173disabled.
4174@item
4175Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4176immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4177set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4178@end itemize
4179
4180You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4181watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4182
4183@table @code
4184@kindex disable
4185@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4186@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4187Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4188listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4189options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4190case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4191@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4192
4193@kindex enable
4194@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4195Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4196become effective once again in stopping your program.
4197
4198@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4199Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4200of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4201
4202@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4203Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4204deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4205Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4206@end table
4207
4208@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4209@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4210Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4211,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4212subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4213the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4214breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4215breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4216Stepping}.)
4217
4218@node Conditions
4219@subsection Break Conditions
4220@cindex conditional breakpoints
4221@cindex breakpoint conditions
4222
4223@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4224@c in particular for a watchpoint?
4225The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4226specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4227breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4228programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4229a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4230and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4231
4232This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4233situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4234when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4235by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4236@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4237
4238Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4239since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4240it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4241and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4242one.
4243
4244Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4245your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4246that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4247format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4248unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4249that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4250program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4251breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4252conditions for the
4253purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4254(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4255
4256Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4257@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4258Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4259with the @code{condition} command.
4260
4261You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4262The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4263@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4264catchpoint.
4265
4266@table @code
4267@kindex condition
4268@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4269Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4270watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4271breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4272@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4273@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4274syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4275referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4276symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4277prints an error message:
4278
4279@smallexample
4280No symbol "foo" in current context.
4281@end smallexample
4282
4283@noindent
4284@value{GDBN} does
4285not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4286command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4287@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4288
4289@item condition @var{bnum}
4290Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4291an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4292@end table
4293
4294@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4295A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4296breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4297useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4298count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4299is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4300therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4301ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4302the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4303value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4304your program reaches it.
4305
4306@table @code
4307@kindex ignore
4308@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4309Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4310The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4311execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4312takes no action.
4313
4314To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4315a count of zero.
4316
4317When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4318breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4319@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4320Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4321
4322If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4323condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4324@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4325
4326You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4327as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4328is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4329Variables}.
4330@end table
4331
4332Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4333
4334
4335@node Break Commands
4336@subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4337
4338@cindex breakpoint commands
4339You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4340commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4341example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4342enable other breakpoints.
4343
4344@table @code
4345@kindex commands
4346@kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4347@item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4348@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4349@itemx end
4350Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4351themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4352@code{end} to terminate the commands.
4353
4354To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4355follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4356
4357With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4358watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4359encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4360command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4361set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4362@code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4363creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4364Expressions}).
4365@end table
4366
4367Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4368disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4369
4370You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4371use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4372that resumes execution.
4373
4374Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4375execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4376(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4377another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4378ambiguities about which list to execute.
4379
4380@kindex silent
4381If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4382usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4383be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4384then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4385see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4386meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4387
4388The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4389print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4390breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4391
4392For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4393value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4394
4395@smallexample
4396break foo if x>0
4397commands
4398silent
4399printf "x is %d\n",x
4400cont
4401end
4402@end smallexample
4403
4404One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4405you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4406of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4407erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4408to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4409so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4410command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4411
4412@smallexample
4413break 403
4414commands
4415silent
4416set x = y + 4
4417cont
4418end
4419@end smallexample
4420
4421@node Save Breakpoints
4422@subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4423
4424To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4425breakpoints}} command.
4426
4427@table @code
4428@kindex save breakpoints
4429@cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4430@item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4431This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4432their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4433suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4434types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4435tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4436@code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4437with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4438because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4439watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4440are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4441breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4442and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4443that can no longer be recreated.
4444@end table
4445
4446@c @ifclear BARETARGET
4447@node Error in Breakpoints
4448@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4449
4450If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4451watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4452
4453@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4454@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4455@smallexample
4456Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4457You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4458@end smallexample
4459
4460@noindent
4461This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4462only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4463watchpoints it needs to insert.
4464
4465When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4466hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4467
4468@node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4469@subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4470@cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4471
4472Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4473which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4474@value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4475with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4476
4477One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4478a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4479bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4480constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4481bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4482honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4483first in the bundle.
4484
4485It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4486instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4487a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4488another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4489breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4490printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4491is hit.
4492
4493A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4494that's been subject to address adjustment:
4495
4496@smallexample
4497warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4498@end smallexample
4499
4500Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4501internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4502verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4503desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4504other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4505E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4506instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4507cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4508
4509@value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4510adjusted breakpoints:
4511
4512@smallexample
4513warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4514to 0x00010410.
4515@end smallexample
4516
4517When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4518action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4519frequently than expected.
4520
4521@node Continuing and Stepping
4522@section Continuing and Stepping
4523
4524@cindex stepping
4525@cindex continuing
4526@cindex resuming execution
4527@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4528completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4529one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4530line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4531particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4532your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4533it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4534@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4535
4536@table @code
4537@kindex continue
4538@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4539@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4540@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4541@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4542@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4543Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4544any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4545@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4546ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4547@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4548
4549The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4550stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4551@code{continue} is ignored.
4552
4553The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4554debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4555purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4556@code{continue}.
4557@end table
4558
4559To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4560(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4561calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4562Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4563
4564A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4565(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4566beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4567is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4568and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4569interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4570
4571@table @code
4572@kindex step
4573@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4574@item step
4575Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4576line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4577abbreviated @code{s}.
4578
4579@quotation
4580@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4581@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4582@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4583@c distinction here.
4584@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4585within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4586execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4587debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4588is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4589without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4590below.
4591@end quotation
4592
4593The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4594line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4595@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4596to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4597the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4598called within the line.
4599
4600Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4601number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4602@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4603on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4604was any debugging information about the routine.
4605
4606@item step @var{count}
4607Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4608breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4609@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4610
4611@kindex next
4612@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4613@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4614Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4615This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4616the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4617control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4618that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4619is abbreviated @code{n}.
4620
4621An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4622
4623
4624@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4625@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4626@c
4627@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4628@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4629@c function are executed without stopping.
4630
4631The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4632source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4633@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4634
4635@kindex set step-mode
4636@item set step-mode
4637@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4638@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4639@itemx set step-mode on
4640The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4641stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4642information rather than stepping over it.
4643
4644This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4645machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4646want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4647
4648@item set step-mode off
4649Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4650debug information. This is the default.
4651
4652@item show step-mode
4653Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4654source line debug information.
4655
4656@kindex finish
4657@kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4658@item finish
4659Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4660returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4661abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4662
4663Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4664,Returning from a Function}).
4665
4666@kindex until
4667@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4668@cindex run until specified location
4669@item until
4670@itemx u
4671Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4672current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4673stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4674command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4675automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4676than the address of the jump.
4677
4678This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4679though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4680exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4681simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4682through the next iteration.
4683
4684@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4685stack frame.
4686
4687@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4688of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4689example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4690(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4691@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4692
4693@smallexample
4694(@value{GDBP}) f
4695#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4696206 expand_input();
4697(@value{GDBP}) until
4698195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4699@end smallexample
4700
4701This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4702generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4703start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4704written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4705to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4706expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4707statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4708
4709@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4710instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4711argument.
4712
4713@item until @var{location}
4714@itemx u @var{location}
4715Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4716reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4717the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4718This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4719hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4720location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4721implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4722invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4723line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4724line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4725invocations have returned.
4726
4727@smallexample
472894 int factorial (int value)
472995 @{
473096 if (value > 1) @{
473197 value *= factorial (value - 1);
473298 @}
473399 return (value);
4734100 @}
4735@end smallexample
4736
4737
4738@kindex advance @var{location}
4739@itemx advance @var{location}
4740Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4741required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4742@ref{Specify Location}.
4743Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4744frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4745not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4746have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4747
4748
4749@kindex stepi
4750@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4751@item stepi
4752@itemx stepi @var{arg}
4753@itemx si
4754Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4755
4756It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4757instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4758instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4759Display,, Automatic Display}.
4760
4761An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4762
4763@need 750
4764@kindex nexti
4765@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4766@item nexti
4767@itemx nexti @var{arg}
4768@itemx ni
4769Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4770proceed until the function returns.
4771
4772An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4773@end table
4774
4775@node Signals
4776@section Signals
4777@cindex signals
4778
4779A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4780operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4781kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4782signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4783@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4784memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4785the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4786requested an alarm).
4787
4788@cindex fatal signals
4789Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4790functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4791errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4792program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4793@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4794fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4795
4796@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4797program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4798signal.
4799
4800@cindex handling signals
4801Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4802@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4803(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4804but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4805You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4806
4807@table @code
4808@kindex info signals
4809@kindex info handle
4810@item info signals
4811@itemx info handle
4812Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4813handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4814the defined types of signals.
4815
4816@item info signals @var{sig}
4817Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4818
4819@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4820
4821@kindex handle
4822@item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4823Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4824can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4825@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4826@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4827known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4828say what change to make.
4829@end table
4830
4831@c @group
4832The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4833Their full names are:
4834
4835@table @code
4836@item nostop
4837@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4838still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4839
4840@item stop
4841@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4842the @code{print} keyword as well.
4843
4844@item print
4845@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4846
4847@item noprint
4848@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4849implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4850
4851@item pass
4852@itemx noignore
4853@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4854can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4855and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4856
4857@item nopass
4858@itemx ignore
4859@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4860@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4861@end table
4862@c @end group
4863
4864When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4865program until you
4866continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4867effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4868after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4869command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4870program sees that signal when you continue.
4871
4872The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4873non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4874@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4875erroneous signals.
4876
4877You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4878seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4879or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4880due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4881values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4882execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4883a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4884you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4885Program a Signal}.
4886
4887@cindex extra signal information
4888@anchor{extra signal information}
4889
4890On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
4891associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
4892delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
4893by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
4894that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
4895receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
4896target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
4897$_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
4898standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
4899system header.
4900
4901Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
4902referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
4903
4904@smallexample
4905@group
4906(@value{GDBP}) continue
4907Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
49080x0000000000400766 in main ()
490969 *(int *)p = 0;
4910(@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
4911type = struct @{
4912 int si_signo;
4913 int si_errno;
4914 int si_code;
4915 union @{
4916 int _pad[28];
4917 struct @{...@} _kill;
4918 struct @{...@} _timer;
4919 struct @{...@} _rt;
4920 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
4921 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
4922 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
4923 @} _sifields;
4924@}
4925(@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
4926type = struct @{
4927 void *si_addr;
4928@}
4929(@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
4930$1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
4931@end group
4932@end smallexample
4933
4934Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
4935
4936@node Thread Stops
4937@section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4938
4939@cindex stopped threads
4940@cindex threads, stopped
4941
4942@cindex continuing threads
4943@cindex threads, continuing
4944
4945@value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4946(@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4947are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4948debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4949when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4950or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4951@value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4952@dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4953you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4954
4955@menu
4956* All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
4957* Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
4958* Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
4959* Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
4960* Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
4961@end menu
4962
4963@node All-Stop Mode
4964@subsection All-Stop Mode
4965
4966@cindex all-stop mode
4967
4968In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4969@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4970allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4971switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4972underfoot.
4973
4974Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4975executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4976like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4977
4978In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4979Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4980system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4981execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4982single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4983statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4984stops.
4985
4986You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4987continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4988thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4989first thread completes whatever you requested.
4990
4991@cindex automatic thread selection
4992@cindex switching threads automatically
4993@cindex threads, automatic switching
4994Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
4995signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
4996signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
4997message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
4998thread.
4999
5000On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5001locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5002
5003@table @code
5004@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5005@cindex scheduler locking mode
5006@cindex lock scheduler
5007Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5008locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5009current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5010mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5011from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5012the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5013Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5014when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5015function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5016like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5017thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5018the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5019
5020@item show scheduler-locking
5021Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5022@end table
5023
5024@cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5025By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5026@code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5027threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5028is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5029@code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5030inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5031forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5032it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5033situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5034of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5035to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5036you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5037inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5038
5039@table @code
5040@kindex set schedule-multiple
5041@item set schedule-multiple
5042Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5043when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5044all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5045of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5046@code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5047or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5048
5049@item show schedule-multiple
5050Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5051multiple processes.
5052@end table
5053
5054@node Non-Stop Mode
5055@subsection Non-Stop Mode
5056
5057@cindex non-stop mode
5058
5059@c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5060@c with more details.
5061
5062For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5063mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5064the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5065minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5066where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5067respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5068
5069In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5070@emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5071threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5072execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5073only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5074in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5075ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5076one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5077one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5078independently and simultaneously.
5079
5080To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5081or attach to your program:
5082
5083@smallexample
5084# Enable the async interface.
5085set target-async 1
5086
5087# If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5088set pagination off
5089
5090# Finally, turn it on!
5091set non-stop on
5092@end smallexample
5093
5094You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5095
5096@table @code
5097@kindex set non-stop
5098@item set non-stop on
5099Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5100@item set non-stop off
5101Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5102@kindex show non-stop
5103@item show non-stop
5104Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5105@end table
5106
5107Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5108not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5109In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5110@value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5111not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5112since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5113non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5114default.
5115
5116In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5117by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5118To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5119
5120You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5121(@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5122while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5123The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5124always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5125
5126Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5127running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5128In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5129but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5130To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5131
5132Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5133
5134In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5135that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5136thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5137command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5138changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5139previously current thread.
5140
5141@node Background Execution
5142@subsection Background Execution
5143
5144@cindex foreground execution
5145@cindex background execution
5146@cindex asynchronous execution
5147@cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5148
5149@value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5150foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5151(asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5152the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5153another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5154a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5155
5156You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5157background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5158manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5159
5160@table @code
5161@kindex set target-async
5162@item set target-async on
5163Enable asynchronous mode.
5164@item set target-async off
5165Disable asynchronous mode.
5166@kindex show target-async
5167@item show target-async
5168Show the current target-async setting.
5169@end table
5170
5171If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5172message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5173
5174To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5175the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5176just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5177are:
5178
5179@table @code
5180@kindex run&
5181@item run
5182@xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5183
5184@item attach
5185@kindex attach&
5186@xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5187
5188@item step
5189@kindex step&
5190@xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5191
5192@item stepi
5193@kindex stepi&
5194@xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5195
5196@item next
5197@kindex next&
5198@xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5199
5200@item nexti
5201@kindex nexti&
5202@xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5203
5204@item continue
5205@kindex continue&
5206@xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5207
5208@item finish
5209@kindex finish&
5210@xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5211
5212@item until
5213@kindex until&
5214@xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5215
5216@end table
5217
5218Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5219mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5220However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5221the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5222previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5223mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5224
5225You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5226using the @code{interrupt} command.
5227
5228@table @code
5229@kindex interrupt
5230@item interrupt
5231@itemx interrupt -a
5232
5233Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5234@code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5235only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5236use @code{interrupt -a}.
5237@end table
5238
5239@node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5240@subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5241
5242When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5243Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5244breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5245
5246@table @code
5247@cindex breakpoints and threads
5248@cindex thread breakpoints
5249@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5250@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5251@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5252@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5253writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5254specify some source line.
5255
5256Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5257to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5258particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5259numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5260column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5261
5262If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5263breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5264program.
5265
5266You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5267well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5268after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5269
5270@smallexample
5271(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5272@end smallexample
5273
5274@end table
5275
5276@node Interrupted System Calls
5277@subsection Interrupted System Calls
5278
5279@cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5280@cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5281@cindex premature return from system calls
5282There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5283multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5284breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5285system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5286consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5287that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5288stop execution.
5289
5290To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5291each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5292style anyways.
5293
5294For example, do not write code like this:
5295
5296@smallexample
5297 sleep (10);
5298@end smallexample
5299
5300The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5301at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5302
5303Instead, write this:
5304
5305@smallexample
5306 int unslept = 10;
5307 while (unslept > 0)
5308 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5309@end smallexample
5310
5311A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5312conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5313multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5314@value{GDBN}.
5315
5316Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5317monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5318When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5319prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5320
5321
5322@node Reverse Execution
5323@chapter Running programs backward
5324@cindex reverse execution
5325@cindex running programs backward
5326
5327When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
5328you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
5329If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
5330``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
5331
5332A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
5333to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
5334program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
5335revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
5336deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
5337all target environments can support reverse execution.
5338
5339When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
5340have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
5341order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
5342thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
5343the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
5344instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
5345a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
5346should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
5347prior values@footnote{
5348Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
5349memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
5350targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
5351
5352The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
5353requires only that the target do something reasonable when
5354@value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
5355results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
5356@value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
5357assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
5358consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
5359}.
5360
5361If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
5362reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
5363
5364@table @code
5365@kindex reverse-continue
5366@kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
5367@item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5368@itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5369Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
5370in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
5371exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
5372asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
5373
5374@kindex reverse-step
5375@kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
5376@item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5377Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
5378different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
5379
5380Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
5381at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
5382executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
5383debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
5384the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
5385statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
5386
5387Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
5388called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
5389
5390@kindex reverse-stepi
5391@kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
5392@item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5393Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
5394to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
5395counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
5396if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
5397back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
5398
5399@kindex reverse-next
5400@kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
5401@item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5402Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
5403the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
5404calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
5405the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
5406to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
5407just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
5408line of a function back to its return to its caller
5409@footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
5410
5411@kindex reverse-nexti
5412@kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
5413@item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5414Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
5415in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
5416That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
5417another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
5418in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
5419frame) is reached.
5420
5421@kindex reverse-finish
5422@item reverse-finish
5423Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
5424current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
5425where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
5426function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
5427
5428@kindex set exec-direction
5429@item set exec-direction
5430Set the direction of target execution.
5431@itemx set exec-direction reverse
5432@cindex execute forward or backward in time
5433@value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
5434exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
5435@code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
5436command cannot be used in reverse mode.
5437@item set exec-direction forward
5438@value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
5439This is the default.
5440@end table
5441
5442
5443@node Process Record and Replay
5444@chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
5445@cindex process record and replay
5446@cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
5447
5448On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
5449and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
5450replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
5451
5452@cindex replay mode
5453When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
5454for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
5455mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
5456instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
5457code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
5458really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
5459program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
5460changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
5461execution log.
5462
5463@cindex record mode
5464If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
5465@value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
5466inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
5467for future replay.
5468
5469The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
5470(@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
5471inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
5472this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
5473log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
5474support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
5475
5476When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
5477replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
5478previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
5479platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
5480
5481For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
5482@value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
5483
5484@table @code
5485@kindex target record
5486@kindex record
5487@kindex rec
5488@item target record
5489This command starts the process record and replay target. The process
5490record and replay target can only debug a process that is already
5491running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with the
5492@kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording with
5493the @kbd{target record} command.
5494
5495Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are aliases of @code{target record}.
5496
5497@cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
5498Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
5499will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
5500is started. That's because the process record and replay target
5501doesn't support displaced stepping.
5502
5503@cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
5504@cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
5505If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
5506the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), the
5507process record and replay target cannot be started because it doesn't
5508support these two modes.
5509
5510@kindex record stop
5511@kindex rec s
5512@item record stop
5513Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
5514replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
5515inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
5516
5517When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
5518the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
5519next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
5520you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
5521will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
5522
5523On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
5524while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
5525but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
5526at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
5527usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
5528
5529When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
5530process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
5531
5532@kindex set record insn-number-max
5533@item set record insn-number-max @var{limit}
5534Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000.
5535
5536If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
5537deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
5538instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
5539instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
5540instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
5541(Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
5542lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
5543the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
5544
5545If @var{limit} is zero, @value{GDBN} will never delete recorded
5546instructions from the execution log. The number of recorded
5547instructions is unlimited in this case.
5548
5549@kindex show record insn-number-max
5550@item show record insn-number-max
5551Show the limit of instructions to be recorded.
5552
5553@kindex set record stop-at-limit
5554@item set record stop-at-limit
5555Control the behavior when the number of recorded instructions reaches
5556the limit. If ON (the default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit
5557is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the
5558inferior or continue running it and recording the execution log. If
5559you decide to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will
5560cause the oldest one to be deleted.
5561
5562If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
5563oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
5564
5565@kindex show record stop-at-limit
5566@item show record stop-at-limit
5567Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
5568
5569@kindex info record
5570@item info record
5571Show various statistics about the state of process record and its
5572in-memory execution log buffer, including:
5573
5574@itemize @bullet
5575@item
5576Whether in record mode or replay mode.
5577@item
5578Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
5579@item
5580Highest recorded instruction number.
5581@item
5582Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
5583@item
5584Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
5585@item
5586Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
5587@end itemize
5588
5589@kindex record delete
5590@kindex rec del
5591@item record delete
5592When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
5593subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
5594from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
5595recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
5596@end table
5597
5598
5599@node Stack
5600@chapter Examining the Stack
5601
5602When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5603stopped and how it got there.
5604
5605@cindex call stack
5606Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5607is generated.
5608That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5609the arguments of the call,
5610and the local variables of the function being called.
5611The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5612The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5613stack}.
5614
5615When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5616stack allow you to see all of this information.
5617
5618@cindex selected frame
5619One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5620@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5621particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5622your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5623special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5624interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5625
5626When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5627currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5628@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5629
5630@menu
5631* Frames:: Stack frames
5632* Backtrace:: Backtraces
5633* Selection:: Selecting a frame
5634* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5635
5636@end menu
5637
5638@node Frames
5639@section Stack Frames
5640
5641@cindex frame, definition
5642@cindex stack frame
5643The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5644frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5645with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5646to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5647which the function is executing.
5648
5649@cindex initial frame
5650@cindex outermost frame
5651@cindex innermost frame
5652When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5653function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5654@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5655made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5656is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5657the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5658actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5659recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5660
5661@cindex frame pointer
5662Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5663stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5664kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5665address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5666in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5667(@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5668
5669@cindex frame number
5670@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5671zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5672and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5673they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5674frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5675
5676@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5677@c underflow problems.
5678@cindex frameless execution
5679Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5680without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5681@smallexample
5682@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5683@end smallexample
5684generates functions without a frame.)
5685This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5686the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5687with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5688has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5689it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5690correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5691no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5692
5693@table @code
5694@kindex frame@r{, command}
5695@cindex current stack frame
5696@item frame @var{args}
5697The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5698and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5699address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5700@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5701
5702@kindex select-frame
5703@cindex selecting frame silently
5704@item select-frame
5705The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5706to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5707@code{frame}.
5708@end table
5709
5710@node Backtrace
5711@section Backtraces
5712
5713@cindex traceback
5714@cindex call stack traces
5715A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5716line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5717frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5718stack.
5719
5720@table @code
5721@kindex backtrace
5722@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5723@item backtrace
5724@itemx bt
5725Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5726frames in the stack.
5727
5728You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5729character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5730
5731@item backtrace @var{n}
5732@itemx bt @var{n}
5733Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5734
5735@item backtrace -@var{n}
5736@itemx bt -@var{n}
5737Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5738
5739@item backtrace full
5740@itemx bt full
5741@itemx bt full @var{n}
5742@itemx bt full -@var{n}
5743Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5744number of frames to print, as described above.
5745@end table
5746
5747@kindex where
5748@kindex info stack
5749The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5750are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5751
5752@cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5753In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5754backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5755several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5756(@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5757apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5758the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5759multi-threaded program.
5760
5761Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5762The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5763print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5764line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5765counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5766line number.
5767
5768Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5769@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5770
5771@smallexample
5772@group
5773#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5774 at builtin.c:993
5775#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
5776#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5777 at macro.c:71
5778(More stack frames follow...)
5779@end group
5780@end smallexample
5781
5782@noindent
5783The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5784value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5785code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5786
5787@noindent
5788The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
5789@code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
5790only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
5791@kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
5792on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
5793
5794@cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
5795@cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5796If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5797optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5798never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5799passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5800in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5801arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5802such a backtrace might look like:
5803
5804@smallexample
5805@group
5806#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5807 at builtin.c:993
5808#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5809#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5810 at macro.c:71
5811(More stack frames follow...)
5812@end group
5813@end smallexample
5814
5815@noindent
5816The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5817shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5818
5819If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5820either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5821you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5822
5823@cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5824@cindex program entry point
5825@cindex startup code, and backtrace
5826Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5827libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5828@code{main}@footnote{
5829Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5830environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5831entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
5832When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
5833it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
5834system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
5835
5836If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
5837in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
5838
5839@table @code
5840@item set backtrace past-main
5841@itemx set backtrace past-main on
5842@kindex set backtrace
5843Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
5844
5845@item set backtrace past-main off
5846Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
5847default.
5848
5849@item show backtrace past-main
5850@kindex show backtrace
5851Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
5852
5853@item set backtrace past-entry
5854@itemx set backtrace past-entry on
5855Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
5856This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
5857and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
5858
5859@item set backtrace past-entry off
5860Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
5861application. This is the default.
5862
5863@item show backtrace past-entry
5864Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
5865
5866@item set backtrace limit @var{n}
5867@itemx set backtrace limit 0
5868@cindex backtrace limit
5869Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
5870unlimited.
5871
5872@item show backtrace limit
5873Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
5874@end table
5875
5876@node Selection
5877@section Selecting a Frame
5878
5879Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
5880whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
5881selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
5882of the stack frame just selected.
5883
5884@table @code
5885@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
5886@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
5887@item frame @var{n}
5888@itemx f @var{n}
5889Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
5890(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
5891innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
5892@code{main}.
5893
5894@item frame @var{addr}
5895@itemx f @var{addr}
5896Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
5897chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
5898impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
5899addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
5900switches between them.
5901
5902On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
5903select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
5904
5905On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
5906pointer and a program counter.
5907
5908On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
5909pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
5910
5911@kindex up
5912@item up @var{n}
5913Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5914advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
5915that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
5916
5917@kindex down
5918@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
5919@item down @var{n}
5920Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5921advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
5922that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
5923abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
5924@end table
5925
5926All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
5927frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
5928arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5929frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
5930
5931@need 1000
5932For example:
5933
5934@smallexample
5935@group
5936(@value{GDBP}) up
5937#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
5938 at env.c:10
593910 read_input_file (argv[i]);
5940@end group
5941@end smallexample
5942
5943After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
5944prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
5945You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
5946editing program by typing @code{edit}.
5947@xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
5948for details.
5949
5950@table @code
5951@kindex down-silently
5952@kindex up-silently
5953@item up-silently @var{n}
5954@itemx down-silently @var{n}
5955These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
5956respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
5957causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
5958in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
5959distracting.
5960@end table
5961
5962@node Frame Info
5963@section Information About a Frame
5964
5965There are several other commands to print information about the selected
5966stack frame.
5967
5968@table @code
5969@item frame
5970@itemx f
5971When used without any argument, this command does not change which
5972frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
5973selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
5974argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
5975@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5976
5977@kindex info frame
5978@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
5979@item info frame
5980@itemx info f
5981This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
5982including:
5983
5984@itemize @bullet
5985@item
5986the address of the frame
5987@item
5988the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
5989@item
5990the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
5991@item
5992the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
5993@item
5994the address of the frame's arguments
5995@item
5996the address of the frame's local variables
5997@item
5998the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
5999@item
6000which registers were saved in the frame
6001@end itemize
6002
6003@noindent The verbose description is useful when
6004something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
6005the usual conventions.
6006
6007@item info frame @var{addr}
6008@itemx info f @var{addr}
6009Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
6010selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
6011command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
6012architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
6013@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6014
6015@kindex info args
6016@item info args
6017Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
6018
6019@item info locals
6020@kindex info locals
6021Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
6022line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
6023accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
6024
6025@kindex info catch
6026@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
6027@cindex exception handlers, how to list
6028@item info catch
6029Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
6030current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
6031exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
6032@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
6033@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
6034
6035@end table
6036
6037
6038@node Source
6039@chapter Examining Source Files
6040
6041@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
6042information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
6043used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
6044the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
6045(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
6046execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
6047source files by explicit command.
6048
6049If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
6050prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
6051@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
6052
6053@menu
6054* List:: Printing source lines
6055* Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
6056* Edit:: Editing source files
6057* Search:: Searching source files
6058* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
6059* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
6060@end menu
6061
6062@node List
6063@section Printing Source Lines
6064
6065@kindex list
6066@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
6067To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
6068(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
6069There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
6070print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
6071
6072Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
6073
6074@table @code
6075@item list @var{linenum}
6076Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
6077current source file.
6078
6079@item list @var{function}
6080Print lines centered around the beginning of function
6081@var{function}.
6082
6083@item list
6084Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
6085@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
6086printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
6087as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
6088Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
6089
6090@item list -
6091Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6092@end table
6093
6094@cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
6095By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
6096the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
6097
6098@table @code
6099@kindex set listsize
6100@item set listsize @var{count}
6101Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
6102the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
6103
6104@kindex show listsize
6105@item show listsize
6106Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
6107@end table
6108
6109Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
6110so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
6111than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
6112argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
6113each repetition moves up in the source file.
6114
6115In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
6116@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
6117of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
6118to specify some source line.
6119
6120Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
6121
6122@table @code
6123@item list @var{linespec}
6124Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
6125
6126@item list @var{first},@var{last}
6127Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
6128linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
6129source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
6130the same source file as the first linespec.
6131
6132@item list ,@var{last}
6133Print lines ending with @var{last}.
6134
6135@item list @var{first},
6136Print lines starting with @var{first}.
6137
6138@item list +
6139Print lines just after the lines last printed.
6140
6141@item list -
6142Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6143
6144@item list
6145As described in the preceding table.
6146@end table
6147
6148@node Specify Location
6149@section Specifying a Location
6150@cindex specifying location
6151@cindex linespec
6152
6153Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
6154of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
6155debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
6156for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
6157
6158Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
6159@value{GDBN} understands:
6160
6161@table @code
6162@item @var{linenum}
6163Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
6164
6165@item -@var{offset}
6166@itemx +@var{offset}
6167Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
6168line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
6169printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
6170execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
6171(@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
6172used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
6173this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
6174linespec.
6175
6176@item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
6177Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
6178
6179@item @var{function}
6180Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
6181For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
6182
6183@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
6184Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
6185in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
6186function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
6187functions in different source files.
6188
6189@item *@var{address}
6190Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
6191commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
6192line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
6193breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
6194parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
6195source files.
6196
6197Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
6198language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
6199address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
6200semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
6201that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
6202of @var{address}:
6203
6204@table @code
6205@item @var{expression}
6206Any expression valid in the current working language.
6207
6208@item @var{funcaddr}
6209An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
6210C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
6211simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
6212of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
6213@code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
6214(although the Pascal form also works).
6215
6216This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
6217before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
6218
6219@item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
6220Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
6221file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
6222specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
6223functions with identical names in different source files.
6224@end table
6225
6226@end table
6227
6228
6229@node Edit
6230@section Editing Source Files
6231@cindex editing source files
6232
6233@kindex edit
6234@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
6235To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
6236The editing program of your choice
6237is invoked with the current line set to
6238the active line in the program.
6239Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
6240want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
6241
6242@table @code
6243@item edit @var{location}
6244Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
6245that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
6246specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
6247of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
6248command most commonly used:
6249
6250@table @code
6251@item edit @var{number}
6252Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
6253
6254@item edit @var{function}
6255Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
6256@end table
6257
6258@end table
6259
6260@subsection Choosing your Editor
6261You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
6262@footnote{
6263The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
6264following command-line syntax:
6265@smallexample
6266ex +@var{number} file
6267@end smallexample
6268The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
6269the file where to start editing.}.
6270By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
6271by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
6272@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
6273@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
6274@smallexample
6275EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
6276export EDITOR
6277gdb @dots{}
6278@end smallexample
6279or in the @code{csh} shell,
6280@smallexample
6281setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
6282gdb @dots{}
6283@end smallexample
6284
6285@node Search
6286@section Searching Source Files
6287@cindex searching source files
6288
6289There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
6290regular expression.
6291
6292@table @code
6293@kindex search
6294@kindex forward-search
6295@item forward-search @var{regexp}
6296@itemx search @var{regexp}
6297The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
6298starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
6299@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
6300synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
6301@code{fo}.
6302
6303@kindex reverse-search
6304@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
6305The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
6306with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
6307for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
6308this command as @code{rev}.
6309@end table
6310
6311@node Source Path
6312@section Specifying Source Directories
6313
6314@cindex source path
6315@cindex directories for source files
6316Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
6317files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
6318the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
6319session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
6320this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
6321it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
6322in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
6323
6324For example, suppose an executable references the file
6325@file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
6326@file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
6327fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
6328fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
6329message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
6330source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
6331Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
6332the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
6333@file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
6334@file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
6335
6336Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
6337names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
6338instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
6339is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
6340@file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
6341that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
6342
6343Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
6344source files.
6345
6346Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
6347any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
6348each line is in the file.
6349
6350@kindex directory
6351@kindex dir
6352When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
6353and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
6354To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
6355
6356The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
6357script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
6358
6359In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
6360that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
6361rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
6362debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
6363directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
6364two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
6365the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
6366In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
6367@var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
6368of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
6369source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
6370name to look up the sources.
6371
6372Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
6373moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
6374@value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
6375@file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
6376@file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
6377of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
6378substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
6379(@pxref{set substitute-path}).
6380
6381To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
6382@var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
6383For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
6384@file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
6385not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
6386is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
6387not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
6388
6389In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
6390command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
6391the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
6392subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
6393subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
6394preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
6395allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
6396command.
6397
6398@code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
6399The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
6400longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
6401the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
6402for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
6403located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
6404method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
6405
6406@cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
6407@cindex default source path substitution
6408You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
6409configuring @value{GDBN} with the
6410@samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
6411should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
6412prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
6413directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
6414automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
6415location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
6416with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
6417together.
6418
6419@table @code
6420@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
6421@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
6422Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
6423directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
6424(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
6425part of absolute file names) or
6426whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
6427path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
6428
6429@kindex cdir
6430@kindex cwd
6431@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
6432@vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
6433@cindex compilation directory
6434@cindex current directory
6435@cindex working directory
6436@cindex directory, current
6437@cindex directory, compilation
6438You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
6439directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
6440working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
6441tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
6442session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
6443directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
6444
6445@item directory
6446Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
6447
6448@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
6449@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
6450
6451@item show directories
6452@kindex show directories
6453Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
6454
6455@anchor{set substitute-path}
6456@item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
6457@kindex set substitute-path
6458Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
6459current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
6460@var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
6461
6462For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
6463@file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
6464
6465@smallexample
6466(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
6467@end smallexample
6468
6469@noindent
6470will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
6471@samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
6472@file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
6473
6474In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
6475the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
6476defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
6477the substitution.
6478
6479For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
6480
6481@smallexample
6482(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
6483(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
6484@end smallexample
6485
6486@noindent
6487@value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
6488@file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
6489use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
6490@file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
6491
6492
6493@item unset substitute-path [path]
6494@kindex unset substitute-path
6495If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
6496for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
6497A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
6498
6499If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
6500
6501@item show substitute-path [path]
6502@kindex show substitute-path
6503If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
6504which would rewrite that path, if any.
6505
6506If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
6507rules.
6508
6509@end table
6510
6511If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
6512interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
6513versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
6514
6515@enumerate
6516@item
6517Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
6518
6519@item
6520Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
6521directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
6522directories in one command.
6523@end enumerate
6524
6525@node Machine Code
6526@section Source and Machine Code
6527@cindex source line and its code address
6528
6529You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
6530addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
6531a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
6532@code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
6533source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6534mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
6535line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
6536well as hex.
6537
6538@table @code
6539@kindex info line
6540@item info line @var{linespec}
6541Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
6542source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
6543the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
6544@end table
6545
6546For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
6547the object code for the first line of function
6548@code{m4_changequote}:
6549
6550@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
6551@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
6552@smallexample
6553(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
6554Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
6555@end smallexample
6556
6557@noindent
6558@cindex code address and its source line
6559We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
6560@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
6561@smallexample
6562(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
6563Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
6564@end smallexample
6565
6566@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
6567@cindex @code{x} command, default address
6568@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
6569After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
6570is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
6571sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
6572,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
6573convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6574Variables}).
6575
6576@table @code
6577@kindex disassemble
6578@cindex assembly instructions
6579@cindex instructions, assembly
6580@cindex machine instructions
6581@cindex listing machine instructions
6582@item disassemble
6583@itemx disassemble /m
6584@itemx disassemble /r
6585This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
6586instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
6587the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
6588in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
6589The default memory range is the function surrounding the
6590program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
6591command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
6592surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
6593be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
6594arguments specify a range of addresses (first inclusive, second exclusive)
6595to dump. In that case, the name of the function is also printed (since
6596there could be several functions in the given range).
6597
6598The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
6599@samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
6600
6601If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
6602the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
6603@end table
6604
6605The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
6606HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
6607
6608@smallexample
6609(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
6610Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
6611 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
6612 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
6613 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6614 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
6615 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
6616 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
6617 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
6618 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6619End of assembler dump.
6620@end smallexample
6621
6622Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
6623program is stopped just after function prologue:
6624
6625@smallexample
6626(@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
6627Dump of assembler code for function main:
66285 @{
6629 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
6630 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6631 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6632 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6633 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6634
66356 printf ("Hello.\n");
6636=> 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6637 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6638
66397 return 0;
66408 @}
6641 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6642 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
6643 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
6644
6645End of assembler dump.
6646@end smallexample
6647
6648Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
6649mnemonics or other syntax.
6650
6651For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
6652instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
6653libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
6654location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
6655might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
6656
6657@table @code
6658@kindex set disassembly-flavor
6659@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
6660@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
6661@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
6662Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
6663program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
6664
6665Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
6666can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
6667The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
6668assemblers for x86-based targets.
6669
6670@kindex show disassembly-flavor
6671@item show disassembly-flavor
6672Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
6673@end table
6674
6675@table @code
6676@kindex set disassemble-next-line
6677@kindex show disassemble-next-line
6678@item set disassemble-next-line
6679@itemx show disassemble-next-line
6680Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
6681line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
6682display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
6683program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
6684displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
6685possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
6686(e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
6687info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
6688next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
6689AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
6690if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
6691@value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
6692with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
6693OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
6694instruction.
6695@end table
6696
6697
6698@node Data
6699@chapter Examining Data
6700
6701@cindex printing data
6702@cindex examining data
6703@kindex print
6704@kindex inspect
6705@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
6706@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
6707@c different window or something like that.
6708The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
6709command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
6710evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
6711program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
6712Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
6713Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
6714
6715@table @code
6716@item print @var{expr}
6717@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
6718@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
6719value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
6720you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
6721@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
6722Formats}.
6723
6724@item print
6725@itemx print /@var{f}
6726@cindex reprint the last value
6727If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
6728@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
6729conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6730@end table
6731
6732A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6733It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6734specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6735
6736If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6737fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6738command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6739Table}.
6740
6741@menu
6742* Expressions:: Expressions
6743* Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6744* Variables:: Program variables
6745* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6746* Output Formats:: Output formats
6747* Memory:: Examining memory
6748* Auto Display:: Automatic display
6749* Print Settings:: Print settings
6750* Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
6751* Value History:: Value history
6752* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6753* Registers:: Registers
6754* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6755* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6756* OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6757* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6758* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6759* Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6760* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6761 character set than GDB does
6762* Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6763* Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
6764@end menu
6765
6766@node Expressions
6767@section Expressions
6768
6769@cindex expressions
6770@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
6771compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
6772by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
6773@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
6774casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
6775you compiled your program to include this information; see
6776@ref{Compilation}.
6777
6778@cindex arrays in expressions
6779@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
6780the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
6781you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
6782of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
6783to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
6784is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
6785
6786Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
6787this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
6788Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
6789languages.
6790
6791In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
6792expressions regardless of your programming language.
6793
6794@cindex casts, in expressions
6795Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
6796useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
6797at that address in memory.
6798@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
6799
6800@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
6801to programming languages:
6802
6803@table @code
6804@item @@
6805@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
6806@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
6807
6808@item ::
6809@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
6810function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
6811
6812@cindex @{@var{type}@}
6813@cindex type casting memory
6814@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
6815@cindex casts, to view memory
6816@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
6817Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
6818memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
6819pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
6820a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
6821normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
6822@end table
6823
6824@node Ambiguous Expressions
6825@section Ambiguous Expressions
6826@cindex ambiguous expressions
6827
6828Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
6829some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
6830a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
6831different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
6832involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
6833templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
6834the same function name being defined in different contexts.
6835
6836In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
6837the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
6838can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
6839@kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
6840qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
6841as well.
6842
6843When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
6844has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
6845possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
6846The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
6847aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
6848used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
6849menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
6850choices.
6851
6852For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
6853breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
6854We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
6855
6856@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
6857@smallexample
6858@group
6859(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
6860[0] cancel
6861[1] all
6862[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
6863[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
6864[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
6865[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
6866[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
6867[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
6868> 2 4 6
6869Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
6870Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
6871Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
6872Multiple breakpoints were set.
6873Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
6874 breakpoints.
6875(@value{GDBP})
6876@end group
6877@end smallexample
6878
6879@table @code
6880@kindex set multiple-symbols
6881@item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
6882@cindex multiple-symbols menu
6883
6884This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
6885is ambiguous.
6886
6887By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
6888the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
6889automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
6890a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
6891inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
6892then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
6893For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
6894in the use of the menu.
6895
6896When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
6897when an ambiguity is detected.
6898
6899Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
6900an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
6901
6902@kindex show multiple-symbols
6903@item show multiple-symbols
6904Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
6905@end table
6906
6907@node Variables
6908@section Program Variables
6909
6910The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
6911in your program.
6912
6913Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
6914(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
6915
6916@itemize @bullet
6917@item
6918global (or file-static)
6919@end itemize
6920
6921@noindent or
6922
6923@itemize @bullet
6924@item
6925visible according to the scope rules of the
6926programming language from the point of execution in that frame
6927@end itemize
6928
6929@noindent This means that in the function
6930
6931@smallexample
6932foo (a)
6933 int a;
6934@{
6935 bar (a);
6936 @{
6937 int b = test ();
6938 bar (b);
6939 @}
6940@}
6941@end smallexample
6942
6943@noindent
6944you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
6945executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
6946examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
6947the block where @code{b} is declared.
6948
6949@cindex variable name conflict
6950There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
6951scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
6952in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
6953function with the same name (in different source files). If that
6954happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
6955you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
6956using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
6957
6958@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
6959@ifnotinfo
6960@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
6961@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
6962@end ifnotinfo
6963@smallexample
6964@var{file}::@var{variable}
6965@var{function}::@var{variable}
6966@end smallexample
6967
6968@noindent
6969Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
6970static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
6971make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
6972to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
6973
6974@smallexample
6975(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
6976@end smallexample
6977
6978@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
6979This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
6980use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
6981scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
6982@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
6983@c conflict?? --mew
6984
6985@cindex wrong values
6986@cindex variable values, wrong
6987@cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
6988@cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
6989@quotation
6990@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
6991wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
6992scope, and just before exit.
6993@end quotation
6994You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
6995This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
6996set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
6997stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
6998values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
6999also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
7000after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
7001variable definitions may be gone.
7002
7003This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
7004To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
7005when compiling.
7006
7007@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
7008Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
7009unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
7010opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
7011offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
7012might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
7013happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
7014
7015@smallexample
7016No symbol "foo" in current context.
7017@end smallexample
7018
7019To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
7020different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
7021formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
7022usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
7023produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
7024COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
7025an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
7026for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
7027Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
7028@xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
7029that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
7030
7031If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
7032@value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
7033by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
7034type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
7035
7036Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
7037signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
7038printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
7039@code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
7040defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
7041For program code
7042
7043@smallexample
7044char var0[] = "A";
7045signed char var1[] = "A";
7046@end smallexample
7047
7048You get during debugging
7049@smallexample
7050(gdb) print var0
7051$1 = "A"
7052(gdb) print var1
7053$2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
7054@end smallexample
7055
7056@node Arrays
7057@section Artificial Arrays
7058
7059@cindex artificial array
7060@cindex arrays
7061@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
7062It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
7063same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
7064dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
7065program.
7066
7067You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
7068@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
7069operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
7070and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
7071of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
7072the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
7073argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
7074following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
7075example. If a program says
7076
7077@smallexample
7078int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
7079@end smallexample
7080
7081@noindent
7082you can print the contents of @code{array} with
7083
7084@smallexample
7085p *array@@len
7086@end smallexample
7087
7088The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
7089with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
7090subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
7091Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
7092(@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
7093
7094Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
7095This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
7096The value need not be in memory:
7097@smallexample
7098(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
7099$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7100@end smallexample
7101
7102As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
7103@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
7104the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
7105@smallexample
7106(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
7107$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7108@end smallexample
7109
7110Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
7111moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
7112actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
7113of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
7114to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7115Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
7116interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
7117instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
7118structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
7119in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
7120
7121@smallexample
7122set $i = 0
7123p dtab[$i++]->fv
7124@key{RET}
7125@key{RET}
7126@dots{}
7127@end smallexample
7128
7129@node Output Formats
7130@section Output Formats
7131
7132@cindex formatted output
7133@cindex output formats
7134By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
7135this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
7136in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
7137at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
7138these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
7139
7140The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
7141already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
7142@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
7143letters supported are:
7144
7145@table @code
7146@item x
7147Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
7148hexadecimal.
7149
7150@item d
7151Print as integer in signed decimal.
7152
7153@item u
7154Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
7155
7156@item o
7157Print as integer in octal.
7158
7159@item t
7160Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
7161@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
7162used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
7163see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
7164
7165@item a
7166@cindex unknown address, locating
7167@cindex locate address
7168Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
7169the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
7170where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
7171
7172@smallexample
7173(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
7174$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
7175@end smallexample
7176
7177@noindent
7178The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
7179@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
7180
7181@item c
7182Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
7183prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
7184character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
7185for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
7186
7187Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
7188@w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
7189constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
7190data.
7191
7192@item f
7193Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
7194using typical floating point syntax.
7195
7196@item s
7197@cindex printing strings
7198@cindex printing byte arrays
7199Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
7200data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
7201are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
7202natural types.
7203
7204Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
7205@code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
7206strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
7207array.
7208
7209@item r
7210@cindex raw printing
7211Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
7212use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
7213Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
7214value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
7215pretty-printer which might exist.
7216@end table
7217
7218For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
7219
7220@smallexample
7221p/x $pc
7222@end smallexample
7223
7224@noindent
7225Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
7226names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
7227
7228To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
7229you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
7230expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
7231
7232@node Memory
7233@section Examining Memory
7234
7235You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
7236any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
7237
7238@cindex examining memory
7239@table @code
7240@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
7241@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
7242@itemx x @var{addr}
7243@itemx x
7244Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
7245@end table
7246
7247@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
7248much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
7249expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
7250If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
7251Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
7252
7253@table @r
7254@item @var{n}, the repeat count
7255The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
7256how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
7257@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
7258@c 4.1.2.
7259
7260@item @var{f}, the display format
7261The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
7262(@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
7263@samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
7264The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
7265each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
7266
7267@item @var{u}, the unit size
7268The unit size is any of
7269
7270@table @code
7271@item b
7272Bytes.
7273@item h
7274Halfwords (two bytes).
7275@item w
7276Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
7277@item g
7278Giant words (eight bytes).
7279@end table
7280
7281Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
7282default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
7283the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
7284the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
7285Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
728632-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
7287Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
7288current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
7289modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
7290UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
7291be altered.
7292
7293@item @var{addr}, starting display address
7294@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
7295memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
7296it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
7297@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
7298@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
7299other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
7300the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
7301starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
7302a value from memory).
7303@end table
7304
7305For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
7306(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
7307starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
7308words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
7309@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
7310
7311Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
7312letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
7313unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
7314specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
7315(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
7316
7317Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
7318and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
7319@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
7320including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
7321the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
7322slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
7323follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
7324@code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
7325instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
7326
7327All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
7328easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
7329you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
7330instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
7331with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
7332the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
7333for successive uses of @code{x}.
7334
7335When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
7336counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
7337
7338@smallexample
7339(@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
7340 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
7341 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
7342 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
7343=> 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
7344 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
7345@end smallexample
7346
7347@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
7348The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
7349in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
7350would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
7351subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
7352@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
7353examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
7354@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
7355the convenience variable @code{$__}.
7356
7357If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
7358are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
7359address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
7360
7361@cindex remote memory comparison
7362@cindex verify remote memory image
7363When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
7364(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
7365remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
7366the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
7367situations.
7368
7369@table @code
7370@kindex compare-sections
7371@item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
7372Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
7373executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
7374the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
7375arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
7376availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
7377remote request.
7378@end table
7379
7380@node Auto Display
7381@section Automatic Display
7382@cindex automatic display
7383@cindex display of expressions
7384
7385If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
7386(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
7387display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
7388Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
7389to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
7390The automatic display looks like this:
7391
7392@smallexample
73932: foo = 38
73943: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
7395@end smallexample
7396
7397@noindent
7398This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
7399displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
7400specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
7401whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
7402specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
7403or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
7404
7405@table @code
7406@kindex display
7407@item display @var{expr}
7408Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
7409each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7410
7411@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
7412
7413@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
7414For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
7415count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
7416arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
7417@xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
7418
7419@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
7420For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
7421number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
7422be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
7423doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7424@end table
7425
7426For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
7427instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
7428is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7429
7430@table @code
7431@kindex delete display
7432@kindex undisplay
7433@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
7434@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7435Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
7436
7437@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7438(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
7439
7440@kindex disable display
7441@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7442Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
7443item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
7444enabled again later.
7445
7446@kindex enable display
7447@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7448Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
7449again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
7450
7451@item display
7452Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
7453done when your program stops.
7454
7455@kindex info display
7456@item info display
7457Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
7458automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
7459values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
7460It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
7461because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
7462@end table
7463
7464@cindex display disabled out of scope
7465If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
7466sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
7467expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
7468variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
7469@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
7470@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
7471continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
7472there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
7473automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
7474is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
7475
7476@node Print Settings
7477@section Print Settings
7478
7479@cindex format options
7480@cindex print settings
7481@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
7482and symbols are printed.
7483
7484@noindent
7485These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
7486
7487@table @code
7488@kindex set print
7489@item set print address
7490@itemx set print address on
7491@cindex print/don't print memory addresses
7492@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
7493traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
7494even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
7495is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
7496@code{set print address on}:
7497
7498@smallexample
7499@group
7500(@value{GDBP}) f
7501#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
7502 at input.c:530
7503530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7504@end group
7505@end smallexample
7506
7507@item set print address off
7508Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
7509this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
7510
7511@smallexample
7512@group
7513(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
7514(@value{GDBP}) f
7515#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
7516530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7517@end group
7518@end smallexample
7519
7520You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
7521dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
7522@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
7523all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
7524
7525@kindex show print
7526@item show print address
7527Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
7528@end table
7529
7530When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
7531closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
7532identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
7533source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
7534@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
7535you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
7536it prints a symbolic address:
7537
7538@table @code
7539@item set print symbol-filename on
7540@cindex source file and line of a symbol
7541@cindex symbol, source file and line
7542Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
7543symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7544
7545@item set print symbol-filename off
7546Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
7547default.
7548
7549@item show print symbol-filename
7550Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
7551line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7552@end table
7553
7554Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
7555numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
7556number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
7557
7558Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
7559printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
7560
7561@table @code
7562@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
7563@cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
7564Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
7565offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
7566@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
7567to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
7568
7569@item show print max-symbolic-offset
7570Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
7571symbolic address.
7572@end table
7573
7574@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
7575@cindex pointer, finding referent
7576If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
7577@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
7578and source file location of the variable where it points, using
7579@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
7580For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
7581at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
7582
7583@smallexample
7584(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
7585(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
7586$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
7587@end smallexample
7588
7589@quotation
7590@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
7591does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
7592the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
7593@end quotation
7594
7595Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
7596
7597@table @code
7598@item set print array
7599@itemx set print array on
7600@cindex pretty print arrays
7601Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
7602but uses more space. The default is off.
7603
7604@item set print array off
7605Return to compressed format for arrays.
7606
7607@item show print array
7608Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
7609arrays.
7610
7611@cindex print array indexes
7612@item set print array-indexes
7613@itemx set print array-indexes on
7614Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
7615convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
7616index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
7617
7618@item set print array-indexes off
7619Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
7620
7621@item show print array-indexes
7622Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
7623arrays.
7624
7625@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
7626@cindex number of array elements to print
7627@cindex limit on number of printed array elements
7628Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
7629If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
7630printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
7631This limit also applies to the display of strings.
7632When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
7633Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
7634
7635@item show print elements
7636Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
7637If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
7638
7639@item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
7640@kindex set print frame-arguments
7641@cindex printing frame argument values
7642@cindex print all frame argument values
7643@cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
7644@cindex do not print frame argument values
7645This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
7646when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
7647values are:
7648
7649@table @code
7650@item all
7651The values of all arguments are printed.
7652
7653@item scalars
7654Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
7655complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
7656by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
7657only scalar arguments are shown:
7658
7659@smallexample
7660#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
7661 at frame-args.c:23
7662@end smallexample
7663
7664@item none
7665None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
7666is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
7667
7668@smallexample
7669#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
7670 at frame-args.c:23
7671@end smallexample
7672@end table
7673
7674By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
7675to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
7676of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
7677of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
7678information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
7679Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
7680the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
7681especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
7682to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
7683thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
7684
7685@item show print frame-arguments
7686Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
7687
7688@item set print repeats
7689@cindex repeated array elements
7690Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
7691elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
7692array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
7693@code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
7694identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
7695themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
7696be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
7697
7698@item show print repeats
7699Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
7700elements.
7701
7702@item set print null-stop
7703@cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
7704Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
7705@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
7706contain only short strings.
7707The default is off.
7708
7709@item show print null-stop
7710Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
7711@sc{null} character.
7712
7713@item set print pretty on
7714@cindex print structures in indented form
7715@cindex indentation in structure display
7716Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
7717per line, like this:
7718
7719@smallexample
7720@group
7721$1 = @{
7722 next = 0x0,
7723 flags = @{
7724 sweet = 1,
7725 sour = 1
7726 @},
7727 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
7728@}
7729@end group
7730@end smallexample
7731
7732@item set print pretty off
7733Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
7734
7735@smallexample
7736@group
7737$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
7738meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
7739@end group
7740@end smallexample
7741
7742@noindent
7743This is the default format.
7744
7745@item show print pretty
7746Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
7747
7748@item set print sevenbit-strings on
7749@cindex eight-bit characters in strings
7750@cindex octal escapes in strings
7751Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
7752@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
7753character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
7754best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
7755high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
7756
7757@item set print sevenbit-strings off
7758Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
7759international character sets, and is the default.
7760
7761@item show print sevenbit-strings
7762Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7763
7764@item set print union on
7765@cindex unions in structures, printing
7766Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
7767and other unions. This is the default setting.
7768
7769@item set print union off
7770Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
7771structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
7772instead.
7773
7774@item show print union
7775Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
7776structures and other unions.
7777
7778For example, given the declarations
7779
7780@smallexample
7781typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
7782typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
7783typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
7784 Bug_forms;
7785
7786struct thing @{
7787 Species it;
7788 union @{
7789 Tree_forms tree;
7790 Bug_forms bug;
7791 @} form;
7792@};
7793
7794struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
7795@end smallexample
7796
7797@noindent
7798with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
7799
7800@smallexample
7801$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
7802@end smallexample
7803
7804@noindent
7805and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
7806
7807@smallexample
7808$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
7809@end smallexample
7810
7811@noindent
7812@code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
7813and in Pascal.
7814@end table
7815
7816@need 1000
7817@noindent
7818These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
7819
7820@table @code
7821@cindex demangling C@t{++} names
7822@item set print demangle
7823@itemx set print demangle on
7824Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
7825(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
7826linkage. The default is on.
7827
7828@item show print demangle
7829Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
7830
7831@item set print asm-demangle
7832@itemx set print asm-demangle on
7833Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
7834in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
7835The default is off.
7836
7837@item show print asm-demangle
7838Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
7839or demangled form.
7840
7841@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
7842@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
7843@kindex set demangle-style
7844@item set demangle-style @var{style}
7845Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
7846represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
7847
7848@table @code
7849@item auto
7850Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
7851
7852@item gnu
7853Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
7854This is the default.
7855
7856@item hp
7857Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
7858
7859@item lucid
7860Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
7861
7862@item arm
7863Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
7864@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
7865debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
7866require further enhancement to permit that.
7867
7868@end table
7869If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
7870
7871@item show demangle-style
7872Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
7873
7874@item set print object
7875@itemx set print object on
7876@cindex derived type of an object, printing
7877@cindex display derived types
7878When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
7879(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
7880the virtual function table.
7881
7882@item set print object off
7883Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
7884virtual function table. This is the default setting.
7885
7886@item show print object
7887Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
7888
7889@item set print static-members
7890@itemx set print static-members on
7891@cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
7892Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
7893
7894@item set print static-members off
7895Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
7896
7897@item show print static-members
7898Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
7899
7900@item set print pascal_static-members
7901@itemx set print pascal_static-members on
7902@cindex static members of Pascal objects
7903@cindex Pascal objects, static members display
7904Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
7905
7906@item set print pascal_static-members off
7907Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
7908
7909@item show print pascal_static-members
7910Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
7911
7912@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
7913@item set print vtbl
7914@itemx set print vtbl on
7915@cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
7916@cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
7917@cindex VTBL display
7918Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
7919(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7920ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7921
7922@item set print vtbl off
7923Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
7924
7925@item show print vtbl
7926Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
7927@end table
7928
7929@node Pretty Printing
7930@section Pretty Printing
7931
7932@value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
7933Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
7934mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
7935
7936For example, here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a
7937pretty-printer:
7938
7939@smallexample
7940(@value{GDBP}) print s
7941$1 = @{
7942 static npos = 4294967295,
7943 _M_dataplus = @{
7944 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
7945 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
7946 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
7947 @},
7948 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
7949 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
7950 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
7951 @}
7952@}
7953@end smallexample
7954
7955With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
7956
7957@smallexample
7958(@value{GDBP}) print s
7959$2 = "abcd"
7960@end smallexample
7961
7962For implementing pretty printers for new types you should read the Python API
7963details (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
7964
7965@node Value History
7966@section Value History
7967
7968@cindex value history
7969@cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
7970Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
7971@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
7972Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
7973(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
7974When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
7975since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
7976symbol table.
7977
7978@cindex @code{$}
7979@cindex @code{$$}
7980@cindex history number
7981The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
7982refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
7983@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
7984printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
7985history number.
7986
7987To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
7988history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
7989remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
7990the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
7991@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
7992is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
7993@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
7994
7995For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
7996want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
7997
7998@smallexample
7999p *$
8000@end smallexample
8001
8002If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
8003to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
8004
8005@smallexample
8006p *$.next
8007@end smallexample
8008
8009@noindent
8010You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
8011command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
8012
8013Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
8014@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
8015
8016@smallexample
8017print x
8018set x=5
8019@end smallexample
8020
8021@noindent
8022then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
8023remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
8024
8025@table @code
8026@kindex show values
8027@item show values
8028Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
8029This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
8030values} does not change the history.
8031
8032@item show values @var{n}
8033Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
8034
8035@item show values +
8036Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
8037values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
8038@end table
8039
8040Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
8041same effect as @samp{show values +}.
8042
8043@node Convenience Vars
8044@section Convenience Variables
8045
8046@cindex convenience variables
8047@cindex user-defined variables
8048@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
8049@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
8050exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
8051setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
8052of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
8053
8054Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
8055@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
8056the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8057(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
8058by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
8059
8060You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
8061expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
8062For example:
8063
8064@smallexample
8065set $foo = *object_ptr
8066@end smallexample
8067
8068@noindent
8069would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
8070@code{object_ptr}.
8071
8072Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
8073value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
8074value with another assignment at any time.
8075
8076Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
8077variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
8078that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
8079variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
8080
8081@table @code
8082@kindex show convenience
8083@cindex show all user variables
8084@item show convenience
8085Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
8086Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
8087
8088@kindex init-if-undefined
8089@cindex convenience variables, initializing
8090@item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
8091Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
8092for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
8093to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
8094convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
8095override default values used in a command script.
8096
8097If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
8098any side-effects do not occur.
8099@end table
8100
8101One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
8102incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
8103a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
8104
8105@smallexample
8106set $i = 0
8107print bar[$i++]->contents
8108@end smallexample
8109
8110@noindent
8111Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
8112
8113Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
8114values likely to be useful.
8115
8116@table @code
8117@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
8118@item $_
8119The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
8120the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
8121commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
8122set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
8123and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
8124except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
8125to the type of @code{$__}.
8126
8127@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
8128@item $__
8129The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
8130to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
8131to match the format in which the data was printed.
8132
8133@item $_exitcode
8134@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
8135The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
8136the program being debugged terminates.
8137
8138@item $_siginfo
8139@vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
8140The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
8141(@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
8142could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
8143For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
8144
8145@item $_tlb
8146@vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
8147The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
8148applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
8149gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
8150@xref{General Query Packets}.
8151This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
8152
8153@end table
8154
8155On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
8156begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
8157name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
8158
8159@cindex convenience functions
8160@value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
8161have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
8162function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
8163however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
8164@value{GDBN}.
8165
8166@table @code
8167@item help function
8168@kindex help function
8169@cindex show all convenience functions
8170Print a list of all convenience functions.
8171@end table
8172
8173@node Registers
8174@section Registers
8175
8176@cindex registers
8177You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
8178with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
8179for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
8180your machine.
8181
8182@table @code
8183@kindex info registers
8184@item info registers
8185Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
8186and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8187
8188@kindex info all-registers
8189@cindex floating point registers
8190@item info all-registers
8191Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
8192and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8193
8194@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
8195Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
8196As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
8197the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
8198the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
8199@end table
8200
8201@cindex stack pointer register
8202@cindex program counter register
8203@cindex process status register
8204@cindex frame pointer register
8205@cindex standard registers
8206@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
8207expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
8208architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
8209@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
8210the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
8211pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
8212register that contains the processor status. For example,
8213you could print the program counter in hex with
8214
8215@smallexample
8216p/x $pc
8217@end smallexample
8218
8219@noindent
8220or print the instruction to be executed next with
8221
8222@smallexample
8223x/i $pc
8224@end smallexample
8225
8226@noindent
8227or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
8228one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
8229memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
8230stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
8231stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
8232regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
8233see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
8234
8235@smallexample
8236set $sp += 4
8237@end smallexample
8238
8239Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
8240your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
8241so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
8242shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
8243registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
8244can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
8245is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
8246
8247@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
8248integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
8249special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
8250registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
8251to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
8252(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
8253@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
8254
8255Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
8256means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
8257the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
8258sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
8259coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
8260programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
8261cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
8262that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
8263prints the data in both formats.
8264
8265@cindex SSE registers (x86)
8266@cindex MMX registers (x86)
8267Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
8268in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
8269have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
8270together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
8271registers in @code{struct} notation:
8272
8273@smallexample
8274(@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
8275$1 = @{
8276 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
8277 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
8278 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
8279 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
8280 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
8281 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
8282 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
8283@}
8284@end smallexample
8285
8286@noindent
8287To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
8288view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
8289value to a @code{struct} member:
8290
8291@smallexample
8292 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
8293@end smallexample
8294
8295Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
8296(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
8297value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
8298were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
8299true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
8300frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
8301
8302However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
8303code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
8304@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
8305frame makes no difference.
8306
8307@node Floating Point Hardware
8308@section Floating Point Hardware
8309@cindex floating point
8310
8311Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
8312you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
8313
8314@table @code
8315@kindex info float
8316@item info float
8317Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
8318point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
8319floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
8320the ARM and x86 machines.
8321@end table
8322
8323@node Vector Unit
8324@section Vector Unit
8325@cindex vector unit
8326
8327Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
8328more information about the status of the vector unit.
8329
8330@table @code
8331@kindex info vector
8332@item info vector
8333Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
8334layout vary depending on the hardware.
8335@end table
8336
8337@node OS Information
8338@section Operating System Auxiliary Information
8339@cindex OS information
8340
8341@value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
8342you debug your program.
8343
8344@cindex @code{ptrace} system call
8345@cindex @code{struct user} contents
8346When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
8347machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
8348system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
8349called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
8350command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
8351structure.
8352
8353@table @code
8354@item info udot
8355@kindex info udot
8356Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
8357kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
8358contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
8359the @code{examine} command.
8360@end table
8361
8362@cindex auxiliary vector
8363@cindex vector, auxiliary
8364Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
8365startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
8366specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
8367binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
8368hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
8369identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
8370Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
8371@value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
8372targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
8373support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
8374@ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
8375
8376@table @code
8377@kindex info auxv
8378@item info auxv
8379Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
8380live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
8381numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
8382tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
8383pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
8384most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
8385an unrecognized tag.
8386@end table
8387
8388On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
8389and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
8390this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
8391@samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
8392
8393@table @code
8394@kindex info os processes
8395@item info os processes
8396Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
8397@value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
8398the command corresponding to the process.
8399@end table
8400
8401@node Memory Region Attributes
8402@section Memory Region Attributes
8403@cindex memory region attributes
8404
8405@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
8406required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
8407attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
8408accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
8409target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
8410fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
8411user can override the fetched regions.
8412
8413Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
8414memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
8415accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
8416been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
8417all memory.
8418
8419When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
8420to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
8421
8422@table @code
8423@kindex mem
8424@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
8425Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
8426attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
8427monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
8428case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
8429(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
8430
8431@item mem auto
8432Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
8433regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
8434
8435@kindex delete mem
8436@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8437Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
8438monitored by @value{GDBN}.
8439
8440@kindex disable mem
8441@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8442Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8443A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
8444It may be enabled again later.
8445
8446@kindex enable mem
8447@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8448Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8449
8450@kindex info mem
8451@item info mem
8452Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
8453for each region:
8454
8455@table @emph
8456@item Memory Region Number
8457@item Enabled or Disabled.
8458Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
8459Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
8460
8461@item Lo Address
8462The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
8463
8464@item Hi Address
8465The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
8466
8467@item Attributes
8468The list of attributes set for this memory region.
8469@end table
8470@end table
8471
8472
8473@subsection Attributes
8474
8475@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
8476The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
8477write accesses to a memory region.
8478
8479While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
8480memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
8481etc.@: from accessing memory.
8482
8483@table @code
8484@item ro
8485Memory is read only.
8486@item wo
8487Memory is write only.
8488@item rw
8489Memory is read/write. This is the default.
8490@end table
8491
8492@subsubsection Memory Access Size
8493The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
8494accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
8495require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
8496specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
8497
8498@table @code
8499@item 8
8500Use 8 bit memory accesses.
8501@item 16
8502Use 16 bit memory accesses.
8503@item 32
8504Use 32 bit memory accesses.
8505@item 64
8506Use 64 bit memory accesses.
8507@end table
8508
8509@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
8510@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8511@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
8512@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
8513@c
8514@c @table @code
8515@c @item hwbreak
8516@c Always use hardware breakpoints
8517@c @item swbreak (default)
8518@c @end table
8519
8520@subsubsection Data Cache
8521The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
8522memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
8523protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
8524does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
8525registers.
8526
8527@table @code
8528@item cache
8529Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
8530@item nocache
8531Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
8532@end table
8533
8534@subsection Memory Access Checking
8535@value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
8536not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
8537regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
8538better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
8539
8540@table @code
8541@kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
8542@item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
8543If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
8544explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
8545to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
8546memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
8547treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
8548The default value is @code{on}.
8549@kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
8550@item show mem inaccessible-by-default
8551Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
8552@end table
8553
8554
8555@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
8556@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8557@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
8558@c
8559@c @table @code
8560@c @item verify
8561@c @item noverify (default)
8562@c @end table
8563
8564@node Dump/Restore Files
8565@section Copy Between Memory and a File
8566@cindex dump/restore files
8567@cindex append data to a file
8568@cindex dump data to a file
8569@cindex restore data from a file
8570
8571You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
8572@code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
8573@code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
8574@code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
8575memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
8576Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
8577files.
8578
8579@table @code
8580
8581@kindex dump
8582@item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8583@itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8584Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8585or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
8586
8587The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
8588@table @code
8589@item binary
8590Raw binary form.
8591@item ihex
8592Intel hex format.
8593@item srec
8594Motorola S-record format.
8595@item tekhex
8596Tektronix Hex format.
8597@end table
8598
8599@value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
8600@sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
8601@var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
8602form.
8603
8604@kindex append
8605@item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8606@itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8607Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8608or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
8609(@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
8610
8611@kindex restore
8612@item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
8613Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
8614@code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
8615file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
8616must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
8617
8618If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
8619contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
8620they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
8621a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
8622from that location.
8623
8624If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
8625file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
8626These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
8627the @var{bias} argument is applied.
8628
8629@end table
8630
8631@node Core File Generation
8632@section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
8633@cindex dump core from inferior
8634
8635A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
8636image of a running process and its process status (register values
8637etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
8638crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
8639automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
8640the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
8641the post-mortem debugging mode.
8642
8643Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
8644are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
8645@value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
8646
8647@table @code
8648@kindex gcore
8649@kindex generate-core-file
8650@item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
8651@itemx gcore [@var{file}]
8652Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
8653@var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
8654specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
8655@var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
8656
8657Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
8658this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
8659@end table
8660
8661@node Character Sets
8662@section Character Sets
8663@cindex character sets
8664@cindex charset
8665@cindex translating between character sets
8666@cindex host character set
8667@cindex target character set
8668
8669If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
8670represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
8671@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
8672you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
8673character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
8674@dfn{target character set}.
8675
8676For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
8677uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
8678remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
8679running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
8680then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
8681@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
8682target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
8683@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
8684character and string literals in expressions.
8685
8686@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
8687the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
8688target-charset} command, described below.
8689
8690Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
8691support:
8692
8693@table @code
8694@item set target-charset @var{charset}
8695@kindex set target-charset
8696Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
8697list of supported target character sets, type
8698@kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8699
8700@item set host-charset @var{charset}
8701@kindex set host-charset
8702Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
8703
8704By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
8705system it is running on; you can override that default using the
8706@code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
8707automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
8708case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
8709
8710@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
8711set. If you type @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8712@value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
8713
8714@item set charset @var{charset}
8715@kindex set charset
8716Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
8717above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
8718@value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
8719for both host and target.
8720
8721@item show charset
8722@kindex show charset
8723Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
8724
8725@item show host-charset
8726@kindex show host-charset
8727Show the name of the current host character set.
8728
8729@item show target-charset
8730@kindex show target-charset
8731Show the name of the current target character set.
8732
8733@item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
8734@kindex set target-wide-charset
8735Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
8736the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
8737display the list of supported wide character sets, type
8738@kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
8739
8740@item show target-wide-charset
8741@kindex show target-wide-charset
8742Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
8743@end table
8744
8745Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
8746Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
8747@file{charset-test.c}:
8748
8749@smallexample
8750#include <stdio.h>
8751
8752char ascii_hello[]
8753 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
8754 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
8755char ibm1047_hello[]
8756 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
8757 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
8758
8759main ()
8760@{
8761 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8762@}
8763@end smallexample
8764
8765In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
8766containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
8767encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
8768
8769We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
8770
8771@smallexample
8772$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
8773$ gdb -nw charset-test
8774GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
8775Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8776@dots{}
8777(@value{GDBP})
8778@end smallexample
8779
8780We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
8781@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
8782strings:
8783
8784@smallexample
8785(@value{GDBP}) show charset
8786The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
8787(@value{GDBP})
8788@end smallexample
8789
8790For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
8791initial character set:
8792@smallexample
8793(@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
8794(@value{GDBP}) show charset
8795The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
8796(@value{GDBP})
8797@end smallexample
8798
8799Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
8800host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
8801characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
8802them properly. Since our current target character set is also
8803@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
8804
8805@smallexample
8806(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8807$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
8808(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8809$2 = 72 'H'
8810(@value{GDBP})
8811@end smallexample
8812
8813@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
8814literals you use in expressions:
8815
8816@smallexample
8817(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8818$3 = 43 '+'
8819(@value{GDBP})
8820@end smallexample
8821
8822The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
8823character.
8824
8825@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
8826target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
8827character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
8828
8829@smallexample
8830(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8831$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
8832(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8833$5 = 200 '\310'
8834(@value{GDBP})
8835@end smallexample
8836
8837If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
8838@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
8839
8840@smallexample
8841(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8842ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
8843(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8844@end smallexample
8845
8846We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
8847program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
8848@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
8849target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
8850@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
8851
8852@smallexample
8853(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
8854(@value{GDBP}) show charset
8855The current host character set is `ASCII'.
8856The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
8857(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8858$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
8859(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8860$7 = 72 '\110'
8861(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8862$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
8863(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8864$9 = 200 'H'
8865(@value{GDBP})
8866@end smallexample
8867
8868As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
8869string literals you use in expressions:
8870
8871@smallexample
8872(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8873$10 = 78 '+'
8874(@value{GDBP})
8875@end smallexample
8876
8877The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
8878character.
8879
8880@node Caching Remote Data
8881@section Caching Data of Remote Targets
8882@cindex caching data of remote targets
8883
8884@value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a
8885remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
8886performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
8887bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately, simply
8888caching everything would lead to incorrect results, since @value{GDBN}
8889does not necessarily know anything about volatile values, memory-mapped I/O
8890addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode})
8891memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command is executing.
8892Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
8893known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
8894rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
8895in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
8896stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.}.
8897Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
8898cacheable; see @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
8899
8900@table @code
8901@kindex set remotecache
8902@item set remotecache on
8903@itemx set remotecache off
8904This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
8905with old scripts.
8906
8907@kindex show remotecache
8908@item show remotecache
8909Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
8910
8911@kindex set stack-cache
8912@item set stack-cache on
8913@itemx set stack-cache off
8914Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{ON}, use
8915caching. By default, this option is @code{ON}.
8916
8917@kindex show stack-cache
8918@item show stack-cache
8919Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
8920
8921@kindex info dcache
8922@item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
8923Print the information about the data cache performance. The
8924information displayed includes the dcache width and depth, and for
8925each cache line, its number, address, and how many times it was
8926referenced. This command is useful for debugging the data cache
8927operation.
8928
8929If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
8930printed in hex.
8931@end table
8932
8933@node Searching Memory
8934@section Search Memory
8935@cindex searching memory
8936
8937Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
8938@code{find} command.
8939
8940@table @code
8941@kindex find
8942@item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8943@itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8944Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
8945etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
8946@var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
8947@end table
8948
8949@var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
8950They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
8951
8952@table @r
8953@item @var{s}, search query size
8954The size of each search query value.
8955
8956@table @code
8957@item b
8958bytes
8959@item h
8960halfwords (two bytes)
8961@item w
8962words (four bytes)
8963@item g
8964giant words (eight bytes)
8965@end table
8966
8967All values are interpreted in the current language.
8968This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
8969then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
8970
8971If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
8972value's type in the current language.
8973This is useful when one wants to specify the search
8974pattern as a mixture of types.
8975Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
8976a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
8977which is typically four bytes.
8978
8979@item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
8980The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
8981@end table
8982
8983You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
8984 (@code{"}).
8985The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
8986regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
8987
8988The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
8989number of matches found.
8990
8991The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
8992@samp{$_}.
8993A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
8994
8995For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
8996
8997@smallexample
8998void
8999hello ()
9000@{
9001 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
9002 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
9003 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
9004 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
9005 printf ("%s\n", hello);
9006@}
9007@end smallexample
9008
9009@noindent
9010you get during debugging:
9011
9012@smallexample
9013(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
90140x804956d <hello.1620+6>
90151 pattern found
9016(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
90170x8049567 <hello.1620>
90180x804956d <hello.1620+6>
90192 patterns found
9020(gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
90210x8049567 <hello.1620>
90221 pattern found
9023(gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
90240x8049560 <mixed.1625>
90251 pattern found
9026(gdb) print $numfound
9027$1 = 1
9028(gdb) print $_
9029$2 = (void *) 0x8049560
9030@end smallexample
9031
9032@node Optimized Code
9033@chapter Debugging Optimized Code
9034@cindex optimized code, debugging
9035@cindex debugging optimized code
9036
9037Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
9038disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
9039directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
9040applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
9041diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
9042information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
9043the running program back to constructs from your original source.
9044
9045@value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
9046can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
9047progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
9048where you may need to debug an optimized version.
9049
9050When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
9051optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
9052really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
9053exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
9054variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
9055variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
9056
9057Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
9058@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
9059doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
9060please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
9061@xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
9062
9063@menu
9064* Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
9065@end menu
9066
9067@node Inline Functions
9068@section Inline Functions
9069@cindex inline functions, debugging
9070
9071@dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
9072body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
9073routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
9074non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
9075arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
9076them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
9077You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
9078@code{info frame} command.
9079
9080For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
9081record information about inlining in the debug information ---
9082@value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
9083other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
9084when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
9085do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
9086@samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
9087function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
9088displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
9089local variables in the caller.
9090
9091The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
9092unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
9093the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
9094start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
9095the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
9096the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
9097instructions are executed.
9098
9099This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
9100context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
9101a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
9102this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
9103
9104There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
9105function calls are the same as normal calls:
9106
9107@itemize @bullet
9108@item
9109You cannot set breakpoints on inlined functions. @value{GDBN}
9110either reports that there is no symbol with that name, or else sets the
9111breakpoint only on non-inlined copies of the function. This limitation
9112will be removed in a future version of @value{GDBN}; until then,
9113set a breakpoint by line number on the first line of the inlined
9114function instead.
9115
9116@item
9117Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
9118work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
9119may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
9120function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
9121version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
9122or inside the inlined function instead.
9123
9124@item
9125@value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
9126using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
9127debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
9128and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
9129
9130@end itemize
9131
9132
9133@node Macros
9134@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
9135
9136Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
9137``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
9138@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
9139the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
9140where it was defined.
9141
9142You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
9143with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
9144include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
9145with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
9146
9147A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
9148and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
9149points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
9150no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
9151uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
9152@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
9153see @ref{List}.
9154
9155Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
9156macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
9157the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
9158
9159@table @code
9160
9161@kindex macro expand
9162@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
9163@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
9164@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
9165@item macro expand @var{expression}
9166@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
9167Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
9168@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
9169not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
9170it can be any string of tokens.
9171
9172@kindex macro exp1
9173@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
9174@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
9175@cindex expand macro once
9176@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
9177expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
9178@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
9179left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
9180particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
9181expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
9182parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
9183can be any string of tokens.
9184
9185@kindex info macro
9186@cindex macro definition, showing
9187@cindex definition, showing a macro's
9188@item info macro @var{macro}
9189Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
9190source location or compiler command-line where that definition was established.
9191
9192@kindex macro define
9193@cindex user-defined macros
9194@cindex defining macros interactively
9195@cindex macros, user-defined
9196@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
9197@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
9198Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
9199invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
9200@var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
9201``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
9202defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
9203@var{arglist}.
9204
9205A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
9206expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
9207@code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
9208all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
9209as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
9210
9211@kindex macro undef
9212@item macro undef @var{macro}
9213Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
9214This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
9215define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
9216in the program being debugged.
9217
9218@kindex macro list
9219@item macro list
9220List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
9221@end table
9222
9223@cindex macros, example of debugging with
9224Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
9225show our source files:
9226
9227@smallexample
9228$ cat sample.c
9229#include <stdio.h>
9230#include "sample.h"
9231
9232#define M 42
9233#define ADD(x) (M + x)
9234
9235main ()
9236@{
9237#define N 28
9238 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9239#undef N
9240 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9241#define N 1729
9242 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9243@}
9244$ cat sample.h
9245#define Q <
9246$
9247@end smallexample
9248
9249Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
9250We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
9251compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
9252information.
9253
9254@smallexample
9255$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
9256$
9257@end smallexample
9258
9259Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
9260
9261@smallexample
9262$ gdb -nw sample
9263GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
9264Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9265GDB is free software, @dots{}
9266(@value{GDBP})
9267@end smallexample
9268
9269We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
9270program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
9271to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
9272
9273@smallexample
9274(@value{GDBP}) list main
92753
92764 #define M 42
92775 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
92786
92797 main ()
92808 @{
92819 #define N 28
928210 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
928311 #undef N
928412 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9285(@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
9286Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
9287#define ADD(x) (M + x)
9288(@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
9289Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
9290 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
9291#define Q <
9292(@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
9293expands to: (42 + 1)
9294(@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
9295expands to: once (M + 1)
9296(@value{GDBP})
9297@end smallexample
9298
9299In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
9300the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
9301@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
9302which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
9303
9304Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
9305force at the source line of the current stack frame:
9306
9307@smallexample
9308(@value{GDBP}) break main
9309Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
9310(@value{GDBP}) run
9311Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
9312
9313Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
931410 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9315(@value{GDBP})
9316@end smallexample
9317
9318At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
9319
9320@smallexample
9321(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9322Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
9323#define N 28
9324(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9325expands to: 28 < 42
9326(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9327$1 = 1
9328(@value{GDBP})
9329@end smallexample
9330
9331As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
9332give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
9333thereof) in force at each point:
9334
9335@smallexample
9336(@value{GDBP}) next
9337Hello, world!
933812 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9339(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9340The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
9341at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
9342(@value{GDBP}) next
9343We're so creative.
934414 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9345(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9346Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
9347#define N 1729
9348(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9349expands to: 1729 < 42
9350(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9351$2 = 0
9352(@value{GDBP})
9353@end smallexample
9354
9355In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
9356line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
9357such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
9358of the source file submitted to the compiler.
9359
9360@smallexample
9361(@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
9362Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
9363-D__STDC__=1
9364(@value{GDBP})
9365@end smallexample
9366
9367
9368@node Tracepoints
9369@chapter Tracepoints
9370@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
9371@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
9372
9373@cindex tracepoints
9374In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
9375the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
9376anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
9377depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
9378might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
9379fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
9380to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
9381
9382Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
9383specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
9384arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
9385Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
9386those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
9387expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
9388for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
9389a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
9390in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
9391values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
9392unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
9393
9394The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
9395targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
9396how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
9397remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
9398support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
9399packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
9400Packets}.
9401
9402It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
9403of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
9404through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
9405
9406This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
9407
9408@menu
9409* Set Tracepoints::
9410* Analyze Collected Data::
9411* Tracepoint Variables::
9412* Trace Files::
9413@end menu
9414
9415@node Set Tracepoints
9416@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
9417
9418Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
9419tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
9420breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
9421standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
9422tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
9423of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
9424as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
9425
9426For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
9427of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
9428it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
9429local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
9430commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
9431tracepoint was hit.
9432
9433Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
9434tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
9435commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
9436either.
9437
9438@cindex fast tracepoints
9439Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
9440a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
9441faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
9442
9443This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
9444conditions and actions.
9445
9446@menu
9447* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
9448* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
9449* Tracepoint Passcounts::
9450* Tracepoint Conditions::
9451* Trace State Variables::
9452* Tracepoint Actions::
9453* Listing Tracepoints::
9454* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
9455* Tracepoint Restrictions::
9456@end menu
9457
9458@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
9459@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
9460
9461@table @code
9462@cindex set tracepoint
9463@kindex trace
9464@item trace @var{location}
9465The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
9466Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
9467an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
9468@code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
9469target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
9470data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
9471changing its actions doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
9472command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
9473not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.
9474
9475Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
9476
9477@smallexample
9478(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
9479
9480(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
9481
9482(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
9483
9484(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
9485
9486(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
9487@end smallexample
9488
9489@noindent
9490You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
9491
9492@item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
9493Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
9494@var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
9495if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
9496@xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
9497information on tracepoint conditions.
9498
9499@item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
9500@cindex set fast tracepoint
9501@kindex ftrace
9502The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
9503support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
9504less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
9505instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
9506may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
9507location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
9508message.
9509
9510@value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
9511@code{trace}.
9512
9513@vindex $tpnum
9514@cindex last tracepoint number
9515@cindex recent tracepoint number
9516@cindex tracepoint number
9517The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
9518of the most recently set tracepoint.
9519
9520@kindex delete tracepoint
9521@cindex tracepoint deletion
9522@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9523Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
9524default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
9525@code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
9526
9527Examples:
9528
9529@smallexample
9530(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
9531
9532(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
9533@end smallexample
9534
9535@noindent
9536You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
9537@end table
9538
9539@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9540@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9541
9542These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
9543
9544@table @code
9545@kindex disable tracepoint
9546@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9547Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
9548@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
9549the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
9550a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
9551
9552@kindex enable tracepoint
9553@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9554Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
9555tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
9556run.
9557@end table
9558
9559@node Tracepoint Passcounts
9560@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
9561
9562@table @code
9563@kindex passcount
9564@cindex tracepoint pass count
9565@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
9566Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
9567automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
9568@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
9569the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
9570@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
9571passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
9572given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
9573user.
9574
9575Examples:
9576
9577@smallexample
9578(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
9579@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
9580
9581(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
9582@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
9583(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
9584(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
9585(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
9586(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
9587(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
9588(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
9589@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
9590@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
9591@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
9592@end smallexample
9593@end table
9594
9595@node Tracepoint Conditions
9596@subsection Tracepoint Conditions
9597@cindex conditional tracepoints
9598@cindex tracepoint conditions
9599
9600The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
9601reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
9602a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
9603programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
9604tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
9605program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
9606is true.
9607
9608Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
9609using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
9610@xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
9611also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
9612just as with breakpoints.
9613
9614Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
9615the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
9616expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions}
9617suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
9618Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
9619accesses, and so forth.
9620
9621For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
9622frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
9623could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
9624of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
9625through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
9626collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
9627search through.
9628
9629@smallexample
9630(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
9631@end smallexample
9632
9633@node Trace State Variables
9634@subsection Trace State Variables
9635@cindex trace state variables
9636
9637A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
9638created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
9639that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
9640but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
9641using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
9642integers.
9643
9644Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
9645to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
9646experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
9647trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
9648
9649@cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
9650Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
9651them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
9652variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
9653while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
9654the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
9655cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
9656@code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
9657variable with the same name.
9658
9659@table @code
9660
9661@item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
9662@kindex tvariable
9663The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
9664@code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
9665@var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
9666entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
9667otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
9668@code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
9669variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
9670existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
9671value. The default initial value is 0.
9672
9673@item info tvariables
9674@kindex info tvariables
9675List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
9676Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
9677currently running.
9678
9679@item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
9680@kindex delete tvariable
9681Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
9682are specified.
9683
9684@end table
9685
9686@node Tracepoint Actions
9687@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
9688
9689@table @code
9690@kindex actions
9691@cindex tracepoint actions
9692@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9693This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
9694tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
9695specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
9696recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
9697@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
9698actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
9699terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
9700far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
9701@code{while-stepping}.
9702
9703@code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
9704Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
9705actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
9706
9707@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
9708To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
9709and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
9710
9711@smallexample
9712(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
9713
9714(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
9715
9716(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
9717@end smallexample
9718
9719In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
9720commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
9721hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
9722following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
9723followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
9724sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
9725terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
9726list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
9727
9728@smallexample
9729(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
9730(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9731Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
9732> collect bar,baz
9733> collect $regs
9734> while-stepping 12
9735 > collect $pc, arr[i]
9736 > end
9737end
9738@end smallexample
9739
9740@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
9741@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
9742Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
9743This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
9744In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
9745special arguments are supported:
9746
9747@table @code
9748@item $regs
9749collect all registers
9750
9751@item $args
9752collect all function arguments
9753
9754@item $locals
9755collect all local variables.
9756@end table
9757
9758You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
9759with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
9760arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
9761
9762The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
9763particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
9764
9765@kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
9766@item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
9767Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
9768command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
9769are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
9770state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
9771values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
9772action were used.
9773
9774@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
9775@item while-stepping @var{n}
9776Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
9777collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
9778command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
9779(followed by its own @code{end} command):
9780
9781@smallexample
9782> while-stepping 12
9783 > collect $regs, myglobal
9784 > end
9785>
9786@end smallexample
9787
9788@noindent
9789Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
9790@code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
9791you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
9792@code{stepping}.
9793
9794@item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
9795@kindex set default-collect
9796@cindex default collection action
9797This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
9798hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
9799to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
9800individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
9801@code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
9802local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
9803
9804@item show default-collect
9805@kindex show default-collect
9806Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
9807tracepoint hit.
9808
9809@end table
9810
9811@node Listing Tracepoints
9812@subsection Listing Tracepoints
9813
9814@table @code
9815@kindex info tracepoints
9816@kindex info tp
9817@cindex information about tracepoints
9818@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9819Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
9820specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
9821tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
9822@code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
9823command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
9824
9825A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
9826tracing:
9827
9828@itemize @bullet
9829@item
9830its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
9831@end itemize
9832
9833@smallexample
9834(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
9835Num Type Disp Enb Address What
98361 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
9837 while-stepping 20
9838 collect globfoo, $regs
9839 end
9840 collect globfoo2
9841 end
9842 pass count 1200
9843(@value{GDBP})
9844@end smallexample
9845
9846@noindent
9847This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
9848@end table
9849
9850@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
9851@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
9852
9853@table @code
9854@kindex tstart
9855@cindex start a new trace experiment
9856@cindex collected data discarded
9857@item tstart
9858This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
9859begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
9860the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
9861experiment.
9862
9863@kindex tstop
9864@cindex stop a running trace experiment
9865@item tstop
9866This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
9867stops collecting data.
9868
9869@strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
9870automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
9871(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
9872
9873@kindex tstatus
9874@cindex status of trace data collection
9875@cindex trace experiment, status of
9876@item tstatus
9877This command displays the status of the current trace data
9878collection.
9879@end table
9880
9881Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
9882
9883@smallexample
9884(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
9885(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9886Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
9887> collect $regs,$locals,$args
9888> while-stepping 11
9889 > collect $regs
9890 > end
9891> end
9892(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
9893 [time passes @dots{}]
9894(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
9895@end smallexample
9896
9897@cindex disconnected tracing
9898You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
9899@value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
9900involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
9901ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
9902terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
9903unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
9904@code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
9905continue running without @value{GDBN}.
9906
9907@table @code
9908@item set disconnected-tracing on
9909@itemx set disconnected-tracing off
9910@kindex set disconnected-tracing
9911Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
9912has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
9913@code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
9914matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
9915for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
9916
9917@item show disconnected-tracing
9918@kindex show disconnected-tracing
9919Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
9920
9921@end table
9922
9923When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
9924still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
9925meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
9926it will continue after reconnection.
9927
9928Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
9929tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
9930information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
9931to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
9932have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
9933the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
9934debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
9935which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
9936necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
9937created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
9938
9939@cindex circular trace buffer
9940If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
9941can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
9942buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
9943frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
9944collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
9945hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
9946buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
9947@samp{circular_trace_buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
9948including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
9949buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
9950the next run.
9951
9952@table @code
9953@item set circular-trace-buffer on
9954@itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
9955@kindex set circular-trace-buffer
9956Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
9957for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
9958fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
9959data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
9960
9961@item show circular-trace-buffer
9962@kindex show circular-trace-buffer
9963Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
9964match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
9965match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
9966for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
9967
9968@end table
9969
9970@node Tracepoint Restrictions
9971@subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
9972
9973@cindex tracepoint restrictions
9974There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
9975described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
9976without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
9977the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
9978examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
9979collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
9980is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
9981mentioned here.
9982
9983@itemize @bullet
9984
9985@item
9986Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
9987the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
9988You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
9989convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
9990state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
9991functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
9992cannot be collected either.
9993
9994@item
9995Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
9996@code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
9997behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
9998instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
9999may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
10000tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
10001variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
10002tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
10003where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
10004program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
10005
10006@item
10007Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
10008may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
10009in a misleading way.
10010
10011@item
10012When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
10013dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
10014being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
10015not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
10016dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
10017collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
10018@code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
10019by @code{ptr}.
10020
10021@item
10022It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
10023tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
10024bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*$esp@@300}
10025(adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
10026target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
10027Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
10028using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
10029depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
10030if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
10031stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
10032invalid address.
10033
10034@item
10035If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
10036infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
10037the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
10038for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
10039multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
10040inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
10041@value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
10042it to zero.
10043
10044@end itemize
10045
10046@node Analyze Collected Data
10047@section Using the Collected Data
10048
10049After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
10050for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
10051collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
10052snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
10053consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
10054examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
10055specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
10056snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
10057registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
10058rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
10059debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
10060(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
10061behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
10062when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
10063the buffer will fail.
10064
10065@menu
10066* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
10067* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
10068* save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
10069@end menu
10070
10071@node tfind
10072@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
10073
10074@kindex tfind
10075@cindex select trace snapshot
10076@cindex find trace snapshot
10077The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
10078@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
10079counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
10080snapshot is selected.
10081
10082Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
10083
10084@table @code
10085@item tfind start
10086Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
10087@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
10088
10089@item tfind none
10090Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
10091
10092@item tfind end
10093Same as @samp{tfind none}.
10094
10095@item tfind
10096No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
10097
10098@item tfind -
10099Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
10100retracing earlier steps.
10101
10102@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
10103Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
10104proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
10105argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
10106for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
10107
10108@item tfind pc @var{addr}
10109Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
10110program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
10111snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
10112snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
10113
10114@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
10115Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
10116addresses (exclusive).
10117
10118@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
10119Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
10120@var{addr2} (inclusive).
10121
10122@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
10123Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
10124the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
10125that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
10126trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
10127next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
10128@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
10129stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
10130@end table
10131
10132The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
10133designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
10134instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
10135snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
10136trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
10137simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
10138snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
10139@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
10140The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
10141for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
10142no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
10143(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
10144no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
10145tracepoint as the current one.
10146
10147In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
10148these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
10149scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
10150you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
10151registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
10152
10153@smallexample
10154(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10155(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
10156> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
10157 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
10158> tfind
10159> end
10160
10161Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
10162Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
10163Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
10164Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
10165Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
10166Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
10167Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
10168Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
10169Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
10170Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
10171Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
10172@end smallexample
10173
10174Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
10175the buffer:
10176
10177@smallexample
10178(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10179(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
10180> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
10181> tfind line
10182> end
10183
10184Frame 0, X = 1
10185Frame 7, X = 2
10186Frame 13, X = 255
10187@end smallexample
10188
10189@node tdump
10190@subsection @code{tdump}
10191@kindex tdump
10192@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
10193@cindex tracepoint data, display
10194
10195This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
10196the current trace snapshot.
10197
10198@smallexample
10199(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
10200(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10201Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
10202> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
10203> end
10204
10205(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
10206
10207(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
10208#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
10209at gdb_test.c:444
10210444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
10211
10212(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
10213Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
10214d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
10215d1 0x18 24
10216d2 0x80 128
10217d3 0x33 51
10218d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
10219d5 0x22 34
10220d6 0xe0 224
10221d7 0x380035 3670069
10222a0 0x19e24a 1696330
10223a1 0x3000668 50333288
10224a2 0x100 256
10225a3 0x322000 3284992
10226a4 0x3000698 50333336
10227a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
10228fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
10229sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
10230ps 0x0 0
10231pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
10232fpcontrol 0x0 0
10233fpstatus 0x0 0
10234fpiaddr 0x0 0
10235p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
10236p1 = (void *) 0x11
10237p2 = (void *) 0x22
10238p3 = (void *) 0x33
10239p4 = (void *) 0x44
10240p5 = (void *) 0x55
10241p6 = (void *) 0x66
10242gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
10243
10244(@value{GDBP})
10245@end smallexample
10246
10247@code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
10248actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
10249@code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
10250actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
10251
10252Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
10253uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
10254frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
10255collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
10256to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
10257body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
10258then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
10259list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
10260same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
10261@c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
10262
10263@node save tracepoints
10264@subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
10265@kindex save tracepoints
10266@kindex save-tracepoints
10267@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
10268
10269This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
10270their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
10271suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
10272tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
10273Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
10274alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
10275
10276@node Tracepoint Variables
10277@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
10278@cindex tracepoint variables
10279@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
10280
10281@table @code
10282@vindex $trace_frame
10283@item (int) $trace_frame
10284The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
10285snapshot is selected.
10286
10287@vindex $tracepoint
10288@item (int) $tracepoint
10289The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
10290
10291@vindex $trace_line
10292@item (int) $trace_line
10293The line number for the current trace snapshot.
10294
10295@vindex $trace_file
10296@item (char []) $trace_file
10297The source file for the current trace snapshot.
10298
10299@vindex $trace_func
10300@item (char []) $trace_func
10301The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
10302@end table
10303
10304Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
10305use @code{output} instead.
10306
10307Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
10308stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
10309data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
10310which are managed by the target.
10311
10312@smallexample
10313(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10314
10315(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
10316> output $trace_file
10317> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
10318> tfind
10319> end
10320@end smallexample
10321
10322@node Trace Files
10323@section Using Trace Files
10324@cindex trace files
10325
10326In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
10327longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
10328for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
10329dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
10330of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
10331
10332@table @code
10333
10334@kindex tsave
10335@item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
10336Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
10337assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
10338necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
10339then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
10340optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
10341the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
10342more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
10343@code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
10344
10345@kindex target tfile
10346@kindex tfile
10347@item target tfile @var{filename}
10348Use the file named @var{filename} as a source of trace data. Commands
10349that examine data work as they do with a live target, but it is not
10350possible to run any new trace experiments. @code{tstatus} will report
10351the state of the trace run at the moment the data was saved, as well
10352as the current trace frame you are examining. @var{filename} must be
10353on a filesystem accessible to the host.
10354
10355@end table
10356
10357@node Overlays
10358@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
10359@cindex overlays
10360
10361If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
10362memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
10363problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
10364use overlays.
10365
10366@menu
10367* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
10368* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
10369* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
10370 mapped by asking the inferior.
10371* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
10372@end menu
10373
10374@node How Overlays Work
10375@section How Overlays Work
10376@cindex mapped overlays
10377@cindex unmapped overlays
10378@cindex load address, overlay's
10379@cindex mapped address
10380@cindex overlay area
10381
10382Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
10383kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
10384other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
10385management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
10386adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
10387
10388One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
10389independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
10390@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
10391their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
10392instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
10393largest overlay as well.
10394
10395Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
10396overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
10397for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
10398there.
10399
10400@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
10401@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
10402@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
10403
10404@smallexample
10405@group
10406 Data Instruction Larger
10407Address Space Address Space Address Space
10408+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
10409| | | | | |
10410+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
10411| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
10412| variables | | program | | +-----------+
10413| and heap | | | | | |
10414+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
10415| | +-----------+ | | | load address
10416+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
10417 | | | | | |
10418 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
10419 address | | | | | |
10420 | overlay | <-' | | |
10421 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
10422 | | <---. | | load address
10423 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
10424 | | | |
10425 +-----------+ | |
10426 +-----------+
10427 | |
10428 +-----------+
10429
10430 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
10431@end group
10432@end smallexample
10433
10434The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
10435and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
10436its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
10437Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
10438may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
10439data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
10440program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
10441program and the overlay area.
10442
10443An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
10444@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
10445instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
10446in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
10447is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
10448the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
10449called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
10450
10451Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
10452program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
10453global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
10454
10455@itemize @bullet
10456
10457@item
10458Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
10459must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
10460return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
10461overlay, and your program will probably crash.
10462
10463@item
10464If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
10465will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
10466your program's performance.
10467
10468@item
10469The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
10470overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
10471mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
10472and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
10473You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
10474addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
10475ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
10476
10477@item
10478The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
10479to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
10480instruction and data spaces.
10481
10482@end itemize
10483
10484The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
10485improved in many ways:
10486
10487@itemize @bullet
10488
10489@item
10490If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
10491hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
10492contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
10493This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
10494area in the usual way.
10495
10496@item
10497If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
10498overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
10499
10500@item
10501You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
10502general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
10503code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
10504return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
10505the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
10506must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
10507different data overlay into the same mapped area.
10508
10509@end itemize
10510
10511
10512@node Overlay Commands
10513@section Overlay Commands
10514
10515To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
10516correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
10517virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
10518mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
10519@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
10520variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
10521
10522@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
10523you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
10524
10525@table @code
10526@item overlay off
10527@kindex overlay
10528Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
10529disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
10530always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
10531overlay support is disabled.
10532
10533@item overlay manual
10534@cindex manual overlay debugging
10535Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
10536relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
10537using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
10538commands described below.
10539
10540@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
10541@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
10542@cindex map an overlay
10543Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
10544be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
10545overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
10546functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
10547that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
10548@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
10549
10550@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
10551@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
10552@cindex unmap an overlay
10553Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
10554must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
10555When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
10556overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
10557
10558@item overlay auto
10559Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
10560consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
10561to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
10562Overlay Debugging}.
10563
10564@item overlay load-target
10565@itemx overlay load
10566@cindex reloading the overlay table
10567Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
10568re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
10569stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
10570overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
10571useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
10572
10573@item overlay list-overlays
10574@itemx overlay list
10575@cindex listing mapped overlays
10576Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
10577addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
10578
10579@end table
10580
10581Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
10582of the function the address falls in:
10583
10584@smallexample
10585(@value{GDBP}) print main
10586$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
10587@end smallexample
10588@noindent
10589When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
10590unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
10591asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
10592unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
10593
10594@smallexample
10595(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
10596No sections are mapped.
10597(@value{GDBP}) print foo
10598$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
10599@end smallexample
10600@noindent
10601When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
10602name normally:
10603
10604@smallexample
10605(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
10606Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
10607 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
10608(@value{GDBP}) print foo
10609$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
10610@end smallexample
10611
10612When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
10613address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
10614overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
10615@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
10616code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
10617
10618@itemize @bullet
10619@item
10620@cindex breakpoints in overlays
10621@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
10622You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
10623@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
10624@item
10625@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
10626unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
10627overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
10628you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
10629breakpoints properly.
10630@end itemize
10631
10632
10633@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
10634@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
10635@cindex automatic overlay debugging
10636
10637@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
10638are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
10639inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
10640@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
10641looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
10642current state of the overlays.
10643
10644Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
10645@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
10646
10647@table @asis
10648
10649@item @code{_ovly_table}:
10650This variable must be an array of the following structures:
10651
10652@smallexample
10653struct
10654@{
10655 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
10656 unsigned long vma;
10657
10658 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
10659 unsigned long size;
10660
10661 /* The overlay's load address. */
10662 unsigned long lma;
10663
10664 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
10665 zero otherwise. */
10666 unsigned long mapped;
10667@}
10668@end smallexample
10669
10670@item @code{_novlys}:
10671This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
10672number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
10673
10674@end table
10675
10676To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
10677looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
10678@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
10679executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
10680the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
10681currently mapped.
10682
10683In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
10684@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
10685will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
10686calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
10687will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
10688are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
10689in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
10690overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
10691are not being executed.
10692
10693@node Overlay Sample Program
10694@section Overlay Sample Program
10695@cindex overlay example program
10696
10697When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
10698at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
10699addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
10700Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
10701since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
10702architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
10703portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
10704
10705However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
10706program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
10707suite. The program consists of the following files from
10708@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
10709
10710@table @file
10711@item overlays.c
10712The main program file.
10713@item ovlymgr.c
10714A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
10715@item foo.c
10716@itemx bar.c
10717@itemx baz.c
10718@itemx grbx.c
10719Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
10720@item d10v.ld
10721@itemx m32r.ld
10722Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
10723and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
10724@end table
10725
10726You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
10727cross-compiler like this:
10728
10729@smallexample
10730$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
10731$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
10732$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
10733$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
10734$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
10735$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
10736$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
10737 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
10738@end smallexample
10739
10740The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
10741you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
10742target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
10743
10744
10745@node Languages
10746@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
10747@cindex languages
10748
10749Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
10750rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
10751dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
10752Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
10753represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
10754@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
10755
10756@cindex working language
10757Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
10758allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
10759native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
10760consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
10761language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
10762language}.
10763
10764@menu
10765* Setting:: Switching between source languages
10766* Show:: Displaying the language
10767* Checks:: Type and range checks
10768* Supported Languages:: Supported languages
10769* Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
10770@end menu
10771
10772@node Setting
10773@section Switching Between Source Languages
10774
10775There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
10776set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
10777@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
10778defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
10779used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
10780are printed, etc.
10781
10782In addition to the working language, every source file that
10783@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
10784file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
10785source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
10786language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
10787controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
10788show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
10789set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
10790set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
10791Displaying the Language}.
10792
10793This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
10794as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
10795another language. In that case, make the
10796program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
10797@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
10798program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
10799
10800@menu
10801* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
10802* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
10803* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
10804@end menu
10805
10806@node Filenames
10807@subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
10808
10809If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
10810@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
10811
10812@table @file
10813@item .ada
10814@itemx .ads
10815@itemx .adb
10816@itemx .a
10817Ada source file.
10818
10819@item .c
10820C source file
10821
10822@item .C
10823@itemx .cc
10824@itemx .cp
10825@itemx .cpp
10826@itemx .cxx
10827@itemx .c++
10828C@t{++} source file
10829
10830@item .d
10831D source file
10832
10833@item .m
10834Objective-C source file
10835
10836@item .f
10837@itemx .F
10838Fortran source file
10839
10840@item .mod
10841Modula-2 source file
10842
10843@item .s
10844@itemx .S
10845Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
10846@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
10847@end table
10848
10849In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
10850extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
10851
10852@node Manually
10853@subsection Setting the Working Language
10854
10855If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
10856expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
10857your program.
10858
10859@kindex set language
10860If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
10861command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
10862a language, such as
10863@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
10864For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
10865
10866Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
10867language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
10868to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
10869source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
10870languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
10871source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
10872command such as:
10873
10874@smallexample
10875print a = b + c
10876@end smallexample
10877
10878@noindent
10879might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
10880@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
10881printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
10882@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
10883
10884@node Automatically
10885@subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
10886
10887To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
10888@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
10889then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
10890frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
10891working language to the language recorded for the function in that
10892frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
10893or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
10894does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
10895not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
10896
10897This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
10898entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
10899written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
10900a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
10901case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
10902
10903@node Show
10904@section Displaying the Language
10905
10906The following commands help you find out which language is the
10907working language, and also what language source files were written in.
10908
10909@table @code
10910@item show language
10911@kindex show language
10912Display the current working language. This is the
10913language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
10914build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
10915
10916@item info frame
10917@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
10918Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
10919working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
10920@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
10921information listed here.
10922
10923@item info source
10924@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
10925Display the source language of this source file.
10926@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
10927information listed here.
10928@end table
10929
10930In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
10931not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
10932with a language explicitly:
10933
10934@table @code
10935@item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
10936@kindex set extension-language
10937Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
10938assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
10939
10940@item info extensions
10941@kindex info extensions
10942List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
10943@end table
10944
10945@node Checks
10946@section Type and Range Checking
10947
10948@quotation
10949@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
10950checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
10951section documents the intended facilities.
10952@end quotation
10953@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
10954
10955Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
10956errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
10957checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
10958sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
10959these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
10960by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
10961errors when your program is running.
10962
10963@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
10964Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
10965it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
10966evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
10967working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
10968automatically based on your program's source language.
10969@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
10970settings of supported languages.
10971
10972@menu
10973* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
10974* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
10975@end menu
10976
10977@cindex type checking
10978@cindex checks, type
10979@node Type Checking
10980@subsection An Overview of Type Checking
10981
10982Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
10983arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
10984otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
10985errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
10986
10987@smallexample
109881 + 2 @result{} 3
10989@exdent but
10990@error{} 1 + 2.3
10991@end smallexample
10992
10993The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
10994type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
10995
10996For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
10997@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
10998to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
10999or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
11000but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
11001these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
11002also issues a warning.
11003
11004Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
11005related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
11006For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
11007a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
11008with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
11009the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
11010
11011Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
11012instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
11013operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
11014represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
11015operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
11016details on specific languages.
11017
11018@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
11019
11020@kindex set check type
11021@kindex show check type
11022@table @code
11023@item set check type auto
11024Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
11025@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
11026each language.
11027
11028@item set check type on
11029@itemx set check type off
11030Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
11031current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
11032match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
11033evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
11034message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
11035
11036@item set check type warn
11037Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
11038evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
11039be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
11040numbers and structures.
11041
11042@item show type
11043Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
11044is setting it automatically.
11045@end table
11046
11047@cindex range checking
11048@cindex checks, range
11049@node Range Checking
11050@subsection An Overview of Range Checking
11051
11052In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
11053bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
11054checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
11055computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
11056not exceed the bounds of the array.
11057
11058For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
11059@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
11060always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
11061warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
11062
11063A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
11064array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
11065of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
11066error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
11067result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
11068the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
11069
11070@smallexample
11071@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
11072@end smallexample
11073
11074This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
11075specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
11076Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
11077
11078@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
11079
11080@kindex set check range
11081@kindex show check range
11082@table @code
11083@item set check range auto
11084Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
11085@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
11086each language.
11087
11088@item set check range on
11089@itemx set check range off
11090Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
11091current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
11092match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
11093then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
11094
11095@item set check range warn
11096Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
11097but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
11098expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
11099memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
11100systems).
11101
11102@item show range
11103Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
11104being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
11105@end table
11106
11107@node Supported Languages
11108@section Supported Languages
11109
11110@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
11111assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
11112@c This is false ...
11113Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
11114language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
11115and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
11116,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
11117language.
11118
11119The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
11120supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
11121tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
11122@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
11123formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
11124books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
11125language reference or tutorial.
11126
11127@menu
11128* C:: C and C@t{++}
11129* D:: D
11130* Objective-C:: Objective-C
11131* Fortran:: Fortran
11132* Pascal:: Pascal
11133* Modula-2:: Modula-2
11134* Ada:: Ada
11135@end menu
11136
11137@node C
11138@subsection C and C@t{++}
11139
11140@cindex C and C@t{++}
11141@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
11142
11143Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
11144to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
11145together.
11146
11147@cindex C@t{++}
11148@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
11149@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
11150The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
11151compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
11152effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
11153C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
11154compiler (@code{aCC}).
11155
11156For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
11157format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
11158format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
11159command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
11160@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
11161gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
11162
11163@menu
11164* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
11165* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
11166* C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
11167* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
11168* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
11169* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
11170* Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
11171* Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
11172@end menu
11173
11174@node C Operators
11175@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
11176
11177@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
11178
11179Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11180@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
11181often defined on groups of types.
11182
11183For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
11184
11185@itemize @bullet
11186
11187@item
11188@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
11189specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
11190
11191@item
11192@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
11193@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
11194
11195@item
11196@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
11197
11198@item
11199@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
11200
11201@end itemize
11202
11203@noindent
11204The following operators are supported. They are listed here
11205in order of increasing precedence:
11206
11207@table @code
11208@item ,
11209The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
11210are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
11211expression being the last expression evaluated.
11212
11213@item =
11214Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
11215assigned. Defined on scalar types.
11216
11217@item @var{op}=
11218Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
11219and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
11220@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
11221@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
11222@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
11223
11224@item ?:
11225The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
11226of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
11227integral type.
11228
11229@item ||
11230Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11231
11232@item &&
11233Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
11234
11235@item |
11236Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11237
11238@item ^
11239Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11240
11241@item &
11242Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
11243
11244@item ==@r{, }!=
11245Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
11246expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
11247
11248@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
11249Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
11250Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
11251and non-zero for true.
11252
11253@item <<@r{, }>>
11254left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
11255
11256@item @@
11257The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
11258
11259@item +@r{, }-
11260Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
11261pointer types.
11262
11263@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
11264Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
11265defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
11266integral types.
11267
11268@item ++@r{, }--
11269Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
11270operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
11271when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
11272operation takes place.
11273
11274@item *
11275Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
11276@code{++}.
11277
11278@item &
11279Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
11280
11281For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
11282allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
11283to examine the address
11284where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
11285stored.
11286
11287@item -
11288Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
11289precedence as @code{++}.
11290
11291@item !
11292Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11293@code{++}.
11294
11295@item ~
11296Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11297@code{++}.
11298
11299
11300@item .@r{, }->
11301Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
11302@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
11303pointer based on the stored type information.
11304Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
11305
11306@item .*@r{, }->*
11307Dereferences of pointers to members.
11308
11309@item []
11310Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
11311@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11312
11313@item ()
11314Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11315
11316@item ::
11317C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
11318and @code{class} types.
11319
11320@item ::
11321Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
11322(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
11323above.
11324@end table
11325
11326If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
11327attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
11328predefined meaning.
11329
11330@node C Constants
11331@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
11332
11333@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
11334
11335@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
11336following ways:
11337
11338@itemize @bullet
11339@item
11340Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
11341specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
11342by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
11343@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
11344@code{long} value.
11345
11346@item
11347Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
11348point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
11349exponent. An exponent is of the form:
11350@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
11351sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
11352A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
11353@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
11354the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
11355a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
11356constant.
11357
11358@item
11359Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
11360integral equivalents.
11361
11362@item
11363Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
11364(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
11365(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
11366be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
11367the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
11368of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
11369@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
11370@samp{\n} for newline.
11371
11372@item
11373String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
11374double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
11375above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
11376a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
11377characters.
11378
11379@item
11380Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
11381to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
11382
11383@item
11384Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
11385and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
11386integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
11387and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
11388@end itemize
11389
11390@node C Plus Plus Expressions
11391@subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
11392
11393@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
11394@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
11395
11396@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
11397@cindex C@t{++} compilers
11398@cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
11399@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
11400@quotation
11401@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
11402proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
11403works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
11404@value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
11405@option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
11406stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
11407stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
11408specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
11409are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
11410C@t{++} code.
11411@end quotation
11412
11413@enumerate
11414
11415@cindex member functions
11416@item
11417Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
11418
11419@smallexample
11420count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
11421@end smallexample
11422
11423@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
11424@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
11425@item
11426While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
11427expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
11428that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
11429pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
11430
11431@cindex call overloaded functions
11432@cindex overloaded functions, calling
11433@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
11434@item
11435You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
11436call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
11437perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
11438calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
11439in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
11440default arguments.
11441
11442It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
11443promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
11444class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
11445functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
11446number of function arguments.
11447
11448Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
11449@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
11450,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
11451
11452You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
11453explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
11454@smallexample
11455p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
11456@end smallexample
11457
11458The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
11459see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
11460
11461@cindex reference declarations
11462@item
11463@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
11464them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
11465dereferenced.
11466
11467In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
11468reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
11469avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
11470The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
11471you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
11472
11473@item
11474@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
11475expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
11476one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
11477necessary, for example in an expression like
11478@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
11479resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
11480debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
11481@end enumerate
11482
11483In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
11484calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
11485objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
11486invoking user-defined operators.
11487
11488@node C Defaults
11489@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
11490
11491@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
11492
11493If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
11494both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
11495C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
11496selects the working language.
11497
11498If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
11499recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
11500@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
11501these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
11502@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
11503for further details.
11504
11505@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
11506@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
11507@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
11508
11509@node C Checks
11510@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
11511
11512@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
11513
11514By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
11515is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
11516considers two variables type equivalent if:
11517
11518@itemize @bullet
11519@item
11520The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
11521enumerated tag.
11522
11523@item
11524The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
11525declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
11526
11527@ignore
11528@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
11529@c FIXME--beers?
11530@item
11531The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
11532declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
11533compilers.)
11534@end ignore
11535@end itemize
11536
11537Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
11538indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
11539that is not itself an array.
11540
11541@node Debugging C
11542@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
11543
11544The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
11545the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
11546inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
11547appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
11548
11549The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
11550with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
11551,Expressions}.
11552
11553@node Debugging C Plus Plus
11554@subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
11555
11556@cindex commands for C@t{++}
11557
11558Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
11559designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
11560
11561@table @code
11562@cindex break in overloaded functions
11563@item @r{breakpoint menus}
11564When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
11565@value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
11566locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
11567@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
11568
11569@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
11570@item rbreak @var{regex}
11571Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
11572breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
11573classes.
11574@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11575
11576@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
11577@item catch throw
11578@itemx catch catch
11579Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
11580Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
11581
11582@cindex inheritance
11583@item ptype @var{typename}
11584Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
11585@var{typename}.
11586@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
11587
11588@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
11589@item set print demangle
11590@itemx show print demangle
11591@itemx set print asm-demangle
11592@itemx show print asm-demangle
11593Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
11594displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
11595@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
11596
11597@item set print object
11598@itemx show print object
11599Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
11600@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
11601
11602@item set print vtbl
11603@itemx show print vtbl
11604Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
11605@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
11606(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
11607ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
11608
11609@kindex set overload-resolution
11610@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
11611@item set overload-resolution on
11612Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
11613is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
11614and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
11615using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
11616Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
11617If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
11618
11619@item set overload-resolution off
11620Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
11621overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
11622chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
11623symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
11624overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
11625searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
11626argument types.
11627
11628@kindex show overload-resolution
11629@item show overload-resolution
11630Show the current setting of overload resolution.
11631
11632@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
11633You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
11634the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
11635@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
11636also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
11637available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
11638@xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
11639@end table
11640
11641@node Decimal Floating Point
11642@subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
11643@cindex decimal floating point format
11644
11645@value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
11646decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
11647@code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
11648specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
11649
11650There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
11651Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
11652PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
11653target.
11654
11655Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
11656to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
11657(using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
11658
11659In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
11660point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
11661underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
11662
11663In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
11664to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
11665See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
11666
11667@node D
11668@subsection D
11669
11670@cindex D
11671@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
11672GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
11673specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
11674
11675@node Objective-C
11676@subsection Objective-C
11677
11678@cindex Objective-C
11679This section provides information about some commands and command
11680options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
11681@ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
11682few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
11683
11684@menu
11685* Method Names in Commands::
11686* The Print Command with Objective-C::
11687@end menu
11688
11689@node Method Names in Commands
11690@subsubsection Method Names in Commands
11691
11692The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
11693names as line specifications:
11694
11695@kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
11696@kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
11697@kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
11698@kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
11699@kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
11700@itemize
11701@item @code{clear}
11702@item @code{break}
11703@item @code{info line}
11704@item @code{jump}
11705@item @code{list}
11706@end itemize
11707
11708A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
11709
11710@smallexample
11711-[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
11712@end smallexample
11713
11714where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
11715plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
11716name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
11717brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
11718source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
11719instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
11720debugged, enter:
11721
11722@smallexample
11723break -[Fruit create]
11724@end smallexample
11725
11726To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
11727enter:
11728
11729@smallexample
11730list +[NSText initialize]
11731@end smallexample
11732
11733In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
11734required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
11735sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
11736is also possible to specify just a method name:
11737
11738@smallexample
11739break create
11740@end smallexample
11741
11742You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
11743your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
11744you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
11745method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
11746none apply.
11747
11748As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
11749@code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
11750
11751@smallexample
11752clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
11753@end smallexample
11754
11755@node The Print Command with Objective-C
11756@subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
11757@cindex Objective-C, print objects
11758@kindex print-object
11759@kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
11760
11761The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
11762
11763@smallexample
11764print -[@var{object} hash]
11765@end smallexample
11766
11767@cindex print an Objective-C object description
11768@cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
11769@noindent
11770will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
11771and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
11772@code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
11773the description of an object. However, this command may only work
11774with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
11775function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
11776
11777@node Fortran
11778@subsection Fortran
11779@cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
11780
11781@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
11782currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
11783
11784@cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
11785Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
11786among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
11787functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
11788will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
11789underscore.
11790
11791@menu
11792* Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
11793* Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
11794* Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
11795@end menu
11796
11797@node Fortran Operators
11798@subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
11799
11800@cindex Fortran operators and expressions
11801
11802Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11803@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
11804arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
11805
11806@table @code
11807@item **
11808The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
11809of the second one.
11810
11811@item :
11812The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
11813represent a section of array.
11814
11815@item %
11816The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
11817types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
11818this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
11819union type.
11820@end table
11821
11822@node Fortran Defaults
11823@subsubsection Fortran Defaults
11824
11825@cindex Fortran Defaults
11826
11827Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
11828default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
11829change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
11830@ref{Symbols}, for the details.
11831
11832@node Special Fortran Commands
11833@subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
11834
11835@cindex Special Fortran commands
11836
11837@value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
11838such as displaying common blocks.
11839
11840@table @code
11841@cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
11842@kindex info common
11843@item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
11844This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
11845block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
11846all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
11847printed.
11848@end table
11849
11850@node Pascal
11851@subsection Pascal
11852
11853@cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
11854Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
11855nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
11856entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
11857syntax.
11858
11859The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
11860controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
11861@xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
11862
11863@node Modula-2
11864@subsection Modula-2
11865
11866@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
11867
11868The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
11869output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
11870developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
11871attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
11872to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
11873table.
11874
11875@cindex expressions in Modula-2
11876@menu
11877* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
11878* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
11879* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
11880* M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
11881* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
11882* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
11883* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
11884* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
11885* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
11886@end menu
11887
11888@node M2 Operators
11889@subsubsection Operators
11890@cindex Modula-2 operators
11891
11892Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11893@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
11894often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
11895following definitions hold:
11896
11897@itemize @bullet
11898
11899@item
11900@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
11901their subranges.
11902
11903@item
11904@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
11905
11906@item
11907@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
11908
11909@item
11910@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
11911@var{type}}.
11912
11913@item
11914@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
11915
11916@item
11917@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
11918
11919@item
11920@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
11921@end itemize
11922
11923@noindent
11924The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
11925increasing precedence:
11926
11927@table @code
11928@item ,
11929Function argument or array index separator.
11930
11931@item :=
11932Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
11933@var{value}.
11934
11935@item <@r{, }>
11936Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
11937types.
11938
11939@item <=@r{, }>=
11940Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
11941on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
11942set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
11943
11944@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
11945Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
11946Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
11947available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
11948comment character.
11949
11950@item IN
11951Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
11952Same precedence as @code{<}.
11953
11954@item OR
11955Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
11956
11957@item AND@r{, }&
11958Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
11959
11960@item @@
11961The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
11962
11963@item +@r{, }-
11964Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
11965and difference on set types.
11966
11967@item *
11968Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
11969on set types.
11970
11971@item /
11972Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
11973types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
11974
11975@item DIV@r{, }MOD
11976Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
11977precedence as @code{*}.
11978
11979@item -
11980Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
11981
11982@item ^
11983Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
11984
11985@item NOT
11986Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
11987@code{^}.
11988
11989@item .
11990@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
11991precedence as @code{^}.
11992
11993@item []
11994Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
11995
11996@item ()
11997Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
11998as @code{^}.
11999
12000@item ::@r{, }.
12001@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
12002@end table
12003
12004@quotation
12005@emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
12006treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
12007@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
12008@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
12009@end quotation
12010
12011
12012@node Built-In Func/Proc
12013@subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
12014@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
12015
12016Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
12017In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
12018
12019@table @var
12020
12021@item a
12022represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
12023
12024@item c
12025represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
12026
12027@item i
12028represents a variable or constant of integral type.
12029
12030@item m
12031represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
12032same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
12033be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
12034
12035@item n
12036represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
12037
12038@item r
12039represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
12040
12041@item t
12042represents a type.
12043
12044@item v
12045represents a variable.
12046
12047@item x
12048represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
12049explanation of the function for details.
12050@end table
12051
12052All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
12053
12054@table @code
12055@item ABS(@var{n})
12056Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
12057
12058@item CAP(@var{c})
12059If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
12060equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
12061
12062@item CHR(@var{i})
12063Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
12064
12065@item DEC(@var{v})
12066Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
12067
12068@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
12069Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
12070new value.
12071
12072@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
12073Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
12074set.
12075
12076@item FLOAT(@var{i})
12077Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
12078
12079@item HIGH(@var{a})
12080Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
12081
12082@item INC(@var{v})
12083Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
12084
12085@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
12086Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
12087new value.
12088
12089@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
12090Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
12091there. Returns the new set.
12092
12093@item MAX(@var{t})
12094Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
12095
12096@item MIN(@var{t})
12097Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
12098
12099@item ODD(@var{i})
12100Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
12101
12102@item ORD(@var{x})
12103Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
12104value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
12105@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
12106integral, character and enumerated types.
12107
12108@item SIZE(@var{x})
12109Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
12110
12111@item TRUNC(@var{r})
12112Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
12113
12114@item TSIZE(@var{x})
12115Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
12116
12117@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
12118Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
12119@end table
12120
12121@quotation
12122@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
12123@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
12124an error.
12125@end quotation
12126
12127@cindex Modula-2 constants
12128@node M2 Constants
12129@subsubsection Constants
12130
12131@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
12132ways:
12133
12134@itemize @bullet
12135
12136@item
12137Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
12138expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
12139rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
12140trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
12141
12142@item
12143Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
12144decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
12145then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
12146@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
12147digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
12148digits.
12149
12150@item
12151Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
12152like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
12153also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
12154followed by a @samp{C}.
12155
12156@item
12157String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
12158pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
12159Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
12160Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
12161sequences.
12162
12163@item
12164Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
12165
12166@item
12167Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
12168@code{FALSE}.
12169
12170@item
12171Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
12172
12173@item
12174Set constants are not yet supported.
12175@end itemize
12176
12177@node M2 Types
12178@subsubsection Modula-2 Types
12179@cindex Modula-2 types
12180
12181Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
12182syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
12183types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
12184print the contents of variables declared using these type.
12185This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
12186sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
12187
12188The first example contains the following section of code:
12189
12190@smallexample
12191VAR
12192 s: SET OF CHAR ;
12193 r: [20..40] ;
12194@end smallexample
12195
12196@noindent
12197and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
12198@code{r} and @code{s}.
12199
12200@smallexample
12201(@value{GDBP}) print s
12202@{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
12203(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12204SET OF CHAR
12205(@value{GDBP}) print r
1220621
12207(@value{GDBP}) ptype r
12208[20..40]
12209@end smallexample
12210
12211@noindent
12212Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
12213
12214@smallexample
12215VAR
12216 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
12217@end smallexample
12218
12219@noindent
12220then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
12221
12222@smallexample
12223(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12224type = SET ['A'..'Z']
12225@end smallexample
12226
12227@noindent
12228Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
12229expressions using the debugger.
12230
12231The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
12232and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
12233
12234@smallexample
12235VAR
12236 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
12237@end smallexample
12238
12239@smallexample
12240(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12241ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
12242@end smallexample
12243
12244Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
12245is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
12246arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
12247above.
12248
12249Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
12250
12251@smallexample
12252TYPE
12253 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
12254 t = [blue..yellow] ;
12255VAR
12256 s: t ;
12257BEGIN
12258 s := blue ;
12259@end smallexample
12260
12261@noindent
12262The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
12263and value of a variable.
12264
12265@smallexample
12266(@value{GDBP}) print s
12267$1 = blue
12268(@value{GDBP}) ptype t
12269type = [blue..yellow]
12270@end smallexample
12271
12272@noindent
12273In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
12274displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
12275their @code{C} counterparts.
12276
12277@smallexample
12278VAR
12279 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
12280BEGIN
12281 s[1] := 1 ;
12282@end smallexample
12283
12284@smallexample
12285(@value{GDBP}) print s
12286$1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
12287(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12288type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12289@end smallexample
12290
12291The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
12292pointer types as shown in this example:
12293
12294@smallexample
12295VAR
12296 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
12297BEGIN
12298 NEW(s) ;
12299 s^[1] := 1 ;
12300@end smallexample
12301
12302@noindent
12303and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
12304
12305@smallexample
12306(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12307type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12308@end smallexample
12309
12310@value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
12311Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
12312types:
12313
12314@smallexample
12315TYPE
12316 foo = RECORD
12317 f1: CARDINAL ;
12318 f2: CHAR ;
12319 f3: myarray ;
12320 END ;
12321
12322 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
12323 myrange = [-2..2] ;
12324VAR
12325 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
12326@end smallexample
12327
12328@noindent
12329and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
12330below.
12331
12332@smallexample
12333(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12334type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
12335 f1 : CARDINAL;
12336 f2 : CHAR;
12337 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
12338END
12339@end smallexample
12340
12341@node M2 Defaults
12342@subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
12343@cindex Modula-2 defaults
12344
12345If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
12346both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
12347Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
12348selected the working language.
12349
12350If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
12351code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
12352working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
12353Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
12354
12355@node Deviations
12356@subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
12357@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
12358
12359A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
12360This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
12361
12362@itemize @bullet
12363@item
12364Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
12365integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
12366debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
12367pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
12368through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
12369returned a pointer.)
12370
12371@item
12372C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
12373non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
12374escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
12375printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
12376
12377@item
12378The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
12379argument.
12380
12381@item
12382All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
12383@end itemize
12384
12385@node M2 Checks
12386@subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
12387@cindex Modula-2 checks
12388
12389@quotation
12390@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
12391range checking.
12392@end quotation
12393@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
12394
12395@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
12396
12397@itemize @bullet
12398@item
12399They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
12400@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
12401
12402@item
12403They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
12404@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
12405@end itemize
12406
12407As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
12408whose types are not equivalent is an error.
12409
12410Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
12411index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
12412
12413@node M2 Scope
12414@subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
12415@cindex scope
12416@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
12417@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
12418@ifinfo
12419@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
12420@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
12421@end ifinfo
12422@ifnotinfo
12423@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
12424@end ifnotinfo
12425
12426There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
12427(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
12428similar syntax:
12429
12430@smallexample
12431
12432@var{module} . @var{id}
12433@var{scope} :: @var{id}
12434@end smallexample
12435
12436@noindent
12437where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
12438@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
12439identifier within your program, except another module.
12440
12441Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
12442specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
12443found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
12444enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
12445
12446Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
12447the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
12448definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
12449an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
12450module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
12451@var{module}.
12452
12453@node GDB/M2
12454@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
12455
12456Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
12457Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
12458specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
12459@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
12460apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
12461analogue in Modula-2.
12462
12463The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
12464with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
12465intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
12466created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
12467address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
12468@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
12469
12470@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
12471In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
12472interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
12473
12474@node Ada
12475@subsection Ada
12476@cindex Ada
12477
12478The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
12479output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
12480Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
12481attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
12482to be difficult.
12483
12484
12485@cindex expressions in Ada
12486@menu
12487* Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
12488 and semantics supported by Ada mode
12489 in @value{GDBN}.
12490* Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
12491* Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
12492* Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
12493* Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
12494* Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
12495* Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
12496@end menu
12497
12498@node Ada Mode Intro
12499@subsubsection Introduction
12500@cindex Ada mode, general
12501
12502The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
12503syntax, with some extensions.
12504The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
12505
12506@itemize @bullet
12507@item
12508That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
12509arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
12510leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
12511program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
12512
12513@item
12514That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
12515are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
12516
12517@item
12518That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
12519@end itemize
12520
12521Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
12522user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
12523according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
12524names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
12525ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
12526
12527The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
12528As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
12529was translated from an Ada source file.
12530
12531While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
12532mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
12533(@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
12534middle (to allow based literals).
12535
12536The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
12537the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
12538actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
12539the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
12540procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
12541functions to procedures elsewhere.
12542
12543@node Omissions from Ada
12544@subsubsection Omissions from Ada
12545@cindex Ada, omissions from
12546
12547Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
12548
12549@itemize @bullet
12550@item
12551Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
12552
12553@itemize @minus
12554@item
12555@t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
12556 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
12557
12558@item
12559@t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
12560
12561@item
12562@t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
12563
12564@item
12565@t{'Tag}.
12566
12567@item
12568@t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
12569operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
12570
12571@item
12572@t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
12573@t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
12574
12575@item
12576@t{'Address}.
12577@end itemize
12578
12579@item
12580The names in
12581@code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
12582concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
12583not currently available.
12584
12585@item
12586Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
12587equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
12588for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
12589They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
12590types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
12591(in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
12592zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
12593indeterminate values.
12594
12595@item
12596The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
12597@code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
12598are not implemented.
12599
12600@item
12601@cindex array aggregates (Ada)
12602@cindex record aggregates (Ada)
12603@cindex aggregates (Ada)
12604There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
12605permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
12606
12607@smallexample
12608(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
12609(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
12610(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
12611(@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
12612(@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
12613(@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
12614@end smallexample
12615
12616Changing a
12617discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
12618undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
12619However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
12620them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
12621aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
12622declared to have a type such as:
12623
12624@smallexample
12625type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
12626 Id : Integer;
12627 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
12628end record;
12629@end smallexample
12630
12631you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
12632assignments:
12633
12634@smallexample
12635(@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
12636(@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
12637@end smallexample
12638
12639As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
12640rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
12641components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
12642component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
12643original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
12644indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
12645redundant component associations, although which component values are
12646assigned in such cases is not defined.
12647
12648@item
12649Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
12650
12651@item
12652The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
12653than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
12654which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
12655looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
12656function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
12657the proper resolution.
12658
12659@item
12660The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
12661
12662@item
12663Entry calls are not implemented.
12664
12665@item
12666Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
12667formats are not supported.
12668
12669@item
12670It is not possible to slice a packed array.
12671
12672@item
12673The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
12674are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
12675context.
12676Should your program
12677redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
12678you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
12679@end itemize
12680
12681@node Additions to Ada
12682@subsubsection Additions to Ada
12683@cindex Ada, deviations from
12684
12685As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
12686extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
12687
12688@itemize @bullet
12689@item
12690If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
12691a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
12692then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
12693@var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
12694Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
12695in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
12696Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
12697which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
12698
12699@item
12700@code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
12701appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
12702you must typically surround it in single quotes.
12703
12704@item
12705The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
12706@var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
12707
12708@item
12709A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
12710(@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
12711@end itemize
12712
12713In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
12714additions specific to Ada:
12715
12716@itemize @bullet
12717@item
12718The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
12719its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
12720
12721@smallexample
12722(@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
12723(@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
12724@end smallexample
12725
12726@item
12727The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
12728the value of its right-hand operand.
12729This allows, for example,
12730complex conditional breaks:
12731
12732@smallexample
12733(@value{GDBP}) break f
12734(@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
12735@end smallexample
12736
12737@item
12738Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
12739characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
12740which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
12741@samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
12742(single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
12743sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
12744in strings. For example,
12745@smallexample
12746 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
12747@end smallexample
12748@noindent
12749contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
12750after each period.
12751
12752@item
12753The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
12754@t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
12755to write
12756
12757@smallexample
12758(@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
12759@end smallexample
12760
12761@item
12762When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
12763array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
12764For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
12765of 3 might print as
12766
12767@smallexample
12768(3 => 10, 17, 1)
12769@end smallexample
12770
12771@noindent
12772That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
12773clause.
12774
12775@item
12776You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
12777multi-character subsequence of
12778their names (an exact match gets preference).
12779For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
12780in place of @t{a'length}.
12781
12782@item
12783@cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
12784Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
12785to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
12786some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
12787For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
12788enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
12789For example,
12790@smallexample
12791(@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
12792@end smallexample
12793
12794@item
12795Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
12796access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
12797specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
12798selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
12799object.
12800
12801@end itemize
12802
12803@node Stopping Before Main Program
12804@subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
12805
12806@cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
12807It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
12808before reaching the main procedure.
12809As defined in the Ada Reference
12810Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
12811@code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
12812elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
12813@code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
12814
12815@node Ada Tasks
12816@subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
12817@cindex Ada, tasking
12818
12819Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
12820@value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
12821
12822@table @code
12823@kindex info tasks
12824@item info tasks
12825This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
12826
12827
12828@smallexample
12829@iftex
12830@leftskip=0.5cm
12831@end iftex
12832(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12833 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12834 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12835 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
12836 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
12837* 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
12838
12839@end smallexample
12840
12841@noindent
12842In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
12843task currently being inspected.
12844
12845@table @asis
12846@item ID
12847Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
12848
12849@item TID
12850The Ada task ID.
12851
12852@item P-ID
12853The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
12854
12855@item Pri
12856The base priority of the task.
12857
12858@item State
12859Current state of the task.
12860
12861@table @code
12862@item Unactivated
12863The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
12864executing.
12865
12866@item Runnable
12867The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
12868for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
12869
12870@item Terminated
12871The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
12872that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
12873terminated themselves.
12874
12875@item Child Activation Wait
12876The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
12877
12878@item Accept Statement
12879The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
12880
12881@item Waiting on entry call
12882The task is waiting on an entry call.
12883
12884@item Async Select Wait
12885The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
12886select statement.
12887
12888@item Delay Sleep
12889The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
12890alternative open.
12891
12892@item Child Termination Wait
12893The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
12894waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
12895waiting on a terminate Phase.
12896
12897@item Wait Child in Term Alt
12898The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
12899finish terminating.
12900
12901@item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
12902The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
12903@end table
12904
12905@item Name
12906Name of the task in the program.
12907
12908@end table
12909
12910@kindex info task @var{taskno}
12911@item info task @var{taskno}
12912This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
12913the following example:
12914@smallexample
12915@iftex
12916@leftskip=0.5cm
12917@end iftex
12918(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12919 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12920 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12921* 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
12922(@value{GDBP}) info task 2
12923Ada Task: 0x807c468
12924Name: task_1
12925Thread: 0x807f378
12926Parent: 1 (main_task)
12927Base Priority: 15
12928State: Runnable
12929@end smallexample
12930
12931@item task
12932@kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
12933@cindex current Ada task ID
12934This command prints the ID of the current task.
12935
12936@smallexample
12937@iftex
12938@leftskip=0.5cm
12939@end iftex
12940(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12941 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12942 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12943* 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
12944(@value{GDBP}) task
12945[Current task is 2]
12946@end smallexample
12947
12948@item task @var{taskno}
12949@cindex Ada task switching
12950This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
12951command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
12952from the current task to the given task.
12953
12954@smallexample
12955@iftex
12956@leftskip=0.5cm
12957@end iftex
12958(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
12959 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
12960 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
12961* 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
12962(@value{GDBP}) task 1
12963[Switching to task 1]
12964#0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
12965(@value{GDBP}) bt
12966#0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
12967#1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
12968#2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
12969#3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
12970#4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
12971@end smallexample
12972
12973@item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
12974@itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
12975@cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
12976@cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
12977@kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
12978These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
12979command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
12980@var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
12981in @ref{Specify Location}.
12982
12983Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
12984to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
12985particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
12986numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
12987column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
12988
12989If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
12990breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
12991program.
12992
12993You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
12994well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
12995breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
12996
12997For example,
12998
12999@smallexample
13000@iftex
13001@leftskip=0.5cm
13002@end iftex
13003(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13004 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13005 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13006 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
13007 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
13008* 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
13009(@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
13010Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
13011(@value{GDBP}) cont
13012Continuing.
13013task # 1 running
13014task # 2 running
13015
13016Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
1301715 flush;
13018(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13019 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13020 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13021* 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
13022 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
13023 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
13024@end smallexample
13025@end table
13026
13027@node Ada Tasks and Core Files
13028@subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
13029@cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
13030
13031When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
13032tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
13033the platform being used.
13034For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
13035switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
13036as usual.
13037
13038On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
13039memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
13040a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
13041privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
13042Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
13043file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
13044
13045@node Ada Glitches
13046@subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
13047@cindex Ada, problems
13048
13049Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
13050we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
13051@value{GDBN},
13052some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
13053and the GNU Ada compiler.
13054
13055@itemize @bullet
13056@item
13057Currently, the debugger
13058has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
13059pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
13060Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
13061to get it printed properly.
13062
13063@item
13064Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
13065storage are invisible to the debugger.
13066
13067@item
13068Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
13069argument lists are treated as positional).
13070
13071@item
13072Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
13073
13074@item
13075Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
13076floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
13077the host machine.
13078
13079@item
13080The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
13081the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
13082this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
13083look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
13084symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
13085defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
13086local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
13087GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
13088you can usually resolve the confusion
13089by qualifying the problematic names with package
13090@code{Standard} explicitly.
13091@end itemize
13092
13093Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
13094information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
13095of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
13096around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
13097to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
13098enabled.
13099
13100@kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
13101@kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
13102@table @code
13103
13104@item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
13105Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
13106value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
13107types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
13108a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
13109This is the default.
13110
13111@item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
13112This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
13113sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
13114trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
13115the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
13116@code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
13117recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
13118
13119@end table
13120
13121@node Unsupported Languages
13122@section Unsupported Languages
13123
13124@cindex unsupported languages
13125@cindex minimal language
13126In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
13127@value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
13128It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
13129of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
13130This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
13131an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
13132
13133If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
13134select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
13135language.
13136
13137@node Symbols
13138@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
13139
13140The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
13141symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
13142program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
13143does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
13144program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
13145(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
13146file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13147
13148@cindex symbol names
13149@cindex names of symbols
13150@cindex quoting names
13151Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
13152characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
13153most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
13154source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
13155are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
13156ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
13157@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
13158@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
13159
13160@smallexample
13161p 'foo.c'::x
13162@end smallexample
13163
13164@noindent
13165looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
13166
13167@table @code
13168@cindex case-insensitive symbol names
13169@cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
13170@kindex set case-sensitive
13171@item set case-sensitive on
13172@itemx set case-sensitive off
13173@itemx set case-sensitive auto
13174Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
13175with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
13176Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
13177case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
13178case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
13179you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
13180suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
13181matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
13182case-insensitive matches.
13183
13184@kindex show case-sensitive
13185@item show case-sensitive
13186This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
13187lookups.
13188
13189@kindex info address
13190@cindex address of a symbol
13191@item info address @var{symbol}
13192Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
13193variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
13194local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
13195is always stored.
13196
13197Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
13198at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
13199the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
13200
13201@kindex info symbol
13202@cindex symbol from address
13203@cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
13204@item info symbol @var{addr}
13205Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
13206If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
13207nearest symbol and an offset from it:
13208
13209@smallexample
13210(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
13211_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
13212@end smallexample
13213
13214@noindent
13215This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
13216it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
13217
13218For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
13219library containing the symbol is also printed:
13220
13221@smallexample
13222(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
13223_start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
13224(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
13225__read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
13226@end smallexample
13227
13228@kindex whatis
13229@item whatis [@var{arg}]
13230Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
13231a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
13232last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
13233not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
13234assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
13235@var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
13236for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
13237@samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
13238@samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
13239@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
13240
13241@kindex ptype
13242@item ptype [@var{arg}]
13243@code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
13244detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
13245@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
13246
13247For example, for this variable declaration:
13248
13249@smallexample
13250struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
13251@end smallexample
13252
13253@noindent
13254the two commands give this output:
13255
13256@smallexample
13257@group
13258(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
13259type = struct complex
13260(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
13261type = struct complex @{
13262 double real;
13263 double imag;
13264@}
13265@end group
13266@end smallexample
13267
13268@noindent
13269As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
13270the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
13271
13272@cindex incomplete type
13273Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
13274of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
13275program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
13276the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
13277given these declarations:
13278
13279@smallexample
13280 struct foo;
13281 struct foo *fooptr;
13282@end smallexample
13283
13284@noindent
13285but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
13286
13287@smallexample
13288 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
13289 $1 = <incomplete type>
13290@end smallexample
13291
13292@noindent
13293``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
13294completely specified.
13295
13296@kindex info types
13297@item info types @var{regexp}
13298@itemx info types
13299Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
13300expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
13301no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
13302complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
13303types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
13304@samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
13305name is @code{value}.
13306
13307This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
13308@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
13309lists all source files where a type is defined.
13310
13311@kindex info scope
13312@cindex local variables
13313@item info scope @var{location}
13314List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
13315accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
13316an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
13317to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
13318details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
13319
13320@smallexample
13321(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
13322Scope for command_line_handler:
13323Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
13324Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
13325Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
13326Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
13327Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
13328Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
13329Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
13330@end smallexample
13331
13332@noindent
13333This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
13334during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
13335collect}.
13336
13337@kindex info source
13338@item info source
13339Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
13340the function containing the current point of execution:
13341@itemize @bullet
13342@item
13343the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
13344@item
13345the directory it was compiled in,
13346@item
13347its length, in lines,
13348@item
13349which programming language it is written in,
13350@item
13351whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
13352if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
13353@item
13354whether the debugging information includes information about
13355preprocessor macros.
13356@end itemize
13357
13358
13359@kindex info sources
13360@item info sources
13361Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
13362debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
13363have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
13364
13365@kindex info functions
13366@item info functions
13367Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
13368
13369@item info functions @var{regexp}
13370Print the names and data types of all defined functions
13371whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
13372Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
13373include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
13374start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
13375that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
13376@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
13377
13378@kindex info variables
13379@item info variables
13380Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
13381outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
13382
13383@item info variables @var{regexp}
13384Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
13385variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
13386@var{regexp}.
13387
13388@kindex info classes
13389@cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
13390@item info classes
13391@itemx info classes @var{regexp}
13392Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
13393(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
13394expression.
13395
13396@kindex info selectors
13397@item info selectors
13398@itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
13399Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
13400(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
13401expression.
13402
13403@ignore
13404This was never implemented.
13405@kindex info methods
13406@item info methods
13407@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
13408The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
13409methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
13410specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
13411C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
13412from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
13413@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
13414which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
13415@end ignore
13416
13417@cindex reloading symbols
13418Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
13419be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
13420in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
13421running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
13422@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
13423
13424@table @code
13425@kindex set symbol-reloading
13426@item set symbol-reloading on
13427Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
13428object file with a particular name is seen again.
13429
13430@item set symbol-reloading off
13431Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
13432same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
13433running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
13434should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
13435may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
13436several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
13437name.
13438
13439@kindex show symbol-reloading
13440@item show symbol-reloading
13441Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
13442@end table
13443
13444@cindex opaque data types
13445@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
13446@item set opaque-type-resolution on
13447Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
13448declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
13449@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
13450source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
13451another source file. The default is on.
13452
13453A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
13454the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
13455
13456@item set opaque-type-resolution off
13457Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
13458is printed as follows:
13459@smallexample
13460@{<no data fields>@}
13461@end smallexample
13462
13463@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
13464@item show opaque-type-resolution
13465Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
13466
13467@kindex maint print symbols
13468@cindex symbol dump
13469@kindex maint print psymbols
13470@cindex partial symbol dump
13471@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
13472@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
13473@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
13474Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
13475These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
13476symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
13477symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
13478collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
13479only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
13480command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
13481use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
13482symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
13483files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
13484@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
13485required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
13486@xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
13487@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
13488
13489@kindex maint info symtabs
13490@kindex maint info psymtabs
13491@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
13492@cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
13493@cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
13494@cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
13495@item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
13496@itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
13497
13498List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
13499structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
13500given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
13501copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
13502structure in more detail. For example:
13503
13504@smallexample
13505(@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
13506@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
13507 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
13508 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
13509 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
13510 readin no
13511 fullname (null)
13512 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
13513 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
13514 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
13515 dependencies (none)
13516 @}
13517@}
13518(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
13519(@value{GDBP})
13520@end smallexample
13521@noindent
13522We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
13523the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
13524and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
13525If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
13526read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
13527
13528@smallexample
13529(@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
13530Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
13531line 1574.
13532(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
13533@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
13534 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
13535 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
13536 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
13537 dirname (null)
13538 fullname (null)
13539 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
13540 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
13541 debugformat DWARF 2
13542 @}
13543@}
13544(@value{GDBP})
13545@end smallexample
13546@end table
13547
13548
13549@node Altering
13550@chapter Altering Execution
13551
13552Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
13553find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
13554correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
13555experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
13556program.
13557
13558For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
13559locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
13560address, or even return prematurely from a function.
13561
13562@menu
13563* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
13564* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
13565* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
13566* Returning:: Returning from a function
13567* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
13568* Patching:: Patching your program
13569@end menu
13570
13571@node Assignment
13572@section Assignment to Variables
13573
13574@cindex assignment
13575@cindex setting variables
13576To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
13577@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
13578
13579@smallexample
13580print x=4
13581@end smallexample
13582
13583@noindent
13584stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
13585value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
13586@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
13587information on operators in supported languages.
13588
13589@kindex set variable
13590@cindex variables, setting
13591If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
13592@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
13593really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
13594not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
13595,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
13596
13597If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
13598appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
13599variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
13600to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
13601program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
13602a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
13603command @code{set width}:
13604
13605@smallexample
13606(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
13607type = double
13608(@value{GDBP}) p width
13609$4 = 13
13610(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
13611Invalid syntax in expression.
13612@end smallexample
13613
13614@noindent
13615The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
13616order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
13617
13618@smallexample
13619(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
13620@end smallexample
13621
13622Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
13623with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
13624@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
13625your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
13626to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
13627the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
13628
13629@smallexample
13630@group
13631(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
13632type = double
13633(@value{GDBP}) p g
13634$1 = 1
13635(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
13636(@value{GDBP}) p g
13637$2 = 1
13638(@value{GDBP}) r
13639The program being debugged has been started already.
13640Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
13641Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
13642"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
13643 Invalid bfd target.
13644(@value{GDBP}) show g
13645The current BFD target is "=4".
13646@end group
13647@end smallexample
13648
13649@noindent
13650The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
13651@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
13652@code{g}, use
13653
13654@smallexample
13655(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
13656@end smallexample
13657
13658@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
13659freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
13660and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
13661same length or shorter.
13662@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
13663@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
13664
13665To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
13666construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
13667(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
13668to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
13669and representation in memory), and
13670
13671@smallexample
13672set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
13673@end smallexample
13674
13675@noindent
13676stores the value 4 into that memory location.
13677
13678@node Jumping
13679@section Continuing at a Different Address
13680
13681Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
13682it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
13683an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
13684
13685@table @code
13686@kindex jump
13687@item jump @var{linespec}
13688@itemx jump @var{location}
13689Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
13690@var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
13691breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
13692different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
13693practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
13694@code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
13695
13696The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
13697the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
13698register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
13699a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
13700be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
13701of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
13702confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
13703executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
13704well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
13705@end table
13706
13707@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
13708On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
13709command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
13710difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
13711changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
13712example,
13713
13714@smallexample
13715set $pc = 0x485
13716@end smallexample
13717
13718@noindent
13719makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
13720address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
13721@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
13722
13723The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
13724up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
13725that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
13726detail.
13727
13728@c @group
13729@node Signaling
13730@section Giving your Program a Signal
13731@cindex deliver a signal to a program
13732
13733@table @code
13734@kindex signal
13735@item signal @var{signal}
13736Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
13737signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
13738signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
13739SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
13740
13741Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
13742giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
13743a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
13744@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
13745signal.
13746
13747@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
13748after executing the command.
13749@end table
13750@c @end group
13751
13752Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
13753@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
13754causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
13755the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
13756passes the signal directly to your program.
13757
13758
13759@node Returning
13760@section Returning from a Function
13761
13762@table @code
13763@cindex returning from a function
13764@kindex return
13765@item return
13766@itemx return @var{expression}
13767You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
13768command. If you give an
13769@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
13770value.
13771@end table
13772
13773When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
13774(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
13775discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
13776be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
13777
13778This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
13779Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
13780innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
13781specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
13782of functions.
13783
13784The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
13785program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
13786returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
13787and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
13788selected stack frame returns naturally.
13789
13790@value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
13791the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
13792type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
13793OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
13794CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
13795registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
13796specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
13797current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
13798assignment into the right register(s).
13799
13800Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
13801use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
13802debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
13803function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
13804int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
13805into a @code{long long int}:
13806
13807@smallexample
13808Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
1380929 return 31;
13810(@value{GDBP}) return -1
13811Make func return now? (y or n) y
13812#0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
1381343 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
13814(@value{GDBP})
13815@end smallexample
13816
13817However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
13818function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
13819to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
13820in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
13821typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
13822of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
13823architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
13824an appropriate cast explicitly:
13825
13826@smallexample
13827Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
13828(@value{GDBP}) return -1
13829Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
13830Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
13831(@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
13832Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
13833#0 0x00400526 in main ()
13834(@value{GDBP})
13835@end smallexample
13836
13837@node Calling
13838@section Calling Program Functions
13839
13840@table @code
13841@cindex calling functions
13842@cindex inferior functions, calling
13843@item print @var{expr}
13844Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
13845@var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
13846debugged.
13847
13848@kindex call
13849@item call @var{expr}
13850Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
13851returned values.
13852
13853You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
13854execute a function from your program that does not return anything
13855(a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
13856with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
13857print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
13858value history.
13859@end table
13860
13861It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
13862@code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
13863the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
13864in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
13865
13866Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
13867call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
13868exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
13869frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
13870an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
13871dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
13872seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
13873in that case is controlled by the
13874@code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
13875
13876@table @code
13877@item set unwindonsignal
13878@kindex set unwindonsignal
13879@cindex unwind stack in called functions
13880@cindex call dummy stack unwinding
13881Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
13882that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
13883@value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
13884the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
13885default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
13886received.
13887
13888@item show unwindonsignal
13889@kindex show unwindonsignal
13890Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
13891@value{GDBN}.
13892
13893@item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
13894@kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
13895@cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
13896@cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
13897Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
13898unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
13899debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
13900it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
13901the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
13902the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
13903
13904@item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
13905@kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
13906Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
13907@value{GDBN}.
13908
13909@end table
13910
13911@cindex weak alias functions
13912Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
13913for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
13914the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
13915which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
13916As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
13917even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
13918function instead.
13919
13920@node Patching
13921@section Patching Programs
13922
13923@cindex patching binaries
13924@cindex writing into executables
13925@cindex writing into corefiles
13926
13927By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
13928executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
13929alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
13930patching your program's binary.
13931
13932If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
13933explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
13934want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
13935repairs.
13936
13937@table @code
13938@kindex set write
13939@item set write on
13940@itemx set write off
13941If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
13942core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
13943off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
13944
13945If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
13946@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
13947write}, for your new setting to take effect.
13948
13949@item show write
13950@kindex show write
13951Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
13952as well as reading.
13953@end table
13954
13955@node GDB Files
13956@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
13957
13958@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
13959both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
13960program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
13961@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
13962
13963@menu
13964* Files:: Commands to specify files
13965* Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
13966* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
13967* Data Files:: GDB data files
13968@end menu
13969
13970@node Files
13971@section Commands to Specify Files
13972
13973@cindex symbol table
13974@cindex core dump file
13975
13976You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
13977way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
13978@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
13979Out of @value{GDBN}}).
13980
13981Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
13982@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
13983specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
13984via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
13985Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
13986new files are useful.
13987
13988@table @code
13989@cindex executable file
13990@kindex file
13991@item file @var{filename}
13992Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
13993symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
13994executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
13995directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
13996@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
13997directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
13998to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
13999and your program, using the @code{path} command.
14000
14001@cindex unlinked object files
14002@cindex patching object files
14003You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
14004the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
14005file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
14006if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
14007@kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
14008that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
14009case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
14010the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
14011
14012@item file
14013@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
14014has on both executable file and the symbol table.
14015
14016@kindex exec-file
14017@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
14018Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
14019in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
14020if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
14021discard information on the executable file.
14022
14023@kindex symbol-file
14024@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
14025Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
14026searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
14027table and program to run from the same file.
14028
14029@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
14030program's symbol table.
14031
14032The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
14033some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
14034contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
14035which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
14036@value{GDBN}.
14037
14038@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
14039executing it once.
14040
14041When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
14042understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
14043generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
14044other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
14045Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
14046using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
14047optimized code.
14048
14049For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
14050using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
14051symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
14052quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
14053details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
14054
14055The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
14056start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
14057occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
14058file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
14059pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
14060Warnings and Messages}.)
14061
14062We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
14063symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
14064symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
14065still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
14066in stabs format.
14067
14068@kindex readnow
14069@cindex reading symbols immediately
14070@cindex symbols, reading immediately
14071@item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
14072@itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
14073You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
14074tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
14075load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
14076entire symbol table available.
14077
14078@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
14079@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
14080@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
14081@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
14082@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
14083@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
14084@c files.
14085
14086@kindex core-file
14087@item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
14088@itemx core
14089Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
14090of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
14091address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
14092executable file itself for other parts.
14093
14094@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
14095to be used.
14096
14097Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
14098under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
14099wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
14100the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
14101(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
14102
14103@kindex add-symbol-file
14104@cindex dynamic linking
14105@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
14106@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
14107@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
14108The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
14109information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
14110when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
14111into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
14112address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
14113this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
14114of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
14115section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
14116@var{address} as an expression.
14117
14118The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
14119originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
14120@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
14121thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
14122instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
14123
14124@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
14125@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
14126@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
14127@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
14128@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
14129Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
14130executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
14131relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
14132information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
14133
14134@itemize @bullet
14135@item
14136the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
14137that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
14138@item
14139every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
14140been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
14141@item
14142you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
14143provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
14144@end itemize
14145
14146@noindent
14147Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
14148relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
14149typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
14150important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
14151procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
14152assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
14153general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
14154relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
14155as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
14156way.
14157
14158@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
14159
14160@kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
14161@cindex @code{syscall DSO}
14162@cindex load symbols from memory
14163@item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
14164Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
14165object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
14166For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
14167process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
14168some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
14169evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
14170For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
14171@code{exec-file} commands in advance.
14172
14173@kindex add-shared-symbol-files
14174@kindex assf
14175@item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
14176@itemx assf @var{library-file}
14177The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
14178in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
14179alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
14180@value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
14181@value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
14182@code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
14183library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
14184@code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
14185
14186@kindex section
14187@item section @var{section} @var{addr}
14188The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
14189@var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
14190exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
14191@code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
14192itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
14193@code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
14194their addresses.
14195
14196@kindex info files
14197@kindex info target
14198@item info files
14199@itemx info target
14200@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
14201current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
14202including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
14203use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
14204command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
14205current ones.
14206
14207@kindex maint info sections
14208@item maint info sections
14209Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
14210is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
14211displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
14212offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
14213@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
14214may be arbitrarily combined):
14215
14216@table @code
14217@item ALLOBJ
14218Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
14219@item @var{sections}
14220Display info only for named @var{sections}.
14221@item @var{section-flags}
14222Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
14223The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
14224@table @code
14225@item ALLOC
14226Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
14227Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
14228@item LOAD
14229Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
14230Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
14231@item RELOC
14232Section needs to be relocated before loading.
14233@item READONLY
14234Section cannot be modified by the child process.
14235@item CODE
14236Section contains executable code only.
14237@item DATA
14238Section contains data only (no executable code).
14239@item ROM
14240Section will reside in ROM.
14241@item CONSTRUCTOR
14242Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
14243@item HAS_CONTENTS
14244Section is not empty.
14245@item NEVER_LOAD
14246An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
14247@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
14248A notification to the linker that the section contains
14249COFF shared library information.
14250@item IS_COMMON
14251Section contains common symbols.
14252@end table
14253@end table
14254@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
14255@cindex read-only sections
14256@item set trust-readonly-sections on
14257Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
14258really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
14259In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
14260out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
14261For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
14262enhancement to debugging performance.
14263
14264The default is off.
14265
14266@item set trust-readonly-sections off
14267Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
14268the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
14269and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
14270
14271@item show trust-readonly-sections
14272Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
14273@end table
14274
14275All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
14276as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
14277name and remembers it that way.
14278
14279@cindex shared libraries
14280@anchor{Shared Libraries}
14281@value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
14282and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
14283
14284On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
14285shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
14286
14287@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
14288when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
14289(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
14290references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
14291debugging a core file).
14292
14293On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
14294automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
14295
14296@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
14297@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
14298@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
14299
14300There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
14301symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
14302particularly large or there are many of them.
14303
14304To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
14305commands:
14306
14307@table @code
14308@kindex set auto-solib-add
14309@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
14310If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
14311will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
14312attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
14313informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
14314is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
14315@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
14316
14317@cindex memory used for symbol tables
14318If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
14319takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
14320memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
14321symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
14322auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
14323library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
14324@var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
14325the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
14326
14327@kindex show auto-solib-add
14328@item show auto-solib-add
14329Display the current autoloading mode.
14330@end table
14331
14332@cindex load shared library
14333To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
14334command:
14335
14336@table @code
14337@kindex info sharedlibrary
14338@kindex info share
14339@item info share @var{regex}
14340@itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14341Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
14342that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
14343all shared libraries that are loaded.
14344
14345@kindex sharedlibrary
14346@kindex share
14347@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14348@itemx share @var{regex}
14349Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
14350Unix regular expression.
14351As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
14352required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
14353@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
14354loaded.
14355
14356@item nosharedlibrary
14357@kindex nosharedlibrary
14358@cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
14359Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
14360that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
14361libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
14362discarded.
14363@end table
14364
14365Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
14366when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
14367stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
14368
14369@table @code
14370@item set stop-on-solib-events
14371@kindex set stop-on-solib-events
14372This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
14373when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
14374The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
14375shared library.
14376
14377@item show stop-on-solib-events
14378@kindex show stop-on-solib-events
14379Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
14380library events happen.
14381@end table
14382
14383Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
14384configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
14385this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
14386on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
14387libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
14388provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
14389copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
14390not.
14391
14392@cindex where to look for shared libraries
14393For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
14394libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
14395may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
14396to specify the search directories for target libraries.
14397
14398@table @code
14399@cindex prefix for shared library file names
14400@cindex system root, alternate
14401@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
14402@kindex set sysroot
14403@item set sysroot @var{path}
14404Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
14405absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
14406runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
14407target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
14408libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
14409the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
14410under @var{path}.
14411
14412If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
14413retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
14414supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
14415command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
14416The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
14417(if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
14418@footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
14419that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
14420variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
14421
14422For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
14423SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
14424absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
14425@value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
14426slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
14427
14428@smallexample
14429 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
14430@end smallexample
14431
14432Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
14433@var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
14434system:
14435
14436@smallexample
14437 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
14438@end smallexample
14439
14440If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
14441the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
14442for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
14443colons:
14444
14445@smallexample
14446 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
14447@end smallexample
14448
14449This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
14450with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
14451copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
14452@samp{z}):
14453
14454@smallexample
14455 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
14456 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
14457 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
14458@end smallexample
14459
14460@noindent
14461and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
14462@value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
14463@file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
14464
14465If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
14466removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
14467
14468@smallexample
14469 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
14470@end smallexample
14471
14472This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
14473if you don't want or need to.
14474
14475The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
14476sysroot}.
14477
14478@cindex default system root
14479@cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
14480You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
14481@samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
14482@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
14483@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
14484automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
14485location.
14486
14487@kindex show sysroot
14488@item show sysroot
14489Display the current shared library prefix.
14490
14491@kindex set solib-search-path
14492@item set solib-search-path @var{path}
14493If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
14494directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
14495is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
14496path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
14497use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
14498@samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
14499finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
14500it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
14501of shared library symbols.
14502
14503@kindex show solib-search-path
14504@item show solib-search-path
14505Display the current shared library search path.
14506
14507@cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
14508@kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
14509@kindex show target-file-system-kind
14510@item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
14511Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
14512
14513Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
14514make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
14515example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
14516system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
14517@value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
14518@file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
14519drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
14520indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
14521normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
14522the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
14523as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
14524it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
14525shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
14526with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
14527@code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
14528to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
14529map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
14530semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
14531to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
14532tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
14533current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
14534Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
14535
14536@table @code
14537@item unix
14538Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
14539kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
14540are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
14541the forward slash.
14542
14543@item dos-based
14544Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
14545File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
14546followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
14547both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
14548considered directory separators.
14549
14550@item auto
14551Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
14552target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
14553This is the default.
14554@end table
14555@end table
14556
14557
14558@node Separate Debug Files
14559@section Debugging Information in Separate Files
14560@cindex separate debugging information files
14561@cindex debugging information in separate files
14562@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
14563@cindex debugging information directory, global
14564@cindex global debugging information directory
14565@cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
14566@cindex @file{.build-id} directory
14567
14568@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
14569file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
14570@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
14571Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
14572than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
14573information for their executables in separate files, which users can
14574install only when they need to debug a problem.
14575
14576@value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
14577file:
14578
14579@itemize @bullet
14580@item
14581The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
14582the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
14583usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
14584name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
14585(e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
14586debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
14587checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
14588the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
14589
14590@item
14591The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
14592also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
14593only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
14594for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
14595this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
14596command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
14597The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
14598explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
14599below.
14600@end itemize
14601
14602Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
14603uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
14604
14605@itemize @bullet
14606@item
14607For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
14608the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
14609directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
14610directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
14611directories of the executable's absolute file name.
14612
14613@item
14614For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
14615@file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
14616named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
14617first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
14618are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
14619hex characters, not 10.)
14620@end itemize
14621
14622So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
14623@file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
14624file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
14625@code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
14626@file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
14627debug information files, in the indicated order:
14628
14629@itemize @minus
14630@item
14631@file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
14632@item
14633@file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
14634@item
14635@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
14636@item
14637@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
14638@end itemize
14639
14640You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
14641name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
14642
14643@table @code
14644
14645@kindex set debug-file-directory
14646@item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
14647Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
14648information files to @var{directory}. Multiple directory components can be set
14649concatenating them by a directory separator.
14650
14651@kindex show debug-file-directory
14652@item show debug-file-directory
14653Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
14654information files.
14655
14656@end table
14657
14658@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
14659@cindex debug link sections
14660A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
14661@code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
14662
14663@itemize
14664@item
14665A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
14666a zero byte,
14667@item
14668zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
14669boundary within the section, and
14670@item
14671a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
14672executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
14673information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
14674zero as the @var{crc} argument.
14675@end itemize
14676
14677Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
14678contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
14679described above.
14680
14681@cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
14682@cindex build ID sections
14683The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
14684ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
14685often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
14686It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
14687the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
14688algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
14689content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
14690value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
14691stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
14692
14693The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
14694executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
14695debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
14696should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
14697but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
14698in an ordinary executable.
14699
14700The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
14701@samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
14702the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
14703following commands:
14704
14705@smallexample
14706@kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
14707@kbd{strip -g foo}
14708@end smallexample
14709
14710@noindent
14711These commands remove the debugging
14712information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
14713@file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
14714two files:
14715
14716@itemize @bullet
14717@item
14718The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
14719behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
14720
14721@smallexample
14722@kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
14723@end smallexample
14724
14725Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
14726a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
14727foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
14728the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
14729
14730@item
14731Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
14732the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
14733compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
14734utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
14735@end itemize
14736
14737@noindent
14738
14739@cindex CRC algorithm definition
14740The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
14741IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
14742
14743@c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
14744@c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
14745@c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
14746@c different ways!
14747@ifhtml
14748@display
14749@html
14750 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
14751 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
14752@end html
14753@end display
14754@end ifhtml
14755@ifnothtml
14756@display
14757 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
14758 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
14759@end display
14760@end ifnothtml
14761
14762The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
14763significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
14764@code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
14765the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
14766CRC.
14767
14768@emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
14769@dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
14770, @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
14771case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
14772significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
14773zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
14774
14775To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
14776which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
14777initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
14778this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
14779@code{0xffffffff}.
14780
14781@kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
14782@smallexample
14783unsigned long
14784gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
14785 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
14786@{
14787 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
14788 @{
14789 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
14790 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
14791 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
14792 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
14793 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
14794 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
14795 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
14796 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
14797 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
14798 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
14799 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
14800 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
14801 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
14802 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
14803 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
14804 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
14805 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
14806 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
14807 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
14808 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
14809 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
14810 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
14811 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
14812 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
14813 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
14814 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
14815 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
14816 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
14817 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
14818 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
14819 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
14820 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
14821 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
14822 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
14823 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
14824 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
14825 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
14826 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
14827 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
14828 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
14829 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
14830 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
14831 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
14832 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
14833 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
14834 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
14835 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
14836 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
14837 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
14838 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
14839 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
14840 0x2d02ef8d
14841 @};
14842 unsigned char *end;
14843
14844 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
14845 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
14846 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
14847 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
14848@}
14849@end smallexample
14850
14851@noindent
14852This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
14853
14854
14855@node Symbol Errors
14856@section Errors Reading Symbol Files
14857
14858While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
14859such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
14860output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
14861they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
14862debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
14863about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
14864only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
14865times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
14866to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
14867complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
14868Messages}).
14869
14870The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
14871
14872@table @code
14873@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
14874
14875The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
14876(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
14877error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
14878in its outer scope blocks.
14879
14880@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
14881the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
14882may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
14883function.
14884
14885@item block at @var{address} out of order
14886
14887The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
14888order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
14889do so.
14890
14891@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
14892locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
14893can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
14894@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
14895Messages}.)
14896
14897@item bad block start address patched
14898
14899The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
14900smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
14901to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
14902
14903@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
14904starting on the previous source line.
14905
14906@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
14907
14908@cindex foo
14909Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
14910larger than the size of the string table.
14911
14912@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
14913name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
14914with this name.
14915
14916@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
14917
14918The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
14919not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
14920uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
14921
14922@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
14923This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
14924are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
14925debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
14926on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
14927and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
14928
14929@item stub type has NULL name
14930
14931@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
14932
14933@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
14934The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
14935information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
14936it.
14937
14938@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
14939
14940@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
14941
14942@end table
14943
14944@node Data Files
14945@section GDB Data Files
14946
14947@cindex prefix for data files
14948@value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
14949are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
14950
14951You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
14952is currently using.
14953
14954@table @code
14955@kindex set data-directory
14956@item set data-directory @var{directory}
14957Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
14958to @var{directory}.
14959
14960@kindex show data-directory
14961@item show data-directory
14962Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
14963@end table
14964
14965@cindex default data directory
14966@cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
14967You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
14968@samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
14969@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
14970@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
14971automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
14972location.
14973
14974@node Targets
14975@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
14976
14977@cindex debugging target
14978A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
14979
14980Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
14981in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
14982you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
14983flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
14984host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
14985realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
14986command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
14987(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
14988
14989@cindex target architecture
14990It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
14991architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
14992one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
14993command.
14994
14995@table @code
14996@kindex set architecture
14997@kindex show architecture
14998@item set architecture @var{arch}
14999This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
15000value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
15001supported architectures.
15002
15003@item show architecture
15004Show the current target architecture.
15005
15006@item set processor
15007@itemx processor
15008@kindex set processor
15009@kindex show processor
15010These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
15011and @code{show architecture}.
15012@end table
15013
15014@menu
15015* Active Targets:: Active targets
15016* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
15017* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
15018@end menu
15019
15020@node Active Targets
15021@section Active Targets
15022
15023@cindex stacking targets
15024@cindex active targets
15025@cindex multiple targets
15026
15027There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
15028executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
15029active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
15030start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
15031a core file.
15032
15033For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
15034@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
15035well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
15036@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
15037first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
15038requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
15039are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
15040read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
15041executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
15042
15043When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
15044target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
15045commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
15046an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
15047process target is active.
15048
15049Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
15050core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
15051Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
15052the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
15053Process}).
15054
15055@node Target Commands
15056@section Commands for Managing Targets
15057
15058@table @code
15059@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
15060Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
15061process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
15062facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
15063protocol of the target machine.
15064
15065Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
15066typically include things like device names or host names to connect
15067with, process numbers, and baud rates.
15068
15069The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
15070after executing the command.
15071
15072@kindex help target
15073@item help target
15074Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
15075currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
15076(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15077
15078@item help target @var{name}
15079Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
15080select it.
15081
15082@kindex set gnutarget
15083@item set gnutarget @var{args}
15084@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
15085knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
15086a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
15087with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
15088with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
15089
15090@quotation
15091@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
15092you must know the actual BFD name.
15093@end quotation
15094
15095@noindent
15096@xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
15097
15098@kindex show gnutarget
15099@item show gnutarget
15100Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
15101@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
15102@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
15103and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
15104@end table
15105
15106@cindex common targets
15107Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
15108configuration):
15109
15110@table @code
15111@kindex target
15112@item target exec @var{program}
15113@cindex executable file target
15114An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
15115@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
15116
15117@item target core @var{filename}
15118@cindex core dump file target
15119A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
15120@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
15121
15122@item target remote @var{medium}
15123@cindex remote target
15124A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
15125connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
15126protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
15127
15128For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
15129machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
15130
15131@smallexample
15132target remote /dev/ttya
15133@end smallexample
15134
15135@code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
15136useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
15137system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
15138clobbered by the download.
15139
15140@item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
15141@cindex built-in simulator target
15142Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
15143In general,
15144@smallexample
15145 target sim
15146 load
15147 run
15148@end smallexample
15149@noindent
15150works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
15151drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
15152provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
15153see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
15154Processors}.
15155
15156@end table
15157
15158Some configurations may include these targets as well:
15159
15160@table @code
15161
15162@item target nrom @var{dev}
15163@cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
15164NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
15165
15166@end table
15167
15168Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
15169your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
15170
15171Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
15172you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
15173various aspects of this process.
15174
15175@table @code
15176
15177@item set hash
15178@kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
15179@cindex hash mark while downloading
15180This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
15181downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
15182displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
15183monitor.
15184
15185@item show hash
15186@kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
15187Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
15188
15189@item set debug monitor
15190@kindex set debug monitor
15191@cindex display remote monitor communications
15192Enable or disable display of communications messages between
15193@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
15194
15195@item show debug monitor
15196@kindex show debug monitor
15197Show the current status of displaying communications between
15198@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
15199@end table
15200
15201@table @code
15202
15203@kindex load @var{filename}
15204@item load @var{filename}
15205@anchor{load}
15206Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
15207@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
15208is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
15209on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
15210@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
15211the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
15212
15213If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
15214execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
15215target is @dots{}}''
15216
15217The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
15218For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
15219link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
15220specifies a fixed address.
15221@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
15222
15223Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
15224load programs into flash memory.
15225
15226@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
15227@end table
15228
15229@node Byte Order
15230@section Choosing Target Byte Order
15231
15232@cindex choosing target byte order
15233@cindex target byte order
15234
15235Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
15236offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
15237orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
15238designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
15239which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
15240@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
15241
15242@table @code
15243@kindex set endian
15244@item set endian big
15245Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
15246
15247@item set endian little
15248Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
15249
15250@item set endian auto
15251Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
15252executable.
15253
15254@item show endian
15255Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
15256
15257@end table
15258
15259Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
15260data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
15261target system.
15262
15263
15264@node Remote Debugging
15265@chapter Debugging Remote Programs
15266@cindex remote debugging
15267
15268If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
15269@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
15270For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
15271or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
15272powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
15273
15274Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
15275to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
15276@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
15277but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
15278write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
15279communicate with @value{GDBN}.
15280
15281Other remote targets may be available in your
15282configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
15283
15284@menu
15285* Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
15286* File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
15287* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
15288* Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
15289* Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
15290@end menu
15291
15292@node Connecting
15293@section Connecting to a Remote Target
15294
15295On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
15296your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
15297Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
15298program as the first argument.
15299
15300@cindex @code{target remote}
15301@value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
15302over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
15303each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
15304program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
15305@code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
15306Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
15307
15308@table @code
15309
15310@item target remote @var{serial-device}
15311@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
15312Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
15313to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
15314
15315@smallexample
15316target remote /dev/ttyb
15317@end smallexample
15318
15319If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
15320@w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
15321(@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
15322@code{target} command.
15323
15324@item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
15325@itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
15326@cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
15327Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
15328The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
15329address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
15330the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
15331it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
15332target.
15333
15334For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
15335@code{manyfarms}:
15336
15337@smallexample
15338target remote manyfarms:2828
15339@end smallexample
15340
15341If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
15342debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
15343same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
15344port 1234 on your local machine:
15345
15346@smallexample
15347target remote :1234
15348@end smallexample
15349@noindent
15350
15351Note that the colon is still required here.
15352
15353@item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
15354@cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
15355Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
15356connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
15357
15358@smallexample
15359target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
15360@end smallexample
15361
15362When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
15363keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
15364can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
15365cause havoc with your debugging session.
15366
15367@item target remote | @var{command}
15368@cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
15369Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
15370pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
15371by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
15372protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
15373standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
15374that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
15375using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
15376
15377If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
15378@value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
15379program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
15380
15381@end table
15382
15383Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
15384commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
15385running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
15386need to use @kbd{run}.
15387
15388@cindex interrupting remote programs
15389@cindex remote programs, interrupting
15390Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
15391interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
15392program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
15393and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
15394interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
15395
15396@smallexample
15397Interrupted while waiting for the program.
15398Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
15399@end smallexample
15400
15401If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
15402(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
15403remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
15404goes back to waiting.
15405
15406@table @code
15407@kindex detach (remote)
15408@item detach
15409When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
15410@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
15411Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
15412will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
15413command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
15414
15415@kindex disconnect
15416@item disconnect
15417The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
15418the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
15419(this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
15420the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
15421another target.
15422
15423@cindex send command to remote monitor
15424@cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
15425@cindex add new commands for external monitor
15426@kindex monitor
15427@item monitor @var{cmd}
15428This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
15429remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
15430sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
15431can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
15432and implement.
15433@end table
15434
15435@node File Transfer
15436@section Sending files to a remote system
15437@cindex remote target, file transfer
15438@cindex file transfer
15439@cindex sending files to remote systems
15440
15441Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
15442connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
15443for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
15444running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
15445e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
15446the only way to upload or download files.
15447
15448Not all remote targets support these commands.
15449
15450@table @code
15451@kindex remote put
15452@item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
15453Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
15454@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
15455
15456@kindex remote get
15457@item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
15458Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
15459on the host system.
15460
15461@kindex remote delete
15462@item remote delete @var{targetfile}
15463Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
15464
15465@end table
15466
15467@node Server
15468@section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
15469
15470@kindex gdbserver
15471@cindex remote connection without stubs
15472@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
15473allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
15474@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
15475
15476@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
15477because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
15478that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
15479@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
15480@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
15481because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
15482also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
15483started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
15484Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
15485the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
15486do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
15487by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
15488choice for debugging.
15489
15490@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
15491or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
15492protocol.
15493
15494@quotation
15495@emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
15496Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
15497@value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
15498target system with the same privileges as the user running
15499@code{gdbserver}.
15500@end quotation
15501
15502@subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
15503@cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
15504
15505Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
15506program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
15507@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
15508strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
15509system does all the symbol handling.
15510
15511To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
15512the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
15513syntax is:
15514
15515@smallexample
15516target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
15517@end smallexample
15518
15519@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
15520hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
15521@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
15522@file{/dev/com1}:
15523
15524@smallexample
15525target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
15526@end smallexample
15527
15528@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
15529with it.
15530
15531To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
15532
15533@smallexample
15534target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
15535@end smallexample
15536
15537The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
15538specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
15539TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
15540expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
15541(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
15542you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
15543TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
15544reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
15545conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
15546and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
15547@code{target remote} command.
15548
15549@subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
15550
15551On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
15552This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
15553
15554@smallexample
15555target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
15556@end smallexample
15557
15558@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
15559to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
15560
15561@pindex pidof
15562@cindex attach to a program by name
15563You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
15564@code{pidof} utility:
15565
15566@smallexample
15567target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
15568@end smallexample
15569
15570In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
15571has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
15572@code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
15573
15574@subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
15575@cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
15576@cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
15577
15578When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
15579@code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
15580program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
15581and @code{gdbserver} exits.
15582
15583If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
15584enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
15585detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
15586though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
15587commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
15588The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
15589remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
15590arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
15591redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
15592
15593To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
15594or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
15595Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
15596the program you want to debug.
15597
15598@code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
15599You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
15600(@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
15601
15602@subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
15603
15604The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
15605status information about the debugging process. The
15606@option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
15607remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
15608@code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
15609
15610The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
15611for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
15612wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
15613@kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
15614
15615@code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
15616command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
15617program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
15618runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
15619
15620You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
15621its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
15622this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
15623with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
15624
15625For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
15626the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
15627environment:
15628
15629@smallexample
15630$ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
15631@end smallexample
15632
15633@subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
15634
15635Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
15636
15637First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
15638your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
15639@code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
15640was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
15641
15642The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
15643and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
15644system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
15645are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
15646during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
15647files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
15648programs.
15649
15650Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
15651For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
15652the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
15653text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
15654@samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
15655command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
15656already on the target.
15657
15658@subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
15659@cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
15660@anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
15661
15662During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
15663@code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
15664Here are the available commands.
15665
15666@table @code
15667@item monitor help
15668List the available monitor commands.
15669
15670@item monitor set debug 0
15671@itemx monitor set debug 1
15672Disable or enable general debugging messages.
15673
15674@item monitor set remote-debug 0
15675@itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
15676Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
15677protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
15678
15679@item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
15680@cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
15681When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
15682directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
15683libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
15684@samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to an empty list.
15685
15686@item monitor exit
15687Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
15688@code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
15689detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
15690Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
15691of a multi-process mode debug session.
15692
15693@end table
15694
15695@node Remote Configuration
15696@section Remote Configuration
15697
15698@kindex set remote
15699@kindex show remote
15700This section documents the configuration options available when
15701debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
15702extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
15703system-call-allowed}.
15704
15705@table @code
15706@item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
15707@cindex address size for remote targets
15708@cindex bits in remote address
15709Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
15710number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
15711that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
15712default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
15713
15714@item show remoteaddresssize
15715Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
15716
15717@item set remotebaud @var{n}
15718@cindex baud rate for remote targets
15719Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
15720value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
15721remote targets.
15722
15723@item show remotebaud
15724Show the current speed of the remote connection.
15725
15726@item set remotebreak
15727@cindex interrupt remote programs
15728@cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
15729@anchor{set remotebreak}
15730If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
15731when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
15732on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
15733character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
15734expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
15735
15736@item show remotebreak
15737Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
15738interrupt the remote program.
15739
15740@item set remoteflow on
15741@itemx set remoteflow off
15742@kindex set remoteflow
15743Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
15744on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
15745
15746@item show remoteflow
15747@kindex show remoteflow
15748Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
15749
15750@item set remotelogbase @var{base}
15751Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
15752communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
15753@code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
15754@code{ascii}.
15755
15756@item show remotelogbase
15757Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
15758protocol.
15759
15760@item set remotelogfile @var{file}
15761@cindex record serial communications on file
15762Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
15763default is not to record at all.
15764
15765@item show remotelogfile.
15766Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
15767serial communications.
15768
15769@item set remotetimeout @var{num}
15770@cindex timeout for serial communications
15771@cindex remote timeout
15772Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
15773@var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
15774
15775@item show remotetimeout
15776Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
15777responses.
15778
15779@cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
15780@cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
15781@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
15782@anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
15783@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
15784@itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
15785Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
15786watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
15787
15788@item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
15789@itemx show remote exec-file
15790@anchor{set remote exec-file}
15791@cindex executable file, for remote target
15792Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
15793extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
15794target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
15795filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
15796
15797@item set remote interrupt-sequence
15798@cindex interrupt remote programs
15799@cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
15800Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
15801@samp{BREAK-g} as the
15802sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
15803@samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
15804is high level of serial line for some certain time.
15805Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
15806It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
15807
15808@item show interrupt-sequence
15809Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
15810is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
15811@code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
15812also known as Magic SysRq g.
15813
15814@item set remote interrupt-on-connect
15815@cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
15816Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
15817@value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
15818Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
15819which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
15820
15821@item show interrupt-on-connect
15822Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
15823to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
15824
15825@kindex set tcp
15826@kindex show tcp
15827@item set tcp auto-retry on
15828@cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
15829Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
15830debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
15831condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
15832before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
15833enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
15834to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
15835@code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
15836
15837@item set tcp auto-retry off
15838Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
15839
15840@item show tcp auto-retry
15841Show the current auto-retry setting.
15842
15843@item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
15844@cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
15845@cindex timeout, for remote target connection
15846Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
15847@var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
15848(enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
15849that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
15850value.
15851
15852@item show tcp connect-timeout
15853Show the current connection timeout setting.
15854@end table
15855
15856@cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
15857The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
15858your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
15859can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
15860packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
15861packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
15862or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
15863all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
15864see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
15865
15866During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
15867If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
15868in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
15869@value{GDBN} developers.
15870
15871For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
15872packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
15873are:
15874
15875@multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
15876@item Command Name
15877@tab Remote Packet
15878@tab Related Features
15879
15880@item @code{fetch-register}
15881@tab @code{p}
15882@tab @code{info registers}
15883
15884@item @code{set-register}
15885@tab @code{P}
15886@tab @code{set}
15887
15888@item @code{binary-download}
15889@tab @code{X}
15890@tab @code{load}, @code{set}
15891
15892@item @code{read-aux-vector}
15893@tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
15894@tab @code{info auxv}
15895
15896@item @code{symbol-lookup}
15897@tab @code{qSymbol}
15898@tab Detecting multiple threads
15899
15900@item @code{attach}
15901@tab @code{vAttach}
15902@tab @code{attach}
15903
15904@item @code{verbose-resume}
15905@tab @code{vCont}
15906@tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
15907
15908@item @code{run}
15909@tab @code{vRun}
15910@tab @code{run}
15911
15912@item @code{software-breakpoint}
15913@tab @code{Z0}
15914@tab @code{break}
15915
15916@item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
15917@tab @code{Z1}
15918@tab @code{hbreak}
15919
15920@item @code{write-watchpoint}
15921@tab @code{Z2}
15922@tab @code{watch}
15923
15924@item @code{read-watchpoint}
15925@tab @code{Z3}
15926@tab @code{rwatch}
15927
15928@item @code{access-watchpoint}
15929@tab @code{Z4}
15930@tab @code{awatch}
15931
15932@item @code{target-features}
15933@tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
15934@tab @code{set architecture}
15935
15936@item @code{library-info}
15937@tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
15938@tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
15939
15940@item @code{memory-map}
15941@tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
15942@tab @code{info mem}
15943
15944@item @code{read-spu-object}
15945@tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
15946@tab @code{info spu}
15947
15948@item @code{write-spu-object}
15949@tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
15950@tab @code{info spu}
15951
15952@item @code{read-siginfo-object}
15953@tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
15954@tab @code{print $_siginfo}
15955
15956@item @code{write-siginfo-object}
15957@tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
15958@tab @code{set $_siginfo}
15959
15960@item @code{threads}
15961@tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
15962@tab @code{info threads}
15963
15964@item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
15965@tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
15966@tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
15967
15968@item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
15969@tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
15970@tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
15971
15972@item @code{search-memory}
15973@tab @code{qSearch:memory}
15974@tab @code{find}
15975
15976@item @code{supported-packets}
15977@tab @code{qSupported}
15978@tab Remote communications parameters
15979
15980@item @code{pass-signals}
15981@tab @code{QPassSignals}
15982@tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
15983
15984@item @code{hostio-close-packet}
15985@tab @code{vFile:close}
15986@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15987
15988@item @code{hostio-open-packet}
15989@tab @code{vFile:open}
15990@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15991
15992@item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
15993@tab @code{vFile:pread}
15994@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15995
15996@item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
15997@tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
15998@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
15999
16000@item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
16001@tab @code{vFile:unlink}
16002@tab @code{remote delete}
16003
16004@item @code{noack-packet}
16005@tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
16006@tab Packet acknowledgment
16007
16008@item @code{osdata}
16009@tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
16010@tab @code{info os}
16011
16012@item @code{query-attached}
16013@tab @code{qAttached}
16014@tab Querying remote process attach state.
16015@end multitable
16016
16017@node Remote Stub
16018@section Implementing a Remote Stub
16019
16020@cindex debugging stub, example
16021@cindex remote stub, example
16022@cindex stub example, remote debugging
16023The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
16024communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
16025@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
16026these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
16027implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
16028with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
16029organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
16030
16031@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
16032To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
16033@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
16034prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
16035program, you need:
16036
16037@enumerate
16038@item
16039A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
16040have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
16041your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
16042
16043@item
16044A C subroutine library to support your program's
16045subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
16046
16047@item
16048A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
16049download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
16050manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
16051documentation.
16052@end enumerate
16053
16054The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
16055communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
16056machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
16057
16058@table @emph
16059@item On the host,
16060@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
16061else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
16062(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16063
16064@item On the target,
16065you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
16066implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
16067subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
16068
16069On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
16070@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
16071@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
16072@end table
16073
16074The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
16075machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
16076@sc{sparc} boards.
16077
16078@cindex remote serial stub list
16079These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
16080
16081@table @code
16082
16083@item i386-stub.c
16084@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
16085@cindex Intel
16086@cindex i386
16087For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
16088
16089@item m68k-stub.c
16090@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
16091@cindex Motorola 680x0
16092@cindex m680x0
16093For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
16094
16095@item sh-stub.c
16096@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
16097@cindex Renesas
16098@cindex SH
16099For Renesas SH architectures.
16100
16101@item sparc-stub.c
16102@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
16103@cindex Sparc
16104For @sc{sparc} architectures.
16105
16106@item sparcl-stub.c
16107@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
16108@cindex Fujitsu
16109@cindex SparcLite
16110For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
16111
16112@end table
16113
16114The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
16115recently added stubs.
16116
16117@menu
16118* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
16119* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
16120* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
16121@end menu
16122
16123@node Stub Contents
16124@subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
16125
16126@cindex remote serial stub
16127The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
16128subroutines:
16129
16130@table @code
16131@item set_debug_traps
16132@findex set_debug_traps
16133@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
16134This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
16135program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
16136beginning of your program.
16137
16138@item handle_exception
16139@findex handle_exception
16140@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
16141This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
16142explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
16143run when a trap is triggered.
16144
16145@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
16146execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
16147with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
16148protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
16149representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
16150information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
16151retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
16152execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
16153@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
16154machine.
16155
16156@item breakpoint
16157@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
16158Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
16159breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
16160way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
16161machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
16162pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
16163@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
16164simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
16165again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
16166your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
16167@value{GDBN} session gets control.
16168
16169Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
16170to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
16171start of your debugging session.
16172@end table
16173
16174@node Bootstrapping
16175@subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
16176
16177@cindex remote stub, support routines
16178The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
16179chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
16180debugging target machine.
16181
16182First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
16183serial port.
16184
16185@table @code
16186@item int getDebugChar()
16187@findex getDebugChar
16188Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
16189It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
16190different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
16191
16192@item void putDebugChar(int)
16193@findex putDebugChar
16194Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
16195It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
16196different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
16197@end table
16198
16199@cindex control C, and remote debugging
16200@cindex interrupting remote targets
16201If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
16202running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
16203for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
16204character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
16205remote system to stop.
16206
16207Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
16208probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
16209is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
16210@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
16211
16212Other routines you need to supply are:
16213
16214@table @code
16215@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
16216@findex exceptionHandler
16217Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
16218handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
16219way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
16220are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
16221containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
16222@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
16223its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
16224might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
16225exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
16226@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
16227and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
16228you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
16229should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
16230
16231For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
16232gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
16233should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
16234@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
16235help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
16236
16237@item void flush_i_cache()
16238@findex flush_i_cache
16239On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
16240instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
16241instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
16242
16243On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
16244function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
16245@end table
16246
16247@noindent
16248You must also make sure this library routine is available:
16249
16250@table @code
16251@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
16252@findex memset
16253This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
16254memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
16255@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
16256either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
16257@end table
16258
16259If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
16260library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
16261but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
16262subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
16263
16264
16265@node Debug Session
16266@subsection Putting it All Together
16267
16268@cindex remote serial debugging summary
16269In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
16270steps.
16271
16272@enumerate
16273@item
16274Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
16275(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
16276@display
16277@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
16278@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
16279@end display
16280
16281@item
16282Insert these lines near the top of your program:
16283
16284@smallexample
16285set_debug_traps();
16286breakpoint();
16287@end smallexample
16288
16289@item
16290For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
16291@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
16292
16293@smallexample
16294void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
16295@end smallexample
16296
16297@noindent
16298but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
16299function in your program, that function is called when
16300@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
16301error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
16302one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
16303
16304@item
16305Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
16306your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
16307
16308@item
16309Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
16310the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
16311
16312@item
16313@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
16314@c document that. FIXME.
16315Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
16316whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
16317
16318@item
16319Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
16320(@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
16321
16322@end enumerate
16323
16324@node Configurations
16325@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
16326
16327While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
16328cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
16329describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
16330
16331There are three major categories of configurations: native
16332configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
16333operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
16334different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
16335are quite different from each other.
16336
16337@menu
16338* Native::
16339* Embedded OS::
16340* Embedded Processors::
16341* Architectures::
16342@end menu
16343
16344@node Native
16345@section Native
16346
16347This section describes details specific to particular native
16348configurations.
16349
16350@menu
16351* HP-UX:: HP-UX
16352* BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
16353* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
16354* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
16355* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
16356* Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
16357* Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
16358* Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
16359@end menu
16360
16361@node HP-UX
16362@subsection HP-UX
16363
16364On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
16365begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
16366name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
16367
16368
16369@node BSD libkvm Interface
16370@subsection BSD libkvm Interface
16371
16372@cindex libkvm
16373@cindex kernel memory image
16374@cindex kernel crash dump
16375
16376BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
16377interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
16378memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
16379uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
16380dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
16381special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
16382the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
16383@code{kvm} target:
16384
16385@smallexample
16386(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
16387@end smallexample
16388
16389For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
16390argument:
16391
16392@smallexample
16393(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
16394@end smallexample
16395
16396Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
16397available:
16398
16399@table @code
16400@kindex kvm
16401@item kvm pcb
16402Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
16403
16404@item kvm proc
16405Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
16406modern FreeBSD systems.
16407@end table
16408
16409@node SVR4 Process Information
16410@subsection SVR4 Process Information
16411@cindex /proc
16412@cindex examine process image
16413@cindex process info via @file{/proc}
16414
16415Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
16416@samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
16417process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
16418for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
16419proc} is available to report information about the process running
16420your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
16421proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
16422This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
16423Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
16424
16425@table @code
16426@kindex info proc
16427@cindex process ID
16428@item info proc
16429@itemx info proc @var{process-id}
16430Summarize available information about any running process. If a
16431process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
16432that process; otherwise display information about the program being
16433debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
16434line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
16435executable file's absolute file name.
16436
16437On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
16438@samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
16439within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
16440a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
16441needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
16442a process ID rather than a thread ID).
16443
16444@item info proc mappings
16445@cindex memory address space mappings
16446Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
16447information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
16448rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
16449includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
16450memory access rights to that range.
16451
16452@item info proc stat
16453@itemx info proc status
16454@cindex process detailed status information
16455These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
16456the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
16457how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
16458the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
16459consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
16460value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
16461(type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
16462
16463@item info proc all
16464Show all the information about the process described under all of the
16465above @code{info proc} subcommands.
16466
16467@ignore
16468@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
16469@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
16470@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
16471@kindex info proc times
16472@item info proc times
16473Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
16474its children.
16475
16476@kindex info proc id
16477@item info proc id
16478Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
16479the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
16480@end ignore
16481
16482@item set procfs-trace
16483@kindex set procfs-trace
16484@cindex @code{procfs} API calls
16485This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
16486
16487@item show procfs-trace
16488@kindex show procfs-trace
16489Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
16490
16491@item set procfs-file @var{file}
16492@kindex set procfs-file
16493Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
16494@var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
16495contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
16496standard output.
16497
16498@item show procfs-file
16499@kindex show procfs-file
16500Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
16501
16502@item proc-trace-entry
16503@itemx proc-trace-exit
16504@itemx proc-untrace-entry
16505@itemx proc-untrace-exit
16506@kindex proc-trace-entry
16507@kindex proc-trace-exit
16508@kindex proc-untrace-entry
16509@kindex proc-untrace-exit
16510These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
16511from the @code{syscall} interface.
16512
16513@item info pidlist
16514@kindex info pidlist
16515@cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
16516For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
16517processes and all the threads within each process.
16518
16519@item info meminfo
16520@kindex info meminfo
16521@cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
16522For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
16523@end table
16524
16525@node DJGPP Native
16526@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
16527@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
16528@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
16529@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
16530
16531@cindex DPMI
16532@sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
16533MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
16534that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
16535top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
16536
16537@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
16538defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
16539subsection describes those commands.
16540
16541@table @code
16542@kindex info dos
16543@item info dos
16544This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
16545information about the target system and important OS structures.
16546
16547@kindex sysinfo
16548@cindex MS-DOS system info
16549@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
16550@item info dos sysinfo
16551This command displays assorted information about the underlying
16552platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
16553DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
16554
16555@cindex GDT
16556@cindex LDT
16557@cindex IDT
16558@cindex segment descriptor tables
16559@cindex descriptor tables display
16560@item info dos gdt
16561@itemx info dos ldt
16562@itemx info dos idt
16563These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
16564and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
16565tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
16566that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
16567descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
16568descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
16569rights.
16570
16571A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
16572segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
16573allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
16574conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
16575additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
16576
16577@cindex garbled pointers
16578These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
16579Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
16580displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
16581display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
16582example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
16583debugged program's data segment:
16584
16585@smallexample
16586@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
16587@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
16588@end smallexample
16589
16590@noindent
16591This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
16592the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
16593
16594@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
16595@item info dos pde
16596@itemx info dos pte
16597These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
16598Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
16599data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
16600into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
16601page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
16602may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
16603Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
16604that is currently in use.
16605
16606Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
16607Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
16608the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
16609@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
16610Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
16611means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
16612the specified entry in the Page Directory.
16613
16614@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
16615These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
16616Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
16617controller.
16618
16619These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
16620
16621@cindex physical address from linear address
16622@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
16623This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
16624address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
16625already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
16626because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
16627segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
16628the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
16629
16630@smallexample
16631@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
16632@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
16633@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
16634@end smallexample
16635
16636@noindent
16637This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
16638whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
16639attributes of that page.
16640
16641Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
16642since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
16643address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
16644be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
16645declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
16646@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
16647
16648Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
16649transfer buffer:
16650
16651@smallexample
16652@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
16653@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
16654@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
16655@end smallexample
16656
16657@noindent
16658(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
166593rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
16660clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
16661memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
16662linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
16663
16664This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
16665@end table
16666
16667@cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
16668In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
16669debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
16670to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
16671
16672@table @code
16673@kindex set com1base
16674@kindex set com1irq
16675@kindex set com2base
16676@kindex set com2irq
16677@kindex set com3base
16678@kindex set com3irq
16679@kindex set com4base
16680@kindex set com4irq
16681@item set com1base @var{addr}
16682This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
16683port.
16684
16685@item set com1irq @var{irq}
16686This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
16687for the @file{COM1} serial port.
16688
16689There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
16690etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
16691other 3 COM ports.
16692
16693@kindex show com1base
16694@kindex show com1irq
16695@kindex show com2base
16696@kindex show com2irq
16697@kindex show com3base
16698@kindex show com3irq
16699@kindex show com4base
16700@kindex show com4irq
16701The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
16702display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
16703lines used by the COM ports.
16704
16705@item info serial
16706@kindex info serial
16707@cindex DOS serial port status
16708This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
16709port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
16710IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
16711counts of various errors encountered so far.
16712@end table
16713
16714
16715@node Cygwin Native
16716@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
16717@cindex MS Windows debugging
16718@cindex native Cygwin debugging
16719@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
16720
16721@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
16722DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
16723
16724@cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
16725@cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
16726MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
16727special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
16728by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
16729supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
16730sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
16731ignores @kbd{C-c}.
16732
16733There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
16734this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
16735described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
16736
16737@table @code
16738@kindex info w32
16739@item info w32
16740This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
16741information about the target system and important OS structures.
16742
16743@item info w32 selector
16744This command displays information returned by
16745the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
16746It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
16747a long value to give the information about this given selector.
16748Without argument, this command displays information
16749about the six segment registers.
16750
16751@item info w32 thread-information-block
16752This command displays thread specific information stored in the
16753Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
16754selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
16755
16756@kindex info dll
16757@item info dll
16758This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
16759
16760@kindex dll-symbols
16761@item dll-symbols
16762This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
16763add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
16764
16765@kindex set cygwin-exceptions
16766@cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
16767@cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
16768@item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
16769If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
16770happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
16771@value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
16772exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
16773``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
16774Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
16775@value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
16776
16777@kindex show cygwin-exceptions
16778@item show cygwin-exceptions
16779Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
16780inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
16781
16782@kindex set new-console
16783@item set new-console @var{mode}
16784If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
16785be started in a new console on next start.
16786If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
16787be started in the same console as the debugger.
16788
16789@kindex show new-console
16790@item show new-console
16791Displays whether a new console is used
16792when the debuggee is started.
16793
16794@kindex set new-group
16795@item set new-group @var{mode}
16796This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
16797start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
16798This affects the way the Windows OS handles
16799@samp{Ctrl-C}.
16800
16801@kindex show new-group
16802@item show new-group
16803Displays current value of new-group boolean.
16804
16805@kindex set debugevents
16806@item set debugevents
16807This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
16808to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
16809signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
16810unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
16811Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
16812
16813@kindex set debugexec
16814@item set debugexec
16815This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
16816(such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
16817
16818@kindex set debugexceptions
16819@item set debugexceptions
16820This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
16821debuggee seen by the debugger.
16822
16823@kindex set debugmemory
16824@item set debugmemory
16825This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
16826and writes by the debugger.
16827
16828@kindex set shell
16829@item set shell
16830This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
16831via a shell or directly (default value is on).
16832
16833@kindex show shell
16834@item show shell
16835Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
16836
16837@end table
16838
16839@menu
16840* Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
16841@end menu
16842
16843@node Non-debug DLL Symbols
16844@subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
16845@cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
16846@cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
16847
16848Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
16849not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
16850@file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
16851symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
16852information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
16853describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
16854``minimal symbols''.
16855
16856Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
16857will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
16858start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
16859program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
16860@value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
16861see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
16862@code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
16863explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
16864cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
16865which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
16866
16867@subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
16868
16869In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
16870tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
16871DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
16872also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
16873sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
16874(particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
16875necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
16876contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
16877exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
16878
16879Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
16880though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
16881symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
16882some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
16883@code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
16884(@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
16885
16886@smallexample
16887(@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
16888All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
16889
16890Non-debugging symbols:
168910x77e885f4 CreateFileA
168920x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
16893@end smallexample
16894
16895@smallexample
16896(@value{GDBP}) info function !
16897All functions matching regular expression "!":
16898
16899Non-debugging symbols:
169000x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
169010x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
169020x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
16903[etc...]
16904@end smallexample
16905
16906@subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
16907
16908Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
16909type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
16910refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
16911contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
16912contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
16913means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
16914a function within a DLL without a running program.
16915
16916Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
16917automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
16918variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
16919type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
16920problem:
16921
16922@smallexample
16923(@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
16924$1 = 268572168
16925@end smallexample
16926
16927@smallexample
16928(@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
169290x10021610: "\230y\""
16930@end smallexample
16931
16932And two possible solutions:
16933
16934@smallexample
16935(@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
16936$2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
16937@end smallexample
16938
16939@smallexample
16940(@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
169410x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
16942(@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
169430x10021608: 0x0022fd98
16944(@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
169450x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
16946@end smallexample
16947
16948Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
16949starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
16950examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
16951function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
16952to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
16953
16954@smallexample
16955(@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
16956Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
16957@end smallexample
16958
16959The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
16960break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
16961safe.
16962
16963@node Hurd Native
16964@subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
16965@cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
16966
16967This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
16968@sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
16969
16970@table @code
16971@item set signals
16972@itemx set sigs
16973@kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
16974@kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
16975This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
16976@value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
16977affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
16978@code{signals}.
16979
16980@item show signals
16981@itemx show sigs
16982@kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
16983@kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
16984Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
16985
16986@item set signal-thread
16987@itemx set sigthread
16988@kindex set signal-thread
16989@kindex set sigthread
16990This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
16991thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
16992process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
16993signal-thread}.
16994
16995@item show signal-thread
16996@itemx show sigthread
16997@kindex show signal-thread
16998@kindex show sigthread
16999These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
17000delivered a signal.
17001
17002@item set stopped
17003@kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
17004This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
17005as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
17006continued by delivering a signal to it.
17007
17008@item show stopped
17009@kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
17010This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
17011stopped.
17012
17013@item set exceptions
17014@kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
17015Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
17016When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
17017single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
17018trapping on.
17019
17020@item show exceptions
17021@kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
17022Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
17023
17024@item set task pause
17025@kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
17026@cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17027@cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17028This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
17029Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
17030whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
17031effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
17032to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
17033thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
17034
17035@item show task pause
17036@kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
17037Show the current state of task suspension.
17038
17039@item set task detach-suspend-count
17040@cindex task suspend count
17041@cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17042This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
17043@value{GDBN} detaches from it.
17044
17045@item show task detach-suspend-count
17046Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
17047
17048@item set task exception-port
17049@itemx set task excp
17050@cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17051This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
17052forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
17053rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
17054
17055@item set noninvasive
17056@cindex noninvasive task options
17057This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
17058invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
17059is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
17060@code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
17061
17062@item info send-rights
17063@itemx info receive-rights
17064@itemx info port-rights
17065@itemx info port-sets
17066@itemx info dead-names
17067@itemx info ports
17068@itemx info psets
17069@cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17070@cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17071@cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17072@cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17073@cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17074These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
17075receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
17076There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
17077port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
17078
17079@item set thread pause
17080@kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
17081@cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17082@cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17083This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
17084control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
17085thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
17086off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
17087Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
17088control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
17089task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
17090only the current thread.
17091
17092@item show thread pause
17093@kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
17094This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
17095
17096@item set thread run
17097This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
17098
17099@item show thread run
17100Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
17101
17102@item set thread detach-suspend-count
17103@cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17104@cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17105This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
17106thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
17107found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
17108takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
17109
17110@item show thread detach-suspend-count
17111Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
17112detaching.
17113
17114@item set thread exception-port
17115@itemx set thread excp
17116Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
17117overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
17118@code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
17119
17120@item set thread takeover-suspend-count
17121Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
17122value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
17123changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
17124
17125@item set thread default
17126@itemx show thread default
17127@cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17128Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
17129default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
17130thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
17131variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
17132threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
17133the non-default commands.
17134@end table
17135
17136
17137@node Neutrino
17138@subsection QNX Neutrino
17139@cindex QNX Neutrino
17140
17141@value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
17142Neutrino target:
17143
17144@table @code
17145@item set debug nto-debug
17146@kindex set debug nto-debug
17147When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
17148Neutrino support.
17149
17150@item show debug nto-debug
17151@kindex show debug nto-debug
17152Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
17153@end table
17154
17155@node Darwin
17156@subsection Darwin
17157@cindex Darwin
17158
17159@value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
17160
17161@table @code
17162@item set debug darwin @var{num}
17163@kindex set debug darwin
17164When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
17165the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
17166
17167@item show debug darwin
17168@kindex show debug darwin
17169Show the current state of Darwin messages.
17170
17171@item set debug mach-o @var{num}
17172@kindex set debug mach-o
17173When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
17174@value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
17175file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
17176values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
17177problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
17178usage.
17179
17180@item show debug mach-o
17181@kindex show debug mach-o
17182Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
17183
17184@item set mach-exceptions on
17185@itemx set mach-exceptions off
17186@kindex set mach-exceptions
17187On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
17188mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
17189Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
17190better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
17191
17192@item show mach-exceptions
17193@kindex show mach-exceptions
17194Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
17195@end table
17196
17197
17198@node Embedded OS
17199@section Embedded Operating Systems
17200
17201This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
17202embedded operating systems that are available for several different
17203architectures.
17204
17205@menu
17206* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
17207@end menu
17208
17209@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
17210various real-time operating systems.
17211
17212@node VxWorks
17213@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
17214
17215@cindex VxWorks
17216
17217@table @code
17218
17219@kindex target vxworks
17220@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
17221A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
17222is the target system's machine name or IP address.
17223
17224@end table
17225
17226On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
17227current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
17228
17229@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
17230VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
17231the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
17232both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
17233@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
17234installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
17235@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
17236
17237@table @code
17238@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
17239@kindex vxworks-timeout
17240All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
17241This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
17242seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
17243your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
17244of a thin network line.
17245@end table
17246
17247The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
17248this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
17249procedures.
17250
17251@findex INCLUDE_RDB
17252To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
17253to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
17254library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
17255VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
17256kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
17257source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
17258information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
17259manual.
17260@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
17261
17262Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
17263your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
17264run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
17265@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
17266
17267@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
17268
17269@smallexample
17270(vxgdb)
17271@end smallexample
17272
17273@menu
17274* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
17275* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
17276* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
17277@end menu
17278
17279@node VxWorks Connection
17280@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
17281
17282The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
17283network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
17284
17285@smallexample
17286(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
17287@end smallexample
17288
17289@need 750
17290@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
17291
17292@smallexample
17293Attaching remote machine across net...
17294Connected to tt.
17295@end smallexample
17296
17297@need 1000
17298@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
17299loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
17300these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
17301path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
17302to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
17303
17304@smallexample
17305prog.o: No such file or directory.
17306@end smallexample
17307
17308When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
17309the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
17310command again.
17311
17312@node VxWorks Download
17313@subsubsection VxWorks Download
17314
17315@cindex download to VxWorks
17316If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
17317object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
17318@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
17319incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
17320command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
17321to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
17322table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
17323the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
17324filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
17325Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
17326to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
17327the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
17328@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
17329and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
17330program, type this on VxWorks:
17331
17332@smallexample
17333-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
17334@end smallexample
17335
17336@noindent
17337Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
17338
17339@smallexample
17340(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
17341(vxgdb) load prog.o
17342@end smallexample
17343
17344@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
17345
17346@smallexample
17347Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
17348@end smallexample
17349
17350You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
17351after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
17352this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
17353auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
17354history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
17355debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
17356table.)
17357
17358@node VxWorks Attach
17359@subsubsection Running Tasks
17360
17361@cindex running VxWorks tasks
17362You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
17363follows:
17364
17365@smallexample
17366(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
17367@end smallexample
17368
17369@noindent
17370where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
17371or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
17372the time of attachment.
17373
17374@node Embedded Processors
17375@section Embedded Processors
17376
17377This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
17378configurations.
17379
17380@cindex send command to simulator
17381Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
17382allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
17383
17384@table @code
17385@item sim @var{command}
17386@kindex sim@r{, a command}
17387Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
17388documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
17389acceptable commands.
17390@end table
17391
17392
17393@menu
17394* ARM:: ARM RDI
17395* M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
17396* M68K:: Motorola M68K
17397* MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
17398* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
17399* OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
17400* PA:: HP PA Embedded
17401* PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
17402* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
17403* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
17404* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
17405* AVR:: Atmel AVR
17406* CRIS:: CRIS
17407* Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
17408@end menu
17409
17410@node ARM
17411@subsection ARM
17412@cindex ARM RDI
17413
17414@table @code
17415@kindex target rdi
17416@item target rdi @var{dev}
17417ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
17418use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
17419monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
17420
17421@kindex target rdp
17422@item target rdp @var{dev}
17423ARM Demon monitor.
17424
17425@end table
17426
17427@value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
17428
17429@table @code
17430@item set arm disassembler
17431@kindex set arm
17432This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
17433@code{"std"} style is the standard style.
17434
17435@item show arm disassembler
17436@kindex show arm
17437Show the current disassembly style.
17438
17439@item set arm apcs32
17440@cindex ARM 32-bit mode
17441This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
17442
17443@item show arm apcs32
17444Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
17445
17446@item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
17447This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
17448argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
17449
17450@table @code
17451@item auto
17452Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
17453@item softfpa
17454Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
17455processors.
17456@item fpa
17457GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
17458@item softvfp
17459Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
17460@item vfp
17461VFP co-processor.
17462@end table
17463
17464@item show arm fpu
17465Show the current type of the FPU.
17466
17467@item set arm abi
17468This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
17469
17470@item show arm abi
17471Show the currently used ABI.
17472
17473@item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
17474@value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
17475whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
17476@value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
17477available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
17478use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
17479register).
17480
17481@item show arm fallback-mode
17482Show the current fallback instruction mode.
17483
17484@item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
17485This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
17486instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
17487causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
17488of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
17489
17490@item show arm force-mode
17491Show the current forced instruction mode.
17492
17493@item set debug arm
17494Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
17495target support subsystem.
17496
17497@item show debug arm
17498Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
17499@end table
17500
17501The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
17502using the RDI interface:
17503
17504@table @code
17505@item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
17506@kindex rdilogfile
17507@cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
17508Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
17509With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
17510no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
17511@file{rdi.log}.
17512
17513@item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
17514@kindex rdilogenable
17515Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
17516enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
17517no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
17518ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
17519are logged to a file.
17520
17521@item set rdiromatzero
17522@kindex set rdiromatzero
17523@cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
17524Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
17525vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
17526(the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
17527effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
17528
17529@item show rdiromatzero
17530@kindex show rdiromatzero
17531Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
17532
17533@item set rdiheartbeat
17534@kindex set rdiheartbeat
17535@cindex RDI heartbeat
17536Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
17537turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
17538well as the Angel monitor.
17539
17540@item show rdiheartbeat
17541@kindex show rdiheartbeat
17542Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
17543@end table
17544
17545@table @code
17546@item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
17547The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
17548
17549@table @code
17550@item --swi-support=@var{type}
17551Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.
17552@var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
17553The default value is @code{all}.
17554
17555@table @code
17556@item none
17557@item demon
17558@item angel
17559@item redboot
17560@item all
17561@end table
17562@end table
17563@end table
17564
17565@node M32R/D
17566@subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
17567
17568@table @code
17569@kindex target m32r
17570@item target m32r @var{dev}
17571Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
17572
17573@kindex target m32rsdi
17574@item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
17575Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
17576@end table
17577
17578The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
17579
17580@table @code
17581@item set download-path @var{path}
17582@kindex set download-path
17583@cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
17584Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
17585
17586@item show download-path
17587@kindex show download-path
17588Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
17589
17590@item set board-address @var{addr}
17591@kindex set board-address
17592@cindex M32-EVA target board address
17593Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
17594
17595@item show board-address
17596@kindex show board-address
17597Show the current IP address of the target board.
17598
17599@item set server-address @var{addr}
17600@kindex set server-address
17601@cindex download server address (M32R)
17602Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
17603host machine.
17604
17605@item show server-address
17606@kindex show server-address
17607Display the IP address of the download server.
17608
17609@item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
17610@kindex upload@r{, M32R}
17611Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
17612upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
17613executable file is uploaded.
17614
17615@item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
17616@kindex tload@r{, M32R}
17617Test the @code{upload} command.
17618@end table
17619
17620The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
17621
17622@table @code
17623@item sdireset
17624@kindex sdireset
17625@cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
17626This command resets the SDI connection.
17627
17628@item sdistatus
17629@kindex sdistatus
17630This command shows the SDI connection status.
17631
17632@item debug_chaos
17633@kindex debug_chaos
17634@cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
17635Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
17636
17637@item use_debug_dma
17638@kindex use_debug_dma
17639Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
17640
17641@item use_mon_code
17642@kindex use_mon_code
17643Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
17644
17645@item use_ib_break
17646@kindex use_ib_break
17647Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
17648
17649@item use_dbt_break
17650@kindex use_dbt_break
17651Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
17652@end table
17653
17654@node M68K
17655@subsection M68k
17656
17657The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
17658target command for the following ROM monitor.
17659
17660@table @code
17661
17662@kindex target dbug
17663@item target dbug @var{dev}
17664dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
17665
17666@end table
17667
17668@node MicroBlaze
17669@subsection MicroBlaze
17670@cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
17671@cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
17672
17673The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
17674FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
17675usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
17676Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
17677This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
17678the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
17679communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
17680presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
17681@code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
17682this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
17683commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
17684
17685Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
17686
17687@table @code
17688@item target remote :1234
17689Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
17690on the same system as @code{xmd}.
17691
17692@item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
17693Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
17694running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
17695
17696@item load
17697Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
17698
17699@item set debug microblaze @var{n}
17700Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
17701
17702@item show debug microblaze @var{n}
17703Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
17704@end table
17705
17706@node MIPS Embedded
17707@subsection MIPS Embedded
17708
17709@cindex MIPS boards
17710@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
17711MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
17712you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
17713
17714@need 1000
17715Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
17716
17717@table @code
17718@item target mips @var{port}
17719@kindex target mips @var{port}
17720To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
17721name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
17722command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
17723the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
17724been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
17725download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
17726
17727For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
17728port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
17729debugger:
17730
17731@smallexample
17732host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
17733@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
17734(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
17735(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
17736(@value{GDBP}) run
17737@end smallexample
17738
17739@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
17740On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
17741connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
17742concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
17743@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
17744
17745@item target pmon @var{port}
17746@kindex target pmon @var{port}
17747PMON ROM monitor.
17748
17749@item target ddb @var{port}
17750@kindex target ddb @var{port}
17751NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
17752
17753@item target lsi @var{port}
17754@kindex target lsi @var{port}
17755LSI variant of PMON.
17756
17757@kindex target r3900
17758@item target r3900 @var{dev}
17759Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
17760
17761@kindex target array
17762@item target array @var{dev}
17763Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
17764
17765@end table
17766
17767
17768@noindent
17769@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
17770
17771@table @code
17772@item set mipsfpu double
17773@itemx set mipsfpu single
17774@itemx set mipsfpu none
17775@itemx set mipsfpu auto
17776@itemx show mipsfpu
17777@kindex set mipsfpu
17778@kindex show mipsfpu
17779@cindex MIPS remote floating point
17780@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
17781If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
17782coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
17783need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
17784file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
17785functions which return floating point values. It also allows
17786@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
17787functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
17788with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
17789processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
17790double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
17791@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
17792
17793In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
17794floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
17795and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
17796
17797As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
17798@samp{show mipsfpu}.
17799
17800@item set timeout @var{seconds}
17801@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
17802@itemx show timeout
17803@itemx show retransmit-timeout
17804@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
17805@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
17806@kindex set timeout
17807@kindex show timeout
17808@kindex set retransmit-timeout
17809@kindex show retransmit-timeout
17810You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
17811remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
17812default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
17813waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
17814retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
17815You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
17816retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
17817@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
17818
17819The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
17820is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
17821forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
17822to run before stopping.
17823
17824@item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
17825@kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
17826@cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
17827Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
17828it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
17829characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
17830
17831@item show syn-garbage-limit
17832@kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
17833Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
17834trying to synchronize with the remote system.
17835
17836@item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
17837@kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
17838@cindex remote monitor prompt
17839Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
17840remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
17841@table @asis
17842@item pmon target
17843@samp{PMON}
17844@item ddb target
17845@samp{NEC010}
17846@item lsi target
17847@samp{PMON>}
17848@end table
17849
17850@item show monitor-prompt
17851@kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
17852Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
17853remote monitor.
17854
17855@item set monitor-warnings
17856@kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
17857Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
17858has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
17859display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
17860PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
17861
17862@item show monitor-warnings
17863@kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
17864Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
17865
17866@item pmon @var{command}
17867@kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
17868@cindex send PMON command
17869This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
17870monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
17871@end table
17872
17873@node OpenRISC 1000
17874@subsection OpenRISC 1000
17875@cindex OpenRISC 1000
17876
17877@cindex or1k boards
17878See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
17879about platform and commands.
17880
17881@table @code
17882
17883@kindex target jtag
17884@item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
17885
17886Connects to remote JTAG server.
17887JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
17888connected via parallel port to the board.
17889
17890Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
17891
17892@kindex or1ksim
17893@item or1ksim @var{command}
17894If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
17895Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
17896
17897@kindex info or1k spr
17898@item info or1k spr
17899Displays spr groups.
17900
17901@item info or1k spr @var{group}
17902@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
17903Displays register names in selected group.
17904
17905@item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
17906@itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
17907@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
17908@itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
17909Shows information about specified spr register.
17910
17911@kindex spr
17912@item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
17913@itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
17914@itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
17915@itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
17916Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
17917@end table
17918
17919Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
17920It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
17921program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
17922triggers can be set using:
17923@table @code
17924@item $LEA/$LDATA
17925Load effective address/data
17926@item $SEA/$SDATA
17927Store effective address/data
17928@item $AEA/$ADATA
17929Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
17930@item $FETCH
17931Fetch data
17932@end table
17933
17934When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
17935@code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
17936
17937@code{htrace} commands:
17938@cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
17939@table @code
17940@kindex hwatch
17941@item hwatch @var{conditional}
17942Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
17943or Data. For example:
17944
17945@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
17946
17947@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
17948
17949@kindex htrace
17950@item htrace info
17951Display information about current HW trace configuration.
17952
17953@item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
17954Set starting criteria for HW trace.
17955
17956@item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
17957Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
17958
17959@item htrace stop @var{conditional}
17960Set HW trace stopping criteria.
17961
17962@item htrace record [@var{data}]*
17963Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
17964triggered.
17965
17966@item htrace enable
17967@itemx htrace disable
17968Enables/disables the HW trace.
17969
17970@item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
17971Clears currently recorded trace data.
17972
17973If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
17974will be written there.
17975
17976@item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
17977Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
17978
17979@item htrace mode continuous
17980Set continuous trace mode.
17981
17982@item htrace mode suspend
17983Set suspend trace mode.
17984
17985@end table
17986
17987@node PowerPC Embedded
17988@subsection PowerPC Embedded
17989
17990@value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
17991
17992@table @code
17993@kindex set powerpc
17994@item set powerpc soft-float
17995@itemx show powerpc soft-float
17996Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
17997convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
17998on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
17999
18000@item set powerpc vector-abi
18001@itemx show powerpc vector-abi
18002Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
18003arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
18004@samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
18005@samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
18006registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
18007based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
18008
18009@kindex target dink32
18010@item target dink32 @var{dev}
18011DINK32 ROM monitor.
18012
18013@kindex target ppcbug
18014@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
18015@kindex target ppcbug1
18016@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
18017PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
18018
18019@kindex target sds
18020@item target sds @var{dev}
18021SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
18022@end table
18023
18024@cindex SDS protocol
18025The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
18026by @value{GDBN}:
18027
18028@table @code
18029@item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
18030@kindex set sdstimeout
18031Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
18032default is 2 seconds.
18033
18034@item show sdstimeout
18035@kindex show sdstimeout
18036Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
18037
18038@item sds @var{command}
18039@kindex sds@r{, a command}
18040Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
18041@end table
18042
18043
18044@node PA
18045@subsection HP PA Embedded
18046
18047@table @code
18048
18049@kindex target op50n
18050@item target op50n @var{dev}
18051OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
18052
18053@kindex target w89k
18054@item target w89k @var{dev}
18055W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
18056
18057@end table
18058
18059@node Sparclet
18060@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
18061
18062@cindex Sparclet
18063
18064@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
18065Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
18066@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
18067both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
18068@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
18069
18070@table @code
18071@item remotetimeout @var{args}
18072@kindex remotetimeout
18073@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
18074This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
18075seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
18076@end table
18077
18078@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
18079When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
18080information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
18081load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
18082@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
18083
18084@smallexample
18085sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
18086@end smallexample
18087
18088You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
18089
18090@smallexample
18091sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
18092@end smallexample
18093
18094@cindex running, on Sparclet
18095Once you have set
18096your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
18097run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
18098(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
18099
18100@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
18101
18102@smallexample
18103(gdbslet)
18104@end smallexample
18105
18106@menu
18107* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
18108* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
18109* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
18110* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
18111@end menu
18112
18113@node Sparclet File
18114@subsubsection Setting File to Debug
18115
18116The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
18117
18118@smallexample
18119(gdbslet) file prog
18120@end smallexample
18121
18122@need 1000
18123@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
18124@value{GDBN} locates
18125the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
18126path.
18127If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
18128files will be searched as well.
18129@value{GDBN} locates
18130the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
18131path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
18132If it fails
18133to find a file, it displays a message such as:
18134
18135@smallexample
18136prog: No such file or directory.
18137@end smallexample
18138
18139When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
18140the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
18141@code{target} command again.
18142
18143@node Sparclet Connection
18144@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
18145
18146The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
18147To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
18148
18149@smallexample
18150(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
18151Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
18152main () at ../prog.c:3
18153@end smallexample
18154
18155@need 750
18156@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
18157
18158@smallexample
18159Connected to ttya.
18160@end smallexample
18161
18162@node Sparclet Download
18163@subsubsection Sparclet Download
18164
18165@cindex download to Sparclet
18166Once connected to the Sparclet target,
18167you can use the @value{GDBN}
18168@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
18169The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
18170command.
18171Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
18172address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
18173offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
18174of each of the file's sections.
18175For instance, if the program
18176@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
18177and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
18178
18179@smallexample
18180(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
18181Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
18182@end smallexample
18183
18184If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
18185to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
18186to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
18187
18188@node Sparclet Execution
18189@subsubsection Running and Debugging
18190
18191@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
18192You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
18193commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
18194manual for the list of commands.
18195
18196@smallexample
18197(gdbslet) b main
18198Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
18199(gdbslet) run
18200Starting program: prog
18201Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
182023 char *symarg = 0;
18203(gdbslet) step
182044 char *execarg = "hello!";
18205(gdbslet)
18206@end smallexample
18207
18208@node Sparclite
18209@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
18210
18211@table @code
18212
18213@kindex target sparclite
18214@item target sparclite @var{dev}
18215Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
18216You must use an additional command to debug the program.
18217For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
18218remote protocol.
18219
18220@end table
18221
18222@node Z8000
18223@subsection Zilog Z8000
18224
18225@cindex Z8000
18226@cindex simulator, Z8000
18227@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
18228
18229When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
18230a Z8000 simulator.
18231
18232For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
18233unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
18234segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
18235appropriate by inspecting the object code.
18236
18237@table @code
18238@item target sim @var{args}
18239@kindex sim
18240@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
18241Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
18242options, specify them via @var{args}.
18243@end table
18244
18245@noindent
18246After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
18247CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
18248@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
18249to run your program, and so on.
18250
18251As well as making available all the usual machine registers
18252(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
18253additional items of information as specially named registers:
18254
18255@table @code
18256
18257@item cycles
18258Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
18259
18260@item insts
18261Counts instructions run in the simulator.
18262
18263@item time
18264Execution time in 60ths of a second.
18265
18266@end table
18267
18268You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
18269conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
18270conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
18271simulated clock ticks.
18272
18273@node AVR
18274@subsection Atmel AVR
18275@cindex AVR
18276
18277When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
18278following AVR-specific commands:
18279
18280@table @code
18281@item info io_registers
18282@kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
18283@cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
18284This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
18285each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
18286@end table
18287
18288@node CRIS
18289@subsection CRIS
18290@cindex CRIS
18291
18292When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
18293following CRIS-specific commands:
18294
18295@table @code
18296@item set cris-version @var{ver}
18297@cindex CRIS version
18298Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
18299The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
18300case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
18301
18302@item show cris-version
18303Show the current CRIS version.
18304
18305@item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
18306@cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
18307Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
18308Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
18309@code{R59}.
18310
18311@item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
18312Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
18313
18314@item set cris-mode @var{mode}
18315@cindex CRIS mode
18316Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
18317debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
18318@samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
18319
18320@item show cris-mode
18321Show the current CRIS mode.
18322@end table
18323
18324@node Super-H
18325@subsection Renesas Super-H
18326@cindex Super-H
18327
18328For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
18329commands:
18330
18331@table @code
18332@item regs
18333@kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
18334Show the values of all Super-H registers.
18335
18336@item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
18337@kindex set sh calling-convention
18338Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
18339Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
18340With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
18341convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
18342that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
18343is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
18344is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
18345regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
18346default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
18347does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
18348
18349@item show sh calling-convention
18350@kindex show sh calling-convention
18351Show the current calling convention setting.
18352
18353@end table
18354
18355
18356@node Architectures
18357@section Architectures
18358
18359This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
18360all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
18361
18362@menu
18363* i386::
18364* A29K::
18365* Alpha::
18366* MIPS::
18367* HPPA:: HP PA architecture
18368* SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
18369* PowerPC::
18370@end menu
18371
18372@node i386
18373@subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
18374
18375@table @code
18376@item set struct-convention @var{mode}
18377@kindex set struct-convention
18378@cindex struct return convention
18379@cindex struct/union returned in registers
18380Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
18381@code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
18382@var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
18383default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
18384are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
18385@code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
18386be returned in a register.
18387
18388@item show struct-convention
18389@kindex show struct-convention
18390Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
18391from functions.
18392@end table
18393
18394@node A29K
18395@subsection A29K
18396
18397@table @code
18398
18399@kindex set rstack_high_address
18400@cindex AMD 29K register stack
18401@cindex register stack, AMD29K
18402@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
18403On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
18404@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
18405extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
18406stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
18407memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
18408this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
18409the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
18410address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
18411hexadecimal.
18412
18413@kindex show rstack_high_address
18414@item show rstack_high_address
18415Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
18416processors.
18417
18418@end table
18419
18420@node Alpha
18421@subsection Alpha
18422
18423See the following section.
18424
18425@node MIPS
18426@subsection MIPS
18427
18428@cindex stack on Alpha
18429@cindex stack on MIPS
18430@cindex Alpha stack
18431@cindex MIPS stack
18432Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
18433sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
18434find the beginning of a function.
18435
18436@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
18437To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
18438@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
18439you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
18440commands:
18441
18442@table @code
18443@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
18444@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
18445Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
18446search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
18447default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
18448larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
18449and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
18450this command when debugging a stripped executable.
18451
18452@item show heuristic-fence-post
18453Display the current limit.
18454@end table
18455
18456@noindent
18457These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
18458for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
18459
18460Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
18461programs:
18462
18463@table @code
18464@item set mips abi @var{arg}
18465@kindex set mips abi
18466@cindex set ABI for MIPS
18467Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
18468values of @var{arg} are:
18469
18470@table @samp
18471@item auto
18472The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
18473default).
18474@item o32
18475@item o64
18476@item n32
18477@item n64
18478@item eabi32
18479@item eabi64
18480@item auto
18481@end table
18482
18483@item show mips abi
18484@kindex show mips abi
18485Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
18486
18487@item set mipsfpu
18488@itemx show mipsfpu
18489@xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
18490
18491@item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
18492@kindex set mips mask-address
18493@cindex MIPS addresses, masking
18494This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
18495MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
18496@samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
18497setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
18498
18499@item show mips mask-address
18500@kindex show mips mask-address
18501Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
18502not.
18503
18504@item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
18505@kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
18506This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
18507transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
18508that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
18509and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
18510
18511@item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
18512@kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
18513Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
18514
18515@item set debug mips
18516@kindex set debug mips
18517This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
18518target code in @value{GDBN}.
18519
18520@item show debug mips
18521@kindex show debug mips
18522Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
18523@end table
18524
18525
18526@node HPPA
18527@subsection HPPA
18528@cindex HPPA support
18529
18530When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
18531following special commands:
18532
18533@table @code
18534@item set debug hppa
18535@kindex set debug hppa
18536This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
18537messages are to be displayed.
18538
18539@item show debug hppa
18540Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
18541
18542@item maint print unwind @var{address}
18543@kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
18544This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
18545given @var{address}.
18546
18547@end table
18548
18549
18550@node SPU
18551@subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
18552@cindex Cell Broadband Engine
18553@cindex SPU
18554
18555When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
18556it provides the following special commands:
18557
18558@table @code
18559@item info spu event
18560@kindex info spu
18561Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
18562and pending event status.
18563
18564@item info spu signal
18565Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
18566signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
18567notification channels.
18568
18569@item info spu mailbox
18570Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
18571in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
18572SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
18573
18574@item info spu dma
18575Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
18576DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
18577and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
18578
18579@item info spu proxydma
18580Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
18581Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
18582and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
18583
18584@end table
18585
18586When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
18587on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
18588special commands:
18589
18590@table @code
18591@item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
18592@kindex set spu
18593Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
18594will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
18595function. The default is @code{off}.
18596
18597@item show spu stop-on-load
18598@kindex show spu
18599Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
18600
18601@item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
18602Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
18603@code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
18604cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
18605view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
18606does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
18607
18608@item show spu auto-flush-cache
18609Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
18610
18611@end table
18612
18613@node PowerPC
18614@subsection PowerPC
18615@cindex PowerPC architecture
18616
18617When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
18618pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
18619numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
18620in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
18621@code{f0} or @code{f2}.
18622
18623The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
18624by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
18625@code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
18626
18627For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
18628wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
18629
18630
18631@node Controlling GDB
18632@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
18633
18634You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
18635@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
18636data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
18637described here.
18638
18639@menu
18640* Prompt:: Prompt
18641* Editing:: Command editing
18642* Command History:: Command history
18643* Screen Size:: Screen size
18644* Numbers:: Numbers
18645* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
18646* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
18647* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
18648* Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
18649@end menu
18650
18651@node Prompt
18652@section Prompt
18653
18654@cindex prompt
18655
18656@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
18657called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
18658can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
18659instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
18660the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
18661which one you are talking to.
18662
18663@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
18664prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
18665or a prompt that does not.
18666
18667@table @code
18668@kindex set prompt
18669@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
18670Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
18671
18672@kindex show prompt
18673@item show prompt
18674Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
18675@end table
18676
18677@node Editing
18678@section Command Editing
18679@cindex readline
18680@cindex command line editing
18681
18682@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
18683@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
18684command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
18685or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
18686substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
18687debugging sessions.
18688
18689You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
18690command @code{set}.
18691
18692@table @code
18693@kindex set editing
18694@cindex editing
18695@item set editing
18696@itemx set editing on
18697Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
18698
18699@item set editing off
18700Disable command line editing.
18701
18702@kindex show editing
18703@item show editing
18704Show whether command line editing is enabled.
18705@end table
18706
18707@xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
18708interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
18709encouraged to read that chapter.
18710
18711@node Command History
18712@section Command History
18713@cindex command history
18714
18715@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
18716debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
18717happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
18718history facility.
18719
18720@value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
18721package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
18722Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
18723
18724To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
18725the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
18726(@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
18727means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
18728affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
18729pressed on a line by itself.
18730
18731@cindex @code{server}, command prefix
18732The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
18733history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
18734use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
18735
18736Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
18737history.
18738
18739@table @code
18740@cindex history substitution
18741@cindex history file
18742@kindex set history filename
18743@cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
18744@item set history filename @var{fname}
18745Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
18746This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
18747list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
18748exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
18749the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
18750to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
18751@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
18752is not set.
18753
18754@cindex save command history
18755@kindex set history save
18756@item set history save
18757@itemx set history save on
18758Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
18759@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
18760
18761@item set history save off
18762Stop recording command history in a file.
18763
18764@cindex history size
18765@kindex set history size
18766@cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
18767@item set history size @var{size}
18768Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
18769This defaults to the value of the environment variable
18770@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
18771@end table
18772
18773History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
18774@xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
18775
18776@cindex history expansion, turn on/off
18777Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
18778is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
18779@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
18780follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
18781a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
18782history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
18783@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
18784
18785The commands to control history expansion are:
18786
18787@table @code
18788@item set history expansion on
18789@itemx set history expansion
18790@kindex set history expansion
18791Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
18792
18793@item set history expansion off
18794Disable history expansion.
18795
18796@c @group
18797@kindex show history
18798@item show history
18799@itemx show history filename
18800@itemx show history save
18801@itemx show history size
18802@itemx show history expansion
18803These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
18804@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
18805@c @end group
18806@end table
18807
18808@table @code
18809@kindex show commands
18810@cindex show last commands
18811@cindex display command history
18812@item show commands
18813Display the last ten commands in the command history.
18814
18815@item show commands @var{n}
18816Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
18817
18818@item show commands +
18819Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
18820@end table
18821
18822@node Screen Size
18823@section Screen Size
18824@cindex size of screen
18825@cindex pauses in output
18826
18827Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
18828information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
18829@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
18830output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
18831to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
18832determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
18833printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
18834rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
18835
18836Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
18837driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
18838together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
18839@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
18840you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
18841width} commands:
18842
18843@table @code
18844@kindex set height
18845@kindex set width
18846@kindex show width
18847@kindex show height
18848@item set height @var{lpp}
18849@itemx show height
18850@itemx set width @var{cpl}
18851@itemx show width
18852These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
18853a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
18854commands display the current settings.
18855
18856If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
18857output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
18858file or to an editor buffer.
18859
18860Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
18861from wrapping its output.
18862
18863@item set pagination on
18864@itemx set pagination off
18865@kindex set pagination
18866Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
18867pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}. Note that
18868running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
18869Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
18870
18871@item show pagination
18872@kindex show pagination
18873Show the current pagination mode.
18874@end table
18875
18876@node Numbers
18877@section Numbers
18878@cindex number representation
18879@cindex entering numbers
18880
18881You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
18882@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
18883@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
18884begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
18885@samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
1888610; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
18887format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
18888both input and output with the commands described below.
18889
18890@table @code
18891@kindex set input-radix
18892@item set input-radix @var{base}
18893Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
18894for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
18895specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
18896example, any of
18897
18898@smallexample
18899set input-radix 012
18900set input-radix 10.
18901set input-radix 0xa
18902@end smallexample
18903
18904@noindent
18905sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
18906leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
18907@samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
18908interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
18909@samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
18910change the radix.
18911
18912@kindex set output-radix
18913@item set output-radix @var{base}
18914Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
18915for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
18916specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
18917
18918@kindex show input-radix
18919@item show input-radix
18920Display the current default base for numeric input.
18921
18922@kindex show output-radix
18923@item show output-radix
18924Display the current default base for numeric display.
18925
18926@item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
18927@itemx show radix
18928@kindex set radix
18929@kindex show radix
18930These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
18931of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
18932the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
18933default value of 10.
18934
18935@end table
18936
18937@node ABI
18938@section Configuring the Current ABI
18939
18940@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
18941application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
18942conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
18943current ABI.
18944
18945@cindex OS ABI
18946@kindex set osabi
18947@kindex show osabi
18948
18949One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
18950system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
18951@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
18952but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
18953One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
18954an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
18955not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
18956platform provides.
18957
18958@table @code
18959@item show osabi
18960Show the OS ABI currently in use.
18961
18962@item set osabi
18963With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
18964
18965@item set osabi @var{abi}
18966Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
18967@end table
18968
18969@cindex float promotion
18970
18971Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
18972function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
18973(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
18974according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
18975(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
18976@code{double} and then passed.
18977
18978Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
18979a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
18980as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
18981
18982@table @code
18983@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
18984@item set coerce-float-to-double
18985@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
18986Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
18987to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
18988
18989@item set coerce-float-to-double off
18990Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
18991functions.
18992
18993@kindex show coerce-float-to-double
18994@item show coerce-float-to-double
18995Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
18996@end table
18997
18998@kindex set cp-abi
18999@kindex show cp-abi
19000@value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
19001objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
19002used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
19003programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
19004multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
19005program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
19006Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
19007before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
19008``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
19009use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
19010``auto''.
19011
19012@table @code
19013@item show cp-abi
19014Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
19015
19016@item set cp-abi
19017With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
19018
19019@item set cp-abi @var{abi}
19020@itemx set cp-abi auto
19021Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
19022@end table
19023
19024@node Messages/Warnings
19025@section Optional Warnings and Messages
19026
19027@cindex verbose operation
19028@cindex optional warnings
19029By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
19030running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
19031command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
19032internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
19033
19034Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
19035which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
19036see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
19037
19038@table @code
19039@kindex set verbose
19040@item set verbose on
19041Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
19042
19043@item set verbose off
19044Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
19045
19046@kindex show verbose
19047@item show verbose
19048Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
19049@end table
19050
19051By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
19052object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
19053find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
19054Symbol Files}).
19055
19056@table @code
19057
19058@kindex set complaints
19059@item set complaints @var{limit}
19060Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
19061unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
19062@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
19063to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
19064
19065@kindex show complaints
19066@item show complaints
19067Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
19068
19069@end table
19070
19071@anchor{confirmation requests}
19072By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
19073lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
19074you try to run a program which is already running:
19075
19076@smallexample
19077(@value{GDBP}) run
19078The program being debugged has been started already.
19079Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
19080@end smallexample
19081
19082If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
19083commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
19084
19085@table @code
19086
19087@kindex set confirm
19088@cindex flinching
19089@cindex confirmation
19090@cindex stupid questions
19091@item set confirm off
19092Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
19093the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
19094automatically disables confirmation requests.
19095
19096@item set confirm on
19097Enables confirmation requests (the default).
19098
19099@kindex show confirm
19100@item show confirm
19101Displays state of confirmation requests.
19102
19103@end table
19104
19105@cindex command tracing
19106If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
19107useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
19108printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
19109quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
19110
19111@table @code
19112@kindex set trace-commands
19113@cindex command scripts, debugging
19114@item set trace-commands on
19115Enable command tracing.
19116@item set trace-commands off
19117Disable command tracing.
19118@item show trace-commands
19119Display the current state of command tracing.
19120@end table
19121
19122@node Debugging Output
19123@section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
19124@cindex optional debugging messages
19125
19126@value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
19127various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
19128interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
19129section documents those commands.
19130
19131@table @code
19132@kindex set exec-done-display
19133@item set exec-done-display
19134Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
19135completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
19136asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
19137@kindex show exec-done-display
19138@item show exec-done-display
19139Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
19140notification.
19141@kindex set debug
19142@cindex gdbarch debugging info
19143@cindex architecture debugging info
19144@item set debug arch
19145Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
19146@kindex show debug
19147@item show debug arch
19148Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
19149@item set debug aix-thread
19150@cindex AIX threads
19151Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
19152module.
19153@item show debug aix-thread
19154Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
19155@item set debug dwarf2-die
19156@cindex DWARF2 DIEs
19157Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
19158The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
19159A value of zero turns off the display.
19160@item show debug dwarf2-die
19161Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
19162@item set debug displaced
19163@cindex displaced stepping debugging info
19164Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
19165displaced stepping support. The default is off.
19166@item show debug displaced
19167Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
19168related to displaced stepping.
19169@item set debug event
19170@cindex event debugging info
19171Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
19172default is off.
19173@item show debug event
19174Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
19175info.
19176@item set debug expression
19177@cindex expression debugging info
19178Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
19179expression parsing. The default is off.
19180@item show debug expression
19181Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
19182@value{GDBN} expression parsing.
19183@item set debug frame
19184@cindex frame debugging info
19185Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
19186default is off.
19187@item show debug frame
19188Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
19189info.
19190@item set debug gnu-nat
19191@cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
19192Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
19193@item show debug gnu-nat
19194Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
19195@item set debug infrun
19196@cindex inferior debugging info
19197Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
19198The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
19199for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
19200@item show debug infrun
19201Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
19202@item set debug lin-lwp
19203@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
19204@cindex Linux lightweight processes
19205Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
19206@item show debug lin-lwp
19207Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
19208@item set debug lin-lwp-async
19209@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
19210@cindex Linux lightweight processes
19211Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
19212@item show debug lin-lwp-async
19213Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
19214@item set debug observer
19215@cindex observer debugging info
19216Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
19217includes info such as the notification of observable events.
19218@item show debug observer
19219Displays the current state of observer debugging.
19220@item set debug overload
19221@cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
19222Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
19223info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
19224is off.
19225@item show debug overload
19226Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
19227debugging info.
19228@cindex expression parser, debugging info
19229@cindex debug expression parser
19230@item set debug parser
19231Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
19232Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
19233parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
19234details. The default is off.
19235@item show debug parser
19236Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
19237@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
19238@cindex serial connections, debugging
19239@cindex debug remote protocol
19240@cindex remote protocol debugging
19241@cindex display remote packets
19242@item set debug remote
19243Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
19244the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
19245@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
19246@item show debug remote
19247Displays the state of display of remote packets.
19248@item set debug serial
19249Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
19250default is off.
19251@item show debug serial
19252Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
19253info.
19254@item set debug solib-frv
19255@cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
19256Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
19257@item show debug solib-frv
19258Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
19259messages.
19260@item set debug target
19261@cindex target debugging info
19262Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
19263includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
19264default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
19265value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
19266until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
19267@item show debug target
19268Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
19269info.
19270@item set debug timestamp
19271@cindex timestampping debugging info
19272Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
19273When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
19274message.
19275@item show debug timestamp
19276Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
19277debugging info.
19278@item set debugvarobj
19279@cindex variable object debugging info
19280Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
19281info. The default is off.
19282@item show debugvarobj
19283Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
19284debugging info.
19285@item set debug xml
19286@cindex XML parser debugging
19287Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
19288@item show debug xml
19289Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
19290@end table
19291
19292@node Other Misc Settings
19293@section Other Miscellaneous Settings
19294@cindex miscellaneous settings
19295
19296@table @code
19297@kindex set interactive-mode
19298@item set interactive-mode
19299If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate interactively.
19300If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate non-interactively,
19301If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} guesses which mode to use,
19302based on whether the debugger was started in a terminal or not.
19303
19304In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
19305correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
19306in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
19307inside a cygwin window.
19308
19309@kindex show interactive-mode
19310@item show interactive-mode
19311Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
19312@end table
19313
19314@node Extending GDB
19315@chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
19316@cindex extending GDB
19317
19318@value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
19319on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
19320Python scripting language.
19321
19322To facilitate the use of these extensions, @value{GDBN} is capable
19323of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
19324can recognize which scripting language is being used by looking at
19325the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
19326are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
19327@xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
19328
19329You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
19330setting:
19331
19332@table @code
19333@kindex set script-extension
19334@kindex show script-extension
19335@item set script-extension off
19336All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
19337
19338@item set script-extension soft
19339The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
19340extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
19341evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
19342the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
19343
19344@item set script-extension strict
19345The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
19346extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
19347language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
19348
19349@item show script-extension
19350Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
19351
19352@end table
19353
19354@menu
19355* Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
19356* Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
19357@end menu
19358
19359@node Sequences
19360@section Canned Sequences of Commands
19361
19362Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
19363Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
19364commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
19365files.
19366
19367@menu
19368* Define:: How to define your own commands
19369* Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
19370* Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
19371* Output:: Commands for controlled output
19372@end menu
19373
19374@node Define
19375@subsection User-defined Commands
19376
19377@cindex user-defined command
19378@cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
19379A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
19380which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
19381@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
19382separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
19383via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
19384
19385@smallexample
19386define adder
19387 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
19388end
19389@end smallexample
19390
19391@noindent
19392To execute the command use:
19393
19394@smallexample
19395adder 1 2 3
19396@end smallexample
19397
19398@noindent
19399This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
19400its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
19401reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
19402functions calls.
19403
19404@cindex argument count in user-defined commands
19405@cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
19406In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
19407been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
19408
19409@smallexample
19410define adder
19411 if $argc == 2
19412 print $arg0 + $arg1
19413 end
19414 if $argc == 3
19415 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
19416 end
19417end
19418@end smallexample
19419
19420@table @code
19421
19422@kindex define
19423@item define @var{commandname}
19424Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
19425by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
19426@var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
19427numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
19428prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
19429a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
19430
19431The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
19432which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
19433commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
19434
19435@kindex document
19436@kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
19437@item document @var{commandname}
19438Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
19439accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
19440defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
19441reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
19442After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
19443@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
19444
19445You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
19446documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
19447does not change the documentation.
19448
19449@kindex dont-repeat
19450@cindex don't repeat command
19451@item dont-repeat
19452Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
19453command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
19454(@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
19455
19456@kindex help user-defined
19457@item help user-defined
19458List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
19459(if any) for each.
19460
19461@kindex show user
19462@item show user
19463@itemx show user @var{commandname}
19464Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
19465not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
19466definitions for all user-defined commands.
19467
19468@cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
19469@kindex show max-user-call-depth
19470@kindex set max-user-call-depth
19471@item show max-user-call-depth
19472@itemx set max-user-call-depth
19473The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
19474levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
19475infinite recursion and aborts the command.
19476@end table
19477
19478In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
19479use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
19480
19481When user-defined commands are executed, the
19482commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
19483stops execution of the user-defined command.
19484
19485If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
19486without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
19487commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
19488messages when used in a user-defined command.
19489
19490@node Hooks
19491@subsection User-defined Command Hooks
19492@cindex command hooks
19493@cindex hooks, for commands
19494@cindex hooks, pre-command
19495
19496@kindex hook
19497You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
19498command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
19499command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
19500before that command.
19501
19502@cindex hooks, post-command
19503@kindex hookpost
19504A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
19505Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
19506@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
19507that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
19508pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
19509
19510It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
19511occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
19512
19513@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
19514@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
19515
19516@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
19517In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
19518(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
19519execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
19520displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
19521
19522For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
19523single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
19524you could define:
19525
19526@smallexample
19527define hook-stop
19528handle SIGALRM nopass
19529end
19530
19531define hook-run
19532handle SIGALRM pass
19533end
19534
19535define hook-continue
19536handle SIGALRM pass
19537end
19538@end smallexample
19539
19540As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
19541command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
19542you could define:
19543
19544@smallexample
19545define hook-echo
19546echo <<<---
19547end
19548
19549define hookpost-echo
19550echo --->>>\n
19551end
19552
19553(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
19554<<<---Hello World--->>>
19555(@value{GDBP})
19556
19557@end smallexample
19558
19559You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
19560not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
19561name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
19562@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
19563@c or not?
19564You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
19565@code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
19566@samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
19567
19568If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
19569@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
19570(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
19571
19572If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
19573get a warning from the @code{define} command.
19574
19575@node Command Files
19576@subsection Command Files
19577
19578@cindex command files
19579@cindex scripting commands
19580A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
19581@value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
19582also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
19583does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
19584terminal.
19585
19586You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
19587command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
19588scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
19589using the @code{script-extension} setting.
19590@xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
19591
19592@table @code
19593@kindex source
19594@cindex execute commands from a file
19595@item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
19596Execute the command file @var{filename}.
19597@end table
19598
19599The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
19600unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
19601@emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
19602printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
19603execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
19604
19605@value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
19606If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
19607directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
19608(specified with the @samp{directory} command);
19609except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
19610is not relevant to scripts.
19611
19612If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
19613on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
19614The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
19615search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
19616and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
19617look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
19618The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
19619For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
19620the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
19621look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
19622For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
19623it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
19624@file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
19625will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
19626
19627If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
19628each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
19629@var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
19630
19631Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
19632without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
19633normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
19634when called from command files.
19635
19636@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
19637mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
19638standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
19639not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
19640the next command.
19641
19642@smallexample
19643gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
19644@end smallexample
19645
19646(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
19647will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
19648would be directed to @file{log}.
19649
19650Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
19651commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
19652complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
19653variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
19654built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
19655deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
19656complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
19657conditionally, etc.
19658
19659@table @code
19660@kindex if
19661@kindex else
19662@item if
19663@itemx else
19664This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
19665commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
19666expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
19667are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
19668There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
19669of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
19670end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
19671
19672@kindex while
19673@item while
19674This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
19675@code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
19676to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
19677line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
19678@dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
19679executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
19680
19681@kindex loop_break
19682@item loop_break
19683This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
19684Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
19685line.
19686
19687@kindex loop_continue
19688@item loop_continue
19689This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
19690in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
19691branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
19692the controlling expression.
19693
19694@kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
19695@item end
19696Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
19697@code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
19698@end table
19699
19700
19701@node Output
19702@subsection Commands for Controlled Output
19703
19704During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
19705@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
19706explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
19707describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
19708want.
19709
19710@table @code
19711@kindex echo
19712@item echo @var{text}
19713@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
19714@c because it is not in ANSI.
19715Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
19716@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
19717newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
19718In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
19719by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
19720string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
19721trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
19722To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
19723@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
19724
19725A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
19726the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
19727
19728@smallexample
19729echo This is some text\n\
19730which is continued\n\
19731onto several lines.\n
19732@end smallexample
19733
19734produces the same output as
19735
19736@smallexample
19737echo This is some text\n
19738echo which is continued\n
19739echo onto several lines.\n
19740@end smallexample
19741
19742@kindex output
19743@item output @var{expression}
19744Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
19745newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
19746value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
19747on expressions.
19748
19749@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
19750Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
19751the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
19752Formats}, for more information.
19753
19754@kindex printf
19755@item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
19756Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
19757the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
19758@var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
19759which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
19760specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
19761executing the code below:
19762
19763@smallexample
19764printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
19765@end smallexample
19766
19767As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
19768are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
19769by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
19770evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
19771style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
19772printed.
19773
19774For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
19775
19776@smallexample
19777printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
19778@end smallexample
19779
19780@code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
19781specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
19782character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
19783
19784@itemize @bullet
19785@item
19786The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
19787
19788@item
19789The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
19790width.
19791
19792@item
19793The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
19794@code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
19795
19796@item
19797The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
19798supported.
19799
19800@item
19801The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
19802
19803@item
19804The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
19805@end itemize
19806
19807@noindent
19808Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
19809underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
19810the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
19811supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
19812
19813As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
19814sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
19815@samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
19816single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
19817supported.
19818
19819Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
19820(@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
19821together with a floating point specifier.
19822letters:
19823
19824@itemize @bullet
19825@item
19826@samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
19827
19828@item
19829@samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
19830
19831@item
19832@samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
19833@end itemize
19834
19835If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
19836support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
19837such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
19838
19839In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
19840available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
19841
19842Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
19843@smallexample
19844printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
19845@end smallexample
19846
19847@end table
19848
19849@node Python
19850@section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
19851@cindex python scripting
19852@cindex scripting with python
19853
19854You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
19855Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
19856@value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
19857
19858@menu
19859* Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
19860* Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
19861* Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
19862@end menu
19863
19864@node Python Commands
19865@subsection Python Commands
19866@cindex python commands
19867@cindex commands to access python
19868
19869@value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
19870and one related setting:
19871
19872@table @code
19873@kindex python
19874@item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
19875The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
19876
19877If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
19878argument as a Python command. For example:
19879
19880@smallexample
19881(@value{GDBP}) python print 23
1988223
19883@end smallexample
19884
19885If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
19886multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
19887script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
19888@code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
19889containing @code{end}. For example:
19890
19891@smallexample
19892(@value{GDBP}) python
19893Type python script
19894End with a line saying just "end".
19895>print 23
19896>end
1989723
19898@end smallexample
19899
19900@kindex maint set python print-stack
19901@item maint set python print-stack
19902By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
19903in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
19904python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
19905printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
19906disabled.
19907@end table
19908
19909It is also possible to execute a Python script from the @value{GDBN}
19910interpreter:
19911
19912@table @code
19913@item source @file{script-name}
19914The script name must end with @samp{.py} and @value{GDBN} must be configured
19915to recognize the script language based on filename extension using
19916the @code{script-extension} setting. @xref{Extending GDB, ,Extending GDB}.
19917
19918@item python execfile ("script-name")
19919This method is based on the @code{execfile} Python built-in function,
19920and thus is always available.
19921@end table
19922
19923@node Python API
19924@subsection Python API
19925@cindex python api
19926@cindex programming in python
19927
19928@cindex python stdout
19929@cindex python pagination
19930At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
19931@code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
19932A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
19933output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
19934situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
19935
19936@menu
19937* Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
19938* Exception Handling::
19939* Values From Inferior::
19940* Types In Python:: Python representation of types.
19941* Pretty Printing API:: Pretty-printing values.
19942* Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer.
19943* Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
19944* Parameters In Python:: Adding new @value{GDBN} parameters.
19945* Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
19946* Progspaces In Python:: Program spaces.
19947* Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
19948* Frames In Python:: Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
19949* Blocks In Python:: Accessing frame blocks from Python.
19950* Symbols In Python:: Python representation of symbols.
19951* Symbol Tables In Python:: Python representation of symbol tables.
19952* Lazy Strings In Python:: Python representation of lazy strings.
19953* Breakpoints In Python:: Manipulating breakpoints using Python.
19954@end menu
19955
19956@node Basic Python
19957@subsubsection Basic Python
19958
19959@cindex python functions
19960@cindex python module
19961@cindex gdb module
19962@value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
19963methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
19964@value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
19965use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
19966
19967@findex gdb.execute
19968@defun execute command [from_tty]
19969Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
19970If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
19971translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
19972If no exceptions occur, this function returns @code{None}.
19973
19974@var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
19975command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
19976It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
19977@end defun
19978
19979@findex gdb.breakpoints
19980@defun breakpoints
19981Return a sequence holding all of @value{GDBN}'s breakpoints.
19982@xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for more information.
19983@end defun
19984
19985@findex gdb.parameter
19986@defun parameter parameter
19987Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
19988string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
19989spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
19990@samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
19991
19992If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
19993@code{RuntimeError}. Otherwise, the parameter's value is converted to
19994a Python value of the appropriate type, and returned.
19995@end defun
19996
19997@findex gdb.history
19998@defun history number
19999Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
20000History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
20001If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
20002and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
20003find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
20004return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
20005doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{RuntimeError} exception will be
20006raised.
20007
20008If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
20009@code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
20010@end defun
20011
20012@findex gdb.parse_and_eval
20013@defun parse_and_eval expression
20014Parse @var{expression} as an expression in the current language,
20015evaluate it, and return the result as a @code{gdb.Value}.
20016@var{expression} must be a string.
20017
20018This function can be useful when implementing a new command
20019(@pxref{Commands In Python}), as it provides a way to parse the
20020command's argument as an expression. It is also useful simply to
20021compute values, for example, it is the only way to get the value of a
20022convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) as a @code{gdb.Value}.
20023@end defun
20024
20025@findex gdb.write
20026@defun write string
20027Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
20028Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
20029call this function.
20030@end defun
20031
20032@findex gdb.flush
20033@defun flush
20034Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
20035@code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
20036function.
20037@end defun
20038
20039@findex gdb.target_charset
20040@defun target_charset
20041Return the name of the current target character set (@pxref{Character
20042Sets}). This differs from @code{gdb.parameter('target-charset')} in
20043that @samp{auto} is never returned.
20044@end defun
20045
20046@findex gdb.target_wide_charset
20047@defun target_wide_charset
20048Return the name of the current target wide character set
20049(@pxref{Character Sets}). This differs from
20050@code{gdb.parameter('target-wide-charset')} in that @samp{auto} is
20051never returned.
20052@end defun
20053
20054@node Exception Handling
20055@subsubsection Exception Handling
20056@cindex python exceptions
20057@cindex exceptions, python
20058
20059When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
20060uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
20061@value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
20062@code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
20063terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
20064exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
20065backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
20066
20067@smallexample
20068(@value{GDBP}) python print foo
20069Traceback (most recent call last):
20070 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
20071NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
20072@end smallexample
20073
20074@value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by Python
20075code are converted to Python @code{RuntimeError} exceptions. User
20076interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
20077prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt}
20078exception. If you catch these exceptions in your Python code, your
20079exception handler will see @code{RuntimeError} or
20080@code{KeyboardInterrupt} as the exception type, the @value{GDBN} error
20081message as its value, and the Python call stack backtrace at the
20082Python statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
20083traceback.
20084
20085@findex gdb.GdbError
20086When implementing @value{GDBN} commands in Python via @code{gdb.Command},
20087it is useful to be able to throw an exception that doesn't cause a
20088traceback to be printed. For example, the user may have invoked the
20089command incorrectly. Use the @code{gdb.GdbError} exception
20090to handle this case. Example:
20091
20092@smallexample
20093(gdb) python
20094>class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
20095> """Greet the whole world."""
20096> def __init__ (self):
20097> super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
20098> def invoke (self, args, from_tty):
20099> argv = gdb.string_to_argv (args)
20100> if len (argv) != 0:
20101> raise gdb.GdbError ("hello-world takes no arguments")
20102> print "Hello, World!"
20103>HelloWorld ()
20104>end
20105(gdb) hello-world 42
20106hello-world takes no arguments
20107@end smallexample
20108
20109@node Values From Inferior
20110@subsubsection Values From Inferior
20111@cindex values from inferior, with Python
20112@cindex python, working with values from inferior
20113
20114@cindex @code{gdb.Value}
20115@value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
20116an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
20117for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
20118fetching values when necessary.
20119
20120Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
20121Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
20122an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
20123
20124@smallexample
20125bar = some_val + 2
20126@end smallexample
20127
20128@noindent
20129As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
20130whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
20131
20132Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
20133be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
20134@code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
20135can access its @code{foo} element with:
20136
20137@smallexample
20138bar = some_val['foo']
20139@end smallexample
20140
20141Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
20142
20143The following attributes are provided:
20144
20145@table @code
20146@defivar Value address
20147If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
20148@code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
20149this attribute holds @code{None}.
20150@end defivar
20151
20152@cindex optimized out value in Python
20153@defivar Value is_optimized_out
20154This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
20155this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
20156@end defivar
20157
20158@defivar Value type
20159The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a
20160@code{gdb.Type} object.
20161@end defivar
20162@end table
20163
20164The following methods are provided:
20165
20166@table @code
20167@defmethod Value cast type
20168Return a new instance of @code{gdb.Value} that is the result of
20169casting this instance to the type described by @var{type}, which must
20170be a @code{gdb.Type} object. If the cast cannot be performed for some
20171reason, this method throws an exception.
20172@end defmethod
20173
20174@defmethod Value dereference
20175For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
20176whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
20177@code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
20178
20179@smallexample
20180int *foo;
20181@end smallexample
20182
20183@noindent
20184then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
20185@code{foo} points to like this:
20186
20187@smallexample
20188bar = foo.dereference ()
20189@end smallexample
20190
20191The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
20192value pointed to by @code{foo}.
20193@end defmethod
20194
20195@defmethod Value string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}errors@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
20196If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
20197converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
20198throw an exception.
20199
20200Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
20201@code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
20202language.
20203
20204For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
20205array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
20206by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length
20207argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length,
20208ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain.
20209
20210If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
20211naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
20212@code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
20213the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
20214@code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
20215to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
20216@var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
20217(@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
20218will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
20219
20220The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
20221argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
20222
20223If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
20224fetched and converted to the given length.
20225@end defmethod
20226
20227@defmethod Value lazy_string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
20228If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
20229converts the contents to a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings
20230In Python}). Otherwise, this method will throw an exception.
20231
20232If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
20233naming the encoding of the @code{gdb.LazyString}. Some examples are:
20234@samp{ascii}, @samp{iso-8859-6} or @samp{utf-8}. If the
20235@var{encoding} argument is an encoding that @value{GDBN} does
20236recognize, @value{GDBN} will raise an error.
20237
20238When a lazy string is printed, the @value{GDBN} encoding machinery is
20239used to convert the string during printing. If the optional
20240@var{encoding} argument is not provided, or is an empty string,
20241@value{GDBN} will automatically select the encoding most suitable for
20242the string type. For further information on encoding in @value{GDBN}
20243please see @ref{Character Sets}.
20244
20245If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
20246fetched and encoded to the length of characters specified. If
20247the @var{length} argument is not provided, the string will be fetched
20248and encoded until a null of appropriate width is found.
20249@end defmethod
20250@end table
20251
20252@node Types In Python
20253@subsubsection Types In Python
20254@cindex types in Python
20255@cindex Python, working with types
20256
20257@tindex gdb.Type
20258@value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class
20259@code{gdb.Type}.
20260
20261The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
20262module:
20263
20264@findex gdb.lookup_type
20265@defun lookup_type name [block]
20266This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the
20267type to look up. It must be a string.
20268
20269If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
20270Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
20271
20272Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}.
20273If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
20274@end defun
20275
20276An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes:
20277
20278@table @code
20279@defivar Type code
20280The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the
20281@code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below.
20282@end defivar
20283
20284@defivar Type sizeof
20285The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a
20286target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some
20287unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
20288@end defivar
20289
20290@defivar Type tag
20291The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after
20292@code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all
20293languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
20294@code{None} is returned.
20295@end defivar
20296@end table
20297
20298The following methods are provided:
20299
20300@table @code
20301@defmethod Type fields
20302For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range
20303types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types
20304have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one
20305field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also
20306represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit
20307into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned.
20308
20309Each field is an object, with some pre-defined attributes:
20310@table @code
20311@item bitpos
20312This attribute is not available for @code{static} fields (as in
20313C@t{++} or Java). For non-@code{static} fields, the value is the bit
20314position of the field.
20315
20316@item name
20317The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields.
20318
20319@item artificial
20320This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that
20321it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is
20322always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial.
20323
20324@item is_base_class
20325This is @code{True} if the field represents a base class of a C@t{++}
20326structure. This attribute is always provided, and is @code{False}
20327if the field is not a base class of the type that is the argument of
20328@code{fields}, or if that type was not a C@t{++} class.
20329
20330@item bitsize
20331If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a
20332non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise,
20333this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type.
20334
20335@item type
20336The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type},
20337but it can be @code{None} in some situations.
20338@end table
20339@end defmethod
20340
20341@defmethod Type const
20342Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
20343@code{const}-qualified variant of this type.
20344@end defmethod
20345
20346@defmethod Type volatile
20347Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
20348@code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type.
20349@end defmethod
20350
20351@defmethod Type unqualified
20352Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified
20353variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor
20354@code{volatile}.
20355@end defmethod
20356
20357@defmethod Type range
20358Return a Python @code{Tuple} object that contains two elements: the
20359low bound of the argument type and the high bound of that type. If
20360the type does not have a range, @value{GDBN} will raise a
20361@code{RuntimeError} exception.
20362@end defmethod
20363
20364@defmethod Type reference
20365Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this
20366type.
20367@end defmethod
20368
20369@defmethod Type pointer
20370Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a pointer to this
20371type.
20372@end defmethod
20373
20374@defmethod Type strip_typedefs
20375Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type,
20376after removing all layers of typedefs.
20377@end defmethod
20378
20379@defmethod Type target
20380Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type
20381of this type.
20382
20383For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to
20384object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is
20385the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type,
20386the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type,
20387the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the
20388target type is the aliased type.
20389
20390If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an
20391exception.
20392@end defmethod
20393
20394@defmethod Type template_argument n [block]
20395If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will
20396return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the
20397@var{n}th template argument.
20398
20399If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an
20400exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types.
20401
20402If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
20403Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
20404@end defmethod
20405@end table
20406
20407
20408Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls
20409into. The available type categories are represented by constants
20410defined in the @code{gdb} module:
20411
20412@table @code
20413@findex TYPE_CODE_PTR
20414@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
20415@item TYPE_CODE_PTR
20416The type is a pointer.
20417
20418@findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
20419@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
20420@item TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
20421The type is an array.
20422
20423@findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
20424@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
20425@item TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
20426The type is a structure.
20427
20428@findex TYPE_CODE_UNION
20429@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
20430@item TYPE_CODE_UNION
20431The type is a union.
20432
20433@findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM
20434@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
20435@item TYPE_CODE_ENUM
20436The type is an enum.
20437
20438@findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
20439@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
20440@item TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
20441A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
20442
20443@findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC
20444@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
20445@item TYPE_CODE_FUNC
20446The type is a function.
20447
20448@findex TYPE_CODE_INT
20449@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
20450@item TYPE_CODE_INT
20451The type is an integer type.
20452
20453@findex TYPE_CODE_FLT
20454@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
20455@item TYPE_CODE_FLT
20456A floating point type.
20457
20458@findex TYPE_CODE_VOID
20459@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
20460@item TYPE_CODE_VOID
20461The special type @code{void}.
20462
20463@findex TYPE_CODE_SET
20464@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
20465@item TYPE_CODE_SET
20466A Pascal set type.
20467
20468@findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE
20469@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
20470@item TYPE_CODE_RANGE
20471A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
20472
20473@findex TYPE_CODE_STRING
20474@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
20475@item TYPE_CODE_STRING
20476A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with
20477language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
20478
20479@findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
20480@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
20481@item TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
20482A string of bits.
20483
20484@findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR
20485@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
20486@item TYPE_CODE_ERROR
20487An unknown or erroneous type.
20488
20489@findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD
20490@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
20491@item TYPE_CODE_METHOD
20492A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java.
20493
20494@findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
20495@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
20496@item TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
20497A pointer-to-member-function.
20498
20499@findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
20500@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
20501@item TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
20502A pointer-to-member.
20503
20504@findex TYPE_CODE_REF
20505@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
20506@item TYPE_CODE_REF
20507A reference type.
20508
20509@findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR
20510@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
20511@item TYPE_CODE_CHAR
20512A character type.
20513
20514@findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL
20515@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
20516@item TYPE_CODE_BOOL
20517A boolean type.
20518
20519@findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
20520@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
20521@item TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
20522A complex float type.
20523
20524@findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
20525@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
20526@item TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
20527A typedef to some other type.
20528
20529@findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
20530@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
20531@item TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
20532A C@t{++} namespace.
20533
20534@findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
20535@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
20536@item TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
20537A decimal floating point type.
20538
20539@findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
20540@findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
20541@item TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
20542A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent
20543convenience functions.
20544@end table
20545
20546@node Pretty Printing API
20547@subsubsection Pretty Printing API
20548
20549An example output is provided (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
20550
20551A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a
20552specific interface, defined here.
20553
20554@defop Operation {pretty printer} children (self)
20555@value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the
20556children of the pretty-printer's value.
20557
20558This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
20559protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding
20560two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the
20561second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python
20562object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value.
20563
20564This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act
20565as though the value has no children.
20566@end defop
20567
20568@defop Operation {pretty printer} display_hint (self)
20569The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the
20570formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI
20571consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being
20572printed.
20573
20574This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a
20575string.
20576
20577Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}:
20578
20579@table @samp
20580@item array
20581Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI
20582uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and
20583@code{set print array}.
20584
20585@item map
20586Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the
20587children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and
20588values.
20589
20590@item string
20591Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the
20592printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some
20593kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific
20594string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means
20595adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting
20596@code{set print elements}, and the like.
20597@end table
20598@end defop
20599
20600@defop Operation {pretty printer} to_string (self)
20601@value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string
20602representation of the value passed to the object's constructor.
20603
20604When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists,
20605then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by
20606@code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on
20607the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also,
20608depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may
20609print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting
20610the result of @code{children}.
20611
20612If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim.
20613
20614Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value},
20615then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to
20616another pretty-printer.
20617
20618If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a
20619@code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints
20620the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another
20621pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and
20622strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not.
20623
20624Finally, if this method returns @code{None} then no further operations
20625are peformed in this method and nothing is printed.
20626
20627If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised.
20628@end defop
20629
20630@node Selecting Pretty-Printers
20631@subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers
20632
20633The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of
20634functions that have been registered via addition as a pretty-printer.
20635Each @code{gdb.Progspace} contains a @code{pretty_printers} attribute.
20636Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers}
20637attribute.
20638
20639A function on one of these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value}
20640argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the
20641interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). If a function
20642cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return
20643@code{None}.
20644
20645@value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each
20646@code{gdb.Objfile} in the current program space and iteratively calls
20647each function in the list for that @code{gdb.Objfile} until it receives
20648a pretty-printer object.
20649If no pretty-printer is found in the objfile lists, @value{GDBN} then
20650searches the pretty-printer list of the current program space,
20651calling each function until an object is returned.
20652After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global
20653@code{gdb.pretty-printers} list, again calling each function until an
20654object is returned.
20655
20656The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a
20657given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list,
20658and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer
20659object is returned.
20660
20661Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be
20662written:
20663
20664@smallexample
20665class StdStringPrinter:
20666 "Print a std::string"
20667
20668 def __init__ (self, val):
20669 self.val = val
20670
20671 def to_string (self):
20672 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p']
20673
20674 def display_hint (self):
20675 return 'string'
20676@end smallexample
20677
20678And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer
20679example above might be written.
20680
20681@smallexample
20682def str_lookup_function (val):
20683
20684 lookup_tag = val.type.tag
20685 regex = re.compile ("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
20686 if lookup_tag == None:
20687 return None
20688 if regex.match (lookup_tag):
20689 return StdStringPrinter (val)
20690
20691 return None
20692@end smallexample
20693
20694The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to
20695match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the
20696printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it
20697returns @code{None}.
20698
20699We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python
20700package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we
20701further recommend embedding a version number into the package name.
20702This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of
20703your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have
20704different names.
20705
20706You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Auto-loading}) such that it
20707can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An
20708ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your
20709printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with
20710the current objfile.
20711
20712Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple
20713inferiors, each potentially using a different library version.
20714Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that
20715@value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously.
20716Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and
20717because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's
20718printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct
20719printers for the specific version of the library used by each
20720inferior.
20721
20722To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}),
20723this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}:
20724
20725@smallexample
20726def register_printers (objfile):
20727 objfile.pretty_printers.add (str_lookup_function)
20728@end smallexample
20729
20730@noindent
20731And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
20732
20733@smallexample
20734import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
20735gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers (gdb.current_objfile ())
20736@end smallexample
20737
20738@node Commands In Python
20739@subsubsection Commands In Python
20740
20741@cindex commands in python
20742@cindex python commands
20743You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
20744command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
20745class, most commonly using a subclass.
20746
20747@defmethod Command __init__ name @var{command_class} @r{[}@var{completer_class}@r{]} @r{[}@var{prefix}@r{]}
20748The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
20749with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
20750subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
20751
20752@var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
20753multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
20754commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
20755an exception is raised.
20756
20757There is no support for multi-line commands.
20758
20759@var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
20760defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
20761new command in the help system.
20762
20763@var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
20764one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
20765tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
20766given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
20767@code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
20768error will occur when completion is attempted.
20769
20770@var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
20771command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
20772registered.
20773
20774The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
20775documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
20776documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
20777not documented.'' is used.
20778@end defmethod
20779
20780@cindex don't repeat Python command
20781@defmethod Command dont_repeat
20782By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
20783blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
20784behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
20785to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
20786@end defmethod
20787
20788@defmethod Command invoke argument from_tty
20789This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
20790
20791@var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
20792leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
20793
20794@var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
20795command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
20796that the command came from elsewhere.
20797
20798If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
20799@code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
20800
20801@findex gdb.string_to_argv
20802To break @var{argument} up into an argv-like string use
20803@code{gdb.string_to_argv}. This function behaves identically to
20804@value{GDBN}'s internal argument lexer @code{buildargv}.
20805It is recommended to use this for consistency.
20806Arguments are separated by spaces and may be quoted.
20807Example:
20808
20809@smallexample
20810print gdb.string_to_argv ("1 2\ \\\"3 '4 \"5' \"6 '7\"")
20811['1', '2 "3', '4 "5', "6 '7"]
20812@end smallexample
20813
20814@end defmethod
20815
20816@cindex completion of Python commands
20817@defmethod Command complete text word
20818This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
20819completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
20820this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
20821(@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
20822complete}).
20823
20824The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
20825holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
20826@var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
20827using a word-breaking heuristic.
20828
20829The @code{complete} method can return several values:
20830@itemize @bullet
20831@item
20832If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
20833used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
20834contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
20835allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
20836string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
20837sequence are ignored.
20838
20839@item
20840If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
20841below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
20842function is invoked, and its result is used.
20843
20844@item
20845All other results are treated as though there were no available
20846completions.
20847@end itemize
20848@end defmethod
20849
20850When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
20851some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
20852commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
20853listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
20854command. The available classifications are represented by constants
20855defined in the @code{gdb} module:
20856
20857@table @code
20858@findex COMMAND_NONE
20859@findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
20860@item COMMAND_NONE
20861The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
20862this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
20863
20864@findex COMMAND_RUNNING
20865@findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
20866@item COMMAND_RUNNING
20867The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
20868@code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
20869Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20870commands in this category.
20871
20872@findex COMMAND_DATA
20873@findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
20874@item COMMAND_DATA
20875The command is related to data or variables. For example,
20876@code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
20877@kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
20878in this category.
20879
20880@findex COMMAND_STACK
20881@findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
20882@item COMMAND_STACK
20883The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
20884@code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
20885category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
20886list of commands in this category.
20887
20888@findex COMMAND_FILES
20889@findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
20890@item COMMAND_FILES
20891This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
20892@code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
20893Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20894commands in this category.
20895
20896@findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
20897@findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
20898@item COMMAND_SUPPORT
20899This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
20900things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
20901but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
20902@code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
20903@kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20904commands in this category.
20905
20906@findex COMMAND_STATUS
20907@findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
20908@item COMMAND_STATUS
20909The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
20910state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
20911and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
20912@value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
20913
20914@findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
20915@findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
20916@item COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
20917The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
20918@code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
20919breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
20920this category.
20921
20922@findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
20923@findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
20924@item COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
20925The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
20926@code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
20927@kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20928commands in this category.
20929
20930@findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
20931@findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
20932@item COMMAND_OBSCURE
20933The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
20934general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
20935@code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
20936obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
20937category.
20938
20939@findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
20940@findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
20941@item COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
20942The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
20943@code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
20944Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
20945commands in this category.
20946@end table
20947
20948A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
20949specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
20950from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
20951constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
20952
20953@table @code
20954@findex COMPLETE_NONE
20955@findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
20956@item COMPLETE_NONE
20957This constant means that no completion should be done.
20958
20959@findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
20960@findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
20961@item COMPLETE_FILENAME
20962This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
20963
20964@findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
20965@findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
20966@item COMPLETE_LOCATION
20967This constant means that location completion should be done.
20968@xref{Specify Location}.
20969
20970@findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
20971@findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
20972@item COMPLETE_COMMAND
20973This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
20974command names.
20975
20976@findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
20977@findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
20978@item COMPLETE_SYMBOL
20979This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
20980as the source.
20981@end table
20982
20983The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
20984implemented in Python:
20985
20986@smallexample
20987class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
20988 """Greet the whole world."""
20989
20990 def __init__ (self):
20991 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
20992
20993 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
20994 print "Hello, World!"
20995
20996HelloWorld ()
20997@end smallexample
20998
20999The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
21000registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
21001Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
21002@code{gdb} module explicitly.
21003
21004@node Parameters In Python
21005@subsubsection Parameters In Python
21006
21007@cindex parameters in python
21008@cindex python parameters
21009@tindex gdb.Parameter
21010@tindex Parameter
21011You can implement new @value{GDBN} parameters using Python. A new
21012parameter is implemented as an instance of the @code{gdb.Parameter}
21013class.
21014
21015Parameters are exposed to the user via the @code{set} and
21016@code{show} commands. @xref{Help}.
21017
21018There are many parameters that already exist and can be set in
21019@value{GDBN}. Two examples are: @code{set follow fork} and
21020@code{set charset}. Setting these parameters influences certain
21021behavior in @value{GDBN}. Similarly, you can define parameters that
21022can be used to influence behavior in custom Python scripts and commands.
21023
21024@defmethod Parameter __init__ name @var{command-class} @var{parameter-class} @r{[}@var{enum-sequence}@r{]}
21025The object initializer for @code{Parameter} registers the new
21026parameter with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked
21027from the subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
21028
21029@var{name} is the name of the new parameter. If @var{name} consists
21030of multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
21031parameters. An example of this can be illustrated with the
21032@code{set print} set of parameters. If @var{name} is
21033@code{print foo}, then @code{print} will be searched as the prefix
21034parameter. In this case the parameter can subsequently be accessed in
21035@value{GDBN} as @code{set print foo}.
21036
21037If @var{name} consists of multiple words, and no prefix parameter group
21038can be found, an exception is raised.
21039
21040@var{command-class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
21041(@pxref{Commands In Python}). This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to
21042categorize the new parameter in the help system.
21043
21044@var{parameter-class} should be one of the @samp{PARAM_} constants
21045defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} the type of the new
21046parameter; this information is used for input validation and
21047completion.
21048
21049If @var{parameter-class} is @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then
21050@var{enum-sequence} must be a sequence of strings. These strings
21051represent the possible values for the parameter.
21052
21053If @var{parameter-class} is not @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then the presence
21054of a fourth argument will cause an exception to be thrown.
21055
21056The help text for the new parameter is taken from the Python
21057documentation string for the parameter's class, if there is one. If
21058there is no documentation string, a default value is used.
21059@end defmethod
21060
21061@defivar Parameter set_doc
21062If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
21063the help text for this parameter's @code{set} command. The value is
21064examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
21065have no effect.
21066@end defivar
21067
21068@defivar Parameter show_doc
21069If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
21070the help text for this parameter's @code{show} command. The value is
21071examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
21072have no effect.
21073@end defivar
21074
21075@defivar Parameter value
21076The @code{value} attribute holds the underlying value of the
21077parameter. It can be read and assigned to just as any other
21078attribute. @value{GDBN} does validation when assignments are made.
21079@end defivar
21080
21081
21082When a new parameter is defined, its type must be specified. The
21083available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
21084module:
21085
21086@table @code
21087@findex PARAM_BOOLEAN
21088@findex gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
21089@item PARAM_BOOLEAN
21090The value is a plain boolean. The Python boolean values, @code{True}
21091and @code{False} are the only valid values.
21092
21093@findex PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
21094@findex gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
21095@item PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
21096The value has three possible states: true, false, and @samp{auto}. In
21097Python, true and false are represented using boolean constants, and
21098@samp{auto} is represented using @code{None}.
21099
21100@findex PARAM_UINTEGER
21101@findex gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
21102@item PARAM_UINTEGER
21103The value is an unsigned integer. The value of 0 should be
21104interpreted to mean ``unlimited''.
21105
21106@findex PARAM_INTEGER
21107@findex gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
21108@item PARAM_INTEGER
21109The value is a signed integer. The value of 0 should be interpreted
21110to mean ``unlimited''.
21111
21112@findex PARAM_STRING
21113@findex gdb.PARAM_STRING
21114@item PARAM_STRING
21115The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, any escape
21116sequences, such as @samp{\t}, @samp{\f}, and octal escapes, are
21117translated into corresponding characters and encoded into the current
21118host charset.
21119
21120@findex PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
21121@findex gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
21122@item PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
21123The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, escapes are
21124passed through untranslated.
21125
21126@findex PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
21127@findex gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
21128@item PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
21129The value is a either a filename (a string), or @code{None}.
21130
21131@findex PARAM_FILENAME
21132@findex gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
21133@item PARAM_FILENAME
21134The value is a filename. This is just like
21135@code{PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE}, but uses file names for completion.
21136
21137@findex PARAM_ZINTEGER
21138@findex gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
21139@item PARAM_ZINTEGER
21140The value is an integer. This is like @code{PARAM_INTEGER}, except 0
21141is interpreted as itself.
21142
21143@findex PARAM_ENUM
21144@findex gdb.PARAM_ENUM
21145@item PARAM_ENUM
21146The value is a string, which must be one of a collection string
21147constants provided when the parameter is created.
21148@end table
21149
21150@node Functions In Python
21151@subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
21152
21153@cindex writing convenience functions
21154@cindex convenience functions in python
21155@cindex python convenience functions
21156@tindex gdb.Function
21157@tindex Function
21158You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
21159in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
21160class @code{gdb.Function}.
21161
21162@defmethod Function __init__ name
21163The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
21164@value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
21165a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
21166variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
21167the given @var{name}.
21168
21169The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
21170string for the new class.
21171@end defmethod
21172
21173@defmethod Function invoke @var{*args}
21174When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
21175to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
21176@code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
21177predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
21178available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
21179standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
21180function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
21181
21182The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
21183expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
21184to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
21185@end defmethod
21186
21187The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
21188be implemented in Python:
21189
21190@smallexample
21191class Greet (gdb.Function):
21192 """Return string to greet someone.
21193Takes a name as argument."""
21194
21195 def __init__ (self):
21196 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
21197
21198 def invoke (self, name):
21199 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
21200
21201Greet ()
21202@end smallexample
21203
21204The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
21205registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
21206Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
21207@code{gdb} module explicitly.
21208
21209@node Progspaces In Python
21210@subsubsection Program Spaces In Python
21211
21212@cindex progspaces in python
21213@tindex gdb.Progspace
21214@tindex Progspace
21215A program space, or @dfn{progspace}, represents a symbolic view
21216of an address space.
21217It consists of all of the objfiles of the program.
21218@xref{Objfiles In Python}.
21219@xref{Inferiors and Programs, program spaces}, for more details
21220about program spaces.
21221
21222The following progspace-related functions are available in the
21223@code{gdb} module:
21224
21225@findex gdb.current_progspace
21226@defun current_progspace
21227This function returns the program space of the currently selected inferior.
21228@xref{Inferiors and Programs}.
21229@end defun
21230
21231@findex gdb.progspaces
21232@defun progspaces
21233Return a sequence of all the progspaces currently known to @value{GDBN}.
21234@end defun
21235
21236Each progspace is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Progspace}
21237class.
21238
21239@defivar Progspace filename
21240The file name of the progspace as a string.
21241@end defivar
21242
21243@defivar Progspace pretty_printers
21244The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
21245used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
21246function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
21247search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
21248which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
21249information.
21250@end defivar
21251
21252@node Objfiles In Python
21253@subsubsection Objfiles In Python
21254
21255@cindex objfiles in python
21256@tindex gdb.Objfile
21257@tindex Objfile
21258@value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
21259symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
21260executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
21261separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
21262@value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
21263
21264The following objfile-related functions are available in the
21265@code{gdb} module:
21266
21267@findex gdb.current_objfile
21268@defun current_objfile
21269When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
21270sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
21271function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
21272this function returns @code{None}.
21273@end defun
21274
21275@findex gdb.objfiles
21276@defun objfiles
21277Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
21278@xref{Objfiles In Python}.
21279@end defun
21280
21281Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
21282class.
21283
21284@defivar Objfile filename
21285The file name of the objfile as a string.
21286@end defivar
21287
21288@defivar Objfile pretty_printers
21289The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
21290used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
21291function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
21292search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
21293which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
21294information.
21295@end defivar
21296
21297@node Frames In Python
21298@subsubsection Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
21299
21300@cindex frames in python
21301When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
21302stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
21303represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
21304while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
21305to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{RuntimeError}
21306exception.
21307
21308Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
21309operator, like:
21310
21311@smallexample
21312(@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
21313True
21314@end smallexample
21315
21316The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
21317
21318@findex gdb.selected_frame
21319@defun selected_frame
21320Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
21321@end defun
21322
21323@defun frame_stop_reason_string reason
21324Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
21325frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
21326@code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
21327@end defun
21328
21329A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
21330
21331@table @code
21332@defmethod Frame is_valid
21333Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
21334A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
21335exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
21336an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
21337@end defmethod
21338
21339@defmethod Frame name
21340Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
21341obtained.
21342@end defmethod
21343
21344@defmethod Frame type
21345Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of
21346@code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, @code{gdb.DUMMY_FRAME}, @code{gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME}
21347or @code{gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME}.
21348@end defmethod
21349
21350@defmethod Frame unwind_stop_reason
21351Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
21352more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
21353@code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
21354function to a string.
21355@end defmethod
21356
21357@defmethod Frame pc
21358Returns the frame's resume address.
21359@end defmethod
21360
21361@defmethod Frame block
21362Return the frame's code block. @xref{Blocks In Python}.
21363@end defmethod
21364
21365@defmethod Frame function
21366Return the symbol for the function corresponding to this frame.
21367@xref{Symbols In Python}.
21368@end defmethod
21369
21370@defmethod Frame older
21371Return the frame that called this frame.
21372@end defmethod
21373
21374@defmethod Frame newer
21375Return the frame called by this frame.
21376@end defmethod
21377
21378@defmethod Frame find_sal
21379Return the frame's symtab and line object.
21380@xref{Symbol Tables In Python}.
21381@end defmethod
21382
21383@defmethod Frame read_var variable @r{[}block@r{]}
21384Return the value of @var{variable} in this frame. If the optional
21385argument @var{block} is provided, search for the variable from that
21386block; otherwise start at the frame's current block (which is
21387determined by the frame's current program counter). @var{variable}
21388must be a string or a @code{gdb.Symbol} object. @var{block} must be a
21389@code{gdb.Block} object.
21390@end defmethod
21391
21392@defmethod Frame select
21393Set this frame to be the selected frame. @xref{Stack, ,Examining the
21394Stack}.
21395@end defmethod
21396@end table
21397
21398@node Blocks In Python
21399@subsubsection Accessing frame blocks from Python.
21400
21401@cindex blocks in python
21402@tindex gdb.Block
21403
21404Within each frame, @value{GDBN} maintains information on each block
21405stored in that frame. These blocks are organized hierarchically, and
21406are represented individually in Python as a @code{gdb.Block}.
21407Please see @ref{Frames In Python}, for a more in-depth discussion on
21408frames. Furthermore, see @ref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}, for more
21409detailed technical information on @value{GDBN}'s book-keeping of the
21410stack.
21411
21412The following block-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21413module:
21414
21415@findex gdb.block_for_pc
21416@defun block_for_pc pc
21417Return the @code{gdb.Block} containing the given @var{pc} value. If the
21418block cannot be found for the @var{pc} value specified, the function
21419will return @code{None}.
21420@end defun
21421
21422A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following attributes:
21423
21424@table @code
21425@defivar Block start
21426The start address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
21427@end defivar
21428
21429@defivar Block end
21430The end address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
21431@end defivar
21432
21433@defivar Block function
21434The name of the block represented as a @code{gdb.Symbol}. If the
21435block is not named, then this attribute holds @code{None}. This
21436attribute is not writable.
21437@end defivar
21438
21439@defivar Block superblock
21440The block containing this block. If this parent block does not exist,
21441this attribute holds @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
21442@end defivar
21443@end table
21444
21445@node Symbols In Python
21446@subsubsection Python representation of Symbols.
21447
21448@cindex symbols in python
21449@tindex gdb.Symbol
21450
21451@value{GDBN} represents every variable, function and type as an
21452entry in a symbol table. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
21453Similarly, Python represents these symbols in @value{GDBN} with the
21454@code{gdb.Symbol} object.
21455
21456The following symbol-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21457module:
21458
21459@findex gdb.lookup_symbol
21460@defun lookup_symbol name [block] [domain]
21461This function searches for a symbol by name. The search scope can be
21462restricted to the parameters defined in the optional domain and block
21463arguments.
21464
21465@var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string. The
21466optional @var{block} argument restricts the search to symbols visible
21467in that @var{block}. The @var{block} argument must be a
21468@code{gdb.Block} object. The optional @var{domain} argument restricts
21469the search to the domain type. The @var{domain} argument must be a
21470domain constant defined in the @code{gdb} module and described later
21471in this chapter.
21472@end defun
21473
21474A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following attributes:
21475
21476@table @code
21477@defivar Symbol symtab
21478The symbol table in which the symbol appears. This attribute is
21479represented as a @code{gdb.Symtab} object. @xref{Symbol Tables In
21480Python}. This attribute is not writable.
21481@end defivar
21482
21483@defivar Symbol name
21484The name of the symbol as a string. This attribute is not writable.
21485@end defivar
21486
21487@defivar Symbol linkage_name
21488The name of the symbol, as used by the linker (i.e., may be mangled).
21489This attribute is not writable.
21490@end defivar
21491
21492@defivar Symbol print_name
21493The name of the symbol in a form suitable for output. This is either
21494@code{name} or @code{linkage_name}, depending on whether the user
21495asked @value{GDBN} to display demangled or mangled names.
21496@end defivar
21497
21498@defivar Symbol addr_class
21499The address class of the symbol. This classifies how to find the value
21500of a symbol. Each address class is a constant defined in the
21501@code{gdb} module and described later in this chapter.
21502@end defivar
21503
21504@defivar Symbol is_argument
21505@code{True} if the symbol is an argument of a function.
21506@end defivar
21507
21508@defivar Symbol is_constant
21509@code{True} if the symbol is a constant.
21510@end defivar
21511
21512@defivar Symbol is_function
21513@code{True} if the symbol is a function or a method.
21514@end defivar
21515
21516@defivar Symbol is_variable
21517@code{True} if the symbol is a variable.
21518@end defivar
21519@end table
21520
21521The available domain categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
21522as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
21523
21524@table @code
21525@findex SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
21526@findex gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
21527@item SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
21528This is used when a domain has not been discovered or none of the
21529following domains apply. This usually indicates an error either
21530in the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
21531@findex SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
21532@findex gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
21533@item SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
21534This domain contains variables, function names, typedef names and enum
21535type values.
21536@findex SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
21537@findex gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
21538@item SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
21539This domain holds struct, union and enum type names.
21540@findex SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
21541@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
21542@item SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
21543This domain contains names of labels (for gotos).
21544@findex SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
21545@findex gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
21546@item SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
21547This domain holds a subset of the @code{SYMBOLS_VAR_DOMAIN}; it
21548contains everything minus functions and types.
21549@findex SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
21550@findex gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
21551@item SYMBOL_FUNCTION_DOMAIN
21552This domain contains all functions.
21553@findex SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
21554@findex gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
21555@item SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
21556This domain contains all types.
21557@end table
21558
21559The available address class categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
21560as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
21561
21562@table @code
21563@findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
21564@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
21565@item SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
21566If this is returned by address class, it indicates an error either in
21567the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
21568@findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
21569@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
21570@item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
21571Value is constant int.
21572@findex SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
21573@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
21574@item SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
21575Value is at a fixed address.
21576@findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
21577@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
21578@item SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
21579Value is in a register.
21580@findex SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
21581@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
21582@item SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
21583Value is an argument. This value is at the offset stored within the
21584symbol inside the frame's argument list.
21585@findex SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
21586@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
21587@item SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
21588Value address is stored in the frame's argument list. Just like
21589@code{LOC_ARG} except that the value's address is stored at the
21590offset, not the value itself.
21591@findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
21592@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
21593@item SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
21594Value is a specified register. Just like @code{LOC_REGISTER} except
21595the register holds the address of the argument instead of the argument
21596itself.
21597@findex SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
21598@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
21599@item SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
21600Value is a local variable.
21601@findex SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
21602@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
21603@item SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
21604Value not used. Symbols in the domain @code{SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN} all
21605have this class.
21606@findex SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
21607@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
21608@item SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
21609Value is a block.
21610@findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
21611@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
21612@item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
21613Value is a byte-sequence.
21614@findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
21615@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
21616@item SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
21617Value is at a fixed address, but the address of the variable has to be
21618determined from the minimal symbol table whenever the variable is
21619referenced.
21620@findex SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
21621@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
21622@item SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
21623The value does not actually exist in the program.
21624@findex SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
21625@findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
21626@item SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
21627The value's address is a computed location.
21628@end table
21629
21630@node Symbol Tables In Python
21631@subsubsection Symbol table representation in Python.
21632
21633@cindex symbol tables in python
21634@tindex gdb.Symtab
21635@tindex gdb.Symtab_and_line
21636
21637Access to symbol table data maintained by @value{GDBN} on the inferior
21638is exposed to Python via two objects: @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} and
21639@code{gdb.Symtab}. Symbol table and line data for a frame is returned
21640from the @code{find_sal} method in @code{gdb.Frame} object.
21641@xref{Frames In Python}.
21642
21643For more information on @value{GDBN}'s symbol table management, see
21644@ref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, for more information.
21645
21646A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following attributes:
21647
21648@table @code
21649@defivar Symtab_and_line symtab
21650The symbol table object (@code{gdb.Symtab}) for this frame.
21651This attribute is not writable.
21652@end defivar
21653
21654@defivar Symtab_and_line pc
21655Indicates the current program counter address. This attribute is not
21656writable.
21657@end defivar
21658
21659@defivar Symtab_and_line line
21660Indicates the current line number for this object. This
21661attribute is not writable.
21662@end defivar
21663@end table
21664
21665A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following attributes:
21666
21667@table @code
21668@defivar Symtab filename
21669The symbol table's source filename. This attribute is not writable.
21670@end defivar
21671
21672@defivar Symtab objfile
21673The symbol table's backing object file. @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
21674This attribute is not writable.
21675@end defivar
21676@end table
21677
21678The following methods are provided:
21679
21680@table @code
21681@defmethod Symtab fullname
21682Return the symbol table's source absolute file name.
21683@end defmethod
21684@end table
21685
21686@node Breakpoints In Python
21687@subsubsection Manipulating breakpoints using Python
21688
21689@cindex breakpoints in python
21690@tindex gdb.Breakpoint
21691
21692Python code can manipulate breakpoints via the @code{gdb.Breakpoint}
21693class.
21694
21695@defmethod Breakpoint __init__ spec @r{[}type@r{]} @r{[}wp_class@r{]}
21696Create a new breakpoint. @var{spec} is a string naming the
21697location of the breakpoint, or an expression that defines a
21698watchpoint. The contents can be any location recognized by the
21699@code{break} command, or in the case of a watchpoint, by the @code{watch}
21700command. The optional @var{type} denotes the breakpoint to create
21701from the types defined later in this chapter. This argument can be
21702either: @code{BP_BREAKPOINT} or @code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. @var{type}
21703defaults to @code{BP_BREAKPOINT}. The optional @var{wp_class}
21704argument defines the class of watchpoint to create, if @var{type} is
21705defined as @code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. If a watchpoint class is not
21706provided, it is assumed to be a @var{WP_WRITE} class.
21707@end defmethod
21708
21709The available watchpoint types represented by constants are defined in the
21710@code{gdb} module:
21711
21712@table @code
21713@findex WP_READ
21714@findex gdb.WP_READ
21715@item WP_READ
21716Read only watchpoint.
21717
21718@findex WP_WRITE
21719@findex gdb.WP_WRITE
21720@item WP_WRITE
21721Write only watchpoint.
21722
21723@findex WP_ACCESS
21724@findex gdb.WP_ACCESS
21725@item WP_ACCESS
21726Read/Write watchpoint.
21727@end table
21728
21729@defmethod Breakpoint is_valid
21730Return @code{True} if this @code{Breakpoint} object is valid,
21731@code{False} otherwise. A @code{Breakpoint} object can become invalid
21732if the user deletes the breakpoint. In this case, the object still
21733exists, but the underlying breakpoint does not. In the cases of
21734watchpoint scope, the watchpoint remains valid even if execution of the
21735inferior leaves the scope of that watchpoint.
21736@end defmethod
21737
21738@defivar Breakpoint enabled
21739This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is enabled, and
21740@code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
21741@end defivar
21742
21743@defivar Breakpoint silent
21744This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is silent, and
21745@code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
21746
21747Note that a breakpoint can also be silent if it has commands and the
21748first command is @code{silent}. This is not reported by the
21749@code{silent} attribute.
21750@end defivar
21751
21752@defivar Breakpoint thread
21753If the breakpoint is thread-specific, this attribute holds the thread
21754id. If the breakpoint is not thread-specific, this attribute is
21755@code{None}. This attribute is writable.
21756@end defivar
21757
21758@defivar Breakpoint task
21759If the breakpoint is Ada task-specific, this attribute holds the Ada task
21760id. If the breakpoint is not task-specific (or the underlying
21761language is not Ada), this attribute is @code{None}. This attribute
21762is writable.
21763@end defivar
21764
21765@defivar Breakpoint ignore_count
21766This attribute holds the ignore count for the breakpoint, an integer.
21767This attribute is writable.
21768@end defivar
21769
21770@defivar Breakpoint number
21771This attribute holds the breakpoint's number --- the identifier used by
21772the user to manipulate the breakpoint. This attribute is not writable.
21773@end defivar
21774
21775@defivar Breakpoint type
21776This attribute holds the breakpoint's type --- the identifier used to
21777determine the actual breakpoint type or use-case. This attribute is not
21778writable.
21779@end defivar
21780
21781The available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
21782module:
21783
21784@table @code
21785@findex BP_BREAKPOINT
21786@findex gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
21787@item BP_BREAKPOINT
21788Normal code breakpoint.
21789
21790@findex BP_WATCHPOINT
21791@findex gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
21792@item BP_WATCHPOINT
21793Watchpoint breakpoint.
21794
21795@findex BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
21796@findex gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
21797@item BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
21798Hardware assisted watchpoint.
21799
21800@findex BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
21801@findex gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
21802@item BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
21803Hardware assisted read watchpoint.
21804
21805@findex BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
21806@findex gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
21807@item BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
21808Hardware assisted access watchpoint.
21809@end table
21810
21811@defivar Breakpoint hit_count
21812This attribute holds the hit count for the breakpoint, an integer.
21813This attribute is writable, but currently it can only be set to zero.
21814@end defivar
21815
21816@defivar Breakpoint location
21817This attribute holds the location of the breakpoint, as specified by
21818the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have a location
21819(that is, it is a watchpoint) the attribute's value is @code{None}. This
21820attribute is not writable.
21821@end defivar
21822
21823@defivar Breakpoint expression
21824This attribute holds a breakpoint expression, as specified by
21825the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have an
21826expression (the breakpoint is not a watchpoint) the attribute's value
21827is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
21828@end defivar
21829
21830@defivar Breakpoint condition
21831This attribute holds the condition of the breakpoint, as specified by
21832the user. It is a string. If there is no condition, this attribute's
21833value is @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
21834@end defivar
21835
21836@defivar Breakpoint commands
21837This attribute holds the commands attached to the breakpoint. If
21838there are commands, this attribute's value is a string holding all the
21839commands, separated by newlines. If there are no commands, this
21840attribute is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
21841@end defivar
21842
21843@node Lazy Strings In Python
21844@subsubsection Python representation of lazy strings.
21845
21846@cindex lazy strings in python
21847@tindex gdb.LazyString
21848
21849A @dfn{lazy string} is a string whose contents is not retrieved or
21850encoded until it is needed.
21851
21852A @code{gdb.LazyString} is represented in @value{GDBN} as an
21853@code{address} that points to a region of memory, an @code{encoding}
21854that will be used to encode that region of memory, and a @code{length}
21855to delimit the region of memory that represents the string. The
21856difference between a @code{gdb.LazyString} and a string wrapped within
21857a @code{gdb.Value} is that a @code{gdb.LazyString} will be treated
21858differently by @value{GDBN} when printing. A @code{gdb.LazyString} is
21859retrieved and encoded during printing, while a @code{gdb.Value}
21860wrapping a string is immediately retrieved and encoded on creation.
21861
21862A @code{gdb.LazyString} object has the following functions:
21863
21864@defmethod LazyString value
21865Convert the @code{gdb.LazyString} to a @code{gdb.Value}. This value
21866will point to the string in memory, but will lose all the delayed
21867retrieval, encoding and handling that @value{GDBN} applies to a
21868@code{gdb.LazyString}.
21869@end defmethod
21870
21871@defivar LazyString address
21872This attribute holds the address of the string. This attribute is not
21873writable.
21874@end defivar
21875
21876@defivar LazyString length
21877This attribute holds the length of the string in characters. If the
21878length is -1, then the string will be fetched and encoded up to the
21879first null of appropriate width. This attribute is not writable.
21880@end defivar
21881
21882@defivar LazyString encoding
21883This attribute holds the encoding that will be applied to the string
21884when the string is printed by @value{GDBN}. If the encoding is not
21885set, or contains an empty string, then @value{GDBN} will select the
21886most appropriate encoding when the string is printed. This attribute
21887is not writable.
21888@end defivar
21889
21890@defivar LazyString type
21891This attribute holds the type that is represented by the lazy string's
21892type. For a lazy string this will always be a pointer type. To
21893resolve this to the lazy string's character type, use the type's
21894@code{target} method. @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not
21895writable.
21896@end defivar
21897
21898@node Auto-loading
21899@subsection Auto-loading
21900@cindex auto-loading, Python
21901
21902When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
21903command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
21904@value{GDBN} will look for Python support scripts in several ways:
21905@file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} and @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
21906
21907@menu
21908* objfile-gdb.py file:: The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
21909* .debug_gdb_scripts section:: The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
21910* Which flavor to choose?::
21911@end menu
21912
21913The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
21914debugging commands and scripts.
21915
21916Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled.
21917
21918@table @code
21919@kindex maint set python auto-load
21920@item maint set python auto-load [yes|no]
21921Enable or disable the Python auto-loading feature.
21922
21923@kindex maint show python auto-load
21924@item maint show python auto-load
21925Show whether Python auto-loading is enabled or disabled.
21926@end table
21927
21928When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the
21929@dfn{current objfile}. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
21930function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
21931registering objfile-specific pretty-printers.
21932
21933@node objfile-gdb.py file
21934@subsubsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
21935@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
21936
21937When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for
21938a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py},
21939where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring
21940that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving
21941@code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is
21942readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script.
21943
21944If this file does not exist, and if the parameter
21945@code{debug-file-directory} is set (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}),
21946then @value{GDBN} will look for @var{real-name} in all of the
21947directories mentioned in the value of @code{debug-file-directory}.
21948
21949Finally, if this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
21950a file named @file{@var{data-directory}/python/auto-load/@var{real-name}}, where
21951@var{data-directory} is @value{GDBN}'s data directory (available via
21952@code{show data-directory}, @pxref{Data Files}), and @var{real-name}
21953is the object file's real name, as described above.
21954
21955@value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
21956@value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
21957@var{objfile} is opened.
21958So your @file{-gdb.py} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
21959is evaluated more than once.
21960
21961@node .debug_gdb_scripts section
21962@subsubsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
21963@cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
21964
21965For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
21966when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
21967it will look for a special section named @samp{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
21968If this section exists, its contents is a list of names of scripts to load.
21969
21970@value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
21971current directory and then along the source search path
21972(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
21973except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
21974directory is not relevant to scripts.
21975
21976Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
21977for example, this GCC macro:
21978
21979@example
21980/* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remote duplicates. */
21981#define DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT(script_name) \
21982 asm("\
21983.pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
21984.byte 1\n\
21985.asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
21986.popsection \n\
21987");
21988@end example
21989
21990@noindent
21991Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
21992
21993@example
21994DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
21995@end example
21996
21997The script name may include directories if desired.
21998
21999If the macro is put in a header, any application or library
22000using this header will get a reference to the specified script.
22001
22002@node Which flavor to choose?
22003@subsubsection Which flavor to choose?
22004
22005Given the multiple ways of auto-loading Python scripts, it might not always
22006be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
22007
22008Benefits of the @file{-gdb.py} way:
22009
22010@itemize @bullet
22011@item
22012Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
22013
22014@item
22015Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
22016
22017Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
22018in the source search path.
22019For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
22020isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
22021
22022@item
22023Doesn't require source code additions.
22024@end itemize
22025
22026Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
22027
22028@itemize @bullet
22029@item
22030Works with static linking.
22031
22032Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.py} way require an objfile to
22033trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
22034objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
22035scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's @file{-gdb.py} script.
22036
22037@item
22038Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
22039
22040Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
22041shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.py} script to.
22042
22043@item
22044Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
22045
22046In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
22047libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
22048@file{-gdb.py} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
22049cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
22050@code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
22051top of the source tree to the source search path.
22052@end itemize
22053
22054@node Interpreters
22055@chapter Command Interpreters
22056@cindex command interpreters
22057
22058@value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
22059infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
22060between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
22061
22062@value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
22063interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
22064and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
22065describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
22066
22067By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
22068However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
22069interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
22070startup options. Defined interpreters include:
22071
22072@table @code
22073@item console
22074@cindex console interpreter
22075The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
22076used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
22077@value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
22078
22079@item mi
22080@cindex mi interpreter
22081The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
22082by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
22083or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
22084Interface}.
22085
22086@item mi2
22087@cindex mi2 interpreter
22088The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
22089
22090@item mi1
22091@cindex mi1 interpreter
22092The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
22093
22094@end table
22095
22096@cindex invoke another interpreter
22097The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
22098switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
22099precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
22100enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
22101@value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
22102the IDE inoperable!
22103
22104@kindex interpreter-exec
22105Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
22106commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
22107command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
22108@code{interpreter-exec} command:
22109
22110@smallexample
22111interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
22112@end smallexample
22113
22114@sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
22115@value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
22116
22117@node TUI
22118@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
22119@cindex TUI
22120@cindex Text User Interface
22121
22122@menu
22123* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
22124* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
22125* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
22126* TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
22127* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
22128@end menu
22129
22130The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
22131interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
22132file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
22133commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
22134on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
22135is available.
22136
22137@pindex @value{GDBTUI}
22138The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
22139either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
22140You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
22141using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
22142@xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
22143
22144@node TUI Overview
22145@section TUI Overview
22146
22147In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
22148
22149@table @emph
22150@item command
22151This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
22152prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
22153managed using readline.
22154
22155@item source
22156The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
22157line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
22158
22159@item assembly
22160The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
22161
22162@item register
22163This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
22164when their values change.
22165@end table
22166
22167The source and assembly windows show the current program position
22168by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
22169Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
22170indicates the breakpoint type:
22171
22172@table @code
22173@item B
22174Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
22175
22176@item b
22177Breakpoint which was never hit.
22178
22179@item H
22180Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
22181
22182@item h
22183Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
22184@end table
22185
22186The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
22187
22188@table @code
22189@item +
22190Breakpoint is enabled.
22191
22192@item -
22193Breakpoint is disabled.
22194@end table
22195
22196The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
22197thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
22198changes.
22199
22200These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
22201window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
22202layouts:
22203
22204@itemize @bullet
22205@item
22206source only,
22207
22208@item
22209assembly only,
22210
22211@item
22212source and assembly,
22213
22214@item
22215source and registers, or
22216
22217@item
22218assembly and registers.
22219@end itemize
22220
22221A status line above the command window shows the following information:
22222
22223@table @emph
22224@item target
22225Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
22226(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
22227
22228@item process
22229Gives the current process or thread number.
22230When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
22231
22232@item function
22233Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
22234The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
22235When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
22236the string @code{??} is displayed.
22237
22238@item line
22239Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
22240When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
22241
22242@item pc
22243Indicates the current program counter address.
22244@end table
22245
22246@node TUI Keys
22247@section TUI Key Bindings
22248@cindex TUI key bindings
22249
22250The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
22251(@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
22252are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
22253
22254@table @kbd
22255@kindex C-x C-a
22256@item C-x C-a
22257@kindex C-x a
22258@itemx C-x a
22259@kindex C-x A
22260@itemx C-x A
22261Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
22262the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
22263its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
22264the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
22265The screen is then refreshed.
22266
22267@kindex C-x 1
22268@item C-x 1
22269Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
22270either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
22271is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
22272
22273Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
22274
22275@kindex C-x 2
22276@item C-x 2
22277Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
22278layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
22279When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
22280previous layout and the new one.
22281
22282Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
22283
22284@kindex C-x o
22285@item C-x o
22286Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
22287(like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
22288gives the focus to the next TUI window.
22289
22290Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
22291
22292@kindex C-x s
22293@item C-x s
22294Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
22295keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
22296@end table
22297
22298The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
22299
22300@table @asis
22301@kindex PgUp
22302@item @key{PgUp}
22303Scroll the active window one page up.
22304
22305@kindex PgDn
22306@item @key{PgDn}
22307Scroll the active window one page down.
22308
22309@kindex Up
22310@item @key{Up}
22311Scroll the active window one line up.
22312
22313@kindex Down
22314@item @key{Down}
22315Scroll the active window one line down.
22316
22317@kindex Left
22318@item @key{Left}
22319Scroll the active window one column left.
22320
22321@kindex Right
22322@item @key{Right}
22323Scroll the active window one column right.
22324
22325@kindex C-L
22326@item @kbd{C-L}
22327Refresh the screen.
22328@end table
22329
22330Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
22331are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
22332window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
22333other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
22334and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
22335
22336@node TUI Single Key Mode
22337@section TUI Single Key Mode
22338@cindex TUI single key mode
22339
22340The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
22341frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
22342switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
22343
22344@table @kbd
22345@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22346@item c
22347continue
22348
22349@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22350@item d
22351down
22352
22353@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22354@item f
22355finish
22356
22357@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22358@item n
22359next
22360
22361@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22362@item q
22363exit the SingleKey mode.
22364
22365@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22366@item r
22367run
22368
22369@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22370@item s
22371step
22372
22373@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22374@item u
22375up
22376
22377@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22378@item v
22379info locals
22380
22381@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
22382@item w
22383where
22384@end table
22385
22386Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
22387The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
22388it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
22389with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
22390SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
22391this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
22392
22393
22394@node TUI Commands
22395@section TUI-specific Commands
22396@cindex TUI commands
22397
22398The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
22399These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
22400the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
22401of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
22402
22403Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
22404terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
22405interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
22406these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
22407possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
22408
22409@table @code
22410@item info win
22411@kindex info win
22412List and give the size of all displayed windows.
22413
22414@item layout next
22415@kindex layout
22416Display the next layout.
22417
22418@item layout prev
22419Display the previous layout.
22420
22421@item layout src
22422Display the source window only.
22423
22424@item layout asm
22425Display the assembly window only.
22426
22427@item layout split
22428Display the source and assembly window.
22429
22430@item layout regs
22431Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
22432
22433@item focus next
22434@kindex focus
22435Make the next window active for scrolling.
22436
22437@item focus prev
22438Make the previous window active for scrolling.
22439
22440@item focus src
22441Make the source window active for scrolling.
22442
22443@item focus asm
22444Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
22445
22446@item focus regs
22447Make the register window active for scrolling.
22448
22449@item focus cmd
22450Make the command window active for scrolling.
22451
22452@item refresh
22453@kindex refresh
22454Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
22455
22456@item tui reg float
22457@kindex tui reg
22458Show the floating point registers in the register window.
22459
22460@item tui reg general
22461Show the general registers in the register window.
22462
22463@item tui reg next
22464Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
22465their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
22466following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
22467@code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
22468
22469@item tui reg system
22470Show the system registers in the register window.
22471
22472@item update
22473@kindex update
22474Update the source window and the current execution point.
22475
22476@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
22477@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
22478@kindex winheight
22479Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
22480lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
22481decrease it.
22482
22483@item tabset @var{nchars}
22484@kindex tabset
22485Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
22486@end table
22487
22488@node TUI Configuration
22489@section TUI Configuration Variables
22490@cindex TUI configuration variables
22491
22492Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
22493
22494@table @code
22495@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
22496@kindex set tui border-kind
22497Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
22498The possible values are the following:
22499@table @code
22500@item space
22501Use a space character to draw the border.
22502
22503@item ascii
22504Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
22505
22506@item acs
22507Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
22508drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
22509@end table
22510
22511@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
22512@kindex set tui border-mode
22513@itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
22514@kindex set tui active-border-mode
22515Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
22516or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
22517@table @code
22518@item normal
22519Use normal attributes to display the border.
22520
22521@item standout
22522Use standout mode.
22523
22524@item reverse
22525Use reverse video mode.
22526
22527@item half
22528Use half bright mode.
22529
22530@item half-standout
22531Use half bright and standout mode.
22532
22533@item bold
22534Use extra bright or bold mode.
22535
22536@item bold-standout
22537Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
22538@end table
22539@end table
22540
22541@node Emacs
22542@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
22543
22544@cindex Emacs
22545@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
22546A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
22547edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
22548@value{GDBN}.
22549
22550To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
22551executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
22552@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
22553created Emacs buffer.
22554@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
22555
22556Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
22557things:
22558
22559@itemize @bullet
22560@item
22561All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
22562the GUD buffer.
22563
22564This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
22565and output done by the program you are debugging.
22566
22567This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
22568commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
22569in this way.
22570
22571All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
22572with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
22573way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
22574stop.
22575
22576@item
22577@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
22578
22579Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
22580source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
22581left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
22582source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
22583and the source.
22584
22585Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
22586usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
22587@end itemize
22588
22589We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
22590a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
22591that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
22592@xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
22593
22594If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
22595gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
22596your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
22597sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
22598with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
22599program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
22600some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
22601@value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
22602buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
22603
22604The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
22605line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
22606that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
22607,Commands to Specify Files}.
22608
22609By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
22610need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
22611keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
22612customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
22613one you want.
22614
22615In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
22616addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
22617
22618@table @kbd
22619@item C-h m
22620Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
22621
22622@item C-c C-s
22623Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
22624update the display window to show the current file and location.
22625
22626@item C-c C-n
22627Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
22628calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
22629to show the current file and location.
22630
22631@item C-c C-i
22632Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
22633display window accordingly.
22634
22635@item C-c C-f
22636Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
22637@code{finish} command.
22638
22639@item C-c C-r
22640Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
22641command.
22642
22643@item C-c <
22644Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
22645(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
22646like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
22647
22648@item C-c >
22649Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
22650@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
22651@end table
22652
22653In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
22654tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
22655
22656In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
22657separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
22658Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
22659become the current frame and display the associated source in the
22660source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
22661selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
22662speedbar displays watch expressions.
22663
22664If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
22665it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
22666request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
22667the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
22668frame.
22669
22670The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
22671which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
22672the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
22673communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
22674delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
22675to correspond properly with the code.
22676
22677A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
22678given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
22679Emacs Manual}).
22680
22681@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
22682@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
22683@ignore
22684@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
22685@kindex Epoch
22686@kindex inspect
22687
22688Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
22689called the @code{epoch}
22690environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
22691@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
22692each value is printed in its own window.
22693@end ignore
22694
22695
22696@node GDB/MI
22697@chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
22698
22699@unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
22700
22701@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
22702@sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
22703@value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
22704@option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
22705is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
22706use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
22707
22708This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
22709in the form of a reference manual.
22710
22711Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
22712features described below are incomplete and subject to change
22713(@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
22714
22715@unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
22716
22717@cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
22718This chapter uses the following notation:
22719
22720@itemize @bullet
22721@item
22722@code{|} separates two alternatives.
22723
22724@item
22725@code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
22726it may or may not be given.
22727
22728@item
22729@code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
22730may repeat zero or more times.
22731
22732@item
22733@code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
22734may repeat one or more times.
22735
22736@item
22737@code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
22738@end itemize
22739
22740@ignore
22741@heading Dependencies
22742@end ignore
22743
22744@menu
22745* GDB/MI General Design::
22746* GDB/MI Command Syntax::
22747* GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
22748* GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
22749* GDB/MI Output Records::
22750* GDB/MI Simple Examples::
22751* GDB/MI Command Description Format::
22752* GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
22753* GDB/MI Program Context::
22754* GDB/MI Thread Commands::
22755* GDB/MI Program Execution::
22756* GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
22757* GDB/MI Variable Objects::
22758* GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
22759* GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
22760* GDB/MI Symbol Query::
22761* GDB/MI File Commands::
22762@ignore
22763* GDB/MI Kod Commands::
22764* GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
22765* GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
22766@end ignore
22767* GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
22768* GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
22769* GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
22770@end menu
22771
22772@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22773@node GDB/MI General Design
22774@section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
22775@cindex GDB/MI General Design
22776
22777Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
22778parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
22779and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
22780indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
22781For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
22782requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
22783response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
22784Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
22785target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
22786a command and reported as part of that command response.
22787
22788The important examples of notifications are:
22789@itemize @bullet
22790
22791@item
22792Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
22793target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
22794be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
22795commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
22796different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
22797happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
22798command itself was successfully executed.
22799
22800@item
22801Console output, and status notifications. Console output
22802notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
22803diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
22804report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
22805this information in command response would mean no output is produced
22806until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
22807
22808@item
22809General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
22810the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
22811a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
22812be included in command response, using notification allows for more
22813orthogonal frontend design.
22814
22815@end itemize
22816
22817There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
22818@value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
22819the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
22820processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
22821we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
22822the user interface.
22823
22824
22825@menu
22826* Context management::
22827* Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
22828* Thread groups::
22829@end menu
22830
22831@node Context management
22832@subsection Context management
22833
22834In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
22835done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
22836Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
22837be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
22838and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
22839because a command line user would not want to specify that information
22840explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
22841@value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
22842to what thread and frame are the current ones.
22843
22844In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
22845useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
22846itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
22847each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
22848want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
22849increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
22850frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
22851should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
22852make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
22853@samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
22854for thread and frame to operate on.
22855
22856Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
22857a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
22858operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
22859current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
22860it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
22861another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
22862the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
22863one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
22864change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
22865No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
22866
22867Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
22868frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
22869right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
22870simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
22871before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
22872to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
22873if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
22874thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
22875optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
22876sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
22877selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
22878change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
22879problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
22880all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
22881right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
22882@samp{--frame} options.
22883
22884@node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
22885@subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
22886
22887On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
22888even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
22889command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
22890specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
22891@code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
22892either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
22893frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
22894find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
22895@code{-list-target-features} command.
22896
22897Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
22898many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
22899running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
22900when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
22901it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
22902are running.
22903
22904When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
22905target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
22906some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
22907stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
22908modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
22909that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
22910@code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
22911context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
22912stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
22913@samp{--thread} option).
22914
22915Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
22916highly target dependent. However, the two commands
22917@code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
22918to find the state of a thread, will always work.
22919
22920@node Thread groups
22921@subsection Thread groups
22922@value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
22923On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
22924hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
22925processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
22926mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
22927
22928The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
22929target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
22930accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
22931thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
22932neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
22933current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
22934that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
22935into processes.
22936
22937To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
22938hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
22939@dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
22940thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
22941and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
22942command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
22943thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
22944debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
22945to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
22946the members of specific thread group.
22947
22948To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
22949wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
22950introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
22951@value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
22952@code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
22953groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
22954In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
22955after attaching to that thread group.
22956
22957Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
22958Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
22959type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
22960such thread groups.
22961
22962@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22963@node GDB/MI Command Syntax
22964@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
22965
22966@menu
22967* GDB/MI Input Syntax::
22968* GDB/MI Output Syntax::
22969@end menu
22970
22971@node GDB/MI Input Syntax
22972@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
22973
22974@cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
22975@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
22976@table @code
22977@item @var{command} @expansion{}
22978@code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
22979
22980@item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
22981@code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
22982@var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
22983
22984@item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
22985@code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
22986@code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
22987
22988@item @var{token} @expansion{}
22989"any sequence of digits"
22990
22991@item @var{option} @expansion{}
22992@code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
22993
22994@item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
22995@code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
22996
22997@item @var{operation} @expansion{}
22998@emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
22999
23000@item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
23001@emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
23002"-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
23003
23004@item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
23005@code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
23006
23007@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
23008@code{CR | CR-LF}
23009@end table
23010
23011@noindent
23012Notes:
23013
23014@itemize @bullet
23015@item
23016The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
23017output is described below.
23018
23019@item
23020The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
23021finishes.
23022
23023@item
23024Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
23025list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
23026followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
23027parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
23028@samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
23029@end itemize
23030
23031Pragmatics:
23032
23033@itemize @bullet
23034@item
23035We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
23036
23037@item
23038We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
23039@end itemize
23040
23041@node GDB/MI Output Syntax
23042@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
23043
23044@cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
23045@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
23046The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
23047followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
23048is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
23049terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
23050
23051If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
23052corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
23053@var{token}.
23054
23055@table @code
23056@item @var{output} @expansion{}
23057@code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
23058
23059@item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
23060@code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
23061
23062@item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
23063@code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
23064
23065@item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
23066@code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
23067
23068@item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
23069@code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
23070
23071@item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
23072@code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
23073
23074@item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
23075@code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
23076
23077@item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
23078@code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
23079
23080@item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
23081@code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
23082
23083@item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
23084@code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
23085depending on the needs---this is still in development).
23086
23087@item @var{result} @expansion{}
23088@code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
23089
23090@item @var{variable} @expansion{}
23091@code{ @var{string} }
23092
23093@item @var{value} @expansion{}
23094@code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
23095
23096@item @var{const} @expansion{}
23097@code{@var{c-string}}
23098
23099@item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
23100@code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
23101
23102@item @var{list} @expansion{}
23103@code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
23104@var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
23105
23106@item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
23107@code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
23108
23109@item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
23110@code{"~" @var{c-string}}
23111
23112@item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
23113@code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
23114
23115@item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
23116@code{"&" @var{c-string}}
23117
23118@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
23119@code{CR | CR-LF}
23120
23121@item @var{token} @expansion{}
23122@emph{any sequence of digits}.
23123@end table
23124
23125@noindent
23126Notes:
23127
23128@itemize @bullet
23129@item
23130All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
23131
23132@item
23133The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
23134for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
23135may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
23136output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
23137all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
23138target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
23139prior command.
23140
23141@item
23142@cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
23143@var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
23144progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
23145prefixed by @samp{+}.
23146
23147@item
23148@cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
23149@var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
23150(stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
23151@samp{*}.
23152
23153@item
23154@cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
23155@var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
23156client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
23157output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
23158
23159@item
23160@cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
23161@var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
23162console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
23163output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
23164
23165@item
23166@cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
23167@var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
23168All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
23169
23170@item
23171@cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
23172@var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
23173instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
23174the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
23175
23176@item
23177@cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
23178New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
23179@var{values}.
23180
23181
23182@end itemize
23183
23184@xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
23185details about the various output records.
23186
23187@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23188@node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
23189@section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
23190
23191@cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
23192@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
23193
23194For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
23195but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
23196that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
23197command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
23198@code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
23199@samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
23200
23201This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
23202recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
23203(@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
23204
23205@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23206@node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
23207@section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
23208@cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
23209
23210The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
23211program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
23212
23213Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
23214by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
23215to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
23216section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
23217might change.
23218
23219Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
23220for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
23221list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
23222parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
23223
23224@itemize @bullet
23225@item
23226New MI commands may be added.
23227
23228@item
23229New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
23230
23231@item
23232The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
23233@code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
23234
23235@c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
23236@c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
23237
23238@c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
23239@c resolve inconsistencies.
23240@end itemize
23241
23242If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
23243will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
23244output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
23245@value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
23246responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
23247
23248@c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
23249@c version?
23250
23251The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
23252end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
23253follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
23254@email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
23255@cindex mailing lists
23256
23257@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23258@node GDB/MI Output Records
23259@section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
23260
23261@menu
23262* GDB/MI Result Records::
23263* GDB/MI Stream Records::
23264* GDB/MI Async Records::
23265* GDB/MI Frame Information::
23266* GDB/MI Thread Information::
23267@end menu
23268
23269@node GDB/MI Result Records
23270@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
23271
23272@cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
23273@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
23274In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
23275@sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
23276
23277@table @code
23278@findex ^done
23279@item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
23280The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
23281values.
23282
23283@item "^running"
23284@findex ^running
23285This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
23286was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
23287target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
23288all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
23289identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
23290which threads are resumed.
23291
23292@item "^connected"
23293@findex ^connected
23294@value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
23295
23296@item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
23297@findex ^error
23298The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
23299error message.
23300
23301@item "^exit"
23302@findex ^exit
23303@value{GDBN} has terminated.
23304
23305@end table
23306
23307@node GDB/MI Stream Records
23308@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
23309
23310@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
23311@cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
23312@value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
23313target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
23314funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
23315
23316Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
23317identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
23318Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
23319@code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
23320line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
23321
23322@table @code
23323@item "~" @var{string-output}
23324The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
23325CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
23326
23327@item "@@" @var{string-output}
23328The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
23329target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
23330asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
23331
23332@item "&" @var{string-output}
23333The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
23334internals.
23335@end table
23336
23337@node GDB/MI Async Records
23338@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
23339
23340@cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
23341@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
23342@dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
23343additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
23344consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
23345target activity (e.g., target stopped).
23346
23347The following is the list of possible async records:
23348
23349@table @code
23350
23351@item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
23352The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
23353specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
23354are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
23355running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
23356The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
23357only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
23358several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
23359all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
23360be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
23361
23362@item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
23363The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
23364following values:
23365
23366@table @code
23367@item breakpoint-hit
23368A breakpoint was reached.
23369@item watchpoint-trigger
23370A watchpoint was triggered.
23371@item read-watchpoint-trigger
23372A read watchpoint was triggered.
23373@item access-watchpoint-trigger
23374An access watchpoint was triggered.
23375@item function-finished
23376An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
23377@item location-reached
23378An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
23379@item watchpoint-scope
23380A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
23381@item end-stepping-range
23382An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
23383similar CLI command was accomplished.
23384@item exited-signalled
23385The inferior exited because of a signal.
23386@item exited
23387The inferior exited.
23388@item exited-normally
23389The inferior exited normally.
23390@item signal-received
23391A signal was received by the inferior.
23392@end table
23393
23394The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
23395-- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
23396mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
23397stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
23398If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
23399value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
23400field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
23401always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
23402several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
23403processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
23404if such information is not available.
23405
23406@item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
23407@itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
23408A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
23409contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
23410group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
23411process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
23412cannot be used in any way.
23413
23414@item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
23415A thread group became associated with a running program,
23416either because the program was just started or the thread group
23417was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
23418@value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
23419contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
23420
23421@itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
23422A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
23423either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
23424from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
23425thread group.
23426
23427@item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
23428@itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
23429A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
23430contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
23431field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
23432
23433@item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
23434Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
23435command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
23436command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
23437to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
23438invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
23439@code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
23440
23441We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
23442highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
23443that thread.
23444
23445@item =library-loaded,...
23446Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
23447notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
23448@var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
23449opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
23450@var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
23451library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
23452debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
23453@var{symbols-loaded} field reports if the debug symbols for this
23454library are loaded. The @var{thread-group} field, if present,
23455specifies the id of the thread group in whose context the library was loaded.
23456If the field is absent, it means the library was loaded in the context
23457of all present thread groups.
23458
23459@item =library-unloaded,...
23460Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
23461has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
23462the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
23463The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
23464thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
23465absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
23466thread groups.
23467
23468@end table
23469
23470@node GDB/MI Frame Information
23471@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
23472
23473Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
23474frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
23475fields:
23476
23477@table @code
23478@item level
23479The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
23480zero. This field is always present.
23481
23482@item func
23483The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
23484be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
23485
23486@item addr
23487The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
23488
23489@item file
23490The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
23491address. This field may be absent.
23492
23493@item line
23494The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
23495may be absent.
23496
23497@item from
23498The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
23499corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
23500
23501@end table
23502
23503@node GDB/MI Thread Information
23504@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
23505
23506Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
23507uses a tuple with the following fields:
23508
23509@table @code
23510@item id
23511The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
23512always present.
23513
23514@item target-id
23515Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
23516
23517@item details
23518Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
23519It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
23520frontend. This field is optional.
23521
23522@item state
23523Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
23524thread is presently running. This field is always present.
23525
23526@item core
23527The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
23528thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
23529@end table
23530
23531
23532@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23533@node GDB/MI Simple Examples
23534@section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
23535@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
23536
23537This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
23538the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
23539following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
23540the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
23541
23542Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
23543readability, they don't appear in the real output.
23544
23545@subheading Setting a Breakpoint
23546
23547Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
23548information of the breakpoint.
23549
23550@smallexample
23551-> -break-insert main
23552<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
23553 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
23554 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
23555<- (gdb)
23556@end smallexample
23557
23558@subheading Program Execution
23559
23560Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
23561reason that execution stopped.
23562
23563@smallexample
23564-> -exec-run
23565<- ^running
23566<- (gdb)
23567<- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
23568 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
23569 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
23570 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
23571<- (gdb)
23572-> -exec-continue
23573<- ^running
23574<- (gdb)
23575<- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
23576<- (gdb)
23577@end smallexample
23578
23579@subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
23580
23581Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
23582
23583@smallexample
23584-> (gdb)
23585<- -gdb-exit
23586<- ^exit
23587@end smallexample
23588
23589Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
23590take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
23591performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
23592or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
23593@value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
23594fails to exit in reasonable time.
23595
23596@subheading A Bad Command
23597
23598Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
23599
23600@smallexample
23601-> -rubbish
23602<- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
23603<- (gdb)
23604@end smallexample
23605
23606
23607@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23608@node GDB/MI Command Description Format
23609@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
23610
23611The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
23612commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
23613
23614@subheading Motivation
23615
23616The motivation for this collection of commands.
23617
23618@subheading Introduction
23619
23620A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
23621
23622@subheading Commands
23623
23624For each command in the block, the following is described:
23625
23626@subsubheading Synopsis
23627
23628@smallexample
23629 -command @var{args}@dots{}
23630@end smallexample
23631
23632@subsubheading Result
23633
23634@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23635
23636The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
23637
23638@subsubheading Example
23639
23640Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
23641not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
23642
23643
23644@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23645@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
23646@section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
23647
23648@cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
23649@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
23650This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
23651breakpoints.
23652
23653@subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
23654@findex -break-after
23655
23656@subsubheading Synopsis
23657
23658@smallexample
23659 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
23660@end smallexample
23661
23662The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
23663hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
23664the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
23665@samp{-break-list} command below.
23666
23667@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23668
23669The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
23670
23671@subsubheading Example
23672
23673@smallexample
23674(gdb)
23675-break-insert main
23676^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
23677enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
23678fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
23679(gdb)
23680-break-after 1 3
23681~
23682^done
23683(gdb)
23684-break-list
23685^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
23686hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
23687@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
23688@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
23689@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
23690@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
23691@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
23692body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
23693addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
23694line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
23695(gdb)
23696@end smallexample
23697
23698@ignore
23699@subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
23700@findex -break-catch
23701@end ignore
23702
23703@subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
23704@findex -break-commands
23705
23706@subsubheading Synopsis
23707
23708@smallexample
23709 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
23710@end smallexample
23711
23712Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
23713@var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
23714are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
23715commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
23716functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
23717some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
23718
23719@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23720
23721The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
23722
23723@subsubheading Example
23724
23725@smallexample
23726(gdb)
23727-break-insert main
23728^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
23729enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
23730fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
23731(gdb)
23732-break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
23733^done
23734(gdb)
23735@end smallexample
23736
23737@subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
23738@findex -break-condition
23739
23740@subsubheading Synopsis
23741
23742@smallexample
23743 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
23744@end smallexample
23745
23746Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
23747@var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
23748@samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
23749command below).
23750
23751@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23752
23753The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
23754
23755@subsubheading Example
23756
23757@smallexample
23758(gdb)
23759-break-condition 1 1
23760^done
23761(gdb)
23762-break-list
23763^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
23764hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
23765@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
23766@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
23767@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
23768@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
23769@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
23770body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
23771addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
23772line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
23773(gdb)
23774@end smallexample
23775
23776@subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
23777@findex -break-delete
23778
23779@subsubheading Synopsis
23780
23781@smallexample
23782 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
23783@end smallexample
23784
23785Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
23786list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
23787
23788@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23789
23790The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
23791
23792@subsubheading Example
23793
23794@smallexample
23795(gdb)
23796-break-delete 1
23797^done
23798(gdb)
23799-break-list
23800^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
23801hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
23802@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
23803@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
23804@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
23805@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
23806@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
23807body=[]@}
23808(gdb)
23809@end smallexample
23810
23811@subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
23812@findex -break-disable
23813
23814@subsubheading Synopsis
23815
23816@smallexample
23817 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
23818@end smallexample
23819
23820Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
23821break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
23822
23823@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23824
23825The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
23826
23827@subsubheading Example
23828
23829@smallexample
23830(gdb)
23831-break-disable 2
23832^done
23833(gdb)
23834-break-list
23835^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
23836hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
23837@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
23838@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
23839@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
23840@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
23841@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
23842body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
23843addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
23844line="5",times="0"@}]@}
23845(gdb)
23846@end smallexample
23847
23848@subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
23849@findex -break-enable
23850
23851@subsubheading Synopsis
23852
23853@smallexample
23854 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
23855@end smallexample
23856
23857Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
23858
23859@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23860
23861The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
23862
23863@subsubheading Example
23864
23865@smallexample
23866(gdb)
23867-break-enable 2
23868^done
23869(gdb)
23870-break-list
23871^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
23872hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
23873@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
23874@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
23875@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
23876@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
23877@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
23878body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
23879addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
23880line="5",times="0"@}]@}
23881(gdb)
23882@end smallexample
23883
23884@subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
23885@findex -break-info
23886
23887@subsubheading Synopsis
23888
23889@smallexample
23890 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
23891@end smallexample
23892
23893@c REDUNDANT???
23894Get information about a single breakpoint.
23895
23896@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23897
23898The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
23899
23900@subsubheading Example
23901N.A.
23902
23903@subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
23904@findex -break-insert
23905
23906@subsubheading Synopsis
23907
23908@smallexample
23909 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
23910 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
23911 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
23912@end smallexample
23913
23914@noindent
23915If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
23916
23917@itemize @bullet
23918@item function
23919@c @item +offset
23920@c @item -offset
23921@c @item linenum
23922@item filename:linenum
23923@item filename:function
23924@item *address
23925@end itemize
23926
23927The possible optional parameters of this command are:
23928
23929@table @samp
23930@item -t
23931Insert a temporary breakpoint.
23932@item -h
23933Insert a hardware breakpoint.
23934@item -c @var{condition}
23935Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
23936@item -i @var{ignore-count}
23937Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
23938@item -f
23939If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
23940refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
23941breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
23942an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
23943cannot be parsed.
23944@item -d
23945Create a disabled breakpoint.
23946@item -a
23947Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
23948is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
23949@end table
23950
23951@subsubheading Result
23952
23953The result is in the form:
23954
23955@smallexample
23956^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
23957enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
23958fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
23959times="@var{times}"@}
23960@end smallexample
23961
23962@noindent
23963where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
23964@var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
23965inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
23966this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
23967and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
23968(always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
23969which use the same output).
23970
23971Note: this format is open to change.
23972@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
23973
23974@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23975
23976The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
23977@samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
23978
23979@subsubheading Example
23980
23981@smallexample
23982(gdb)
23983-break-insert main
23984^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
23985fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
23986(gdb)
23987-break-insert -t foo
23988^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
23989fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
23990(gdb)
23991-break-list
23992^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
23993hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
23994@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
23995@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
23996@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
23997@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
23998@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
23999body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24000addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
24001fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
24002bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
24003addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
24004fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
24005(gdb)
24006-break-insert -r foo.*
24007~int foo(int, int);
24008^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
24009"fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
24010(gdb)
24011@end smallexample
24012
24013@subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
24014@findex -break-list
24015
24016@subsubheading Synopsis
24017
24018@smallexample
24019 -break-list
24020@end smallexample
24021
24022Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
24023
24024@table @samp
24025@item Number
24026number of the breakpoint
24027@item Type
24028type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
24029@item Disposition
24030should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
24031or @samp{nokeep}
24032@item Enabled
24033is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
24034@item Address
24035memory location at which the breakpoint is set
24036@item What
24037logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
24038name, line number
24039@item Times
24040number of times the breakpoint has been hit
24041@end table
24042
24043If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
24044@code{body} field is an empty list.
24045
24046@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24047
24048The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
24049
24050@subsubheading Example
24051
24052@smallexample
24053(gdb)
24054-break-list
24055^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
24056hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
24057@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
24058@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
24059@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
24060@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
24061@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
24062body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24063addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
24064bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24065addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
24066line="13",times="0"@}]@}
24067(gdb)
24068@end smallexample
24069
24070Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
24071
24072@smallexample
24073(gdb)
24074-break-list
24075^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
24076hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
24077@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
24078@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
24079@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
24080@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
24081@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
24082body=[]@}
24083(gdb)
24084@end smallexample
24085
24086@subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
24087@findex -break-passcount
24088
24089@subsubheading Synopsis
24090
24091@smallexample
24092 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
24093@end smallexample
24094
24095Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
24096@var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
24097is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
24098command @samp{passcount}.
24099
24100@subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
24101@findex -break-watch
24102
24103@subsubheading Synopsis
24104
24105@smallexample
24106 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
24107@end smallexample
24108
24109Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
24110@dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
24111read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
24112option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
24113trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
24114either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
24115i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
24116@xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
24117
24118Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
24119breakpoints inserted.
24120
24121@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24122
24123The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
24124@samp{rwatch}.
24125
24126@subsubheading Example
24127
24128Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
24129
24130@smallexample
24131(gdb)
24132-break-watch x
24133^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
24134(gdb)
24135-exec-continue
24136^running
24137(gdb)
24138*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
24139value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
24140frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
24141fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
24142(gdb)
24143@end smallexample
24144
24145Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
24146the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
24147for the watchpoint going out of scope.
24148
24149@smallexample
24150(gdb)
24151-break-watch C
24152^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
24153(gdb)
24154-exec-continue
24155^running
24156(gdb)
24157*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
24158wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
24159frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
24160file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24161fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
24162(gdb)
24163-exec-continue
24164^running
24165(gdb)
24166*stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
24167frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
24168value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
24169file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24170fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
24171(gdb)
24172@end smallexample
24173
24174Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
24175execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
24176deleted.
24177
24178@smallexample
24179(gdb)
24180-break-watch C
24181^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
24182(gdb)
24183-break-list
24184^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
24185hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
24186@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
24187@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
24188@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
24189@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
24190@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
24191body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24192addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
24193file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24194fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
24195bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
24196enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
24197(gdb)
24198-exec-continue
24199^running
24200(gdb)
24201*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
24202value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
24203frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
24204file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24205fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
24206(gdb)
24207-break-list
24208^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
24209hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
24210@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
24211@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
24212@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
24213@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
24214@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
24215body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24216addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
24217file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24218fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
24219bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
24220enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
24221(gdb)
24222-exec-continue
24223^running
24224^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
24225frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
24226value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
24227file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24228fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
24229(gdb)
24230-break-list
24231^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
24232hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
24233@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
24234@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
24235@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
24236@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
24237@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
24238body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24239addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
24240file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24241fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
24242times="1"@}]@}
24243(gdb)
24244@end smallexample
24245
24246@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24247@node GDB/MI Program Context
24248@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
24249
24250@subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
24251@findex -exec-arguments
24252
24253
24254@subsubheading Synopsis
24255
24256@smallexample
24257 -exec-arguments @var{args}
24258@end smallexample
24259
24260Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
24261@samp{-exec-run}.
24262
24263@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24264
24265The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
24266
24267@subsubheading Example
24268
24269@smallexample
24270(gdb)
24271-exec-arguments -v word
24272^done
24273(gdb)
24274@end smallexample
24275
24276
24277@ignore
24278@subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
24279@findex -exec-show-arguments
24280
24281@subsubheading Synopsis
24282
24283@smallexample
24284 -exec-show-arguments
24285@end smallexample
24286
24287Print the arguments of the program.
24288
24289@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24290
24291The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
24292
24293@subsubheading Example
24294N.A.
24295@end ignore
24296
24297
24298@subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
24299@findex -environment-cd
24300
24301@subsubheading Synopsis
24302
24303@smallexample
24304 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
24305@end smallexample
24306
24307Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
24308
24309@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24310
24311The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
24312
24313@subsubheading Example
24314
24315@smallexample
24316(gdb)
24317-environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
24318^done
24319(gdb)
24320@end smallexample
24321
24322
24323@subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
24324@findex -environment-directory
24325
24326@subsubheading Synopsis
24327
24328@smallexample
24329 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
24330@end smallexample
24331
24332Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
24333If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
24334search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
24335@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
24336occurs as normal.
24337Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
24338multiple directories in a single command
24339results in the directories added to the beginning of the
24340search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
24341If blanks are needed as
24342part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
24343the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
24344by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
24345character must not be used
24346in any directory name.
24347If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
24348
24349@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24350
24351The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
24352
24353@subsubheading Example
24354
24355@smallexample
24356(gdb)
24357-environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
24358^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
24359(gdb)
24360-environment-directory ""
24361^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
24362(gdb)
24363-environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
24364^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
24365(gdb)
24366-environment-directory -r
24367^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
24368(gdb)
24369@end smallexample
24370
24371
24372@subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
24373@findex -environment-path
24374
24375@subsubheading Synopsis
24376
24377@smallexample
24378 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
24379@end smallexample
24380
24381Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
24382If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
24383search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
24384supplied in addition to the
24385@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
24386occurs as normal.
24387Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
24388multiple directories in a single command
24389results in the directories added to the beginning of the
24390search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
24391If blanks are needed as
24392part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
24393the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
24394by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
24395character must not be used
24396in any directory name.
24397If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
24398
24399
24400@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24401
24402The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
24403
24404@subsubheading Example
24405
24406@smallexample
24407(gdb)
24408-environment-path
24409^done,path="/usr/bin"
24410(gdb)
24411-environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
24412^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
24413(gdb)
24414-environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
24415^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
24416(gdb)
24417@end smallexample
24418
24419
24420@subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
24421@findex -environment-pwd
24422
24423@subsubheading Synopsis
24424
24425@smallexample
24426 -environment-pwd
24427@end smallexample
24428
24429Show the current working directory.
24430
24431@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24432
24433The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
24434
24435@subsubheading Example
24436
24437@smallexample
24438(gdb)
24439-environment-pwd
24440^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
24441(gdb)
24442@end smallexample
24443
24444@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24445@node GDB/MI Thread Commands
24446@section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
24447
24448
24449@subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
24450@findex -thread-info
24451
24452@subsubheading Synopsis
24453
24454@smallexample
24455 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
24456@end smallexample
24457
24458Reports information about either a specific thread, if
24459the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
24460threads. When printing information about all threads,
24461also reports the current thread.
24462
24463@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24464
24465The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
24466about all threads.
24467
24468@subsubheading Example
24469
24470@smallexample
24471-thread-info
24472^done,threads=[
24473@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
24474 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
24475@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
24476 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
24477 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}],
24478current-thread-id="1"
24479(gdb)
24480@end smallexample
24481
24482The @samp{state} field may have the following values:
24483
24484@table @code
24485@item stopped
24486The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
24487threads.
24488
24489@item running
24490The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
24491threads.
24492
24493@end table
24494
24495@subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
24496@findex -thread-list-ids
24497
24498@subsubheading Synopsis
24499
24500@smallexample
24501 -thread-list-ids
24502@end smallexample
24503
24504Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
24505end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
24506
24507This command is retained for historical reasons, the
24508@code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
24509
24510@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24511
24512Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
24513
24514@subsubheading Example
24515
24516@smallexample
24517(gdb)
24518-thread-list-ids
24519^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
24520current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
24521(gdb)
24522@end smallexample
24523
24524
24525@subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
24526@findex -thread-select
24527
24528@subsubheading Synopsis
24529
24530@smallexample
24531 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
24532@end smallexample
24533
24534Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
24535current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
24536
24537This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
24538@samp{--thread} option to each command.
24539
24540@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24541
24542The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
24543
24544@subsubheading Example
24545
24546@smallexample
24547(gdb)
24548-exec-next
24549^running
24550(gdb)
24551*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
24552file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
24553(gdb)
24554-thread-list-ids
24555^done,
24556thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
24557number-of-threads="3"
24558(gdb)
24559-thread-select 3
24560^done,new-thread-id="3",
24561frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
24562args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
24563@{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
24564(gdb)
24565@end smallexample
24566
24567@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24568@node GDB/MI Program Execution
24569@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
24570
24571These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
24572record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
24573asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
24574other cases.
24575
24576@subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
24577@findex -exec-continue
24578
24579@subsubheading Synopsis
24580
24581@smallexample
24582 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
24583@end smallexample
24584
24585Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
24586to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
24587@samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
24588it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
24589@itemize @bullet
24590@item
24591breakpoints or watchpoints
24592@item
24593signals or exceptions
24594@item
24595the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
24596@item
24597the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
24598@end itemize
24599In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
24600Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
24601value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
24602specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
24603ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
24604specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
24605
24606@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24607
24608The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
24609
24610@subsubheading Example
24611
24612@smallexample
24613-exec-continue
24614^running
24615(gdb)
24616@@Hello world
24617*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
24618func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
24619line="13"@}
24620(gdb)
24621@end smallexample
24622
24623
24624@subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
24625@findex -exec-finish
24626
24627@subsubheading Synopsis
24628
24629@smallexample
24630 -exec-finish [--reverse]
24631@end smallexample
24632
24633Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
24634function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
24635If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
24636execution of the inferior program until the point where current
24637function was called.
24638
24639@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24640
24641The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
24642
24643@subsubheading Example
24644
24645Function returning @code{void}.
24646
24647@smallexample
24648-exec-finish
24649^running
24650(gdb)
24651@@hello from foo
24652*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
24653file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
24654(gdb)
24655@end smallexample
24656
24657Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
24658@value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
24659value itself.
24660
24661@smallexample
24662-exec-finish
24663^running
24664(gdb)
24665*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
24666args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
24667file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
24668gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
24669(gdb)
24670@end smallexample
24671
24672
24673@subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
24674@findex -exec-interrupt
24675
24676@subsubheading Synopsis
24677
24678@smallexample
24679 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
24680@end smallexample
24681
24682Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
24683associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
24684that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
24685appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
24686interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
24687
24688Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
24689asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
24690@samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
24691reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
24692
24693In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
24694All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
24695@samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
24696option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
24697
24698@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24699
24700The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
24701
24702@subsubheading Example
24703
24704@smallexample
24705(gdb)
24706111-exec-continue
24707111^running
24708
24709(gdb)
24710222-exec-interrupt
24711222^done
24712(gdb)
24713111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
24714frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
24715fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
24716(gdb)
24717
24718(gdb)
24719-exec-interrupt
24720^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
24721(gdb)
24722@end smallexample
24723
24724@subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
24725@findex -exec-jump
24726
24727@subsubheading Synopsis
24728
24729@smallexample
24730 -exec-jump @var{location}
24731@end smallexample
24732
24733Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
24734parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
24735different forms of @var{location}.
24736
24737@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24738
24739The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
24740
24741@subsubheading Example
24742
24743@smallexample
24744-exec-jump foo.c:10
24745*running,thread-id="all"
24746^running
24747@end smallexample
24748
24749
24750@subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
24751@findex -exec-next
24752
24753@subsubheading Synopsis
24754
24755@smallexample
24756 -exec-next [--reverse]
24757@end smallexample
24758
24759Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
24760of the next source line is reached.
24761
24762If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
24763of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
24764source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
24765function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
24766source line where the function was called.
24767
24768
24769@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24770
24771The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
24772
24773@subsubheading Example
24774
24775@smallexample
24776-exec-next
24777^running
24778(gdb)
24779*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
24780(gdb)
24781@end smallexample
24782
24783
24784@subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
24785@findex -exec-next-instruction
24786
24787@subsubheading Synopsis
24788
24789@smallexample
24790 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
24791@end smallexample
24792
24793Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
24794call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
24795instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
24796printed as well.
24797
24798If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
24799of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
24800previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
24801it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
24802(from the current stack frame) is reached.
24803
24804@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24805
24806The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
24807
24808@subsubheading Example
24809
24810@smallexample
24811(gdb)
24812-exec-next-instruction
24813^running
24814
24815(gdb)
24816*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
24817addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
24818(gdb)
24819@end smallexample
24820
24821
24822@subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
24823@findex -exec-return
24824
24825@subsubheading Synopsis
24826
24827@smallexample
24828 -exec-return
24829@end smallexample
24830
24831Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
24832Displays the new current frame.
24833
24834@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24835
24836The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
24837
24838@subsubheading Example
24839
24840@smallexample
24841(gdb)
24842200-break-insert callee4
24843200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
24844file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
24845(gdb)
24846000-exec-run
24847000^running
24848(gdb)
24849000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
24850frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
24851file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24852fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
24853(gdb)
24854205-break-delete
24855205^done
24856(gdb)
24857111-exec-return
24858111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
24859args=[@{name="strarg",
24860value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
24861file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
24862fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
24863(gdb)
24864@end smallexample
24865
24866
24867@subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
24868@findex -exec-run
24869
24870@subsubheading Synopsis
24871
24872@smallexample
24873 -exec-run [--all | --thread-group N]
24874@end smallexample
24875
24876Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
24877executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
24878exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
24879the program has exited exceptionally.
24880
24881When no option is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
24882@samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
24883group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
24884If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
24885
24886@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24887
24888The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
24889
24890@subsubheading Examples
24891
24892@smallexample
24893(gdb)
24894-break-insert main
24895^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
24896(gdb)
24897-exec-run
24898^running
24899(gdb)
24900*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
24901frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
24902fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
24903(gdb)
24904@end smallexample
24905
24906@noindent
24907Program exited normally:
24908
24909@smallexample
24910(gdb)
24911-exec-run
24912^running
24913(gdb)
24914x = 55
24915*stopped,reason="exited-normally"
24916(gdb)
24917@end smallexample
24918
24919@noindent
24920Program exited exceptionally:
24921
24922@smallexample
24923(gdb)
24924-exec-run
24925^running
24926(gdb)
24927x = 55
24928*stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
24929(gdb)
24930@end smallexample
24931
24932Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
24933@code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
24934
24935@smallexample
24936(gdb)
24937*stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
24938signal-meaning="Interrupt"
24939@end smallexample
24940
24941
24942@c @subheading -exec-signal
24943
24944
24945@subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
24946@findex -exec-step
24947
24948@subsubheading Synopsis
24949
24950@smallexample
24951 -exec-step [--reverse]
24952@end smallexample
24953
24954Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
24955of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
24956function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
24957function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
24958execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
24959previously executed source line.
24960
24961@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24962
24963The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
24964
24965@subsubheading Example
24966
24967Stepping into a function:
24968
24969@smallexample
24970-exec-step
24971^running
24972(gdb)
24973*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
24974frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
24975@{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
24976fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
24977(gdb)
24978@end smallexample
24979
24980Regular stepping:
24981
24982@smallexample
24983-exec-step
24984^running
24985(gdb)
24986*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
24987(gdb)
24988@end smallexample
24989
24990
24991@subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
24992@findex -exec-step-instruction
24993
24994@subsubheading Synopsis
24995
24996@smallexample
24997 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
24998@end smallexample
24999
25000Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
25001@samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
25002inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
25003The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
25004whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
25005former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
25006as well.
25007
25008@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25009
25010The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
25011
25012@subsubheading Example
25013
25014@smallexample
25015(gdb)
25016-exec-step-instruction
25017^running
25018
25019(gdb)
25020*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
25021frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
25022fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
25023(gdb)
25024-exec-step-instruction
25025^running
25026
25027(gdb)
25028*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
25029frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
25030fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
25031(gdb)
25032@end smallexample
25033
25034
25035@subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
25036@findex -exec-until
25037
25038@subsubheading Synopsis
25039
25040@smallexample
25041 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
25042@end smallexample
25043
25044Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
25045argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
25046until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
25047reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
25048
25049@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25050
25051The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
25052
25053@subsubheading Example
25054
25055@smallexample
25056(gdb)
25057-exec-until recursive2.c:6
25058^running
25059(gdb)
25060x = 55
25061*stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
25062file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
25063(gdb)
25064@end smallexample
25065
25066@ignore
25067@subheading -file-clear
25068Is this going away????
25069@end ignore
25070
25071@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25072@node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
25073@section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
25074
25075
25076@subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
25077@findex -stack-info-frame
25078
25079@subsubheading Synopsis
25080
25081@smallexample
25082 -stack-info-frame
25083@end smallexample
25084
25085Get info on the selected frame.
25086
25087@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25088
25089The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
25090(without arguments).
25091
25092@subsubheading Example
25093
25094@smallexample
25095(gdb)
25096-stack-info-frame
25097^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
25098file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25099fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
25100(gdb)
25101@end smallexample
25102
25103@subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
25104@findex -stack-info-depth
25105
25106@subsubheading Synopsis
25107
25108@smallexample
25109 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
25110@end smallexample
25111
25112Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
25113is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
25114
25115@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25116
25117There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
25118
25119@subsubheading Example
25120
25121For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
25122
25123@smallexample
25124(gdb)
25125-stack-info-depth
25126^done,depth="12"
25127(gdb)
25128-stack-info-depth 4
25129^done,depth="4"
25130(gdb)
25131-stack-info-depth 12
25132^done,depth="12"
25133(gdb)
25134-stack-info-depth 11
25135^done,depth="11"
25136(gdb)
25137-stack-info-depth 13
25138^done,depth="12"
25139(gdb)
25140@end smallexample
25141
25142@subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
25143@findex -stack-list-arguments
25144
25145@subsubheading Synopsis
25146
25147@smallexample
25148 -stack-list-arguments @var{print-values}
25149 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
25150@end smallexample
25151
25152Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
25153and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
25154@var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
25155call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
25156at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
25157larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
25158@var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
25159which case only existing frames will be returned.
25160
25161If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
25162the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
25163values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
25164type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
25165structures and unions.
25166
25167Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
25168deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
25169
25170@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25171
25172@value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
25173@samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
25174functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
25175
25176@subsubheading Example
25177
25178@smallexample
25179(gdb)
25180-stack-list-frames
25181^done,
25182stack=[
25183frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25184file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25185fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
25186frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
25187file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25188fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
25189frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
25190file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25191fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
25192frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
25193file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25194fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
25195frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
25196file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25197fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
25198(gdb)
25199-stack-list-arguments 0
25200^done,
25201stack-args=[
25202frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
25203frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
25204frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
25205frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
25206frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
25207(gdb)
25208-stack-list-arguments 1
25209^done,
25210stack-args=[
25211frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
25212frame=@{level="1",
25213 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
25214frame=@{level="2",args=[
25215@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
25216@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
25217@{frame=@{level="3",args=[
25218@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
25219@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
25220@{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
25221frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
25222(gdb)
25223-stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
25224^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
25225(gdb)
25226-stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
25227^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
25228args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
25229@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
25230(gdb)
25231@end smallexample
25232
25233@c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
25234
25235
25236@subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
25237@findex -stack-list-frames
25238
25239@subsubheading Synopsis
25240
25241@smallexample
25242 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
25243@end smallexample
25244
25245List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
25246following info:
25247
25248@table @samp
25249@item @var{level}
25250The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
25251@item @var{addr}
25252The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
25253@item @var{func}
25254Function name.
25255@item @var{file}
25256File name of the source file where the function lives.
25257@item @var{line}
25258Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
25259@end table
25260
25261If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
25262whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
25263levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
25264are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
25265an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
25266frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
25267actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
25268
25269@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25270
25271The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
25272
25273@subsubheading Example
25274
25275Full stack backtrace:
25276
25277@smallexample
25278(gdb)
25279-stack-list-frames
25280^done,stack=
25281[frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
25282 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
25283frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25284 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25285frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25286 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25287frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25288 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25289frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25290 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25291frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25292 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25293frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25294 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25295frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25296 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25297frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25298 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25299frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25300 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25301frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25302 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25303frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
25304 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
25305(gdb)
25306@end smallexample
25307
25308Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
25309
25310@smallexample
25311(gdb)
25312-stack-list-frames 3 5
25313^done,stack=
25314[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25315 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25316frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25317 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25318frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25319 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
25320(gdb)
25321@end smallexample
25322
25323Show a single frame:
25324
25325@smallexample
25326(gdb)
25327-stack-list-frames 3 3
25328^done,stack=
25329[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
25330 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
25331(gdb)
25332@end smallexample
25333
25334
25335@subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
25336@findex -stack-list-locals
25337
25338@subsubheading Synopsis
25339
25340@smallexample
25341 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
25342@end smallexample
25343
25344Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
25345@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
25346the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
25347values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
25348type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
25349structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
25350display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
25351other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
25352more detail.
25353
25354This command is deprecated in favor of the
25355@samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
25356
25357@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25358
25359@samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
25360
25361@subsubheading Example
25362
25363@smallexample
25364(gdb)
25365-stack-list-locals 0
25366^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
25367(gdb)
25368-stack-list-locals --all-values
25369^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
25370 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
25371-stack-list-locals --simple-values
25372^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
25373 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
25374(gdb)
25375@end smallexample
25376
25377@subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
25378@findex -stack-list-variables
25379
25380@subsubheading Synopsis
25381
25382@smallexample
25383 -stack-list-variables @var{print-values}
25384@end smallexample
25385
25386Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
25387@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
25388the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
25389values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
25390type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
25391structures and unions.
25392
25393@subsubheading Example
25394
25395@smallexample
25396(gdb)
25397-stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
25398^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
25399(gdb)
25400@end smallexample
25401
25402
25403@subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
25404@findex -stack-select-frame
25405
25406@subsubheading Synopsis
25407
25408@smallexample
25409 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
25410@end smallexample
25411
25412Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
25413the stack.
25414
25415This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
25416option to every command.
25417
25418@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25419
25420The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
25421@samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
25422
25423@subsubheading Example
25424
25425@smallexample
25426(gdb)
25427-stack-select-frame 2
25428^done
25429(gdb)
25430@end smallexample
25431
25432@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25433@node GDB/MI Variable Objects
25434@section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
25435
25436@ignore
25437
25438@subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
25439
25440For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
25441expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
25442used by @code{Insight}.
25443
25444The two main reasons for that are:
25445
25446@enumerate 1
25447@item
25448It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
25449
25450@item
25451It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
25452now).
25453@end enumerate
25454
25455The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
25456slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
25457describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
25458hints about their use.
25459
25460@emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
25461expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
25462least, the following operations:
25463
25464@itemize @bullet
25465@item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
25466@item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
25467@item @code{-stack-list-locals}
25468@item @code{-stack-select-frame}
25469@end itemize
25470
25471@end ignore
25472
25473@subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
25474
25475@cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
25476
25477Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
25478changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
25479work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
25480simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
25481is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
25482frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
25483expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
25484expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
25485variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
25486operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
25487object, or to change display format.
25488
25489Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
25490that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
25491a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
25492element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
25493children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
25494leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
25495objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
25496is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
25497child will be created.
25498
25499For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
25500string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
25501obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
25502that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
25503contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
25504
25505A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
25506the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
25507variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
25508operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
25509be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
25510objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
25511real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
25512variables that frontend has created.
25513
25514The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
25515might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
25516and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
25517relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
25518to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
25519visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
25520called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
25521implicitly updated.
25522
25523Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
25524fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
25525object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
25526variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
25527variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
25528expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
25529frame. Consider this example:
25530
25531@smallexample
25532void do_work(...)
25533@{
25534 struct work_state state;
25535
25536 if (...)
25537 do_work(...);
25538@}
25539@end smallexample
25540
25541If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
25542this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable
25543object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
25544@code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
25545object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
25546
25547If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
25548refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
25549thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
25550variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
25551thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
25552and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
25553
25554The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
25555access this functionality:
25556
25557@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
25558@item @strong{Operation}
25559@tab @strong{Description}
25560
25561@item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
25562@tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
25563@item @code{-var-create}
25564@tab create a variable object
25565@item @code{-var-delete}
25566@tab delete the variable object and/or its children
25567@item @code{-var-set-format}
25568@tab set the display format of this variable
25569@item @code{-var-show-format}
25570@tab show the display format of this variable
25571@item @code{-var-info-num-children}
25572@tab tells how many children this object has
25573@item @code{-var-list-children}
25574@tab return a list of the object's children
25575@item @code{-var-info-type}
25576@tab show the type of this variable object
25577@item @code{-var-info-expression}
25578@tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
25579@item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
25580@tab print full expression that this variable object represents
25581@item @code{-var-show-attributes}
25582@tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
25583@item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
25584@tab get the value of this variable
25585@item @code{-var-assign}
25586@tab set the value of this variable
25587@item @code{-var-update}
25588@tab update the variable and its children
25589@item @code{-var-set-frozen}
25590@tab set frozeness attribute
25591@item @code{-var-set-update-range}
25592@tab set range of children to display on update
25593@end multitable
25594
25595In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
25596how it can be used.
25597
25598@subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
25599
25600@subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
25601@findex -enable-pretty-printing
25602
25603@smallexample
25604-enable-pretty-printing
25605@end smallexample
25606
25607@value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
25608MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
25609implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
25610request that this functionality be enabled.
25611
25612Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
25613
25614Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
25615this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
25616
25617This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
25618may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
25619
25620@subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
25621@findex -var-create
25622
25623@subsubheading Synopsis
25624
25625@smallexample
25626 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
25627 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
25628@end smallexample
25629
25630This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
25631a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
25632register.
25633
25634The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
25635referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
25636system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
25637unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
25638The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
25639
25640The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
25641specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
25642frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
25643object must be created.
25644
25645@var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
25646begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
25647
25648@itemize @bullet
25649@item
25650@samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
25651
25652@item
25653@samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
25654
25655@item
25656@samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
25657@end itemize
25658
25659@cindex dynamic varobj
25660A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
25661case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
25662have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
25663@code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
25664will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
25665compatibility for existing clients.
25666
25667@subsubheading Result
25668
25669This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
25670are:
25671
25672@table @samp
25673@item name
25674The name of the varobj.
25675
25676@item numchild
25677The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
25678reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
25679@samp{has_more} attribute.
25680
25681@item value
25682The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
25683aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
25684will not be interesting.
25685
25686@item type
25687The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
25688would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI.
25689
25690@item thread-id
25691If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
25692thread's identifier.
25693
25694@item has_more
25695For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
25696children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
25697
25698@item dynamic
25699This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
25700varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
25701then this attribute will not be present.
25702
25703@item displayhint
25704A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
25705value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
25706@code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
25707@end table
25708
25709Typical output will look like this:
25710
25711@smallexample
25712 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
25713 has_more="@var{has_more}"
25714@end smallexample
25715
25716
25717@subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
25718@findex -var-delete
25719
25720@subsubheading Synopsis
25721
25722@smallexample
25723 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
25724@end smallexample
25725
25726Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
25727With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
25728
25729Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
25730
25731
25732@subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
25733@findex -var-set-format
25734
25735@subsubheading Synopsis
25736
25737@smallexample
25738 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
25739@end smallexample
25740
25741Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
25742@var{format-spec}.
25743
25744@anchor{-var-set-format}
25745The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
25746
25747@smallexample
25748 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
25749 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
25750@end smallexample
25751
25752The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
25753based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
25754for pointers, etc.).
25755
25756For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
25757variable itself, and the children are not affected.
25758
25759@subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
25760@findex -var-show-format
25761
25762@subsubheading Synopsis
25763
25764@smallexample
25765 -var-show-format @var{name}
25766@end smallexample
25767
25768Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
25769
25770@smallexample
25771 @var{format} @expansion{}
25772 @var{format-spec}
25773@end smallexample
25774
25775
25776@subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
25777@findex -var-info-num-children
25778
25779@subsubheading Synopsis
25780
25781@smallexample
25782 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
25783@end smallexample
25784
25785Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
25786
25787@smallexample
25788 numchild=@var{n}
25789@end smallexample
25790
25791Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
25792It will return the current number of children, but more children may
25793be available.
25794
25795
25796@subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
25797@findex -var-list-children
25798
25799@subsubheading Synopsis
25800
25801@smallexample
25802 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
25803@end smallexample
25804@anchor{-var-list-children}
25805
25806Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
25807create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
25808a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
25809@code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
25810@var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
25811values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
25812value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
25813and unions.
25814
25815@var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
25816to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
25817reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
25818at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
25819reported.
25820
25821If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
25822@code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
25823For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
25824intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
25825update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
25826front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
25827then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
25828different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
25829the visible items.
25830
25831For each child the following results are returned:
25832
25833@table @var
25834
25835@item name
25836Name of the variable object created for this child.
25837
25838@item exp
25839The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
25840For example this may be the name of a structure member.
25841
25842For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
25843expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
25844
25845For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
25846designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
25847@samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
25848type and value are not present.
25849
25850A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
25851pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
25852available at all with a dynamic varobj.
25853
25854@item numchild
25855Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
258560.
25857
25858@item type
25859The type of the child.
25860
25861@item value
25862If values were requested, this is the value.
25863
25864@item thread-id
25865If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
25866Otherwise this result is not present.
25867
25868@item frozen
25869If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
25870@end table
25871
25872The result may have its own attributes:
25873
25874@table @samp
25875@item displayhint
25876A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
25877value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
25878@code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
25879
25880@item has_more
25881This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
25882remaining after the end of the selected range.
25883@end table
25884
25885@subsubheading Example
25886
25887@smallexample
25888(gdb)
25889 -var-list-children n
25890 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
25891 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
25892(gdb)
25893 -var-list-children --all-values n
25894 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
25895 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
25896@end smallexample
25897
25898
25899@subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
25900@findex -var-info-type
25901
25902@subsubheading Synopsis
25903
25904@smallexample
25905 -var-info-type @var{name}
25906@end smallexample
25907
25908Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
25909returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
25910@value{GDBN} CLI:
25911
25912@smallexample
25913 type=@var{typename}
25914@end smallexample
25915
25916
25917@subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
25918@findex -var-info-expression
25919
25920@subsubheading Synopsis
25921
25922@smallexample
25923 -var-info-expression @var{name}
25924@end smallexample
25925
25926Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
25927variable object in user interface. The string is generally
25928not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
25929
25930For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
25931@code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
25932
25933@smallexample
25934(gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
25935^done,lang="C",exp="1"
25936@end smallexample
25937
25938@noindent
25939Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
25940
25941Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
25942includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
25943is of limited use.
25944
25945@subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
25946@findex -var-info-path-expression
25947
25948@subsubheading Synopsis
25949
25950@smallexample
25951 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
25952@end smallexample
25953
25954Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
25955context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
25956Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
25957result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
25958the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
25959watchpoint from a variable object.
25960
25961This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
25962and will give an error when invoked on one.
25963
25964For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
25965@code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
25966@code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
25967@code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
25968@code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
25969@smallexample
25970(gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
25971^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
25972@end smallexample
25973
25974@subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
25975@findex -var-show-attributes
25976
25977@subsubheading Synopsis
25978
25979@smallexample
25980 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
25981@end smallexample
25982
25983List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
25984
25985@smallexample
25986 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
25987@end smallexample
25988
25989@noindent
25990where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
25991
25992@subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
25993@findex -var-evaluate-expression
25994
25995@subsubheading Synopsis
25996
25997@smallexample
25998 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
25999@end smallexample
26000
26001Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
26002object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
26003can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
26004this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
26005(@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
26006the current display format will be used. The current display format
26007can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
26008
26009@smallexample
26010 value=@var{value}
26011@end smallexample
26012
26013Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
26014before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
26015
26016@subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
26017@findex -var-assign
26018
26019@subsubheading Synopsis
26020
26021@smallexample
26022 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
26023@end smallexample
26024
26025Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
26026by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
26027value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
26028subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
26029
26030@subsubheading Example
26031
26032@smallexample
26033(gdb)
26034-var-assign var1 3
26035^done,value="3"
26036(gdb)
26037-var-update *
26038^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
26039(gdb)
26040@end smallexample
26041
26042@subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
26043@findex -var-update
26044
26045@subsubheading Synopsis
26046
26047@smallexample
26048 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
26049@end smallexample
26050
26051Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
26052@var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
26053list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
26054be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
26055@code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
26056@code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
26057object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
26058for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
26059@var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
26060names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
26061as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
26062recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
26063number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
26064
26065With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
26066currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
26067diagnostic.
26068
26069If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
26070only the selected range of children will be reported.
26071
26072@code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
26073@samp{changelist}.
26074
26075Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
26076
26077@table @samp
26078@item name
26079The name of the varobj.
26080
26081@item value
26082If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
26083present and will hold the value of the varobj.
26084
26085@item in_scope
26086@anchor{-var-update}
26087This field is a string which may take one of three values:
26088
26089@table @code
26090@item "true"
26091The variable object's current value is valid.
26092
26093@item "false"
26094The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
26095hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
26096scope.
26097
26098@item "invalid"
26099The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
26100This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
26101either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
26102command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
26103objects.
26104@end table
26105
26106In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
26107be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
26108
26109@item type_changed
26110This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
26111changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
26112be @samp{false}.
26113
26114@item new_type
26115If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
26116hold the new type.
26117
26118@item new_num_children
26119For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
26120type changed, this will be the new number of children.
26121
26122The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
26123valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
26124@value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
26125instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
26126children which may be available.
26127
26128The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
26129number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
26130detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
26131only happen at the end of the update range).
26132
26133@item displayhint
26134The display hint, if any.
26135
26136@item has_more
26137This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
26138available outside the varobj's update range.
26139
26140@item dynamic
26141This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
26142varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
26143then this attribute will not be present.
26144
26145@item new_children
26146If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
26147update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
26148be listed in this attribute.
26149@end table
26150
26151@subsubheading Example
26152
26153@smallexample
26154(gdb)
26155-var-assign var1 3
26156^done,value="3"
26157(gdb)
26158-var-update --all-values var1
26159^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
26160type_changed="false"@}]
26161(gdb)
26162@end smallexample
26163
26164@subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
26165@findex -var-set-frozen
26166@anchor{-var-set-frozen}
26167
26168@subsubheading Synopsis
26169
26170@smallexample
26171 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
26172@end smallexample
26173
26174Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
26175@var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
26176frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
26177frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
26178implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
26179a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
26180@code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
26181values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
26182implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
26183Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
26184@code{-var-update} does.
26185
26186@subsubheading Example
26187
26188@smallexample
26189(gdb)
26190-var-set-frozen V 1
26191^done
26192(gdb)
26193@end smallexample
26194
26195@subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
26196@findex -var-set-update-range
26197@anchor{-var-set-update-range}
26198
26199@subsubheading Synopsis
26200
26201@smallexample
26202 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
26203@end smallexample
26204
26205Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
26206@code{-var-update}.
26207
26208@var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
26209@var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
26210children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
26211(zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
26212
26213@subsubheading Example
26214
26215@smallexample
26216(gdb)
26217-var-set-update-range V 1 2
26218^done
26219@end smallexample
26220
26221@subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
26222@findex -var-set-visualizer
26223@anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
26224
26225@subsubheading Synopsis
26226
26227@smallexample
26228 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
26229@end smallexample
26230
26231Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
26232
26233@var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
26234@samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
26235
26236If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
26237This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
26238single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
26239the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
26240Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
26241When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
26242pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
26243
26244The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
26245select a visualizer by following the built-in process
26246(@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
26247a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
26248
26249This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
26250command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands})
26251can be used to check this.
26252
26253@subsubheading Example
26254
26255Resetting the visualizer:
26256
26257@smallexample
26258(gdb)
26259-var-set-visualizer V None
26260^done
26261@end smallexample
26262
26263Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
26264
26265@smallexample
26266(gdb)
26267-var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
26268^done
26269@end smallexample
26270
26271Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
26272can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
26273
26274@smallexample
26275(gdb)
26276-var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
26277^done
26278@end smallexample
26279
26280@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26281@node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
26282@section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
26283
26284@cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
26285@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
26286This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
26287examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
26288
26289@c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
26290@c @subheading -data-assign
26291@c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
26292@c @subsubheading GDB Command
26293@c set variable
26294@c @subsubheading Example
26295@c N.A.
26296
26297@subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
26298@findex -data-disassemble
26299
26300@subsubheading Synopsis
26301
26302@smallexample
26303 -data-disassemble
26304 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
26305 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
26306 -- @var{mode}
26307@end smallexample
26308
26309@noindent
26310Where:
26311
26312@table @samp
26313@item @var{start-addr}
26314is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
26315@item @var{end-addr}
26316is the end address
26317@item @var{filename}
26318is the name of the file to disassemble
26319@item @var{linenum}
26320is the line number to disassemble around
26321@item @var{lines}
26322is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
26323the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
26324specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
26325@var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
26326@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
26327displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
26328@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
26329are displayed.
26330@item @var{mode}
26331is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
26332disassembly).
26333@end table
26334
26335@subsubheading Result
26336
26337The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
26338
26339@itemize @bullet
26340@item Address
26341@item Func-name
26342@item Offset
26343@item Instruction
26344@end itemize
26345
26346Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
26347directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
26348
26349@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26350
26351There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
26352
26353@subsubheading Example
26354
26355Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
26356
26357@smallexample
26358(gdb)
26359-data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
26360^done,
26361asm_insns=[
26362@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
26363inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
26364@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
26365inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
26366@{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
26367inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
26368@{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
26369inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
26370@{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
26371inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
26372(gdb)
26373@end smallexample
26374
26375Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
26376@code{main}.
26377
26378@smallexample
26379-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
26380^done,asm_insns=[
26381@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
26382inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
26383@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
26384inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
26385@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
26386inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
26387[@dots{}]
26388@{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
26389@{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
26390(gdb)
26391@end smallexample
26392
26393Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
26394
26395@smallexample
26396(gdb)
26397-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
26398^done,asm_insns=[
26399@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
26400inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
26401@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
26402inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
26403@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
26404inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
26405(gdb)
26406@end smallexample
26407
26408Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
26409
26410@smallexample
26411(gdb)
26412-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
26413^done,asm_insns=[
26414src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
26415file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
26416 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
26417@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
26418inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
26419src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
26420file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
26421 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
26422@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
26423inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
26424@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
26425inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
26426(gdb)
26427@end smallexample
26428
26429
26430@subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
26431@findex -data-evaluate-expression
26432
26433@subsubheading Synopsis
26434
26435@smallexample
26436 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
26437@end smallexample
26438
26439Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
26440inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
26441If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
26442
26443@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26444
26445The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
26446@samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
26447@samp{gdb_eval} command.
26448
26449@subsubheading Example
26450
26451In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
26452@dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
26453Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
26454output.
26455
26456@smallexample
26457211-data-evaluate-expression A
26458211^done,value="1"
26459(gdb)
26460311-data-evaluate-expression &A
26461311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
26462(gdb)
26463411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
26464411^done,value="4"
26465(gdb)
26466511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
26467511^done,value="4"
26468(gdb)
26469@end smallexample
26470
26471
26472@subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
26473@findex -data-list-changed-registers
26474
26475@subsubheading Synopsis
26476
26477@smallexample
26478 -data-list-changed-registers
26479@end smallexample
26480
26481Display a list of the registers that have changed.
26482
26483@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26484
26485@value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
26486has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
26487
26488@subsubheading Example
26489
26490On a PPC MBX board:
26491
26492@smallexample
26493(gdb)
26494-exec-continue
26495^running
26496
26497(gdb)
26498*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
26499func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
26500line="5"@}
26501(gdb)
26502-data-list-changed-registers
26503^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
26504"10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
26505"24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
26506(gdb)
26507@end smallexample
26508
26509
26510@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
26511@findex -data-list-register-names
26512
26513@subsubheading Synopsis
26514
26515@smallexample
26516 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
26517@end smallexample
26518
26519Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
26520are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
26521integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
26522names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
26523consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
26524include empty register names.
26525
26526@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26527
26528@value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
26529@samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
26530corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
26531
26532@subsubheading Example
26533
26534For the PPC MBX board:
26535@smallexample
26536(gdb)
26537-data-list-register-names
26538^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
26539"r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
26540"r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
26541"r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
26542"f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
26543"f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
26544"", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
26545(gdb)
26546-data-list-register-names 1 2 3
26547^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
26548(gdb)
26549@end smallexample
26550
26551@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
26552@findex -data-list-register-values
26553
26554@subsubheading Synopsis
26555
26556@smallexample
26557 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
26558@end smallexample
26559
26560Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
26561which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
26562list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
26563numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
26564
26565Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
26566
26567@table @code
26568@item x
26569Hexadecimal
26570@item o
26571Octal
26572@item t
26573Binary
26574@item d
26575Decimal
26576@item r
26577Raw
26578@item N
26579Natural
26580@end table
26581
26582@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26583
26584The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
26585all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
26586
26587@subsubheading Example
26588
26589For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
26590don't appear in the actual output):
26591
26592@smallexample
26593(gdb)
26594-data-list-register-values r 64 65
26595^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
26596@{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
26597(gdb)
26598-data-list-register-values x
26599^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
26600@{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
26601@{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
26602@{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
26603@{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
26604@{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
26605@{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
26606@{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
26607@{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
26608@{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
26609@{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
26610@{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
26611@{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
26612@{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
26613@{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
26614@{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
26615@{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
26616@{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
26617@{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
26618@{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
26619@{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
26620@{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
26621@{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
26622@{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
26623@{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
26624@{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
26625@{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
26626@{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
26627@{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
26628@{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
26629@{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
26630@{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
26631@{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
26632@{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
26633@{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
26634@{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
26635(gdb)
26636@end smallexample
26637
26638
26639@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
26640@findex -data-read-memory
26641
26642@subsubheading Synopsis
26643
26644@smallexample
26645 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
26646 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
26647 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
26648@end smallexample
26649
26650@noindent
26651where:
26652
26653@table @samp
26654@item @var{address}
26655An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
26656read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
26657quoted using the C convention.
26658
26659@item @var{word-format}
26660The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
26661same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
26662,Output Formats}).
26663
26664@item @var{word-size}
26665The size of each memory word in bytes.
26666
26667@item @var{nr-rows}
26668The number of rows in the output table.
26669
26670@item @var{nr-cols}
26671The number of columns in the output table.
26672
26673@item @var{aschar}
26674If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
26675value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
26676member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
26677characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
26678
26679@item @var{byte-offset}
26680An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
26681@end table
26682
26683This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
26684@var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
26685@code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
26686(returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
26687of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
26688using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
26689in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
26690@samp{addr}.
26691
26692The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
26693@samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
26694@samp{prev-page}.
26695
26696@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26697
26698The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
26699@samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
26700
26701@subsubheading Example
26702
26703Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
26704@code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
26705word. Display each word in hex.
26706
26707@smallexample
26708(gdb)
267099-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
267109^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
26711next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
26712prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
26713@{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
26714@{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
26715@{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
26716(gdb)
26717@end smallexample
26718
26719Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
26720display as a single word formatted in decimal.
26721
26722@smallexample
26723(gdb)
267245-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
267255^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
26726next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
26727next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
26728@{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
26729(gdb)
26730@end smallexample
26731
26732Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
26733as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
26734used as the non-printable character.
26735
26736@smallexample
26737(gdb)
267384-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
267394^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
26740next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
26741next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
26742@{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
26743@{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
26744@{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
26745@{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
26746@{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
26747@{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
26748@{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
26749@{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
26750(gdb)
26751@end smallexample
26752
26753@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26754@node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
26755@section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
26756
26757The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
26758tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
26759
26760@subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
26761@findex -trace-find
26762
26763@subsubheading Synopsis
26764
26765@smallexample
26766 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
26767@end smallexample
26768
26769Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
26770@var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
26771modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
26772
26773@table @samp
26774
26775@item none
26776No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
26777
26778@item frame-number
26779An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
26780that index.
26781
26782@item tracepoint-number
26783An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
26784trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
26785
26786@item pc
26787An address is required as parameter. Finds
26788next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
26789address.
26790
26791@item pc-inside-range
26792Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
26793frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
26794specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
26795
26796@item pc-outside-range
26797Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
26798next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
26799the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
26800
26801@item line
26802Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
26803Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
26804the specified location.
26805
26806@end table
26807
26808If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
26809have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
26810
26811@table @samp
26812@item found
26813This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
26814on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
26815
26816@item traceframe
26817The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
26818the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
26819
26820@item tracepoint
26821The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
26822the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
26823
26824@item frame
26825The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
26826frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
26827@xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
26828
26829@end table
26830
26831@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26832
26833The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
26834
26835@subheading -trace-define-variable
26836@findex -trace-define-variable
26837
26838@subsubheading Synopsis
26839
26840@smallexample
26841 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
26842@end smallexample
26843
26844Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
26845@var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
26846trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
26847with the @samp{$} character.
26848
26849@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26850
26851The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
26852
26853@subheading -trace-list-variables
26854@findex -trace-list-variables
26855
26856@subsubheading Synopsis
26857
26858@smallexample
26859 -trace-list-variables
26860@end smallexample
26861
26862Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
26863table has the following fields:
26864
26865@table @samp
26866@item name
26867The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
26868
26869@item initial
26870The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
26871field is always present.
26872
26873@item current
26874The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
26875signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
26876not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
26877presently running.
26878
26879@end table
26880
26881@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26882
26883The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
26884
26885@subsubheading Example
26886
26887@smallexample
26888(gdb)
26889-trace-list-variables
26890^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
26891hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
26892 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
26893 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
26894body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
26895 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
26896(gdb)
26897@end smallexample
26898
26899@subheading -trace-save
26900@findex -trace-save
26901
26902@subsubheading Synopsis
26903
26904@smallexample
26905 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
26906@end smallexample
26907
26908Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
26909@samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
26910in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
26911to perform the save.
26912
26913@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26914
26915The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
26916
26917
26918@subheading -trace-start
26919@findex -trace-start
26920
26921@subsubheading Synopsis
26922
26923@smallexample
26924 -trace-start
26925@end smallexample
26926
26927Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
26928have any fields.
26929
26930@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26931
26932The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
26933
26934@subheading -trace-status
26935@findex -trace-status
26936
26937@subsubheading Synopsis
26938
26939@smallexample
26940 -trace-status
26941@end smallexample
26942
26943Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
26944the following fields:
26945
26946@table @samp
26947
26948@item supported
26949May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
26950supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
26951@samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
26952of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
26953started. This field is always present.
26954
26955@item running
26956May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
26957tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
26958if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
26959
26960@item stop-reason
26961Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
26962may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
26963value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
26964the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
26965the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
26966tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
26967The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
26968tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
26969This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
26970
26971@item stopping-tracepoint
26972The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
26973present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
26974@samp{passcount}.
26975
26976@item frames
26977@itemx frames-created
26978The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
26979in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
26980during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
26981circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
26982
26983@item buffer-size
26984@itemx buffer-free
26985These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
26986remaining space. These fields are optional.
26987
26988@item circular
26989The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
26990trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
26991necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
26992and may fill up.
26993
26994@item disconnected
26995The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
26996tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
26997that the trace run will stop.
26998
26999@end table
27000
27001@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27002
27003The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
27004
27005@subheading -trace-stop
27006@findex -trace-stop
27007
27008@subsubheading Synopsis
27009
27010@smallexample
27011 -trace-stop
27012@end smallexample
27013
27014Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
27015fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
27016@samp{running} fields are not output.
27017
27018@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27019
27020The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
27021
27022
27023@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27024@node GDB/MI Symbol Query
27025@section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
27026
27027
27028@ignore
27029@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
27030@findex -symbol-info-address
27031
27032@subsubheading Synopsis
27033
27034@smallexample
27035 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
27036@end smallexample
27037
27038Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
27039
27040@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27041
27042The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
27043
27044@subsubheading Example
27045N.A.
27046
27047
27048@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
27049@findex -symbol-info-file
27050
27051@subsubheading Synopsis
27052
27053@smallexample
27054 -symbol-info-file
27055@end smallexample
27056
27057Show the file for the symbol.
27058
27059@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27060
27061There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
27062@samp{gdb_find_file}.
27063
27064@subsubheading Example
27065N.A.
27066
27067
27068@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
27069@findex -symbol-info-function
27070
27071@subsubheading Synopsis
27072
27073@smallexample
27074 -symbol-info-function
27075@end smallexample
27076
27077Show which function the symbol lives in.
27078
27079@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27080
27081@samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
27082
27083@subsubheading Example
27084N.A.
27085
27086
27087@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
27088@findex -symbol-info-line
27089
27090@subsubheading Synopsis
27091
27092@smallexample
27093 -symbol-info-line
27094@end smallexample
27095
27096Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
27097
27098@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27099
27100The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
27101@code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
27102
27103@subsubheading Example
27104N.A.
27105
27106
27107@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
27108@findex -symbol-info-symbol
27109
27110@subsubheading Synopsis
27111
27112@smallexample
27113 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
27114@end smallexample
27115
27116Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
27117
27118@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27119
27120The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
27121
27122@subsubheading Example
27123N.A.
27124
27125
27126@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
27127@findex -symbol-list-functions
27128
27129@subsubheading Synopsis
27130
27131@smallexample
27132 -symbol-list-functions
27133@end smallexample
27134
27135List the functions in the executable.
27136
27137@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27138
27139@samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
27140@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
27141
27142@subsubheading Example
27143N.A.
27144@end ignore
27145
27146
27147@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
27148@findex -symbol-list-lines
27149
27150@subsubheading Synopsis
27151
27152@smallexample
27153 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
27154@end smallexample
27155
27156Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
27157addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
27158ascending PC order.
27159
27160@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27161
27162There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
27163
27164@subsubheading Example
27165@smallexample
27166(gdb)
27167-symbol-list-lines basics.c
27168^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
27169(gdb)
27170@end smallexample
27171
27172
27173@ignore
27174@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
27175@findex -symbol-list-types
27176
27177@subsubheading Synopsis
27178
27179@smallexample
27180 -symbol-list-types
27181@end smallexample
27182
27183List all the type names.
27184
27185@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27186
27187The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
27188@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
27189
27190@subsubheading Example
27191N.A.
27192
27193
27194@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
27195@findex -symbol-list-variables
27196
27197@subsubheading Synopsis
27198
27199@smallexample
27200 -symbol-list-variables
27201@end smallexample
27202
27203List all the global and static variable names.
27204
27205@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27206
27207@samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
27208
27209@subsubheading Example
27210N.A.
27211
27212
27213@subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
27214@findex -symbol-locate
27215
27216@subsubheading Synopsis
27217
27218@smallexample
27219 -symbol-locate
27220@end smallexample
27221
27222@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27223
27224@samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
27225
27226@subsubheading Example
27227N.A.
27228
27229
27230@subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
27231@findex -symbol-type
27232
27233@subsubheading Synopsis
27234
27235@smallexample
27236 -symbol-type @var{variable}
27237@end smallexample
27238
27239Show type of @var{variable}.
27240
27241@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27242
27243The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
27244@samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
27245
27246@subsubheading Example
27247N.A.
27248@end ignore
27249
27250
27251@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27252@node GDB/MI File Commands
27253@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
27254
27255This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
27256and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
27257
27258@subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
27259@findex -file-exec-and-symbols
27260
27261@subsubheading Synopsis
27262
27263@smallexample
27264 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
27265@end smallexample
27266
27267Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
27268which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
27269command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
27270are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
27271error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
27272notification.
27273
27274@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27275
27276The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
27277
27278@subsubheading Example
27279
27280@smallexample
27281(gdb)
27282-file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
27283^done
27284(gdb)
27285@end smallexample
27286
27287
27288@subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
27289@findex -file-exec-file
27290
27291@subsubheading Synopsis
27292
27293@smallexample
27294 -file-exec-file @var{file}
27295@end smallexample
27296
27297Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
27298@samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
27299from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
27300about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
27301notification.
27302
27303@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27304
27305The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
27306
27307@subsubheading Example
27308
27309@smallexample
27310(gdb)
27311-file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
27312^done
27313(gdb)
27314@end smallexample
27315
27316
27317@ignore
27318@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
27319@findex -file-list-exec-sections
27320
27321@subsubheading Synopsis
27322
27323@smallexample
27324 -file-list-exec-sections
27325@end smallexample
27326
27327List the sections of the current executable file.
27328
27329@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27330
27331The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
27332information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
27333@samp{gdb_load_info}.
27334
27335@subsubheading Example
27336N.A.
27337@end ignore
27338
27339
27340@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
27341@findex -file-list-exec-source-file
27342
27343@subsubheading Synopsis
27344
27345@smallexample
27346 -file-list-exec-source-file
27347@end smallexample
27348
27349List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
27350to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
27351information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
27352whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
27353
27354@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27355
27356The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
27357
27358@subsubheading Example
27359
27360@smallexample
27361(gdb)
27362123-file-list-exec-source-file
27363123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
27364(gdb)
27365@end smallexample
27366
27367
27368@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
27369@findex -file-list-exec-source-files
27370
27371@subsubheading Synopsis
27372
27373@smallexample
27374 -file-list-exec-source-files
27375@end smallexample
27376
27377List the source files for the current executable.
27378
27379It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
27380the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
27381
27382@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27383
27384The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
27385@code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
27386
27387@subsubheading Example
27388@smallexample
27389(gdb)
27390-file-list-exec-source-files
27391^done,files=[
27392@{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
27393@{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
27394@{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
27395(gdb)
27396@end smallexample
27397
27398@ignore
27399@subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
27400@findex -file-list-shared-libraries
27401
27402@subsubheading Synopsis
27403
27404@smallexample
27405 -file-list-shared-libraries
27406@end smallexample
27407
27408List the shared libraries in the program.
27409
27410@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27411
27412The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
27413
27414@subsubheading Example
27415N.A.
27416
27417
27418@subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
27419@findex -file-list-symbol-files
27420
27421@subsubheading Synopsis
27422
27423@smallexample
27424 -file-list-symbol-files
27425@end smallexample
27426
27427List symbol files.
27428
27429@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27430
27431The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
27432
27433@subsubheading Example
27434N.A.
27435@end ignore
27436
27437
27438@subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
27439@findex -file-symbol-file
27440
27441@subsubheading Synopsis
27442
27443@smallexample
27444 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
27445@end smallexample
27446
27447Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
27448used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
27449produced, except for a completion notification.
27450
27451@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27452
27453The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
27454
27455@subsubheading Example
27456
27457@smallexample
27458(gdb)
27459-file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
27460^done
27461(gdb)
27462@end smallexample
27463
27464@ignore
27465@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27466@node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
27467@section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
27468
27469The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
27470
27471@c @subheading -overlay-auto
27472
27473@c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
27474
27475@c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
27476
27477@c @subheading -overlay-map
27478
27479@c @subheading -overlay-off
27480
27481@c @subheading -overlay-on
27482
27483@c @subheading -overlay-unmap
27484
27485@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27486@node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
27487@section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
27488
27489Signal handling commands are not implemented.
27490
27491@c @subheading -signal-handle
27492
27493@c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
27494
27495@c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
27496@end ignore
27497
27498
27499@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27500@node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
27501@section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
27502
27503
27504@subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
27505@findex -target-attach
27506
27507@subsubheading Synopsis
27508
27509@smallexample
27510 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
27511@end smallexample
27512
27513Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
27514@value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
27515group, the id previously returned by
27516@samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
27517
27518@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27519
27520The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
27521
27522@subsubheading Example
27523@smallexample
27524(gdb)
27525-target-attach 34
27526=thread-created,id="1"
27527*stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
27528^done
27529(gdb)
27530@end smallexample
27531
27532@ignore
27533@subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
27534@findex -target-compare-sections
27535
27536@subsubheading Synopsis
27537
27538@smallexample
27539 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
27540@end smallexample
27541
27542Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
27543Without the argument, all sections are compared.
27544
27545@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27546
27547The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
27548
27549@subsubheading Example
27550N.A.
27551@end ignore
27552
27553
27554@subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
27555@findex -target-detach
27556
27557@subsubheading Synopsis
27558
27559@smallexample
27560 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
27561@end smallexample
27562
27563Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
27564If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
27565the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
27566
27567@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27568
27569The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
27570
27571@subsubheading Example
27572
27573@smallexample
27574(gdb)
27575-target-detach
27576^done
27577(gdb)
27578@end smallexample
27579
27580
27581@subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
27582@findex -target-disconnect
27583
27584@subsubheading Synopsis
27585
27586@smallexample
27587 -target-disconnect
27588@end smallexample
27589
27590Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
27591generally not resumed.
27592
27593@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27594
27595The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
27596
27597@subsubheading Example
27598
27599@smallexample
27600(gdb)
27601-target-disconnect
27602^done
27603(gdb)
27604@end smallexample
27605
27606
27607@subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
27608@findex -target-download
27609
27610@subsubheading Synopsis
27611
27612@smallexample
27613 -target-download
27614@end smallexample
27615
27616Loads the executable onto the remote target.
27617It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
27618
27619@table @samp
27620@item section
27621The name of the section.
27622@item section-sent
27623The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
27624@item section-size
27625The size of the section.
27626@item total-sent
27627The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
27628@item total-size
27629The size of the overall executable to download.
27630@end table
27631
27632@noindent
27633Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
27634@sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
27635
27636In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
27637downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
27638
27639@table @samp
27640@item section
27641The name of the section.
27642@item section-size
27643The size of the section.
27644@item total-size
27645The size of the overall executable to download.
27646@end table
27647
27648@noindent
27649At the end, a summary is printed.
27650
27651@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27652
27653The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
27654
27655@subsubheading Example
27656
27657Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
27658have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
27659
27660@smallexample
27661(gdb)
27662-target-download
27663+download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
27664+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
27665total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
27666+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
27667total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
27668+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
27669total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
27670+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
27671total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
27672+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
27673total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
27674+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
27675total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
27676+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
27677total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
27678+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
27679total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
27680+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
27681total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
27682+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
27683total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
27684+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
27685total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
27686+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
27687total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
27688+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
27689total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
27690+download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
27691+download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
27692+download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
27693+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
27694total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
27695+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
27696total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
27697+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
27698total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
27699+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
27700total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
27701+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
27702total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
27703+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
27704total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
27705^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
27706write-rate="429"
27707(gdb)
27708@end smallexample
27709
27710
27711@ignore
27712@subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
27713@findex -target-exec-status
27714
27715@subsubheading Synopsis
27716
27717@smallexample
27718 -target-exec-status
27719@end smallexample
27720
27721Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
27722not, for instance).
27723
27724@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27725
27726There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
27727
27728@subsubheading Example
27729N.A.
27730
27731
27732@subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
27733@findex -target-list-available-targets
27734
27735@subsubheading Synopsis
27736
27737@smallexample
27738 -target-list-available-targets
27739@end smallexample
27740
27741List the possible targets to connect to.
27742
27743@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27744
27745The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
27746
27747@subsubheading Example
27748N.A.
27749
27750
27751@subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
27752@findex -target-list-current-targets
27753
27754@subsubheading Synopsis
27755
27756@smallexample
27757 -target-list-current-targets
27758@end smallexample
27759
27760Describe the current target.
27761
27762@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27763
27764The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
27765other things).
27766
27767@subsubheading Example
27768N.A.
27769
27770
27771@subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
27772@findex -target-list-parameters
27773
27774@subsubheading Synopsis
27775
27776@smallexample
27777 -target-list-parameters
27778@end smallexample
27779
27780@c ????
27781@end ignore
27782
27783@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27784
27785No equivalent.
27786
27787@subsubheading Example
27788N.A.
27789
27790
27791@subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
27792@findex -target-select
27793
27794@subsubheading Synopsis
27795
27796@smallexample
27797 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
27798@end smallexample
27799
27800Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
27801
27802@table @samp
27803@item @var{type}
27804The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
27805@item @var{parameters}
27806Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
27807Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
27808@end table
27809
27810The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
27811which the target program is, in the following form:
27812
27813@smallexample
27814^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
27815 args=[@var{arg list}]
27816@end smallexample
27817
27818@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27819
27820The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
27821
27822@subsubheading Example
27823
27824@smallexample
27825(gdb)
27826-target-select remote /dev/ttya
27827^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
27828(gdb)
27829@end smallexample
27830
27831@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27832@node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
27833@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
27834
27835
27836@subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
27837@findex -target-file-put
27838
27839@subsubheading Synopsis
27840
27841@smallexample
27842 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
27843@end smallexample
27844
27845Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
27846@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
27847
27848@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27849
27850The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
27851
27852@subsubheading Example
27853
27854@smallexample
27855(gdb)
27856-target-file-put localfile remotefile
27857^done
27858(gdb)
27859@end smallexample
27860
27861
27862@subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
27863@findex -target-file-get
27864
27865@subsubheading Synopsis
27866
27867@smallexample
27868 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
27869@end smallexample
27870
27871Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
27872on the host system.
27873
27874@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27875
27876The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
27877
27878@subsubheading Example
27879
27880@smallexample
27881(gdb)
27882-target-file-get remotefile localfile
27883^done
27884(gdb)
27885@end smallexample
27886
27887
27888@subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
27889@findex -target-file-delete
27890
27891@subsubheading Synopsis
27892
27893@smallexample
27894 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
27895@end smallexample
27896
27897Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
27898
27899@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27900
27901The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
27902
27903@subsubheading Example
27904
27905@smallexample
27906(gdb)
27907-target-file-delete remotefile
27908^done
27909(gdb)
27910@end smallexample
27911
27912
27913@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27914@node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
27915@section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
27916
27917@c @subheading -gdb-complete
27918
27919@subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
27920@findex -gdb-exit
27921
27922@subsubheading Synopsis
27923
27924@smallexample
27925 -gdb-exit
27926@end smallexample
27927
27928Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
27929
27930@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27931
27932Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
27933
27934@subsubheading Example
27935
27936@smallexample
27937(gdb)
27938-gdb-exit
27939^exit
27940@end smallexample
27941
27942
27943@ignore
27944@subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
27945@findex -exec-abort
27946
27947@subsubheading Synopsis
27948
27949@smallexample
27950 -exec-abort
27951@end smallexample
27952
27953Kill the inferior running program.
27954
27955@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27956
27957The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
27958
27959@subsubheading Example
27960N.A.
27961@end ignore
27962
27963
27964@subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
27965@findex -gdb-set
27966
27967@subsubheading Synopsis
27968
27969@smallexample
27970 -gdb-set
27971@end smallexample
27972
27973Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
27974@c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
27975
27976@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27977
27978The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
27979
27980@subsubheading Example
27981
27982@smallexample
27983(gdb)
27984-gdb-set $foo=3
27985^done
27986(gdb)
27987@end smallexample
27988
27989
27990@subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
27991@findex -gdb-show
27992
27993@subsubheading Synopsis
27994
27995@smallexample
27996 -gdb-show
27997@end smallexample
27998
27999Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
28000
28001@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28002
28003The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
28004
28005@subsubheading Example
28006
28007@smallexample
28008(gdb)
28009-gdb-show annotate
28010^done,value="0"
28011(gdb)
28012@end smallexample
28013
28014@c @subheading -gdb-source
28015
28016
28017@subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
28018@findex -gdb-version
28019
28020@subsubheading Synopsis
28021
28022@smallexample
28023 -gdb-version
28024@end smallexample
28025
28026Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
28027
28028@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28029
28030The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
28031default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
28032
28033@subsubheading Example
28034
28035@c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
28036@c box in TeX.
28037@smallexample
28038(gdb)
28039-gdb-version
28040~GNU gdb 5.2.1
28041~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
28042~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
28043~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
28044~ certain conditions.
28045~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
28046~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
28047~ details.
28048~This GDB was configured as
28049 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
28050^done
28051(gdb)
28052@end smallexample
28053
28054@subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
28055@findex -list-features
28056
28057Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
28058this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
28059or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
28060important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
28061of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
28062startup.
28063
28064The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
28065available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
28066have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
28067is given below.
28068
28069Example output:
28070
28071@smallexample
28072(gdb) -list-features
28073^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
28074@end smallexample
28075
28076The current list of features is:
28077
28078@table @samp
28079@item frozen-varobjs
28080Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
28081as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
28082of @code{-varobj-create}.
28083@item pending-breakpoints
28084Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
28085@item python
28086Indicates presence of Python scripting support, Python-based
28087pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
28088@samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
28089@item thread-info
28090Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
28091
28092@end table
28093
28094@subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
28095@findex -list-target-features
28096
28097Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
28098target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
28099unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
28100features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
28101a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
28102@code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
28103may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
28104Example output:
28105
28106@smallexample
28107(gdb) -list-features
28108^done,result=["async"]
28109@end smallexample
28110
28111The current list of features is:
28112
28113@table @samp
28114@item async
28115Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
28116execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
28117while the target is running.
28118
28119@end table
28120
28121@subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
28122@findex -list-thread-groups
28123
28124@subheading Synopsis
28125
28126@smallexample
28127-list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
28128@end smallexample
28129
28130Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
28131group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
28132When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
28133thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
28134top-level thread groups.
28135
28136Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
28137With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
28138available on the target.
28139
28140The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
28141a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
28142as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
28143Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
28144each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
28145requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
28146are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
28147of the @samp{group} result is described below.
28148
28149To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
28150together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
28151and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
28152permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
28153will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
28154@samp{threads} field.
28155
28156In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
28157the following caveats:
28158
28159@itemize @bullet
28160@item
28161When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
28162be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
28163anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
28164
28165@item
28166When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
28167be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
28168be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
28169not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
28170The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
28171is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
28172
28173@end itemize
28174
28175The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
28176have the following fields:
28177
28178@table @code
28179@item id
28180Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
28181The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
28182convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
28183
28184@item type
28185The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
28186valid type.
28187
28188@item pid
28189The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
28190for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
28191
28192@item num_children
28193The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
28194absent for an available thread group.
28195
28196@item threads
28197This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
28198thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
28199specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
28200
28201@item cores
28202This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
28203thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
28204such information is not available.
28205
28206@item executable
28207The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
28208The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
28209and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
28210
28211@end table
28212
28213@subheading Example
28214
28215@smallexample
28216@value{GDBP}
28217-list-thread-groups
28218^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
28219-list-thread-groups 17
28220^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28221 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
28222@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28223 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28224 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
28225-list-thread-groups --available
28226^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
28227-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
28228 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
28229 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
28230 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
28231-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
28232^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
28233 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
28234 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
28235@end smallexample
28236
28237
28238@subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
28239@findex -add-inferior
28240
28241@subheading Synopsis
28242
28243@smallexample
28244-add-inferior
28245@end smallexample
28246
28247Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
28248inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
28249be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
28250(@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
28251field, @samp{thread-group}, whose value is the identifier of the
28252thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
28253
28254@subheading Example
28255
28256@smallexample
28257@value{GDBP}
28258-add-inferior
28259^done,thread-group="i3"
28260@end smallexample
28261
28262@subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
28263@findex -interpreter-exec
28264
28265@subheading Synopsis
28266
28267@smallexample
28268-interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
28269@end smallexample
28270@anchor{-interpreter-exec}
28271
28272Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
28273
28274@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
28275
28276The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
28277
28278@subheading Example
28279
28280@smallexample
28281(gdb)
28282-interpreter-exec console "break main"
28283&"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
28284&"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
28285~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
28286^done
28287(gdb)
28288@end smallexample
28289
28290@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
28291@findex -inferior-tty-set
28292
28293@subheading Synopsis
28294
28295@smallexample
28296-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
28297@end smallexample
28298
28299Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
28300
28301@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
28302
28303The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
28304
28305@subheading Example
28306
28307@smallexample
28308(gdb)
28309-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
28310^done
28311(gdb)
28312@end smallexample
28313
28314@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
28315@findex -inferior-tty-show
28316
28317@subheading Synopsis
28318
28319@smallexample
28320-inferior-tty-show
28321@end smallexample
28322
28323Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
28324
28325@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
28326
28327The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
28328
28329@subheading Example
28330
28331@smallexample
28332(gdb)
28333-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
28334^done
28335(gdb)
28336-inferior-tty-show
28337^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
28338(gdb)
28339@end smallexample
28340
28341@subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
28342@findex -enable-timings
28343
28344@subheading Synopsis
28345
28346@smallexample
28347-enable-timings [yes | no]
28348@end smallexample
28349
28350Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
28351command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
28352developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
28353equivalent to @samp{yes}.
28354
28355@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
28356
28357No equivalent.
28358
28359@subheading Example
28360
28361@smallexample
28362(gdb)
28363-enable-timings
28364^done
28365(gdb)
28366-break-insert main
28367^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28368addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28369fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
28370time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
28371(gdb)
28372-enable-timings no
28373^done
28374(gdb)
28375-exec-run
28376^running
28377(gdb)
28378*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
28379frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
28380@{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
28381fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
28382(gdb)
28383@end smallexample
28384
28385@node Annotations
28386@chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
28387
28388This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
28389designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
28390similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
28391relatively high level.
28392
28393The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
28394(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
28395
28396@ignore
28397This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
28398@end ignore
28399
28400@menu
28401* Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
28402* Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
28403* Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
28404* Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
28405* Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
28406* Annotations for Running::
28407 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
28408* Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
28409@end menu
28410
28411@node Annotations Overview
28412@section What is an Annotation?
28413@cindex annotations
28414
28415Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
28416characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
28417information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
28418is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
28419information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
28420additional information, and a newline. The additional information
28421cannot contain newline characters.
28422
28423Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
28424characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
28425no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
28426@samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
28427annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
28428means those three characters as output.
28429
28430The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
28431@option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
28432how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
28433values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
28434is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
28435subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
28436for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
28437been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
28438Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
28439
28440@table @code
28441@kindex set annotate
28442@item set annotate @var{level}
28443The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
28444annotations to the specified @var{level}.
28445
28446@item show annotate
28447@kindex show annotate
28448Show the current annotation level.
28449@end table
28450
28451This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
28452
28453A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
28454
28455@smallexample
28456$ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
28457GNU gdb 6.0
28458Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
28459GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
28460and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
28461under certain conditions.
28462Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
28463There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
28464for details.
28465This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
28466
28467^Z^Zpre-prompt
28468(@value{GDBP})
28469^Z^Zprompt
28470@kbd{quit}
28471
28472^Z^Zpost-prompt
28473$
28474@end smallexample
28475
28476Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
28477@value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
28478denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
28479output from @value{GDBN}.
28480
28481@node Server Prefix
28482@section The Server Prefix
28483@cindex server prefix
28484
28485If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
28486the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
28487command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
28488means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
28489a transparent manner.
28490
28491The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
28492the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
28493value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
28494@code{print} command.
28495
28496Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
28497(@pxref{confirmation requests}).
28498
28499@node Prompting
28500@section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
28501
28502@cindex annotations for prompts
28503When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
28504to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
28505over, etc.
28506
28507Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
28508input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
28509denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
28510annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
28511annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
28512associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
28513features the following annotations:
28514
28515@smallexample
28516^Z^Zpre-prompt
28517^Z^Zprompt
28518^Z^Zpost-prompt
28519@end smallexample
28520
28521The input types are
28522
28523@table @code
28524@findex pre-prompt annotation
28525@findex prompt annotation
28526@findex post-prompt annotation
28527@item prompt
28528When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
28529
28530@findex pre-commands annotation
28531@findex commands annotation
28532@findex post-commands annotation
28533@item commands
28534When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
28535command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
28536
28537@findex pre-overload-choice annotation
28538@findex overload-choice annotation
28539@findex post-overload-choice annotation
28540@item overload-choice
28541When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
28542
28543@findex pre-query annotation
28544@findex query annotation
28545@findex post-query annotation
28546@item query
28547When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
28548
28549@findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
28550@findex prompt-for-continue annotation
28551@findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
28552@item prompt-for-continue
28553When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
28554expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
28555prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
28556presence of annotations.
28557@end table
28558
28559@node Errors
28560@section Errors
28561@cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
28562
28563@findex quit annotation
28564@smallexample
28565^Z^Zquit
28566@end smallexample
28567
28568This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
28569
28570@findex error annotation
28571@smallexample
28572^Z^Zerror
28573@end smallexample
28574
28575This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
28576
28577Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
28578in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
28579@code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
28580cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
28581cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
28582does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
28583to the top level.
28584
28585@findex error-begin annotation
28586A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
28587
28588@smallexample
28589^Z^Zerror-begin
28590@end smallexample
28591
28592Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
28593message.
28594
28595Warning messages are not yet annotated.
28596@c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
28597@c range_error(), and possibly other places.
28598
28599@node Invalidation
28600@section Invalidation Notices
28601
28602@cindex annotations for invalidation messages
28603The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
28604changed.
28605
28606@table @code
28607@findex frames-invalid annotation
28608@item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
28609
28610The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
28611have changed.
28612
28613@findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
28614@item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
28615
28616The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
28617deleted a breakpoint.
28618@end table
28619
28620@node Annotations for Running
28621@section Running the Program
28622@cindex annotations for running programs
28623
28624@findex starting annotation
28625@findex stopping annotation
28626When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
28627@code{step} or @code{continue},
28628
28629@smallexample
28630^Z^Zstarting
28631@end smallexample
28632
28633is output. When the program stops,
28634
28635@smallexample
28636^Z^Zstopped
28637@end smallexample
28638
28639is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
28640annotations describe how the program stopped.
28641
28642@table @code
28643@findex exited annotation
28644@item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
28645The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
28646successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
28647
28648@findex signalled annotation
28649@findex signal-name annotation
28650@findex signal-name-end annotation
28651@findex signal-string annotation
28652@findex signal-string-end annotation
28653@item ^Z^Zsignalled
28654The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
28655annotation continues:
28656
28657@smallexample
28658@var{intro-text}
28659^Z^Zsignal-name
28660@var{name}
28661^Z^Zsignal-name-end
28662@var{middle-text}
28663^Z^Zsignal-string
28664@var{string}
28665^Z^Zsignal-string-end
28666@var{end-text}
28667@end smallexample
28668
28669@noindent
28670where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
28671@code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
28672as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
28673@var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
28674user's benefit and have no particular format.
28675
28676@findex signal annotation
28677@item ^Z^Zsignal
28678The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
28679just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
28680terminated with it.
28681
28682@findex breakpoint annotation
28683@item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
28684The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
28685
28686@findex watchpoint annotation
28687@item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
28688The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
28689@end table
28690
28691@node Source Annotations
28692@section Displaying Source
28693@cindex annotations for source display
28694
28695@findex source annotation
28696The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
28697
28698@smallexample
28699^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
28700@end smallexample
28701
28702where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
28703file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
28704first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
28705within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
28706debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
28707@var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
28708line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
28709@var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
28710source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
28711followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
28712depend on the language).
28713
28714@node JIT Interface
28715@chapter JIT Compilation Interface
28716@cindex just-in-time compilation
28717@cindex JIT compilation interface
28718
28719This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
28720interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
28721executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
28722performance while maintaining platform independence.
28723
28724Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
28725portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
28726object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
28727and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
28728@value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
28729symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
28730
28731If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
28732it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
28733you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
28734of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
28735LLVM JIT.
28736
28737Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
28738JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
28739variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
28740attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
28741find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
28742out about additional code.
28743
28744@menu
28745* Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
28746* Registering Code:: Steps to register code
28747* Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
28748@end menu
28749
28750@node Declarations
28751@section JIT Declarations
28752
28753These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
28754implement the interface:
28755
28756@smallexample
28757typedef enum
28758@{
28759 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
28760 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
28761 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
28762@} jit_actions_t;
28763
28764struct jit_code_entry
28765@{
28766 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
28767 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
28768 const char *symfile_addr;
28769 uint64_t symfile_size;
28770@};
28771
28772struct jit_descriptor
28773@{
28774 uint32_t version;
28775 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
28776 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
28777 uint32_t action_flag;
28778 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
28779 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
28780@};
28781
28782/* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
28783void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
28784
28785/* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
28786 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
28787struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
28788@end smallexample
28789
28790If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
28791modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
28792a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
28793
28794@node Registering Code
28795@section Registering Code
28796
28797To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
28798
28799@itemize @bullet
28800@item
28801Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
28802information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
28803
28804@item
28805Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
28806file.
28807
28808@item
28809Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
28810
28811@item
28812Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
28813
28814@item
28815Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
28816@code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
28817@end itemize
28818
28819When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
28820@code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
28821new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
28822@value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
28823
28824@node Unregistering Code
28825@section Unregistering Code
28826
28827If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
28828
28829@itemize @bullet
28830@item
28831Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
28832
28833@item
28834Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
28835
28836@item
28837Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
28838@code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
28839@end itemize
28840
28841If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
28842and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
28843
28844@node GDB Bugs
28845@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
28846@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
28847@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
28848
28849Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
28850
28851Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
28852may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
28853the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
28854reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
28855
28856In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
28857information that enables us to fix the bug.
28858
28859@menu
28860* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
28861* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
28862@end menu
28863
28864@node Bug Criteria
28865@section Have You Found a Bug?
28866@cindex bug criteria
28867
28868If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
28869
28870@itemize @bullet
28871@cindex fatal signal
28872@cindex debugger crash
28873@cindex crash of debugger
28874@item
28875If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
28876@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
28877
28878@cindex error on valid input
28879@item
28880If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
28881bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
28882somewhere in the connection to the target.)
28883
28884@cindex invalid input
28885@item
28886If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
28887that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
28888``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
28889for traditional practice''.
28890
28891@item
28892If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
28893for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
28894@end itemize
28895
28896@node Bug Reporting
28897@section How to Report Bugs
28898@cindex bug reports
28899@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
28900
28901A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
28902If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
28903contact that organization first.
28904
28905You can find contact information for many support companies and
28906individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
28907distribution.
28908@c should add a web page ref...
28909
28910@ifset BUGURL
28911@ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
28912In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
28913@value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
28914@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
28915page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
28916be used.
28917
28918@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
28919@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
28920not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
28921@samp{bug-gdb}.
28922
28923The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
28924serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
28925the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
28926newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
28927problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
28928path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
28929we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
28930bug reports to the mailing list.
28931@end ifset
28932@ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
28933In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
28934@value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
28935@end ifclear
28936@end ifset
28937
28938The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
28939@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
28940fact or leave it out, state it!
28941
28942Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
28943problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
28944assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
28945Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
28946stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
28947name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
28948of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
28949the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
28950easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
28951
28952Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
28953bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
28954you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
28955self-contained.
28956
28957Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
28958bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
28959@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
28960bugs properly.
28961
28962To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
28963
28964@itemize @bullet
28965@item
28966The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
28967with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
28968version}.
28969
28970Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
28971the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
28972
28973@item
28974The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
28975version number.
28976
28977@item
28978What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
28979``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
28980
28981@item
28982What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
28983debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
28984C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
28985to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
28986those compilers.
28987
28988@item
28989The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
28990observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
28991you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
28992Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
28993
28994If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
28995and then we might not encounter the bug.
28996
28997@item
28998A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
28999reproduce the bug.
29000
29001@item
29002A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
29003incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
29004
29005Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
29006will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
29007not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
29008a chance to make a mistake.
29009
29010Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
29011say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
29012copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
29013the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
29014crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
29015ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
29016us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
29017to draw any conclusion from our observations.
29018
29019@pindex script
29020@cindex recording a session script
29021To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
29022such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
29023Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
29024include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
29025
29026Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
29027inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
29028
29029@item
29030If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
29031diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
29032it by context, not by line number.
29033
29034The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
29035sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
29036
29037@end itemize
29038
29039Here are some things that are not necessary:
29040
29041@itemize @bullet
29042@item
29043A description of the envelope of the bug.
29044
29045Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
29046which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
29047changes will not affect it.
29048
29049This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
29050will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
29051with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
29052We recommend that you save your time for something else.
29053
29054Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
29055of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
29056output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
29057less time, and so on.
29058
29059However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
29060report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
29061
29062@item
29063A patch for the bug.
29064
29065A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
29066the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
29067a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
29068to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
29069
29070Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
29071construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
29072through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
29073to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
29074
29075And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
29076patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
29077help us to understand.
29078
29079@item
29080A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
29081
29082Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
29083things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
29084@end itemize
29085
29086@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
29087@c and consists of the two following files:
29088@c rluser.texinfo
29089@c inc-hist.texinfo
29090@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
29091@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
29092@include rluser.texi
29093@include inc-hist.texinfo
29094
29095
29096@node Formatting Documentation
29097@appendix Formatting Documentation
29098
29099@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
29100@cindex reference card
29101The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
29102for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
29103subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
29104@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
29105release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
29106you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
29107
29108The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
29109can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
29110
29111@smallexample
29112make refcard.dvi
29113@end smallexample
29114
29115The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
29116mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
29117that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
29118high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
29119your @sc{dvi} output program.
29120
29121@cindex documentation
29122
29123All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
29124distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
29125a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
29126on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
29127formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
29128and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
29129
29130@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
29131version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
29132file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
29133subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
29134necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
29135but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
29136Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
29137@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
29138
29139If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
29140Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
29141@code{makeinfo}.
29142
29143If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
29144@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
29145version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
29146
29147@smallexample
29148cd gdb
29149make gdb.info
29150@end smallexample
29151
29152If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
29153a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
29154Texinfo definitions file.
29155
29156@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
29157produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
29158document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
29159has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
29160command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
29161(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
29162require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
29163
29164@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
29165@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
29166written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
29167typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
29168and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
29169directory.
29170
29171If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
29172typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
29173subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
29174@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
29175
29176@smallexample
29177make gdb.dvi
29178@end smallexample
29179
29180Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
29181
29182@node Installing GDB
29183@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
29184@cindex installation
29185
29186@menu
29187* Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
29188* Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
29189* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
29190* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
29191* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
29192* System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
29193@end menu
29194
29195@node Requirements
29196@section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
29197@cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
29198
29199Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
29200Other packages will be used only if they are found.
29201
29202@heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
29203@table @asis
29204@item ISO C90 compiler
29205@value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
29206working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
29207
29208@end table
29209
29210@heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
29211@table @asis
29212@item Expat
29213@anchor{Expat}
29214@value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
29215included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
29216can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
29217The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
29218standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
29219use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
29220
29221Expat is used for:
29222
29223@itemize @bullet
29224@item
29225Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
29226@item
29227Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
29228@item
29229Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
29230@item
29231MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
29232@end itemize
29233
29234@item zlib
29235@cindex compressed debug sections
29236@value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
29237compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
29238of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
29239is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
29240information in such binaries.
29241
29242The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
29243distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
29244@url{http://zlib.net}.
29245
29246@item iconv
29247@value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
29248Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
29249on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
29250other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
29251
29252On systems with @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
29253have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
29254@option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
29255
29256@value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
29257arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
29258in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
29259if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
29260implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
29261by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
29262Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
29263Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
29264@end table
29265
29266@node Running Configure
29267@section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
29268@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
29269@value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
29270of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
29271build the @code{gdb} program.
29272@iftex
29273@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
29274@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
29275look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
29276installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
29277@end iftex
29278
29279The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
29280@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
29281appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
29282
29283For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
29284@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
29285
29286@table @code
29287@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
29288script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
29289
29290@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
29291the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
29292
29293@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
29294source for the Binary File Descriptor library
29295
29296@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
29297@sc{gnu} include files
29298
29299@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
29300source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
29301
29302@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
29303source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
29304
29305@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
29306source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
29307
29308@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
29309source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
29310
29311@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
29312source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
29313@end table
29314
29315The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
29316from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
29317this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
29318
29319First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
29320if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
29321identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
29322argument.
29323
29324For example:
29325
29326@smallexample
29327cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
29328./configure @var{host}
29329make
29330@end smallexample
29331
29332@noindent
29333where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
29334@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
29335(You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
29336correct value by examining your system.)
29337
29338Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
29339@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
29340libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
29341binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
29342
29343@need 750
29344@file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
29345system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
29346shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
29347
29348@smallexample
29349sh configure @var{host}
29350@end smallexample
29351
29352If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
29353directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
29354@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
29355@file{configure}
29356creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
29357you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
29358
29359You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
29360source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
29361@file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
29362that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
29363if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
29364of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
29365configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
29366directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
29367about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
29368
29369You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
29370However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
29371the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
29372that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
29373let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
29374
29375@node Separate Objdir
29376@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
29377
29378If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
29379you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
29380host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
29381allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
29382rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
29383handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
29384@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
29385program specified there.
29386
29387To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
29388with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
29389(You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
29390itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
29391would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
29392the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
29393
29394For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
29395separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
29396
29397@smallexample
29398@group
29399cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
29400mkdir ../gdb-sun4
29401cd ../gdb-sun4
29402../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
29403make
29404@end group
29405@end smallexample
29406
29407When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
29408directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
29409(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
29410the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
29411directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
29412@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
29413
29414Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
29415instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
29416like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
29417one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
29418build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
29419
29420One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
29421directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
29422@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
29423programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
29424You specify a cross-debugging target by
29425giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
29426
29427When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
29428it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
29429called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
29430
29431The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
29432directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
29433directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
29434directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
29435will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
29436
29437When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
29438directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
29439if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
29440with each other.
29441
29442@node Config Names
29443@section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
29444
29445The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
29446script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
29447aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
29448of information in the following pattern:
29449
29450@smallexample
29451@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
29452@end smallexample
29453
29454For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
29455or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
29456option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
29457
29458The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
29459any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
29460aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
29461@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
29462script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
29463abbreviations---for example:
29464
29465@smallexample
29466% sh config.sub i386-linux
29467i386-pc-linux-gnu
29468% sh config.sub alpha-linux
29469alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
29470% sh config.sub hp9k700
29471hppa1.1-hp-hpux
29472% sh config.sub sun4
29473sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
29474% sh config.sub sun3
29475m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
29476% sh config.sub i986v
29477Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
29478@end smallexample
29479
29480@noindent
29481@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
29482directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
29483
29484@node Configure Options
29485@section @file{configure} Options
29486
29487Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
29488are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
29489several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
29490Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
29491
29492@smallexample
29493configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
29494 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
29495 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
29496 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
29497 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
29498 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
29499 @var{host}
29500@end smallexample
29501
29502@noindent
29503You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
29504@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
29505@samp{--}.
29506
29507@table @code
29508@item --help
29509Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
29510
29511@item --prefix=@var{dir}
29512Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
29513@file{@var{dir}}.
29514
29515@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
29516Configure the source to install programs under directory
29517@file{@var{dir}}.
29518
29519@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
29520@need 2000
29521@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
29522@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
29523@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
29524Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
29525@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
29526build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
29527directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
29528the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
29529directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
29530the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
29531@var{dirname}.
29532
29533@item --norecursion
29534Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
29535propagate configuration to subdirectories.
29536
29537@item --target=@var{target}
29538Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
29539@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
29540programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
29541
29542There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
29543
29544@item @var{host} @dots{}
29545Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
29546
29547There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
29548@end table
29549
29550There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
29551needed for special purposes only.
29552
29553@node System-wide configuration
29554@section System-wide configuration and settings
29555@cindex system-wide init file
29556
29557@value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
29558this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
29559@value{GDBN} does during startup}).
29560
29561Here is the corresponding configure option:
29562
29563@table @code
29564@item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
29565Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
29566@var{file}.
29567@end table
29568
29569If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
29570it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
29571
29572@itemize @bullet
29573@item
29574If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
29575it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
29576are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
29577if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
29578init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
29579@file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
29580
29581@item
29582By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
29583it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
29584@option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
29585then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
29586wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
29587@end itemize
29588
29589@node Maintenance Commands
29590@appendix Maintenance Commands
29591@cindex maintenance commands
29592@cindex internal commands
29593
29594In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
29595includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
29596that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
29597provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
29598messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
29599
29600@table @code
29601@kindex maint agent
29602@kindex maint agent-eval
29603@item maint agent @var{expression}
29604@itemx maint agent-eval @var{expression}
29605Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
29606This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
29607(@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
29608expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
29609@samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
29610to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
29611globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
29612of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
29613the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
29614addition and return the sum.
29615
29616@kindex maint info breakpoints
29617@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
29618Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
29619breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
29620internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
29621breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
29622is shown:
29623
29624@table @code
29625@item breakpoint
29626Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
29627
29628@item watchpoint
29629Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
29630
29631@item longjmp
29632Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
29633@code{longjmp} calls.
29634
29635@item longjmp resume
29636Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
29637
29638@item until
29639Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
29640
29641@item finish
29642Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
29643
29644@item shlib events
29645Shared library events.
29646
29647@end table
29648
29649@kindex set displaced-stepping
29650@kindex show displaced-stepping
29651@cindex displaced stepping support
29652@cindex out-of-line single-stepping
29653@item set displaced-stepping
29654@itemx show displaced-stepping
29655Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
29656if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
29657over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
29658an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
29659breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
29660
29661@table @code
29662@item set displaced-stepping on
29663If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
29664displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
29665
29666@item set displaced-stepping off
29667@value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
29668even if such is supported by the target architecture.
29669
29670@cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
29671@item set displaced-stepping auto
29672This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
29673only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
29674architecture supports displaced stepping.
29675@end table
29676
29677@kindex maint check-symtabs
29678@item maint check-symtabs
29679Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
29680
29681@kindex maint cplus first_component
29682@item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
29683Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
29684
29685@kindex maint cplus namespace
29686@item maint cplus namespace
29687Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
29688
29689@kindex maint demangle
29690@item maint demangle @var{name}
29691Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
29692
29693@kindex maint deprecate
29694@kindex maint undeprecate
29695@cindex deprecated commands
29696@item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
29697@itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
29698Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
29699cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
29700argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
29701favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
29702the replacement as part of the warning.
29703
29704@kindex maint dump-me
29705@item maint dump-me
29706@cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
29707Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
29708This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
29709with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
29710
29711@kindex maint internal-error
29712@kindex maint internal-warning
29713@item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
29714@itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
29715Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
29716or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
29717or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
29718internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
29719either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
29720@value{GDBN} session.
29721
29722These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
29723used as the text of the error or warning message.
29724
29725Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
29726
29727@smallexample
29728(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
29729@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
29730A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
29731debugging may prove unreliable.
29732Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
29733Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
29734(@value{GDBP})
29735@end smallexample
29736
29737@cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
29738@cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
29739
29740@kindex maint set internal-error
29741@kindex maint show internal-error
29742@kindex maint set internal-warning
29743@kindex maint show internal-warning
29744@item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
29745@itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
29746@itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
29747@itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
29748When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
29749gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
29750core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
29751override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
29752described in the table below.
29753
29754@table @samp
29755@item quit
29756You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
29757quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
29758
29759@item corefile
29760You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
29761create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
29762@end table
29763
29764@kindex maint packet
29765@item maint packet @var{text}
29766If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
29767then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
29768displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
29769@samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
29770checksum.
29771
29772@kindex maint print architecture
29773@item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
29774Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
29775@var{file} names the file where the output goes.
29776
29777@kindex maint print c-tdesc
29778@item maint print c-tdesc
29779Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
29780a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
29781when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
29782
29783@kindex maint print dummy-frames
29784@item maint print dummy-frames
29785Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
29786
29787@smallexample
29788(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
29789@dots{}
29790(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
29791Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
2979258 return (a + b);
29793The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
29794@dots{}
29795(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
297960x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
29797 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
29798 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
29799(@value{GDBP})
29800@end smallexample
29801
29802Takes an optional file parameter.
29803
29804@kindex maint print registers
29805@kindex maint print raw-registers
29806@kindex maint print cooked-registers
29807@kindex maint print register-groups
29808@item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
29809@itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
29810@itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
29811@itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
29812Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
29813
29814The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
29815the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
29816includes the (cooked) value of all registers, including registers which
29817aren't available on the target nor visible to user; and the
29818command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
29819register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
29820@value{GDBN} Internals}.
29821
29822These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
29823write the information.
29824
29825@kindex maint print reggroups
29826@item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
29827Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
29828optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
29829information.
29830
29831The register groups info looks like this:
29832
29833@smallexample
29834(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
29835 Group Type
29836 general user
29837 float user
29838 all user
29839 vector user
29840 system user
29841 save internal
29842 restore internal
29843@end smallexample
29844
29845@kindex flushregs
29846@item flushregs
29847This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
29848
29849@kindex maint print objfiles
29850@cindex info for known object files
29851@item maint print objfiles
29852Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
29853command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
29854and symtabs.
29855
29856@kindex maint print section-scripts
29857@cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
29858@item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
29859Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
29860If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
29861matching @var{regexp}.
29862For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
29863and the full path if known.
29864@xref{.debug_gdb_scripts section}.
29865
29866@kindex maint print statistics
29867@cindex bcache statistics
29868@item maint print statistics
29869This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
29870about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
29871statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
29872of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
29873defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
29874the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
29875used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
29876sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
29877average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
29878savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
29879lengths.
29880
29881@kindex maint print target-stack
29882@cindex target stack description
29883@item maint print target-stack
29884A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
29885kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
29886so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
29887In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
29888until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
29889address.
29890
29891This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
29892the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
29893
29894@kindex maint print type
29895@cindex type chain of a data type
29896@item maint print type @var{expr}
29897Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
29898can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
29899that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
29900a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
29901data structures, including its flags and contained types.
29902
29903@kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
29904@kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
29905@item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
29906@itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
29907Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
29908
29909@cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
29910In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
29911produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
29912reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
29913This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
29914cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
29915compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
29916memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
29917slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
29918
29919@kindex maint set profile
29920@kindex maint show profile
29921@cindex profiling GDB
29922@item maint set profile
29923@itemx maint show profile
29924Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
29925
29926Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
29927command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
29928collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
29929exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
29930if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
29931(often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
29932data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
29933
29934Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
29935compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
29936
29937@kindex maint set show-debug-regs
29938@kindex maint show show-debug-regs
29939@cindex hardware debug registers
29940@item maint set show-debug-regs
29941@itemx maint show show-debug-regs
29942Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
29943registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
29944enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
29945removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
29946triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
29947
29948@kindex maint set show-all-tib
29949@kindex maint show show-all-tib
29950@item maint set show-all-tib
29951@itemx maint show show-all-tib
29952Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
29953at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
29954command.
29955
29956@kindex maint space
29957@cindex memory used by commands
29958@item maint space
29959Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
29960nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
29961took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
29962by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
29963switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
29964
29965@kindex maint time
29966@cindex time of command execution
29967@item maint time
29968Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
29969set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
29970took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
29971The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
29972there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
29973by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
29974it's not possibly currently
29975This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
29976@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
29977
29978@kindex maint translate-address
29979@item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
29980Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
29981@var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
29982@value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
29983the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
29984the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
29985command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
29986
29987If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
29988is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
29989executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
29990
29991@end table
29992
29993The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
29994@value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
29995
29996@table @code
29997@item set watchdog @var{nsec}
29998@kindex set watchdog
29999@cindex watchdog timer
30000@cindex timeout for commands
30001Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
30002target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
30003reports and error and the command is aborted.
30004
30005@item show watchdog
30006Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
30007@end table
30008
30009@node Remote Protocol
30010@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
30011
30012@menu
30013* Overview::
30014* Packets::
30015* Stop Reply Packets::
30016* General Query Packets::
30017* Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
30018* Tracepoint Packets::
30019* Host I/O Packets::
30020* Interrupts::
30021* Notification Packets::
30022* Remote Non-Stop::
30023* Packet Acknowledgment::
30024* Examples::
30025* File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
30026* Library List Format::
30027* Memory Map Format::
30028* Thread List Format::
30029@end menu
30030
30031@node Overview
30032@section Overview
30033
30034There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
30035protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
30036machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
30037recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
30038
30039In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
30040transmitted and received data, respectively.
30041
30042@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
30043@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
30044@cindex remote serial protocol
30045All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
30046and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
30047@var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
30048@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
30049@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
30050
30051@smallexample
30052@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
30053@end smallexample
30054@noindent
30055
30056@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
30057@noindent
30058The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
30059characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
30060eight bit unsigned checksum).
30061
30062Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
30063specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
30064
30065@smallexample
30066@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
30067@end smallexample
30068
30069@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
30070@noindent
30071That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
30072has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
30073since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
30074
30075When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
30076response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
30077the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
30078retransmission):
30079
30080@smallexample
30081-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
30082<- @code{+}
30083@end smallexample
30084@noindent
30085
30086The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
30087once a connection is established.
30088@xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
30089
30090The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
30091debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
30092the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
30093when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
30094threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
30095behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
30096execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
30097
30098@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
30099exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
30100exceptions).
30101
30102@cindex remote protocol, field separator
30103Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
30104@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
30105@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
30106
30107Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
30108@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
30109would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
30110
30111@cindex remote protocol, binary data
30112@anchor{Binary Data}
30113Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
30114digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
30115protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
30116Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
30117connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
30118binary data.
30119
30120The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
30121as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
30122character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
30123For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
30124bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
30125@code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
30126@samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
30127must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
30128is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
30129(described next).
30130
30131Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
30132Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
30133instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
30134repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
30135binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
30136@code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
30137produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
30138code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
30139encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
30140@samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
30141after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
301423}} more times.
30143
30144The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
30145greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
30146seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
30147five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
30148@samp{0*"00}.
30149
30150The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
30151error number. That number is not well defined.
30152
30153@cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
30154For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
30155(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
30156protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
30157on that response.
30158
30159A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
30160@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
30161optional.
30162
30163@node Packets
30164@section Packets
30165
30166The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
30167@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
30168@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
30169I/O extension of the remote protocol.
30170
30171Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
30172syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
30173include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
30174part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
30175separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
30176@var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
30177bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
30178@var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
30179@samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
30180@var{baz}.
30181
30182@cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
30183@anchor{thread-id syntax}
30184Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
30185a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
30186interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
30187can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
30188pick any thread.
30189
30190In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
30191which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
30192process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
30193The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
30194format described above: a positive number with target-specific
30195interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
30196to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
30197indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
30198@samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
30199error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
30200@samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
30201for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
30202ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
30203
30204The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
30205@value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
30206feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
30207more information.
30208
30209Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
30210letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
30211
30212Here are the packet descriptions.
30213
30214@table @samp
30215
30216@item !
30217@cindex @samp{!} packet
30218@anchor{extended mode}
30219Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
30220persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
30221debugged.
30222
30223Reply:
30224@table @samp
30225@item OK
30226The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
30227@end table
30228
30229@item ?
30230@cindex @samp{?} packet
30231Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
30232step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
30233target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
30234
30235Reply:
30236@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30237
30238@item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
30239@cindex @samp{A} packet
30240Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
30241specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
30242@var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
30243
30244Reply:
30245@table @samp
30246@item OK
30247The arguments were set.
30248@item E @var{NN}
30249An error occurred.
30250@end table
30251
30252@item b @var{baud}
30253@cindex @samp{b} packet
30254(Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
30255Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
30256
30257JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
30258received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
30259problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
30260
30261Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
30262it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
30263some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
30264switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
30265of view, nothing actually happened.}
30266
30267@item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
30268@cindex @samp{B} packet
30269Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
30270breakpoint at @var{addr}.
30271
30272Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
30273(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
30274
30275@cindex @samp{bc} packet
30276@anchor{bc}
30277@item bc
30278Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
30279@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
30280
30281Reply:
30282@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30283
30284@cindex @samp{bs} packet
30285@anchor{bs}
30286@item bs
30287Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
30288@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
30289
30290Reply:
30291@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30292
30293@item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
30294@cindex @samp{c} packet
30295Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
30296resume at current address.
30297
30298Reply:
30299@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30300
30301@item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
30302@cindex @samp{C} packet
30303Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
30304@samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
30305
30306Reply:
30307@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30308
30309@item d
30310@cindex @samp{d} packet
30311Toggle debug flag.
30312
30313Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
30314(@pxref{General Query Packets}).
30315
30316@item D
30317@itemx D;@var{pid}
30318@cindex @samp{D} packet
30319The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
30320remote system. It is sent to the remote target
30321before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
30322
30323The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
30324protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
30325detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
30326big-endian hex string.
30327
30328Reply:
30329@table @samp
30330@item OK
30331for success
30332@item E @var{NN}
30333for an error
30334@end table
30335
30336@item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
30337@cindex @samp{F} packet
30338A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
30339This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
30340Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
30341
30342@item g
30343@anchor{read registers packet}
30344@cindex @samp{g} packet
30345Read general registers.
30346
30347Reply:
30348@table @samp
30349@item @var{XX@dots{}}
30350Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
30351with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
30352each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
30353determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
30354@code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
30355specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
30356@item E @var{NN}
30357for an error.
30358@end table
30359
30360@item G @var{XX@dots{}}
30361@cindex @samp{G} packet
30362Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
30363description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
30364
30365Reply:
30366@table @samp
30367@item OK
30368for success
30369@item E @var{NN}
30370for an error
30371@end table
30372
30373@item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
30374@cindex @samp{H} packet
30375Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
30376@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
30377should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
30378operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
30379interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
30380
30381Reply:
30382@table @samp
30383@item OK
30384for success
30385@item E @var{NN}
30386for an error
30387@end table
30388
30389@c FIXME: JTC:
30390@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
30391@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
30392@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
30393@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
30394@c described. For example:
30395@c
30396@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
30397@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
30398@c otherwise returns current registers.
30399@c
30400@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
30401@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
30402@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
30403
30404@item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
30405@anchor{cycle step packet}
30406@cindex @samp{i} packet
30407Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
30408present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
30409step starting at that address.
30410
30411@item I
30412@cindex @samp{I} packet
30413Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
30414step packet}.
30415
30416@item k
30417@cindex @samp{k} packet
30418Kill request.
30419
30420FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
30421thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
30422thread?)}.
30423
30424@item m @var{addr},@var{length}
30425@cindex @samp{m} packet
30426Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
30427Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
30428
30429The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
30430data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
30431and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
30432use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
30433suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
30434@cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
30435@cindex size of remote memory accesses
30436@cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
30437
30438Reply:
30439@table @samp
30440@item @var{XX@dots{}}
30441Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
30442number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
30443server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
30444@item E @var{NN}
30445@var{NN} is errno
30446@end table
30447
30448@item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
30449@cindex @samp{M} packet
30450Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
30451@var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
30452hexadecimal number.
30453
30454Reply:
30455@table @samp
30456@item OK
30457for success
30458@item E @var{NN}
30459for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
30460written).
30461@end table
30462
30463@item p @var{n}
30464@cindex @samp{p} packet
30465Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
30466@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
30467register value is encoded.
30468
30469Reply:
30470@table @samp
30471@item @var{XX@dots{}}
30472the register's value
30473@item E @var{NN}
30474for an error
30475@item
30476Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
30477@end table
30478
30479@item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
30480@anchor{write register packet}
30481@cindex @samp{P} packet
30482Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
30483number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
30484digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
30485
30486Reply:
30487@table @samp
30488@item OK
30489for success
30490@item E @var{NN}
30491for an error
30492@end table
30493
30494@item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
30495@itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
30496@cindex @samp{q} packet
30497@cindex @samp{Q} packet
30498General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
30499described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
30500
30501@item r
30502@cindex @samp{r} packet
30503Reset the entire system.
30504
30505Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
30506
30507@item R @var{XX}
30508@cindex @samp{R} packet
30509Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
30510This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
30511
30512The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
30513
30514@item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
30515@cindex @samp{s} packet
30516Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
30517@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
30518
30519Reply:
30520@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30521
30522@item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
30523@anchor{step with signal packet}
30524@cindex @samp{S} packet
30525Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
30526requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
30527
30528Reply:
30529@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30530
30531@item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
30532@cindex @samp{t} packet
30533Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
30534@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
30535@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
30536
30537@item T @var{thread-id}
30538@cindex @samp{T} packet
30539Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
30540
30541Reply:
30542@table @samp
30543@item OK
30544thread is still alive
30545@item E @var{NN}
30546thread is dead
30547@end table
30548
30549@item v
30550Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
30551up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
30552
30553@item vAttach;@var{pid}
30554@cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
30555Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
30556The process ID is a
30557hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
30558threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
30559attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
30560
30561@c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
30562@c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
30563@c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
30564@c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
30565@c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
30566@c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
30567@c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
30568@c stopping or restarting threads.
30569
30570This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
30571
30572Reply:
30573@table @samp
30574@item E @var{nn}
30575for an error
30576@item @r{Any stop packet}
30577for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
30578@item OK
30579for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
30580@end table
30581
30582@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
30583@cindex @samp{vCont} packet
30584Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
30585If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
30586threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
30587specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
30588in their current state in non-stop mode.
30589Specifying multiple
30590default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
30591Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
30592
30593Currently supported actions are:
30594
30595@table @samp
30596@item c
30597Continue.
30598@item C @var{sig}
30599Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
30600@item s
30601Step.
30602@item S @var{sig}
30603Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
30604@item t
30605Stop.
30606@end table
30607
30608The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
30609@samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
30610not supported in @samp{vCont}.
30611
30612The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
30613(@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
30614A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
30615When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
30616the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
30617signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
30618as an implementation detail.
30619
30620Reply:
30621@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
30622
30623@item vCont?
30624@cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
30625Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
30626
30627Reply:
30628@table @samp
30629@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
30630The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
30631command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
30632@item
30633The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
30634@end table
30635
30636@item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
30637@cindex @samp{vFile} packet
30638Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
30639see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
30640
30641@item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
30642@cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
30643Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
30644@var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
30645its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
30646flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
30647Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
30648together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
30649stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
30650packet is received.
30651
30652The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
30653multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
30654this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
30655in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
30656@var{thread-id}.
30657
30658Reply:
30659@table @samp
30660@item OK
30661for success
30662@item E @var{NN}
30663for an error
30664@end table
30665
30666@item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
30667@cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
30668Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
30669is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
30670packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
30671@samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
30672not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
30673(although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
30674have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
30675@samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
30676neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
30677target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
30678
30679
30680Reply:
30681@table @samp
30682@item OK
30683for success
30684@item E.memtype
30685for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
30686@item E @var{NN}
30687for an error
30688@end table
30689
30690@item vFlashDone
30691@cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
30692Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
30693The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
30694@samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
30695@samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
30696regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
30697request is completed.
30698
30699@item vKill;@var{pid}
30700@cindex @samp{vKill} packet
30701Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
30702hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
30703preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
30704supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
30705
30706Reply:
30707@table @samp
30708@item E @var{nn}
30709for an error
30710@item OK
30711for success
30712@end table
30713
30714@item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
30715@cindex @samp{vRun} packet
30716Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
30717command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
30718@var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
30719(e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
30720state.
30721
30722@c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
30723
30724This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
30725
30726Reply:
30727@table @samp
30728@item E @var{nn}
30729for an error
30730@item @r{Any stop packet}
30731for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
30732@end table
30733
30734@item vStopped
30735@anchor{vStopped packet}
30736@cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
30737
30738In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
30739reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
30740
30741Reply:
30742@table @samp
30743@item @r{Any stop packet}
30744if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
30745@item OK
30746if there are no unreported stop events
30747@end table
30748
30749@item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
30750@anchor{X packet}
30751@cindex @samp{X} packet
30752Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
30753@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
30754@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
30755
30756Reply:
30757@table @samp
30758@item OK
30759for success
30760@item E @var{NN}
30761for an error
30762@end table
30763
30764@item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
30765@itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
30766@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
30767@cindex @samp{z} packet
30768@cindex @samp{Z} packets
30769Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
30770watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
30771
30772Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
30773separately.
30774
30775@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
30776for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
30777remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
30778@samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
30779avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
30780be implemented in an idempotent way.}
30781
30782@item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30783@itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30784@cindex @samp{z0} packet
30785@cindex @samp{Z0} packet
30786Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
30787@var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
30788
30789A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
30790@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
30791@var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
30792the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
30793and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
30794architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
30795see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
30796
30797@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
30798code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
30799overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
30800target, is not defined.}
30801
30802Reply:
30803@table @samp
30804@item OK
30805success
30806@item
30807not supported
30808@item E @var{NN}
30809for an error
30810@end table
30811
30812@item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30813@itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30814@cindex @samp{z1} packet
30815@cindex @samp{Z1} packet
30816Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
30817address @var{addr}.
30818
30819A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
30820dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind}
30821has the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
30822
30823@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
30824movement.}
30825
30826Reply:
30827@table @samp
30828@item OK
30829success
30830@item
30831not supported
30832@item E @var{NN}
30833for an error
30834@end table
30835
30836@item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30837@itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30838@cindex @samp{z2} packet
30839@cindex @samp{Z2} packet
30840Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
30841@var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
30842
30843Reply:
30844@table @samp
30845@item OK
30846success
30847@item
30848not supported
30849@item E @var{NN}
30850for an error
30851@end table
30852
30853@item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30854@itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30855@cindex @samp{z3} packet
30856@cindex @samp{Z3} packet
30857Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
30858@var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
30859
30860Reply:
30861@table @samp
30862@item OK
30863success
30864@item
30865not supported
30866@item E @var{NN}
30867for an error
30868@end table
30869
30870@item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30871@itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
30872@cindex @samp{z4} packet
30873@cindex @samp{Z4} packet
30874Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
30875@var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
30876
30877Reply:
30878@table @samp
30879@item OK
30880success
30881@item
30882not supported
30883@item E @var{NN}
30884for an error
30885@end table
30886
30887@end table
30888
30889@node Stop Reply Packets
30890@section Stop Reply Packets
30891@cindex stop reply packets
30892
30893The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
30894@samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
30895receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
30896and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
30897when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
30898number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
30899@value{GDBN} source code.
30900
30901As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
30902reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
30903syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
30904components.
30905
30906@table @samp
30907
30908@item S @var{AA}
30909The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
30910number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
30911@var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
30912
30913@item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
30914@cindex @samp{T} packet reply
30915The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
30916number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
30917@samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
30918and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
30919round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
30920this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
30921
30922@itemize @bullet
30923@item
30924If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
30925corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
30926series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
30927two-digit hex number.
30928
30929@item
30930If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
30931the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
30932
30933@item
30934If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
30935the core on which the stop event was detected.
30936
30937@item
30938If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
30939specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
30940reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
30941signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
30942
30943@item
30944Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
30945and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
30946future.
30947@end itemize
30948
30949The currently defined stop reasons are:
30950
30951@table @samp
30952@item watch
30953@itemx rwatch
30954@itemx awatch
30955The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
30956hex.
30957
30958@cindex shared library events, remote reply
30959@item library
30960The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
30961@value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
30962list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
30963
30964@cindex replay log events, remote reply
30965@item replaylog
30966The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
30967logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
30968beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
30969will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
30970for more information.
30971@end table
30972
30973@item W @var{AA}
30974@itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
30975The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
30976applicable to certain targets.
30977
30978The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
30979process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
30980multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
30981The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
30982
30983@item X @var{AA}
30984@itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
30985The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
30986
30987The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
30988terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
30989support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
30990extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
30991
30992@item O @var{XX}@dots{}
30993@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
30994written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
30995while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
30996for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
30997
30998@item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
30999@var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
31000be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
31001correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
31002@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
31003system calls.
31004
31005@samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
31006this very system call.
31007
31008The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
31009call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
31010with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
31011reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
31012or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
31013Protocol Extension}, for more details.
31014
31015@end table
31016
31017@node General Query Packets
31018@section General Query Packets
31019@cindex remote query requests
31020
31021Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
31022packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
31023query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
31024sending information to and from the stub.
31025
31026The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
31027indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
31028@value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
31029definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
31030conventions:
31031
31032@itemize @bullet
31033@item
31034The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
31035@item
31036Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
31037letter.
31038@item
31039The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
31040lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
31041the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
31042foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
31043@end itemize
31044
31045The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
31046parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
31047separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
31048full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
31049in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
31050with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
31051packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
31052for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
31053are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
31054existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
31055packet.}.
31056
31057Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
31058has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
31059explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
31060templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
31061@value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
31062
31063Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
31064
31065@table @samp
31066
31067@item qC
31068@cindex current thread, remote request
31069@cindex @samp{qC} packet
31070Return the current thread ID.
31071
31072Reply:
31073@table @samp
31074@item QC @var{thread-id}
31075Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
31076@ref{thread-id syntax}.
31077@item @r{(anything else)}
31078Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
31079@end table
31080
31081@item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
31082@cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
31083@cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
31084Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
31085IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
31086significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
31087@code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
31088
31089@emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
31090files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
31091Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
31092separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
31093significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
31094detect trailing zeros.
31095
31096Reply:
31097@table @samp
31098@item E @var{NN}
31099An error (such as memory fault)
31100@item C @var{crc32}
31101The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
31102@end table
31103
31104@item qfThreadInfo
31105@itemx qsThreadInfo
31106@cindex list active threads, remote request
31107@cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
31108@cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
31109Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
31110may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
31111works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
31112obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
31113be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
31114sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
31115
31116NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
31117
31118Reply:
31119@table @samp
31120@item m @var{thread-id}
31121A single thread ID
31122@item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
31123a comma-separated list of thread IDs
31124@item l
31125(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
31126@end table
31127
31128In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
31129more thread IDs, separated by commas.
31130@value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
31131ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
31132with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
31133Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
31134fields.
31135
31136@item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
31137@cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
31138@cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
31139Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
31140by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
31141
31142@var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
31143thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
31144
31145@var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
31146thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
31147information associated with the variable.)
31148
31149@var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
31150the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
31151a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
31152object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
31153Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
31154differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
31155
31156Reply:
31157@table @samp
31158@item @var{XX}@dots{}
31159Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
31160local storage requested.
31161
31162@item E @var{nn}
31163An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
31164
31165@item
31166An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
31167@end table
31168
31169@item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
31170@cindex get thread information block address
31171@cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
31172Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
31173
31174@var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
31175
31176Reply:
31177@table @samp
31178@item @var{XX}@dots{}
31179Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
31180thread information block.
31181
31182@item E @var{nn}
31183An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
31184address could not be retrieved.
31185
31186@item
31187An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
31188@end table
31189
31190@item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
31191Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
31192digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
31193subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
31194number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
31195(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
31196returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
31197
31198Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
31199
31200Reply:
31201@table @samp
31202@item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
31203Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
31204returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
31205and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
31206digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
31207is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
31208digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
31209@end table
31210
31211@item qOffsets
31212@cindex section offsets, remote request
31213@cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
31214Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
31215image.
31216
31217Reply:
31218@table @samp
31219@item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
31220Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
31221Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
31222If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
31223@samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
31224segments by the supplied offsets.
31225
31226@emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
31227@value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
31228to the @code{Bss} section.}
31229
31230@item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
31231Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
31232contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
31233@samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
31234conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
31235@var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
31236does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
31237as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
31238kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
31239@end table
31240
31241@item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
31242@cindex thread information, remote request
31243@cindex @samp{qP} packet
31244Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
31245encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
31246(@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
31247
31248Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
31249(see below).
31250
31251Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
31252
31253@item QNonStop:1
31254@item QNonStop:0
31255@cindex non-stop mode, remote request
31256@cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
31257@anchor{QNonStop}
31258Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
31259@xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
31260
31261Reply:
31262@table @samp
31263@item OK
31264The request succeeded.
31265
31266@item E @var{nn}
31267An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
31268
31269@item
31270An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
31271the stub.
31272@end table
31273
31274This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31275by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
31276Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
31277@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
31278
31279@item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
31280@cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
31281@cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
31282@anchor{QPassSignals}
31283Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
31284Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
31285(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
31286strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
31287the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
31288reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
31289combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
31290new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
31291@var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
31292
31293Reply:
31294@table @samp
31295@item OK
31296The request succeeded.
31297
31298@item E @var{nn}
31299An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
31300
31301@item
31302An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
31303the stub.
31304@end table
31305
31306Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
31307command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
31308This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31309by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
31310
31311@item qRcmd,@var{command}
31312@cindex execute remote command, remote request
31313@cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
31314@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
31315execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
31316string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
31317with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
31318packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
31319stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
31320
31321Reply:
31322@table @samp
31323@item OK
31324A command response with no output.
31325@item @var{OUTPUT}
31326A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
31327@item E @var{NN}
31328Indicate a badly formed request.
31329@item
31330An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
31331@end table
31332
31333(Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
31334command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
31335conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
31336packets.)
31337
31338@item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
31339@cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
31340@cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
31341@anchor{qSearch memory}
31342Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
31343@var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
31344@var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
31345
31346Reply:
31347@table @samp
31348@item 0
31349The pattern was not found.
31350@item 1,address
31351The pattern was found at @var{address}.
31352@item E @var{NN}
31353A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
31354@item
31355An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
31356@end table
31357
31358@item QStartNoAckMode
31359@cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
31360@anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
31361Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
31362protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
31363
31364Reply:
31365@table @samp
31366@item OK
31367The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
31368@value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
31369but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
31370@samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
31371@item
31372An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
31373@end table
31374
31375@item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
31376@cindex supported packets, remote query
31377@cindex features of the remote protocol
31378@cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
31379@anchor{qSupported}
31380Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
31381query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
31382@value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
31383features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
31384at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
31385packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
31386high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
31387be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
31388stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
31389automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
31390reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
31391unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
31392helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
31393versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
31394
31395Reply:
31396@table @samp
31397@item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
31398The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
31399depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
31400possible forms).
31401@item
31402An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
31403or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
31404@end table
31405
31406The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
31407@samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
31408are:
31409
31410@table @samp
31411@item @var{name}=@var{value}
31412The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
31413with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
31414on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
31415@item @var{name}+
31416The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
31417need an associated value.
31418@item @var{name}-
31419The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
31420@item @var{name}?
31421The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
31422@value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
31423needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
31424but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
31425@end table
31426
31427Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
31428supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
31429request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
31430state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
31431a different version of @value{GDBN}.
31432
31433The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
31434are defined:
31435
31436@table @samp
31437@item multiprocess
31438This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
31439extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
31440extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
31441including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
31442@xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
31443
31444@item xmlRegisters
31445This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
31446description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
31447specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
31448description.
31449
31450@item qRelocInsn
31451This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
31452@samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
31453instruction reply packet}).
31454@end table
31455
31456Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
31457@var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
31458packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
31459versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
31460for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
31461advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
31462improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
31463an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
31464of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
31465describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
31466all the features it supports.
31467
31468Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
31469responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
31470
31471Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
31472should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
31473require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
31474form response.
31475
31476Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
31477@samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
31478in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
31479stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
31480
31481Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
31482mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
31483architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
31484about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
31485stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
31486
31487These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
31488
31489@multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
31490@c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
31491@c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
31492@item Feature Name
31493@tab Value Required
31494@tab Default
31495@tab Probe Allowed
31496
31497@item @samp{PacketSize}
31498@tab Yes
31499@tab @samp{-}
31500@tab No
31501
31502@item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
31503@tab No
31504@tab @samp{-}
31505@tab Yes
31506
31507@item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
31508@tab No
31509@tab @samp{-}
31510@tab Yes
31511
31512@item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
31513@tab No
31514@tab @samp{-}
31515@tab Yes
31516
31517@item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
31518@tab No
31519@tab @samp{-}
31520@tab Yes
31521
31522@item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
31523@tab No
31524@tab @samp{-}
31525@tab Yes
31526
31527@item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
31528@tab No
31529@tab @samp{-}
31530@tab Yes
31531
31532@item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
31533@tab No
31534@tab @samp{-}
31535@tab Yes
31536
31537@item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
31538@tab No
31539@tab @samp{-}
31540@tab Yes
31541
31542@item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
31543@tab No
31544@tab @samp{-}
31545@tab Yes
31546
31547
31548@item @samp{QNonStop}
31549@tab No
31550@tab @samp{-}
31551@tab Yes
31552
31553@item @samp{QPassSignals}
31554@tab No
31555@tab @samp{-}
31556@tab Yes
31557
31558@item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
31559@tab No
31560@tab @samp{-}
31561@tab Yes
31562
31563@item @samp{multiprocess}
31564@tab No
31565@tab @samp{-}
31566@tab No
31567
31568@item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
31569@tab No
31570@tab @samp{-}
31571@tab No
31572
31573@item @samp{ReverseContinue}
31574@tab No
31575@tab @samp{-}
31576@tab No
31577
31578@item @samp{ReverseStep}
31579@tab No
31580@tab @samp{-}
31581@tab No
31582
31583@item @samp{TracepointSource}
31584@tab No
31585@tab @samp{-}
31586@tab No
31587
31588@end multitable
31589
31590These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
31591
31592@table @samp
31593@cindex packet size, remote protocol
31594@item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
31595The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
31596length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
31597transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
31598data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
31599There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
31600stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
31601byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
31602@value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
31603
31604@item qXfer:auxv:read
31605The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
31606(@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
31607
31608@item qXfer:features:read
31609The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
31610(@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
31611
31612@item qXfer:libraries:read
31613The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
31614(@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
31615
31616@item qXfer:memory-map:read
31617The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
31618(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
31619
31620@item qXfer:spu:read
31621The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
31622(@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
31623
31624@item qXfer:spu:write
31625The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
31626(@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
31627
31628@item qXfer:siginfo:read
31629The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
31630(@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
31631
31632@item qXfer:siginfo:write
31633The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
31634(@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
31635
31636@item qXfer:threads:read
31637The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
31638(@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
31639
31640@item QNonStop
31641The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
31642(@pxref{QNonStop}).
31643
31644@item QPassSignals
31645The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
31646(@pxref{QPassSignals}).
31647
31648@item QStartNoAckMode
31649The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
31650prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
31651
31652@item multiprocess
31653@anchor{multiprocess extensions}
31654@cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
31655The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
31656protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
31657thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
31658add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
31659replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
31660syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
31661debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
31662multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
31663indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
31664
31665@item qXfer:osdata:read
31666The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
31667((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
31668
31669@item ConditionalTracepoints
31670The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
31671for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
31672
31673@item ReverseContinue
31674The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
31675(@pxref{bc}).
31676
31677@item ReverseStep
31678The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
31679(@pxref{bs}).
31680
31681@item TracepointSource
31682The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
31683the source form of tracepoint definitions.
31684
31685@end table
31686
31687@item qSymbol::
31688@cindex symbol lookup, remote request
31689@cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
31690Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
31691requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
31692
31693Reply:
31694@table @samp
31695@item OK
31696The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
31697@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
31698The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
31699@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
31700@samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
31701below.
31702@end table
31703
31704@item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
31705Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
31706
31707@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
31708target has previously requested.
31709
31710@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
31711@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
31712will be empty.
31713
31714Reply:
31715@table @samp
31716@item OK
31717The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
31718@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
31719The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
31720encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
31721(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
31722@end table
31723
31724@item qTBuffer
31725@item QTBuffer
31726@item QTDisconnected
31727@itemx QTDP
31728@itemx QTDPsrc
31729@itemx QTDV
31730@itemx qTfP
31731@itemx qTfV
31732@itemx QTFrame
31733@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
31734
31735@item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
31736@cindex thread attributes info, remote request
31737@cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
31738Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
31739the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
31740see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
31741string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
31742for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
31743displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
31744examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
31745@samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
31746
31747Reply:
31748@table @samp
31749@item @var{XX}@dots{}
31750Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
31751comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
31752the thread's attributes.
31753@end table
31754
31755(Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
31756the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
31757conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
31758packets.)
31759
31760@item QTSave
31761@item qTsP
31762@item qTsV
31763@itemx QTStart
31764@itemx QTStop
31765@itemx QTinit
31766@itemx QTro
31767@itemx qTStatus
31768@itemx qTV
31769@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
31770
31771@item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
31772@cindex read special object, remote request
31773@cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
31774@anchor{qXfer read}
31775Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
31776identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
31777starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
31778encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
31779additional details about what data to access.
31780
31781Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
31782@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
31783formats, listed below.
31784
31785@table @samp
31786@item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
31787@anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
31788Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
31789auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
31790
31791This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31792by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
31793
31794@item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
31795@anchor{qXfer target description read}
31796Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
31797annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
31798always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
31799
31800This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31801by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
31802
31803@item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
31804@anchor{qXfer library list read}
31805Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
31806The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
31807(@pxref{qXfer read}).
31808
31809Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
31810not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
31811the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
31812
31813This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31814by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
31815
31816@item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
31817@anchor{qXfer memory map read}
31818Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
31819annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
31820(@pxref{qXfer read}).
31821
31822This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31823by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
31824
31825@item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
31826@anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
31827Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
31828system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
31829empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
31830
31831This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31832by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
31833(@pxref{qSupported}).
31834
31835@item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
31836@anchor{qXfer spu read}
31837Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
31838annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
31839@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
31840in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
31841in that context to be accessed.
31842
31843This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31844by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
31845(@pxref{qSupported}).
31846
31847@item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
31848@anchor{qXfer threads read}
31849Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
31850annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
31851(@pxref{qXfer read}).
31852
31853This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31854by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
31855
31856@item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
31857@anchor{qXfer osdata read}
31858Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
31859@xref{Operating System Information}.
31860
31861@end table
31862
31863Reply:
31864@table @samp
31865@item m @var{data}
31866Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
31867target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
31868it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
31869block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
31870@var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
31871request.
31872
31873@item l @var{data}
31874Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
31875There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
31876than the @var{length} in the request.
31877
31878@item l
31879The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
31880There is no more data to be read.
31881
31882@item E00
31883The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
31884
31885@item E @var{nn}
31886The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
31887@var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
31888
31889@item
31890An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
31891the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
31892@end table
31893
31894@item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
31895@cindex write data into object, remote request
31896@anchor{qXfer write}
31897Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
31898identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
31899into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
31900(@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
31901is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
31902to access.
31903
31904Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
31905@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
31906formats, listed below.
31907
31908@table @samp
31909@item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
31910@anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
31911Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
31912The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
31913empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
31914
31915This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31916by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
31917(@pxref{qSupported}).
31918
31919@item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
31920@anchor{qXfer spu write}
31921Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
31922annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
31923@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
31924in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
31925in that context to be accessed.
31926
31927This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
31928by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
31929@end table
31930
31931Reply:
31932@table @samp
31933@item @var{nn}
31934@var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
31935This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
31936
31937@item E00
31938The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
31939
31940@item E @var{nn}
31941The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
31942@var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
31943
31944@item
31945An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
31946recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
31947@end table
31948
31949@item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
31950Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
31951not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
31952@var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
31953must respond with an empty packet.
31954
31955@item qAttached:@var{pid}
31956@cindex query attached, remote request
31957@cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
31958Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
31959existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
31960protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
31961@var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
31962process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
31963the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
31964
31965This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
31966should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
31967the @code{quit} command.
31968
31969Reply:
31970@table @samp
31971@item 1
31972The remote server attached to an existing process.
31973@item 0
31974The remote server created a new process.
31975@item E @var{NN}
31976A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
31977@end table
31978
31979@end table
31980
31981@node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
31982@section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
31983
31984This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
31985target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
31986details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
31987
31988@subsection ARM
31989
31990@subsubsection Breakpoint Kinds
31991
31992These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
31993
31994@table @r
31995
31996@item 2
3199716-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
31998
31999@item 3
3200032-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
32001
32002@item 4
3200332-bit ARM mode breakpoint.
32004
32005@end table
32006
32007@subsection MIPS
32008
32009@subsubsection Register Packet Format
32010
32011The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
32012In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
32013sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
32014to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
32015byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
32016most-significant - least-significant.
32017
32018@table @r
32019
32020@item MIPS32
32021
32022All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
3202332 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
32024registers; fsr; fir; fp.
32025
32026@item MIPS64
32027
32028All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
32029thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
32030as @code{MIPS32}.
32031
32032@end table
32033
32034@node Tracepoint Packets
32035@section Tracepoint Packets
32036@cindex tracepoint packets
32037@cindex packets, tracepoint
32038
32039Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
32040tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32041
32042@table @samp
32043
32044@item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
32045Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
32046is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
32047the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
32048count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
32049then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
32050the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
32051for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
32052tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
32053by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
32054encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
32055further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
32056actions.
32057
32058Replies:
32059@table @samp
32060@item OK
32061The packet was understood and carried out.
32062@item qRelocInsn
32063@xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
32064@item
32065The packet was not recognized.
32066@end table
32067
32068@item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
32069Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
32070@var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
32071this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
32072another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
32073trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
32074specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
32075
32076In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
32077can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
32078is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
32079actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
32080taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
32081@samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
32082tracepoint actions.
32083
32084The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
32085actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
32086following forms:
32087
32088@table @samp
32089
32090@item R @var{mask}
32091Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
32092a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
32093@var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
32094zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
32095not fit in a 32-bit word.
32096
32097@item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
32098Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
32099number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
32100@samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
32101address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
32102@var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
32103values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
32104
32105@item X @var{len},@var{expr}
32106Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
32107it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
32108@ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
32109two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
32110in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
32111packet).
32112
32113@end table
32114
32115Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
32116packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
32117length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
32118action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
32119actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
32120must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
32121``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
32122separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
32123
32124Replies:
32125@table @samp
32126@item OK
32127The packet was understood and carried out.
32128@item qRelocInsn
32129@xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
32130@item
32131The packet was not recognized.
32132@end table
32133
32134@item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
32135@cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
32136Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
32137This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
32138originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type}
32139is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
32140tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
32141@var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
32142
32143@var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
32144string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
32145This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
32146fit in a single packet.
32147@c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
32148@c tracepoint descriptions section.
32149
32150The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
32151@samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
32152@value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
32153list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
32154
32155The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
32156report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
32157query packets.
32158
32159Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
32160if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
32161Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
32162much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
32163tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
32164the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
32165could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
32166be found.
32167
32168@item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
32169@cindex define trace state variable, remote request
32170@cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
32171Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
32172value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
32173and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
32174the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
32175target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
32176mentioned in expressions.
32177
32178@item QTFrame:@var{n}
32179Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
32180register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
32181request packets from @value{GDBN}.
32182
32183A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
32184requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
32185without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
32186one of the following forms:
32187
32188@table @samp
32189@item F @var{f}
32190The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
32191@var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
32192was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
32193
32194@item T @var{t}
32195The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
32196@var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
32197
32198@end table
32199
32200@item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
32201Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
32202currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
32203@var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
32204
32205@item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
32206Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
32207currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
32208is a hexadecimal number.
32209
32210@item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
32211Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
32212currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
32213and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
32214numbers.
32215
32216@item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
32217Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
32218frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
32219
32220@item QTStart
32221Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
32222tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
32223@samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
32224instruction reply packet}).
32225
32226@item QTStop
32227End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
32228
32229@item QTinit
32230Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
32231
32232@item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
32233Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
32234will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
32235if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
32236
32237@value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
32238containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
32239still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
32240there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
32241
32242@item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
32243Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
32244disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
32245continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
32246@value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
32247
32248@item qTStatus
32249Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
32250
32251The reply has the form:
32252
32253@table @samp
32254
32255@item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
32256@var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
32257running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
32258optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
32259
32260@end table
32261
32262If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
32263explanations as one of the optional fields:
32264
32265@table @samp
32266
32267@item tnotrun:0
32268No trace has been run yet.
32269
32270@item tstop:0
32271The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command.
32272
32273@item tfull:0
32274The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
32275
32276@item tdisconnected:0
32277The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
32278
32279@item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
32280The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
32281
32282@item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
32283The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
32284string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
32285(for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression).
32286@var{text} is hex encoded.
32287
32288@item tunknown:0
32289The trace stopped for some other reason.
32290
32291@end table
32292
32293Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
32294Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
32295the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
32296numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
32297trace.
32298
32299@table @samp
32300
32301@item tframes:@var{n}
32302The number of trace frames in the buffer.
32303
32304@item tcreated:@var{n}
32305The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
32306be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
32307
32308@item tsize:@var{n}
32309The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
32310
32311@item tfree:@var{n}
32312The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
32313
32314@item circular:@var{n}
32315The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32316trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32317necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32318and may fill up.
32319
32320@item disconn:@var{n}
32321The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32322tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32323that the trace run will stop.
32324
32325@end table
32326
32327@item qTV:@var{var}
32328@cindex trace state variable value, remote request
32329@cindex @samp{qTV} packet
32330Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
32331
32332Replies:
32333@table @samp
32334@item V@var{value}
32335The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
32336value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
32337saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
32338user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
32339different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
32340program is running.
32341
32342@item U
32343The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
32344if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
32345was not collected.
32346@end table
32347
32348@item qTfP
32349@itemx qTsP
32350These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
32351the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
32352of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
32353to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
32354that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
32355
32356@item qTfV
32357@itemx qTsV
32358These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
32359target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
32360and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
32361these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
32362trace state variables.
32363
32364@item QTSave:@var{filename}
32365This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
32366@var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded
32367as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
32368absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
32369
32370@item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
32371Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
32372starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
32373a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
32374The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
32375in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
32376A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
32377available.
32378
32379@item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
32380This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
32381@var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
32382
32383@end table
32384
32385@subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
32386When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
32387relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
32388different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
32389enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
32390return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
32391PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
32392of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
32393it had executed in the original location.
32394
32395In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
32396respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
32397packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
32398this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
32399documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
32400descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
32401format of the request is:
32402
32403@table @samp
32404@item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
32405
32406This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
32407to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
32408instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
32409@var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
32410memory starting at @var{to}.
32411@end table
32412
32413Replies:
32414@table @samp
32415@item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
32416Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is
32417the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
32418@item E @var{NN}
32419A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
32420relocating the instruction.
32421@end table
32422
32423@node Host I/O Packets
32424@section Host I/O Packets
32425@cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
32426@cindex file transfer, remote protocol
32427
32428The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
32429operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
32430used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
32431filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
32432layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
32433Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
32434protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
32435Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
32436target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
32437Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
32438
32439The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
32440its arguments. They have this format:
32441
32442@table @samp
32443
32444@item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
32445@var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
32446should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
32447for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
32448the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
32449numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
32450used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
32451hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
32452buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
32453
32454@end table
32455
32456The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
32457
32458@table @samp
32459
32460@item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
32461@var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
32462non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
32463@var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
32464value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
32465operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
32466binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
32467normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
32468documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
32469@var{attachment}.
32470
32471@item
32472An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
32473
32474@end table
32475
32476These are the supported Host I/O operations:
32477
32478@table @samp
32479@item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
32480Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
32481return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
32482@var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
32483(@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
32484of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
32485@xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
32486
32487@item vFile:close: @var{fd}
32488Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
32489-1 if an error occurs.
32490
32491@item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
32492Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
32493@var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
32494relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
32495common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
32496condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
32497returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
32498@var{count} was zero.
32499
32500The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
32501If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
32502attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
32503number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
32504some characters were escaped.
32505
32506@item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
32507Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
32508to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
32509file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
32510separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
32511packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
32512which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
32513error occurred.
32514
32515@item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
32516Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
32517or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
32518
32519@end table
32520
32521@node Interrupts
32522@section Interrupts
32523@cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
32524
32525When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
32526attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
32527a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
32528control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
32529
32530The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
32531mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
32532currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
32533interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
32534@code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
32535
32536@samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
32537transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
32538@code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
32539the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
32540transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
32541and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
32542(@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
32543@code{0x03} as part of its packet.
32544
32545@code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
32546When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
32547it stops execution and connects to gdb.
32548
32549Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
32550precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
32551implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
32552threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
32553currently-executing threads and processes.
32554If the stub is successful at interrupting the
32555running program, it should send one of the stop
32556reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
32557of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
32558for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
32559Interrupts received while the
32560program is stopped are discarded.
32561
32562@node Notification Packets
32563@section Notification Packets
32564@cindex notification packets
32565@cindex packets, notification
32566
32567The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
32568packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
32569may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
32570present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
32571without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
32572are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
32573is not a problem.
32574
32575A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
32576@var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
32577and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
32578as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
32579never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
32580receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
32581to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
32582
32583Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
32584colon characters, followed by a colon character.
32585
32586Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
32587notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
32588timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
32589not they understand it.
32590
32591Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
32592protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
32593future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
32594new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
32595recipients.
32596
32597(Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
32598the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
32599transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
32600are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
32601assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
32602
32603The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
32604defined:
32605
32606@table @samp
32607@item Stop: @var{reply}
32608Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
32609The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
32610described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
32611for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
32612@value{GDBN}.
32613@end table
32614
32615@node Remote Non-Stop
32616@section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
32617
32618@value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
32619multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
32620supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
32621@samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
32622
32623@value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
32624establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
32625does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
32626must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
32627all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
32628probe the target state after a mode change.
32629
32630In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
32631would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
32632asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
32633inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
32634in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
32635mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
32636when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
32637of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
32638affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
32639to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
32640threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
32641
32642Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
32643additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
32644previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
32645synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
32646@value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
32647the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
32648if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
32649ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
32650finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
32651sending any queued stop events.
32652
32653Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
32654notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
32655@value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
32656@value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
32657@samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
32658Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
32659the stub so there is no ambiguity.
32660
32661After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
32662acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
32663as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
32664is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
32665send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
32666process normally.
32667
32668Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
32669stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
32670normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
32671@samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
32672permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
32673should process normally.
32674
32675If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
32676additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
32677response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
32678send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
32679notification, and the process shall be repeated.
32680
32681In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
32682follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
32683sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
32684sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
32685it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
32686stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
32687subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
32688using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
32689asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
32690If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
32691or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
32692@samp{OK}.
32693
32694@node Packet Acknowledgment
32695@section Packet Acknowledgment
32696
32697@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
32698@cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
32699By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
32700the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
32701the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
32702This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
32703unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
32704
32705In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
32706TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
32707It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
32708overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
32709@samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
32710
32711When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
32712expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
32713and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
32714@ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
32715
32716If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
32717no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
32718by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
32719@pxref{qSupported}.
32720If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
32721disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
32722(@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
32723@value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
32724Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
32725@value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
32726response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
32727
32728Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
32729between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
32730it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
32731connection.
32732Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
32733new connection is established,
32734there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
32735for the current connection, once disabled.
32736
32737@node Examples
32738@section Examples
32739
32740Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
32741does not get any direct output:
32742
32743@smallexample
32744-> @code{R00}
32745<- @code{+}
32746@emph{target restarts}
32747-> @code{?}
32748<- @code{+}
32749<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
32750-> @code{+}
32751@end smallexample
32752
32753Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
32754
32755@smallexample
32756-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
32757<- @code{+}
32758-> @code{s}
32759<- @code{+}
32760@emph{time passes}
32761<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
32762-> @code{+}
32763-> @code{g}
32764<- @code{+}
32765<- @code{1455@dots{}}
32766-> @code{+}
32767@end smallexample
32768
32769@node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
32770@section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
32771@cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
32772
32773@menu
32774* File-I/O Overview::
32775* Protocol Basics::
32776* The F Request Packet::
32777* The F Reply Packet::
32778* The Ctrl-C Message::
32779* Console I/O::
32780* List of Supported Calls::
32781* Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
32782* Constants::
32783* File-I/O Examples::
32784@end menu
32785
32786@node File-I/O Overview
32787@subsection File-I/O Overview
32788@cindex file-i/o overview
32789
32790The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
32791target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
32792system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
32793remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
32794actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
32795This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
32796
32797The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
32798It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
32799@value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
32800translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
32801protocol representations when data is transmitted.
32802
32803The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
32804@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
32805or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
32806the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
32807memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
32808the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
32809(@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
32810
32811The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
32812the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
32813after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
32814previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
32815request from @value{GDBN} is required.
32816
32817@smallexample
32818(@value{GDBP}) continue
32819 <- target requests 'system call X'
32820 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
32821 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
32822 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
32823 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
32824@end smallexample
32825
32826The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
32827the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
32828named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
32829system are not supported by this protocol.
32830
32831File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
32832
32833@node Protocol Basics
32834@subsection Protocol Basics
32835@cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
32836
32837The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
32838as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
32839@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
32840the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
32841of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
32842This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
32843to call the appropriate host system call:
32844
32845@itemize @bullet
32846@item
32847A unique identifier for the requested system call.
32848
32849@item
32850All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
32851in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
32852pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
32853Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
32854
32855@end itemize
32856
32857At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
32858
32859@itemize @bullet
32860@item
32861If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
32862system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
32863standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
32864expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
32865packet.
32866
32867@item
32868@value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
32869representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
32870
32871@item
32872@value{GDBN} calls the system call.
32873
32874@item
32875It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
32876
32877@item
32878If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
32879by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
32880target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
32881by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
32882packet.
32883
32884@end itemize
32885
32886Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
32887necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
32888
32889@itemize @bullet
32890@item
32891Return value.
32892
32893@item
32894@code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
32895
32896@item
32897``Ctrl-C'' flag.
32898
32899@end itemize
32900
32901After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
32902the latest continue or step action.
32903
32904@node The F Request Packet
32905@subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
32906@cindex file-i/o request packet
32907@cindex @code{F} request packet
32908
32909The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
32910
32911@table @samp
32912@item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
32913
32914@var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
32915This is just the name of the function.
32916
32917@var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
32918Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
32919of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
32920datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
32921of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
32922comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
32923string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
32924
32925@end table
32926
32927
32928
32929@node The F Reply Packet
32930@subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
32931@cindex file-i/o reply packet
32932@cindex @code{F} reply packet
32933
32934The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
32935
32936@table @samp
32937
32938@item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
32939
32940@var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
32941
32942@var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
32943representation.
32944This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
32945
32946@var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
32947case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
32948The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
32949
32950@smallexample
32951F0,0,C
32952@end smallexample
32953
32954@noindent
32955or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
32956
32957@smallexample
32958F-1,4,C
32959@end smallexample
32960
32961@noindent
32962assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
32963
32964@end table
32965
32966
32967@node The Ctrl-C Message
32968@subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
32969@cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
32970
32971If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
32972reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
32973the target should behave as if it had
32974gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
32975interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
32976(as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
32977packet.
32978
32979It's important for the target to know in which
32980state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
32981
32982@itemize @bullet
32983@item
32984The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
32985
32986@item
32987The system call on the host has been finished.
32988
32989@end itemize
32990
32991These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
32992returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
32993call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
32994on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
32995system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
32996as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
32997
32998@value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
32999yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
33000@code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
33001before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
33002@value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
33003The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
33004or the full action has been completed.
33005
33006@node Console I/O
33007@subsection Console I/O
33008@cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
33009
33010By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
33011descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
33012on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
33013(@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
33014by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
330150 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
33016conditions is met:
33017
33018@itemize @bullet
33019@item
33020The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
33021@code{read}
33022system call is treated as finished.
33023
33024@item
33025The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
33026newline.
33027
33028@item
33029The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
33030character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
33031
33032@end itemize
33033
33034If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
33035the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
33036either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
33037is stopped at the user's request.
33038
33039
33040@node List of Supported Calls
33041@subsection List of Supported Calls
33042@cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
33043
33044@menu
33045* open::
33046* close::
33047* read::
33048* write::
33049* lseek::
33050* rename::
33051* unlink::
33052* stat/fstat::
33053* gettimeofday::
33054* isatty::
33055* system::
33056@end menu
33057
33058@node open
33059@unnumberedsubsubsec open
33060@cindex open, file-i/o system call
33061
33062@table @asis
33063@item Synopsis:
33064@smallexample
33065int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
33066int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
33067@end smallexample
33068
33069@item Request:
33070@samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
33071
33072@noindent
33073@var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
33074
33075@table @code
33076@item O_CREAT
33077If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
33078rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
33079are concerned.
33080
33081@item O_EXCL
33082When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
33083an error and open() fails.
33084
33085@item O_TRUNC
33086If the file already exists and the open mode allows
33087writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
33088truncated to zero length.
33089
33090@item O_APPEND
33091The file is opened in append mode.
33092
33093@item O_RDONLY
33094The file is opened for reading only.
33095
33096@item O_WRONLY
33097The file is opened for writing only.
33098
33099@item O_RDWR
33100The file is opened for reading and writing.
33101@end table
33102
33103@noindent
33104Other bits are silently ignored.
33105
33106
33107@noindent
33108@var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
33109
33110@table @code
33111@item S_IRUSR
33112User has read permission.
33113
33114@item S_IWUSR
33115User has write permission.
33116
33117@item S_IRGRP
33118Group has read permission.
33119
33120@item S_IWGRP
33121Group has write permission.
33122
33123@item S_IROTH
33124Others have read permission.
33125
33126@item S_IWOTH
33127Others have write permission.
33128@end table
33129
33130@noindent
33131Other bits are silently ignored.
33132
33133
33134@item Return value:
33135@code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
33136occurred.
33137
33138@item Errors:
33139
33140@table @code
33141@item EEXIST
33142@var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
33143
33144@item EISDIR
33145@var{pathname} refers to a directory.
33146
33147@item EACCES
33148The requested access is not allowed.
33149
33150@item ENAMETOOLONG
33151@var{pathname} was too long.
33152
33153@item ENOENT
33154A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
33155
33156@item ENODEV
33157@var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
33158
33159@item EROFS
33160@var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
33161write access was requested.
33162
33163@item EFAULT
33164@var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
33165
33166@item ENOSPC
33167No space on device to create the file.
33168
33169@item EMFILE
33170The process already has the maximum number of files open.
33171
33172@item ENFILE
33173The limit on the total number of files open on the system
33174has been reached.
33175
33176@item EINTR
33177The call was interrupted by the user.
33178@end table
33179
33180@end table
33181
33182@node close
33183@unnumberedsubsubsec close
33184@cindex close, file-i/o system call
33185
33186@table @asis
33187@item Synopsis:
33188@smallexample
33189int close(int fd);
33190@end smallexample
33191
33192@item Request:
33193@samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
33194
33195@item Return value:
33196@code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
33197
33198@item Errors:
33199
33200@table @code
33201@item EBADF
33202@var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
33203
33204@item EINTR
33205The call was interrupted by the user.
33206@end table
33207
33208@end table
33209
33210@node read
33211@unnumberedsubsubsec read
33212@cindex read, file-i/o system call
33213
33214@table @asis
33215@item Synopsis:
33216@smallexample
33217int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
33218@end smallexample
33219
33220@item Request:
33221@samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
33222
33223@item Return value:
33224On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
33225Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
33226returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
33227
33228@item Errors:
33229
33230@table @code
33231@item EBADF
33232@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
33233reading.
33234
33235@item EFAULT
33236@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
33237
33238@item EINTR
33239The call was interrupted by the user.
33240@end table
33241
33242@end table
33243
33244@node write
33245@unnumberedsubsubsec write
33246@cindex write, file-i/o system call
33247
33248@table @asis
33249@item Synopsis:
33250@smallexample
33251int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
33252@end smallexample
33253
33254@item Request:
33255@samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
33256
33257@item Return value:
33258On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
33259Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
33260is returned.
33261
33262@item Errors:
33263
33264@table @code
33265@item EBADF
33266@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
33267writing.
33268
33269@item EFAULT
33270@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
33271
33272@item EFBIG
33273An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
33274host-specific maximum file size allowed.
33275
33276@item ENOSPC
33277No space on device to write the data.
33278
33279@item EINTR
33280The call was interrupted by the user.
33281@end table
33282
33283@end table
33284
33285@node lseek
33286@unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
33287@cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
33288
33289@table @asis
33290@item Synopsis:
33291@smallexample
33292long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
33293@end smallexample
33294
33295@item Request:
33296@samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
33297
33298@var{flag} is one of:
33299
33300@table @code
33301@item SEEK_SET
33302The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
33303
33304@item SEEK_CUR
33305The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
33306bytes.
33307
33308@item SEEK_END
33309The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
33310bytes.
33311@end table
33312
33313@item Return value:
33314On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
33315the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
33316value of -1 is returned.
33317
33318@item Errors:
33319
33320@table @code
33321@item EBADF
33322@var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
33323
33324@item ESPIPE
33325@var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
33326
33327@item EINVAL
33328@var{flag} is not a proper value.
33329
33330@item EINTR
33331The call was interrupted by the user.
33332@end table
33333
33334@end table
33335
33336@node rename
33337@unnumberedsubsubsec rename
33338@cindex rename, file-i/o system call
33339
33340@table @asis
33341@item Synopsis:
33342@smallexample
33343int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
33344@end smallexample
33345
33346@item Request:
33347@samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
33348
33349@item Return value:
33350On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
33351
33352@item Errors:
33353
33354@table @code
33355@item EISDIR
33356@var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
33357directory.
33358
33359@item EEXIST
33360@var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
33361
33362@item EBUSY
33363@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
33364process.
33365
33366@item EINVAL
33367An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
33368of itself.
33369
33370@item ENOTDIR
33371A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
33372path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
33373and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
33374
33375@item EFAULT
33376@var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
33377
33378@item EACCES
33379No access to the file or the path of the file.
33380
33381@item ENAMETOOLONG
33382
33383@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
33384
33385@item ENOENT
33386A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
33387
33388@item EROFS
33389The file is on a read-only filesystem.
33390
33391@item ENOSPC
33392The device containing the file has no room for the new
33393directory entry.
33394
33395@item EINTR
33396The call was interrupted by the user.
33397@end table
33398
33399@end table
33400
33401@node unlink
33402@unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
33403@cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
33404
33405@table @asis
33406@item Synopsis:
33407@smallexample
33408int unlink(const char *pathname);
33409@end smallexample
33410
33411@item Request:
33412@samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
33413
33414@item Return value:
33415On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
33416
33417@item Errors:
33418
33419@table @code
33420@item EACCES
33421No access to the file or the path of the file.
33422
33423@item EPERM
33424The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
33425
33426@item EBUSY
33427The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
33428being used by another process.
33429
33430@item EFAULT
33431@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
33432
33433@item ENAMETOOLONG
33434@var{pathname} was too long.
33435
33436@item ENOENT
33437A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
33438
33439@item ENOTDIR
33440A component of the path is not a directory.
33441
33442@item EROFS
33443The file is on a read-only filesystem.
33444
33445@item EINTR
33446The call was interrupted by the user.
33447@end table
33448
33449@end table
33450
33451@node stat/fstat
33452@unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
33453@cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
33454@cindex stat, file-i/o system call
33455
33456@table @asis
33457@item Synopsis:
33458@smallexample
33459int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
33460int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
33461@end smallexample
33462
33463@item Request:
33464@samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
33465@samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
33466
33467@item Return value:
33468On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
33469
33470@item Errors:
33471
33472@table @code
33473@item EBADF
33474@var{fd} is not a valid open file.
33475
33476@item ENOENT
33477A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
33478path is an empty string.
33479
33480@item ENOTDIR
33481A component of the path is not a directory.
33482
33483@item EFAULT
33484@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
33485
33486@item EACCES
33487No access to the file or the path of the file.
33488
33489@item ENAMETOOLONG
33490@var{pathname} was too long.
33491
33492@item EINTR
33493The call was interrupted by the user.
33494@end table
33495
33496@end table
33497
33498@node gettimeofday
33499@unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
33500@cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
33501
33502@table @asis
33503@item Synopsis:
33504@smallexample
33505int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
33506@end smallexample
33507
33508@item Request:
33509@samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
33510
33511@item Return value:
33512On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
33513
33514@item Errors:
33515
33516@table @code
33517@item EINVAL
33518@var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
33519
33520@item EFAULT
33521@var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
33522@end table
33523
33524@end table
33525
33526@node isatty
33527@unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
33528@cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
33529
33530@table @asis
33531@item Synopsis:
33532@smallexample
33533int isatty(int fd);
33534@end smallexample
33535
33536@item Request:
33537@samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
33538
33539@item Return value:
33540Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
33541
33542@item Errors:
33543
33544@table @code
33545@item EINTR
33546The call was interrupted by the user.
33547@end table
33548
33549@end table
33550
33551Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
335521 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
33553to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
33554would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
33555needed.
33556
33557
33558@node system
33559@unnumberedsubsubsec system
33560@cindex system, file-i/o system call
33561
33562@table @asis
33563@item Synopsis:
33564@smallexample
33565int system(const char *command);
33566@end smallexample
33567
33568@item Request:
33569@samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
33570
33571@item Return value:
33572If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
33573available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
33574For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
33575return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
33576command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
33577return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
33578@file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
33579
33580@item Errors:
33581
33582@table @code
33583@item EINTR
33584The call was interrupted by the user.
33585@end table
33586
33587@end table
33588
33589@value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
33590to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
33591the host is simplified before it's returned
33592to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
33593is discarded, and the return value consists
33594entirely of the exit status of the called command.
33595
33596Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
33597by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
33598@code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
33599
33600@table @code
33601@item set remote system-call-allowed
33602@kindex set remote system-call-allowed
33603Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
33604protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
33605
33606@item show remote system-call-allowed
33607@kindex show remote system-call-allowed
33608Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
33609protocol.
33610@end table
33611
33612@node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
33613@subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
33614@cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
33615
33616@menu
33617* Integral Datatypes::
33618* Pointer Values::
33619* Memory Transfer::
33620* struct stat::
33621* struct timeval::
33622@end menu
33623
33624@node Integral Datatypes
33625@unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
33626@cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
33627
33628The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
33629@code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
33630@code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
33631
33632@code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
33633implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
33634
33635@code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
33636
33637@xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
33638in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
33639
33640@code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
33641
33642All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
33643structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
33644byte order.
33645
33646@node Pointer Values
33647@unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
33648@cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
33649
33650Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
33651is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
33652transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
33653are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
33654
33655@smallexample
33656@code{1aaf/12}
33657@end smallexample
33658
33659@noindent
33660which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
33661The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
33662the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
33663at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
33664
33665@smallexample
33666@code{123456/d}
33667@end smallexample
33668
33669@node Memory Transfer
33670@unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
33671@cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
33672
33673Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
33674example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
33675with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
33676this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
33677packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
33678it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
33679data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
33680
33681
33682@node struct stat
33683@unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
33684@cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
33685
33686The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
33687is defined as follows:
33688
33689@smallexample
33690struct stat @{
33691 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
33692 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
33693 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
33694 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
33695 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
33696 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
33697 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
33698 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
33699 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
33700 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
33701 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
33702 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
33703 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
33704@};
33705@end smallexample
33706
33707The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
33708appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
33709structure is of size 64 bytes.
33710
33711The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
33712range of values.
33713
33714@table @code
33715
33716@item st_dev
33717A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
33718
33719@item st_ino
33720No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
33721
33722@item st_mode
33723Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
33724bits have currently no meaning for the target.
33725
33726@item st_uid
33727@itemx st_gid
33728@itemx st_rdev
33729No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
33730
33731@item st_atime
33732@itemx st_mtime
33733@itemx st_ctime
33734These values have a host and file system dependent
33735accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
33736support exact timing values.
33737@end table
33738
33739The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
33740responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
33741continuing.
33742
33743Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
33744representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
33745get truncated on the target.
33746
33747@node struct timeval
33748@unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
33749@cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
33750
33751The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
33752is defined as follows:
33753
33754@smallexample
33755struct timeval @{
33756 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
33757 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
33758@};
33759@end smallexample
33760
33761The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
33762appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
33763structure is of size 8 bytes.
33764
33765@node Constants
33766@subsection Constants
33767@cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
33768
33769The following values are used for the constants inside of the
33770protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
33771values before and after the call as needed.
33772
33773@menu
33774* Open Flags::
33775* mode_t Values::
33776* Errno Values::
33777* Lseek Flags::
33778* Limits::
33779@end menu
33780
33781@node Open Flags
33782@unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
33783@cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
33784
33785All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
33786
33787@smallexample
33788 O_RDONLY 0x0
33789 O_WRONLY 0x1
33790 O_RDWR 0x2
33791 O_APPEND 0x8
33792 O_CREAT 0x200
33793 O_TRUNC 0x400
33794 O_EXCL 0x800
33795@end smallexample
33796
33797@node mode_t Values
33798@unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
33799@cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
33800
33801All values are given in octal representation.
33802
33803@smallexample
33804 S_IFREG 0100000
33805 S_IFDIR 040000
33806 S_IRUSR 0400
33807 S_IWUSR 0200
33808 S_IXUSR 0100
33809 S_IRGRP 040
33810 S_IWGRP 020
33811 S_IXGRP 010
33812 S_IROTH 04
33813 S_IWOTH 02
33814 S_IXOTH 01
33815@end smallexample
33816
33817@node Errno Values
33818@unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
33819@cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
33820
33821All values are given in decimal representation.
33822
33823@smallexample
33824 EPERM 1
33825 ENOENT 2
33826 EINTR 4
33827 EBADF 9
33828 EACCES 13
33829 EFAULT 14
33830 EBUSY 16
33831 EEXIST 17
33832 ENODEV 19
33833 ENOTDIR 20
33834 EISDIR 21
33835 EINVAL 22
33836 ENFILE 23
33837 EMFILE 24
33838 EFBIG 27
33839 ENOSPC 28
33840 ESPIPE 29
33841 EROFS 30
33842 ENAMETOOLONG 91
33843 EUNKNOWN 9999
33844@end smallexample
33845
33846 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
33847 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
33848
33849@node Lseek Flags
33850@unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
33851@cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
33852
33853@smallexample
33854 SEEK_SET 0
33855 SEEK_CUR 1
33856 SEEK_END 2
33857@end smallexample
33858
33859@node Limits
33860@unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
33861@cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
33862
33863All values are given in decimal representation.
33864
33865@smallexample
33866 INT_MIN -2147483648
33867 INT_MAX 2147483647
33868 UINT_MAX 4294967295
33869 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
33870 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
33871 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
33872@end smallexample
33873
33874@node File-I/O Examples
33875@subsection File-I/O Examples
33876@cindex file-i/o examples
33877
33878Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
33879address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
33880
33881@smallexample
33882<- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
33883@emph{request memory read from target}
33884-> @code{m1234,6}
33885<- XXXXXX
33886@emph{return "6 bytes written"}
33887-> @code{F6}
33888@end smallexample
33889
33890Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
33891address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
33892
33893@smallexample
33894<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
33895@emph{request memory write to target}
33896-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
33897@emph{return "6 bytes read"}
33898-> @code{F6}
33899@end smallexample
33900
33901Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
33902file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
33903
33904@smallexample
33905<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
33906-> @code{F-1,9}
33907@end smallexample
33908
33909Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
33910host is called:
33911
33912@smallexample
33913<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
33914-> @code{F-1,4,C}
33915<- @code{T02}
33916@end smallexample
33917
33918Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
33919host is called:
33920
33921@smallexample
33922<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
33923-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
33924<- @code{T02}
33925@end smallexample
33926
33927@node Library List Format
33928@section Library List Format
33929@cindex library list format, remote protocol
33930
33931On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
33932same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
33933@value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
33934operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
33935platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
33936@value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
33937through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
33938packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
33939queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
33940are loaded.
33941
33942The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
33943lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
33944associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
33945which report where the library was loaded in memory.
33946
33947For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
33948library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
33949dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
33950should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
33951section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
33952depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
33953
33954@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
33955library lists. @xref{Expat}.
33956
33957A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
33958offset, looks like this:
33959
33960@smallexample
33961<library-list>
33962 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
33963 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
33964 </library>
33965</library-list>
33966@end smallexample
33967
33968Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
33969allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
33970
33971@smallexample
33972<library-list>
33973 <library name="sharedlib.o">
33974 <section address="0x10000000"/>
33975 <section address="0x20000000"/>
33976 <section address="0x30000000"/>
33977 </library>
33978</library-list>
33979@end smallexample
33980
33981The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
33982
33983@smallexample
33984<!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
33985<!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
33986<!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
33987<!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
33988<!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
33989<!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
33990<!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
33991<!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
33992<!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
33993@end smallexample
33994
33995In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
33996single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
33997section for each library.
33998
33999@node Memory Map Format
34000@section Memory Map Format
34001@cindex memory map format
34002
34003To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
34004memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
34005memory map.
34006
34007The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
34008(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
34009lists memory regions.
34010
34011@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
34012memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
34013
34014The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
34015
34016@smallexample
34017<?xml version="1.0"?>
34018<!DOCTYPE memory-map
34019 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
34020 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
34021<memory-map>
34022 region...
34023</memory-map>
34024@end smallexample
34025
34026Each region can be either:
34027
34028@itemize
34029
34030@item
34031A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
34032bytes from there:
34033
34034@smallexample
34035<memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
34036@end smallexample
34037
34038
34039@item
34040A region of read-only memory:
34041
34042@smallexample
34043<memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
34044@end smallexample
34045
34046
34047@item
34048A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
34049bytes in length:
34050
34051@smallexample
34052<memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
34053 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
34054</memory>
34055@end smallexample
34056
34057@end itemize
34058
34059Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
34060by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
34061packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
34062
34063The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
34064
34065@smallexample
34066<!-- ................................................... -->
34067<!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
34068<!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
34069<!-- .................................... .............. -->
34070<!-- memory-map.dtd -->
34071<!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
34072<!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
34073<!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
34074<!ELEMENT memory (property)>
34075<!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
34076 and its type, or device. -->
34077<!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
34078 start CDATA #REQUIRED
34079 length CDATA #REQUIRED
34080 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
34081<!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
34082<!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
34083<!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
34084@end smallexample
34085
34086@node Thread List Format
34087@section Thread List Format
34088@cindex thread list format
34089
34090To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
34091@value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
34092(@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
34093the following structure:
34094
34095@smallexample
34096<?xml version="1.0"?>
34097<threads>
34098 <thread id="id" core="0">
34099 ... description ...
34100 </thread>
34101</threads>
34102@end smallexample
34103
34104Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
34105identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
34106@samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
34107the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
34108element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
34109
34110@include agentexpr.texi
34111
34112@node Trace File Format
34113@appendix Trace File Format
34114@cindex trace file format
34115
34116The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
34117section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
34118
34119The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
34120@code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
34121while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
34122in the future.
34123
34124The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
34125separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
34126variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
34127as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
34128ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
34129of this section.
34130
34131@c FIXME add some specific types of data
34132
34133The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
34134Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
34135four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
34136the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
34137character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
34138state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
34139hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
34140endianness.
34141
34142@c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
34143
34144@table @code
34145@item R @var{bytes}
34146Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
34147@code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
34148actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
34149hexadecimal encoding.
34150
34151@item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
34152Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
34153address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
34154@var{length} bytes.
34155
34156@item V @var{number} @var{value}
34157Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
34158@var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
34159
34160@end table
34161
34162Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
34163of blocks.
34164
34165@node Target Descriptions
34166@appendix Target Descriptions
34167@cindex target descriptions
34168
34169@strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
34170and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
34171The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
34172
34173One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
34174is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
34175architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
34176a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
34177and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
34178architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
34179vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
34180
34181@itemize @bullet
34182@item
34183With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
34184the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
34185@item
34186Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
34187audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
34188variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
34189@item
34190When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
34191at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
34192@command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
34193@end itemize
34194
34195To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
34196target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
34197actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
34198processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
34199descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
34200
34201@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
34202target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
34203
34204@menu
34205* Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
34206* Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
34207* Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
34208 descriptions.
34209* Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
34210@end menu
34211
34212@node Retrieving Descriptions
34213@section Retrieving Descriptions
34214
34215Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
34216specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
34217description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
34218protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
34219qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
34220@samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
34221XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
34222Format}.
34223
34224Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
34225If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
34226specify a file are:
34227
34228@table @code
34229@cindex set tdesc filename
34230@item set tdesc filename @var{path}
34231Read the target description from @var{path}.
34232
34233@cindex unset tdesc filename
34234@item unset tdesc filename
34235Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
34236will use the description supplied by the current target.
34237
34238@cindex show tdesc filename
34239@item show tdesc filename
34240Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
34241@end table
34242
34243
34244@node Target Description Format
34245@section Target Description Format
34246@cindex target descriptions, XML format
34247
34248A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
34249document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
34250the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
34251means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
34252check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
34253However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
34254their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
34255
34256Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
34257and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
34258sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
34259@value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
34260target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
34261
34262Here is a simple target description:
34263
34264@smallexample
34265<target version="1.0">
34266 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
34267</target>
34268@end smallexample
34269
34270@noindent
34271This minimal description only says that the target uses
34272the x86-64 architecture.
34273
34274A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
34275optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
34276are explained further below.
34277
34278@smallexample
34279<?xml version="1.0"?>
34280<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
34281<target version="1.0">
34282 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
34283 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
34284 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
34285 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
34286</target>
34287@end smallexample
34288
34289@noindent
34290The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
34291breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
34292declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
34293(@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
34294useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
34295@samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
34296including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
34297revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
34298the version mismatch.
34299
34300@subsection Inclusion
34301@cindex target descriptions, inclusion
34302@cindex XInclude
34303@ifnotinfo
34304@cindex <xi:include>
34305@end ifnotinfo
34306
34307It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
34308several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
34309share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
34310divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
34311the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
34312
34313@smallexample
34314<xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
34315@end smallexample
34316
34317@noindent
34318When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
34319the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
34320the contents of that document. If the current description was read
34321using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
34322@var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
34323current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
34324@var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
34325original description.
34326
34327@subsection Architecture
34328@cindex <architecture>
34329
34330An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
34331
34332@smallexample
34333 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
34334@end smallexample
34335
34336@var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
34337@code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
34338
34339@subsection OS ABI
34340@cindex @code{<osabi>}
34341
34342This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
34343Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
34344
34345An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
34346
34347@smallexample
34348 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
34349@end smallexample
34350
34351@var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
34352@w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
34353
34354@subsection Compatible Architecture
34355@cindex @code{<compatible>}
34356
34357This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
34358Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
34359
34360A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
34361
34362@smallexample
34363 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
34364@end smallexample
34365
34366@var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
34367@code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
34368
34369A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
34370is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
34371given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
34372Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
34373or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
34374in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
34375capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
34376
34377@smallexample
34378 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
34379 <compatible>spu</compatible>
34380@end smallexample
34381
34382@subsection Features
34383@cindex <feature>
34384
34385Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
34386system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
34387registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
34388has this form:
34389
34390@smallexample
34391<feature name="@var{name}">
34392 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
34393 @var{reg}@dots{}
34394</feature>
34395@end smallexample
34396
34397@noindent
34398Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
34399of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
34400knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
34401should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
34402
34403@subsection Types
34404
34405Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
34406interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
34407but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
34408Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
34409Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
34410
34411Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
34412a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
34413Types must be defined before they are used.
34414
34415@cindex <vector>
34416Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
34417of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
34418specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
34419@var{count}:
34420
34421@smallexample
34422<vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
34423@end smallexample
34424
34425@cindex <union>
34426If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
34427with a union type containing the useful representations. The
34428@samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
34429each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
34430
34431@smallexample
34432<union id="@var{id}">
34433 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
34434 @dots{}
34435</union>
34436@end smallexample
34437
34438@cindex <struct>
34439If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
34440it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
34441element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
34442or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
34443its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
34444explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
34445integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
34446equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
34447
34448@smallexample
34449<struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
34450 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
34451 @dots{}
34452</struct>
34453@end smallexample
34454
34455If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
34456explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
34457
34458@smallexample
34459<struct id="@var{id}">
34460 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
34461 @dots{}
34462</struct>
34463@end smallexample
34464
34465@cindex <flags>
34466If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
34467a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
34468and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
34469@var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
34470are supported.
34471
34472@smallexample
34473<flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
34474 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
34475 @dots{}
34476</flags>
34477@end smallexample
34478
34479@subsection Registers
34480@cindex <reg>
34481
34482Each register is represented as an element with this form:
34483
34484@smallexample
34485<reg name="@var{name}"
34486 bitsize="@var{size}"
34487 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
34488 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
34489 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
34490 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
34491@end smallexample
34492
34493@noindent
34494The components are as follows:
34495
34496@table @var
34497
34498@item name
34499The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
34500
34501@item bitsize
34502The register's size, in bits.
34503
34504@item regnum
34505The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
34506than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
34507a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
34508defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
34509the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
34510packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
34511in order of increasing register number.
34512
34513@item save-restore
34514Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
34515calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
34516@code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
34517some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
34518ABI.
34519
34520@item type
34521The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
34522defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
34523and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
34524for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
34525architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
34526@var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
34527
34528@item group
34529The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
34530be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
34531@var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
34532in @code{info registers}.
34533
34534@end table
34535
34536@node Predefined Target Types
34537@section Predefined Target Types
34538@cindex target descriptions, predefined types
34539
34540Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
34541from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
34542standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
34543types. The currently supported types are:
34544
34545@table @code
34546
34547@item int8
34548@itemx int16
34549@itemx int32
34550@itemx int64
34551@itemx int128
34552Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
34553
34554@item uint8
34555@itemx uint16
34556@itemx uint32
34557@itemx uint64
34558@itemx uint128
34559Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
34560
34561@item code_ptr
34562@itemx data_ptr
34563Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
34564any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
34565pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
34566address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
34567may be marked as data pointers.
34568
34569@item ieee_single
34570Single precision IEEE floating point.
34571
34572@item ieee_double
34573Double precision IEEE floating point.
34574
34575@item arm_fpa_ext
34576The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
34577
34578@item i387_ext
34579The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
34580
34581@item i386_eflags
3458232bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
34583
34584@item i386_mxcsr
3458532bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
34586
34587@end table
34588
34589@node Standard Target Features
34590@section Standard Target Features
34591@cindex target descriptions, standard features
34592
34593A target description must contain either no registers or all the
34594target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
34595@value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
34596the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
34597default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
34598described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
34599can recognize them.
34600
34601This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
34602which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
34603with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
34604if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
34605feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
34606description. You can add additional registers to any of the
34607standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
34608they were added to an unrecognized feature.
34609
34610This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
34611Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
34612@value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
34613
34614Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
34615company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
34616architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
34617containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
34618
34619The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
34620of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
34621registers using the capitalization used in the description.
34622
34623@menu
34624* ARM Features::
34625* i386 Features::
34626* MIPS Features::
34627* M68K Features::
34628* PowerPC Features::
34629@end menu
34630
34631
34632@node ARM Features
34633@subsection ARM Features
34634@cindex target descriptions, ARM features
34635
34636The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
34637It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
34638@samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
34639
34640The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
34641should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
34642
34643The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
34644it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
34645@samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
34646@samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
34647
34648The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
34649should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
34650they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
34651@value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
34652halves of the double-precision registers.
34653
34654The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
34655need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
34656VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
34657quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
34658If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
34659be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
34660
34661@node i386 Features
34662@subsection i386 Features
34663@cindex target descriptions, i386 features
34664
34665The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
34666targets. It should describe the following registers:
34667
34668@itemize @minus
34669@item
34670@samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
34671@item
34672@samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
34673@item
34674@samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
34675@samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
34676@item
34677@samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
34678@item
34679@samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
34680@samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
34681@end itemize
34682
34683The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
34684
34685The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
34686describe registers:
34687
34688@itemize @minus
34689@item
34690@samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
34691@item
34692@samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
34693@item
34694@samp{mxcsr}
34695@end itemize
34696
34697The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
34698@samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
34699describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
34700
34701@itemize @minus
34702@item
34703@samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
34704@item
34705@samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
34706@item
34707@end itemize
34708
34709The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
34710describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
34711
34712@node MIPS Features
34713@subsection MIPS Features
34714@cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
34715
34716The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
34717It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
34718@samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
34719on the target.
34720
34721The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
34722contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
34723registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
34724
34725The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
34726it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
34727contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
34728@samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
34729
34730The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
34731contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
34732Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
34733
34734@node M68K Features
34735@subsection M68K Features
34736@cindex target descriptions, M68K features
34737
34738@table @code
34739@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
34740@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
34741@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
34742One of those features must be always present.
34743The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
34744used. The feature that is present should contain registers
34745@samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
34746@samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
34747
34748@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
34749This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
34750@samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
34751@samp{fpiaddr}.
34752@end table
34753
34754@node PowerPC Features
34755@subsection PowerPC Features
34756@cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
34757
34758The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
34759targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
34760@samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
34761@samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
34762
34763The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
34764contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
34765
34766The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
34767contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
34768and @samp{vrsave}.
34769
34770The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
34771contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
34772will combine these registers with the floating point registers
34773(@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
34774through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
34775through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
34776
34777The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
34778contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
34779@samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
34780@samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
34781@samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
34782these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
34783user.
34784
34785@node Operating System Information
34786@appendix Operating System Information
34787@cindex operating system information
34788
34789@menu
34790* Process list::
34791@end menu
34792
34793Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
34794the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
34795processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
34796mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
34797target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
34798on a different aspect of target.
34799
34800Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
34801remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
34802read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
34803the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
34804
34805@node Process list
34806@appendixsection Process list
34807@cindex operating system information, process list
34808
34809When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
34810@samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
34811an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
34812@file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
34813
34814An example document is:
34815
34816@smallexample
34817<?xml version="1.0"?>
34818<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
34819<osdata type="processes">
34820 <item>
34821 <column name="pid">1</column>
34822 <column name="user">root</column>
34823 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
34824 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
34825 </item>
34826</osdata>
34827@end smallexample
34828
34829Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
34830of that column should identify the process on the target. The
34831@samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
34832displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
34833should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
34834is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
34835which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
34836
34837@include gpl.texi
34838
34839@raisesections
34840@include fdl.texi
34841@lowersections
34842
34843@node Index
34844@unnumbered Index
34845
34846@printindex cp
34847
34848@tex
34849% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
34850% meantime:
34851\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
34852\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
34853\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
34854\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
34855\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
34856\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
34857\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
34858\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
34859\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
34860\page\colophon
34861% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
34862@end tex
34863
34864@bye
This page took 0.154417 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.